BE AEROSPACE INC
10-K, 1998-05-29
PUBLIC BLDG & RELATED FURNITURE
Previous: MUNICIPAL INCOME OPPORTUNITIES TRUST III/MA, NSAR-B, 1998-05-29
Next: OPPENHEIMER GLOBAL GROWTH & INCOME FUND, NSAR-A, 1998-05-29



<PAGE>   1
                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

                                    FORM 10-K


           [ X ] ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE
                         SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
                   For the fiscal year ended February 28, 1998

            [ ] TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF
                       THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

                           Commission File No. 0-18348

                               BE AEROSPACE, INC.
             (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
<S>                                                                             <C>
DELAWARE                                                                                      06-1209796
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)                    (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)

1400 CORPORATE CENTER WAY, WELLINGTON, FLORIDA                                                 33414
(Address of principal executive offices)                                                     (Zip Code)
</TABLE>

(561) 791-5000
(Registrant's telephone number, including area code)

        Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act: None

           Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

                          Common Stock, $.01 Par Value

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant: (1) has filed all reports
required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Act of 1934 during
the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was
required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing
requirements for the past 90 days: Yes[X] No[  ].

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405
of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the
best of the registrant's knowledge, in definitive proxy or information
statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any
amendment to this Form 10-K.[ ]

The aggregate market value of the registrant's voting stock held by
non-affiliates was approximately $696,357,028 on May 20, 1998 based on the
closing sales price of the registrant's Common Stock as reported on the Nasdaq
National Market as of such date.

The number of shares of the registrant's Common Stock, $.01 par value,
outstanding as of May 20, 1998 was 23,192,600 shares.

                       DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

Those sections of the Registrant's Proxy Statement to be filed with the
Commission in connection with its 1998 Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held
on August 5, 1998, described in Part III hereof, are incorporated by reference
in this report.

                                       1
<PAGE>   2
                                      INDEX

                                     PART I

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
<S>             <C>                                                                                              <C>
ITEM 1.         Business..........................................................................................3

ITEM 2.         Properties.......................................................................................15

ITEM 3.         Legal Proceedings................................................................................17

ITEM 4.         Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders..............................................17

                Executive Officers of the Registrant.............................................................18

                                     PART II

ITEM 5.         Market for the Registrant's Common Equity and Related Stockholder
                Matters..........................................................................................21

ITEM 6.         Selected Financial Data..........................................................................22

ITEM 7.         Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and
                Results of Operations............................................................................24

ITEM 8.         Financial Statements and Supplementary Data......................................................29

ITEM 9.         Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and
                Financial Disclosure.............................................................................29

                                    PART III

ITEM 10.        Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant...............................................30

ITEM 11.        Executive Compensation...........................................................................30

ITEM 12.        Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management...................................30

ITEM 13.        Certain Relationships and Related Transactions...................................................30

                                     PART IV

ITEM 14.        Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules, and Reports on Form 8-K.................................30

                Index to Consolidated Financial Statements and Schedule.........................................F-1
</TABLE>

                                       2
<PAGE>   3
                                     PART I

This Item 1 "Business" includes forward-looking statements which involve risks
and uncertainties. The Company's actual experience may differ materially from
that discussed in such statements. Factors that might cause such a difference
include, but are not limited to, those discussed in "Risk Factors" contained in
Exhibit 99.1 hereto, as well as future events that have the effect of reducing
the Company's operating income and available cash balances, such as unexpected
operating losses or delays in the integration of the Company's acquired
businesses, the delivery of the Company's MDDS interactive video system,
customer delivery requirements, new or expected refurbishments, or cash
expenditures related to possible future acquisitions.

ITEM 1.  BUSINESS

INTRODUCTION

        B/E Aerospace, Inc. ("B/E" or the "Company") is the world's largest
manufacturer of interior products for commercial and general aviation aircraft
cabins, serving virtually all major airlines and commercial and general aviation
original equipment manufacturers with a broad line of products, including a full
range of aircraft seating products, a full line of food and beverage preparation
and storage equipment, cabin interior structures, oxygen delivery systems, and
in-flight entertainment systems. In addition, B/E provides upgrade, maintenance
and repair services for the products that it manufactures as well as for those
supplied by other manufacturers.

        On April 13, 1998, the Company acquired Puritan Bennett Aero Systems Co.
("PBASCO"). PBASCO is the leading manufacturer of commercial aircraft oxygen
delivery systems and a leading manufacturer of passenger service unit components
and systems, and is a major supplier of air valves, overhead lights and
switches, crew masks and protective breathing devices for both commercial and
general aviation aircraft.

        On April 21, 1998, the Company acquired substantially all of the assets
and assumed certain liabilities of Aircraft Modular Products ("AMP"). AMP is the
leading manufacturer of cabin interior products for general aviation (business
jet) and commercial type VIP aircraft, providing a broad line of products,
including seating, side walls, bulkheads, credenzas, closets, galley structures,
lavatories, tables, and sofas, along with related spare parts.

        Management believes that the Company has leading global market positions
in each of its major product categories. B/E is the largest manufacturer of
aircraft seating products in the world, offering an extensive line of commercial
aircraft first class, business class, tourist class and commuter seats and a
complete line of general aviation seating products. The Company is also the
world's largest manufacturer of equipment for the preparation and preservation
of food and beverages on aircraft, including a wide selection of coffee and
beverage makers, water boilers, liquid containers, ovens, and refrigeration
equipment. In addition, the Company manufacturers a broad range of interior
structures, including galleys, lavatories, sidewalls, credenzas, and closets.
The Company is also a worldwide leader in the manufacturer of oxygen delivery
systems, passenger service units, air valves, lighting and switches, and is a
leading manufacturer of passenger entertainment and service systems, including
passenger control systems and individual-passenger in-flight entertainment
systems.

        B/E's substantial installed base provides significant ongoing revenues
from replacements, upgrades, repairs and spare parts. Approximately 61% of B/E's
revenues for the year ended February 28, 1998 were derived from refurbishment,
retrofit and upgrade orders.

        In the late 1980s and early 1990s, the airline industry suffered a
significant downturn, which resulted in a deferral of cabin interior maintenance
expenditures. Since early 1994, the airlines have experienced a turnaround in
operating results, leading the domestic airline industry to record operating
earnings during calendar years 1995 through 1997. Deterioration of cabin
interior product functionality and aesthetics occurred within the commercial
airline fleets during the industry downturn because of maintenance deferrals.
Since the turnaround began, the airlines have experienced greater utilization
resulting from higher load factors, which has encouraged airlines to increase
spending on refurbishments and upgrades. The Company believes that it is well
positioned to benefit over the next several years from the airlines'
dramatically improved financial condition and liquidity and the need to
refurbish, retrofit and upgrade cabin interiors. A significant portion of the
Company's recent growth in backlog, revenues and operating earnings has been
from refurbishment, retrofit and upgrade programs, and the Company is currently
experiencing a high level of new order quote activity related to such programs.

                                       3
<PAGE>   4
        Airlines have recently been purchasing a significant number of new
aircraft in part due to current high load factors and the projected growth in
worldwide air travel. According to the "Current Market Outlook" published by the
Boeing Commercial Airplane Group in 1997 (the "Boeing Report"), worldwide air
travel is projected to increase by 75% by calendar 2006, and the worldwide fleet
of commercial passenger aircraft is projected to expand from approximately
10,300 at the end of 1996 to approximately 15,300 by the end of 2006 and to more
than 21,200 by 2016. In 1997, Boeing shipped 375 aircraft versus 218 in 1996. In
addition, Boeing has stated plans to ship 550 aircraft in each of calendar years
1998 and 1999. Furthermore, according to the July 1997 "Airline Monitor", the
percentage of new Boeing aircraft deliveries projected to be widebody aircraft
for 1997 through 2001 is 39% as compared to 33% for the five year period ended
December 31, 1996. This shift toward widebody aircraft is significant to the
Company since these aircraft require as much as seven times the dollar value of
the type of products manufactured by the Company as those used in narrowbody
aircraft.

INDUSTRY OVERVIEW

   The commercial and general aviation aircraft cabin interior products industry
encompasses a broad range of products and services, including not only aircraft
seating products, passenger entertainment and service systems, food and beverage
preparation and storage systems, and oxygen delivery systems, but also
lavatories, side walls, overhead bins, closets, lighting systems and evacuation
equipment. Management estimates that the industry had sales in excess of $1.5
billion during fiscal 1998.

   Historically, revenues in the commercial aircraft cabin interior products
industry have been derived from five sources: (i) refurbishment and retrofit
programs in which airlines purchase new components to substantially overhaul the
interiors of aircraft already in service; (ii) refurbishment programs in which
the interior components of the aircraft are substantially overhauled to improve
the appearance and functionality; (iii) new installation programs to outfit
newly delivered aircraft; (iv) spare parts; and (v) equipment to upgrade the
functionality or appearance of the aircraft interior. The retrofit and
refurbishment cycles for commercial aircraft cabin interior products differ by
product category.

   Historically, revenues in the general aviation cabin interior products
industry have been derived from four sources: (i) retrofit and refurbishment
programs in which the interior components of the aircraft are substantially
overhauled to improve the appearance and functionality; (ii) new installation
programs to outfit newly delivered aircraft; (iii) spare parts; and (iv)
equipment to upgrade the functionality or appearance of the aircraft interior.

The various product categories currently manufactured by the Company include:

- -    Aircraft Seats. This is the largest single product category in the industry
     and includes first class, business class, tourist class and commuter seats.
     Management estimates that the aggregate size of the worldwide aircraft seat
     market (including spare parts) during fiscal 1998 was in excess of $530
     million. Approximately ten companies worldwide, including the Company,
     supply aircraft seats, although the Company (which has an approximately 50%
     market share) and two competitors share approximately 90% of the market.

- -    Passenger Entertainment and Service Systems ("PESS"). This product category
     includes individual seat video systems, overhead video projection systems,
     audio distribution systems, passenger control units ("PCUs") and related
     wiring and harness assemblies and sophisticated interactive
     telecommunications and entertainment systems. Management estimates that the
     aggregate size of the worldwide PESS market was approximately $325 million
     during fiscal 1998. Industry sources expect the PESS market to increase
     substantially in the near term as individual-passenger entertainment
     systems become standard in-flight entertainment equipment in first,
     business and tourist classes on widebody aircraft, and with the further
     development of LiveTV(TM) on many narrowbody aircraft. PESS products are
     currently supplied by approximately five companies worldwide. The Company
     has a market share of approximately 30% in individual-passenger in-flight
     entertainment systems, determined on the basis of installed units as of
     February 28, 1998.

- -    Interior Systems Products. This product category includes interior systems
     for both narrowbody and widebody commercial aircraft and general aviation /
     VIP aircraft, including a wide selection of coffee and beverage

                                       4
<PAGE>   5
     makers, water boilers, ovens, liquid containers, air chillers, wine coolers
     and other refrigeration equipment, oxygen delivery systems, air valves,
     lighting and switches, and other interior systems components. The Company
     is the only manufacturer with a complete line of interior systems products
     and the only supplier with the capability to fully integrate overhead
     passenger service units with either chemical or gaseous oxygen equipment.

- -    General Aviation and VIP Products. The Company entered this line of
     business with its acquisition of AMP in April 1998. By combining AMP's
     substantial presence in the general aviation and VIP aircraft cabin
     interior products industry with that of PBASCO, B/E has become the
     industry's leading manufacturer with a broad product line, including a
     complete line of seating products, sidewalls, bulkheads, credenzas,
     closets, galley structures, lavatories, tables, sofas, oxygen delivery
     systems, air valves and lighting. B/E has the capability to provide
     complete interior packages, including all design services, all interior
     components and program management services for executive aircraft
     interiors. B/E is the preferred supplier of seating products of essentially
     every general aviation airframe manufacturer.

   Through February 28, 1998, the Company operated primarily in the commercial
aircraft cabin interior products segment of the commercial airlines supplier
industry. Revenues for similar classes of products or services within this
business segment for the fiscal years ended February 1998, 1997 and 1996 are
presented below:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                           Fiscal Year
                                                      (dollars in millions)
                                                   1998        1997        1996
                                                   ----        ----        ----
<S>                                               <C>         <C>         <C>
Seating products ..........................        $252        $217        $ 97
Interior systems products .................         126         101          79
Passenger entertainment and service systems          81          52          33
Services ..................................          29          42          23
                                                   ----        ----        ----
Total revenues ............................        $488        $412        $232
                                                   ====        ====        ====
</TABLE>


RECENT INDUSTRY CONDITIONS

   The Company's principal customers are the world's commercial airlines. The
airlines, particularly the U.S. carriers, incurred record losses during the
three-year period ended December 31, 1993. The losses incurred during the
downturn seriously impaired airline balance sheets and negatively influenced
airline purchasing decisions with respect to both new aircraft and refurbishment
programs. The domestic airlines in large part returned to profitable operations
during calendar year 1994 have achieved record operating earnings during
calendar years 1995 through 1997 and have substantially restored their balance
sheets since then through cash generated from operations and debt and equity
placements. This improvement in the airlines' profitability and liquidity has,
in turn, led to an increase in refurbishment and retrofit programs, which
coupled with spares revenues, generated approximately 61% of the Company's
revenues in fiscal 1998. Further, throughout calendar year 1997, the aircraft
manufacturers continued to experience a significant increase in new aircraft
orders. Among those factors expected to affect the cabin interior products
industry are the following:

- -    Large Existing Installed Base. According to the Boeing Report, the world
     commercial passenger aircraft fleet, as of the end of 1996, consisted of
     approximately 10,300 aircraft, including 3,000 aircraft with fewer than 120
     seats, 4,511 aircraft with between 120 and 240 seats and 2,760 aircraft
     with more than 240 seats. Based on such fleet numbers, management estimates
     that the total worldwide installed base of commercial aircraft cabin
     interior products, valued at replacement prices, was approximately $9.5
     billion at the end of 1997. This existing installed base will generate
     continued retrofit, refurbishment and spare parts revenue, particularly in
     light of the deterioration of existing interior cabin functionality and
     aesthetics resulting from the airlines' deferral of refurbishment programs
     in recent years.

- -    Expanding Worldwide Fleet. Worldwide air traffic has grown in every year
     since 1946 (except in 1990) and, according to the Boeing Report, is
     projected to grow at a compounded average rate of approximately five
     percent per year through 2016, increasing annual revenue passenger miles
     from approximately 1.7 trillion in 1996 to approximately 4.4 trillion by
     2016. According to the Boeing Report, the worldwide fleet of commercial
     passenger aircraft is projected to expand from approximately 10,300 at the
     end of 1996 to approximately 15,300 by 2006 and 21,200 by 2016. In 1997,
     Boeing shipped 375 aircraft versus 218 in 1996. In addition,

                                       5
<PAGE>   6
     Boeing has stated plans to ship 550 aircraft in each of calendar years 1998
     and 1999. According to Airbus Industrie "Global Market Forecast" published
     in March 1997 (the "Airbus Industrie Report"), the worldwide installed seat
     base, which management considers to be a good indicator for potential
     growth in the aircraft cabin interior products industry, is expected to
     increase from approximately 1.7 million passenger seats at the end of 1996
     to approximately 4.0 million passenger seats at the end of 2016. The
     expanding worldwide fleet will generate additional revenues from new
     installation programs, and the increase in the size of the installed base
     will generate additional and recurring retrofit, refurbishment and spare
     parts revenue. According to industry sources, the worldwide fleet of
     general aviation and VIP commercial type jets at the end of calendar 1997
     consisted of more than 10,000 aircraft, of which approximately two-thirds
     were located domestically. The average age of the domestic fleet is
     approximately 15 years, which should provide the Company a continuing large
     market for its products and services as business jet owners move toward the
     lighter weight, more modern, FAA-compliant products offered by the Company.
     The general aviation and VIP airframe manufacturers are experiencing a
     surge in new aircraft deliveries similar to that occurring in the
     commercial aircraft industry. According to industry sources, executive
     aircraft deliveries amounted to 222 units in calendar 1994 and were
     approximately 348 in calendar 1997, an increase of 57%. Industry sources
     indicate that executive aircraft deliveries are expected to be
     approximately 450 in calendar 1998 and should reach 550 per year by the
     year 2000. The Company believes it is well positioned to meet the cabin
     interior product requirements for general aviation and VIP aircraft arising
     from both the retrofit and upgrade of cabin interiors of the existing
     10,000 general aviation / VIP aircraft fleet and the anticipated increase
     in new aircraft deliveries over the next several years.

- -    Widebody Aircraft Orders. Orders for widebody, long-haul aircraft
     constitute an increasing share of total new airframe orders. According to
     the July 1997 "Airline Monitor", the percentage of Boeing aircraft
     deliveries projected to be widebody aircraft for 1997 through 2001 is 39%,
     as compared to 33% for the three-year period ended December 31, 1995.
     Widebody aircraft currently carry up to three times the number of seats as
     narrowbody aircraft, and because of multiple classes of service, including
     large first class and business class configurations, the Company's average
     revenue per seat on widebody aircraft is significantly higher. Aircraft
     crews on widebody aircraft may make and serve between 300 and 900 meals and
     may brew and serve more than 2,000 cups of coffee on a single flight. As a
     result, widebody aircraft may require as much as seven times the dollar
     value of cabin interior products as narrowbody aircraft, as well as
     products which are technically more sophisticated and typically more
     expensive. Further, individual-passenger in-flight entertainment systems
     are installed principally on widebody aircraft. Airlines are increasingly
     demanding such systems for long-haul flights to attract and retain
     customers, especially as the quality of in-flight entertainment has become
     a differentiating factor in passengers' airline selection decisions. Such
     systems also provide the airlines with the opportunity to increase revenues
     per passenger mile, without raising ticket prices, by charging individually
     for services used. For these reasons, management believes that in the
     future, interactive in-flight entertainment systems will be installed on
     essentially all widebody aircraft and, with the further development of live
     broadcast in-flight television, many narrowbody planes.

- -    New Product Development. The commercial and general aviation aircraft cabin
     interior products industries are engaged in intensive development and
     marketing efforts for a number of new products, including full electric
     "sleeper" seats, convertible seats, interactive individual-passenger
     entertainment systems, live broadcast television, advanced
     telecommunications equipment, crew masks, protective breathing equipment,
     oxygen generating systems, and new galley equipment. Interactive video
     technology provides passengers with a wide range of computer capabilities,
     which are designed to accept information generated by the passenger and
     communicate such information to the cabin crew for assisting passengers and
     crew with food service selection, the purchase of duty-free goods,
     information in connection with arrival time, connecting flights, gate and
     other passenger information, as well as facilitate effective on-board
     inventory control and provide individual entertainment. LiveTV(TM), a new
     product line being developed by a joint venture between the Company and
     Harris Corporation, will provide live broadcast television via satellite to
     passenger aircraft, allowing passengers the capability to view up to 48
     different channels of television service. New cabin interior products will
     generate new installation and retrofit revenues as well as service revenues
     from equipment maintenance, inspection and repair.

- -    Growing Upgrade, Maintenance, Inspection and Repair Service Markets.
     Historically, the airlines have relied on their airframe and engine
     mechanics to repair or replace cabin interior products that have become

                                       6
<PAGE>   7
     damaged or otherwise non-functional. As cabin interior product
     configurations have become increasingly sophisticated and the airline
     industry increasingly competitive, the airlines have begun to outsource
     such services to increase productivity and reduce costs and overhead.
     Outsourced services include product upgrades (such as the installation of a
     telecommunications module or individual-passenger entertainment unit in an
     aircraft seat not originally designed to accommodate such equipment), cabin
     interior product maintenance and inspection, as well as other repair
     services.

COMPETITIVE STRENGTHS AND BUSINESS STRATEGY

   The Company believes that it has a strong competitive position attributable
to a number of factors including the following:

- -    Leading Market Share and Significant Installed Base. Management believes
     that the Company has achieved a leading global market position in each of
     its major product categories with market shares, based upon industry
     sources, of approximately 50% in commercial aircraft seats, 90% in coffee
     makers, 60% in executive aircraft seats, 90% in refrigeration equipment,
     90% in air valves, 50% in oxygen delivery systems, 50% in ovens, and 30% in
     individual-passenger in-flight entertainment systems. The Company believes
     these market shares provide it with significant competitive advantages in
     serving its customers, including economies of scale and the ability to
     commit greater product development, global product support and marketing
     resources. Furthermore, because of economies of scale, in part attributable
     to its large market shares and its approximate $3.7 billion installed base
     of commercial aircraft cabin interior equipment (valued at replacement
     prices as of February 28, 1998), the Company believes it is among the
     lowest-cost producers in the cabin interior products industry. The Company
     also believes that its large installed base provides B/E with a significant
     advantage over competitors in obtaining orders for retrofit and
     refurbishment programs. Finally, B/E is well positioned to obtain ongoing
     upgrade, maintenance, inspection and repair service contracts due to the
     breadth of its product line and the size of its installed base.

- -    Broadest Product Line in the Industry. Management believes the Company
     offers the broadest and most technologically advanced line of products for
     the cabin interiors of commercial aircraft. With an established reputation
     for quality, service and product innovation, the Company enjoys broad
     recognition among the world's commercial airlines. The Company maintains a
     constant dialogue with a wide array of existing and potential customers,
     enabling it to become aware of emerging industry trends and needs and
     thereby play a leading role in product development. The Company has
     continued to expand its product line, believing that the airline industry
     increasingly will seek an integrated approach to the development, testing
     and sourcing of the aircraft's cabin interior.

- -    Technological Leadership/New Product Development. Management believes that
     the Company is a technological leader in its industry, with the largest R&D
     organization in the industry, currently comprised of 500 engineers. The
     Company believes that its R&D effort and its on-site engineers at both the
     airlines and airframe manufacturers enable B/E to consistently introduce
     innovative products and thereby gain early entrant advantages and
     substantial market shares. Examples of such product development include:
     the introduction of several premium and main cabin class seats, which the
     Company believes provide greater comfort and are lighter in weight as a
     result of their ergonomic design and pre-engineered individual-passenger
     comfort features; the Company's family of in-flight entertainment systems,
     which it believes to be superior to existing operational systems in terms
     of performance, reliability, weight, heat generation and flexibility to
     adapt to changing technology; a cappuccino/espresso maker; a quick-chill
     wine cooling system; and a constant-pressure, steam cooking oven, which the
     Company believes substantially improves the appearance, aroma and taste of
     airline food.

- -    Proven Track Record of Integration. The Company has demonstrated the
     ability to make strategic acquisitions and successfully integrate such
     acquired businesses by identifying opportunities to consolidate
     engineering, manufacturing and marketing activities, as well as
     rationalizing product lines. The Company has purchased 12 businesses over
     the last nine years, for an aggregate purchase price of approximately $489
     million. Since 1989, the Company has integrated its acquisitions by
     reducing the number of operating facilities acquired from 20 to nine and
     substantially improving productivity, efficiency and quality at the
     acquired businesses.

                                       7
<PAGE>   8
GROWTH OPPORTUNITIES

   B/E believes that it is benefiting from four major growth trends.

- -    Increase in Refurbishment and Upgrade Orders. B/E's substantial installed
     base provides significant ongoing revenues from replacements, upgrades,
     repairs and spare parts. Approximately 61% of B/E's revenues for the year
     ended February 28, 1998 were derived from refurbishment and upgrade orders.
     In the late 1980s and early 1990s, the airline industry suffered a
     significant downturn, which resulted in a deferral of cabin interior
     maintenance expenditures. Since early 1994, the airlines have experienced a
     turnaround in operating results, leading the domestic airline industry to
     record operating earnings during 1995 and 1997. Deterioration of cabin
     interior product functionality and aesthetics occurred within the
     commercial airline fleets during the industry downturn because of
     maintenance deferrals. Since the turnaround began, the airlines have
     experienced greater utilization resulting from higher load factors, which
     has encouraged airlines to increase spending on refurbishments and
     upgrades. The Company believes that it is well positioned to benefit over
     the next several years as a result of the airlines' dramatically improved
     financial condition and liquidity and the need to refurbish and upgrade
     cabin interiors. The Company's recent growth in backlog, revenues and
     operating earnings has been primarily from refurbishment and upgrade
     programs, and the Company is currently experiencing a high level of new
     order quote activity related to such programs.

- -    Expansion of Worldwide Fleet and Shift Toward Widebody Aircraft. Airlines
     have recently purchased a significant number of new aircraft due in part to
     current high load factors and the projected growth in worldwide air travel.
     According to the Boeing Report, worldwide air travel is projected to
     increase by 75% by calendar 2006 and the worldwide fleet of commercial
     passenger aircraft is projected to expand from approximately 10,300 at the
     end of 1996 to approximately 15,300 by the end of 2006 and to more than
     21,200 by 2016. Related growth in aircraft interior product shipments
     associated with new aircraft deliveries began during calendar 1996. In
     1997, Boeing shipped 375 aircraft versus 218 in 1996. In addition, Boeing
     has stated plans to ship 550 aircraft in each of calendar years 1998 and
     1999. Furthermore, according to the July 1997 "Airline Monitor", the
     percentage of new Boeing aircraft deliveries projected to be widebody
     aircraft for 1997 through 2001 is 39% as compared to 33% for the five-year
     period ended December 31, 1996. This shift toward widebody aircraft is
     significant to the Company since these aircraft require as much as seven
     times the dollar value of cabin interior products as narrowbody aircraft,
     including substantially more seats, galley equipment and in-flight
     entertainment products.

- -    General Aviation and VIP Aircraft Fleet Expansion and Related Retrofit
     Opportunities. General aviation and VIP airframe manufacturers are
     experiencing a surge in new aircraft deliveries similar to that occurring
     in the commercial aircraft industry. According to industry sources,
     executive aircraft deliveries amounted to 222 units in calendar 1994 and
     were approximately 348 in calendar 1997, an increase of 57%. Industry
     sources indicate that executive aircraft deliveries are expected to be
     approximately 450 in calendar 1998 and should reach 550 per year by the
     year 2000. Several new aircraft models including the Visionaire Vantage,
     Cessna Citation Excel, the Boeing Business Jet, Global Express and Airbus
     Business Jet have been, or will be introduced over the next several years.
     The overall strength of the global economy, advances in engine and avionics
     and emergence of fractional ownership of executive aircraft are all
     important growth factors. In addition, the general aviation and VIP
     aircraft fleet consists of approximately 10,000 aircraft with an average
     age of approximately 15 years. As aircraft age or ownership changes,
     operators retrofit and upgrade the cabin interior, including seats, sofas
     and tables, sidewalls, headliners, structures such as closets, lavatories
     and galleys, and related equipment including lighting and oxygen delivery
     systems. The installed value of a new interior can range from $1 million
     for smaller models to up to $7 million for a long haul aircraft. In
     addition, operators generally reupholster or replace seats every five to
     seven years. Management believes the Company is well positioned to benefit
     from the retrofit opportunities due to (i) the 15-year average age of the
     executive jet fleet; (ii) operators who have historically reupholstered
     their seats are now more inclined to replace these seats with lighter
     weight, more modern and 16g- compliant seating models; and (iii) the
     Company is the only manufacturer with the capability for cabin interior
     design services, a broad product line for essentially all cabin interior
     products and program management services, for true "one-stop shopping."

- -    Emergence of Individual Passenger In-Flight Entertainment Systems. Airlines
     increasingly are demanding individual-passenger in-flight entertainment
     systems in order to attract and retain customers, as the availability of
     such service affects passengers' decisions on airline selection. These
     systems also provide the

                                       8
<PAGE>   9
     airlines with the opportunity to generate increased revenues, without
     raising ticket prices, by charging passengers for the services used. In
     June 1997, the Company announced a joint venture with Harris Corporation to
     develop and deliver live-broadcast television (LiveTV(TM)), to domestic
     narrowbody commercial aircraft. The Company expects that in-flight
     entertainment systems will be one of the fastest growing, and among the
     largest, product categories in the commercial aircraft cabin interior
     products industry.

     The Company has developed a number of individual in-flight entertainment
     systems that are designed to meet the varying technological and price
     specifications of the airlines. The Company's three current systems are:
     (i) the B/E 2000, with an installed base of approximately 28,000 units,
     which is a system that provides non-interactive video programming, (ii) the
     B/E 2000M, with an installed base of approximately 6,000 units, which
     offers similar functionality to the B/E 2000 but can be upgraded to the
     Company's Multimedia Digital Distribution System ("MDDS") product and (iii)
     the MDDS product, which is in its final development stage, is an
     interactive entertainment system with the capacity to provide movies on
     demand, telecommunications, gaming and other services. The Company
     completed the initial development and testing of the MDDS product and
     delivered the first MDDS system to its launch customer, Japan Airlines
     ("JAL"), in April 1998. The Company also completed the engineering
     necessary to enable installation of the MDDS as a line-fit option on Boeing
     aircraft in April 1998.

Business Strategy

     The Company's business strategy is to maintain its leadership position and
best serve its customers by: (i) offering the broadest and most integrated
product line in the industry for both new product sales and follow-on products
and services; (ii) pursuing a worldwide marketing approach focused by airline
and encompassing the Company's entire product line; (iii) pursuing the highest
level of quality in every facet of its operations, from the factory floor to
customer support; (iv) remaining the technological leader in its industry; (v)
enhancing its position in the growing upgrade, maintenance, inspection and
repair services market; and; (vi) pursuing selective strategic acquisitions in
the aircraft cabin interior products industry.

PRODUCTS AND SERVICES

Seating Products

   The Company is the world's leading manufacturer of aircraft seats, offering a
wide selection of first class, business class, tourist class and commuter seats.
A typical seat manufactured and sold by the Company includes the seat frame,
cushions, armrests and tray table, together with a variety of optional features
such as in-flight entertainment systems, oxygen masks and telephones. Management
estimates that the Company has an aggregate installed base as of February 28,
1998 of aircraft seats, valued at replacement prices, of approximately $2
billion comprised of more than 1,000,000 seats.

- -    Tourist Class. The Company is the leading worldwide manufacturer of tourist
     class seats. B/E has designed tourist class seats that incorporate features
     not previously utilized in that class, such as top-mounted passenger
     control units, footrests and improved oxygen systems.

- -    First and Business Classes. Based upon major airlines program selection and
     orders on hand the Company is the leading worldwide manufacturer of premium
     class seats. First class and business class seats are generally larger,
     heavier and more complicated in design and are substantially more expensive
     than tourist class aircraft seats. The Company's first class seats and
     certain of its business class seats are equipped with articulating bottom
     cushion suspension systems, sophisticated hydraulic legrests, lumbar
     massage devices, adjustable thigh support cushions, reading lights,
     adjustable head and neck supports and large tables.

- -    Commuter Seats. The Company is the leading manufacturer of commuter seats
     in both the U.S. and worldwide markets. The Company's Silhouette(TM)
     Composite commuter seats are similar to commercial jet seats in comfort and
     performance, but are lightweight and require minimal maintenance.

- -    Spares. Aircraft seats are exposed to significant stress in the course of
     normal passenger activity, and certain seat parts are particularly
     susceptible to damage from continued use. As a result, a significant market
     exists for spare parts.

                                       9
<PAGE>   10
Passenger Entertainment and Service Systems

   Management estimates that the Company has one of the largest installed bases
of PESS products in the world, which, valued at replacement prices, is
approximately $360 million. The Company has the leading share of the market for
PCUs and related wiring and harness assemblies, and has developed products aimed
at other portions of the PESS market, including individual seat video systems,
advanced multiplexer and hard-wired distribution systems and other products. The
Company believes that it is a market leader in individual-passenger in-flight
entertainment systems and that this product category will be the fastest
growing, and among the largest, product categories in the commercial aircraft
cabin interior products industry in the future.

- -    Individual Passenger Entertainment. The Company has developed a number of
     in-flight entertainment systems designed to meet the technological and
     price specifications of the airlines:

        B/E 2000. The B/E 2000, introduced in 1992, is one of the Company's
        first-generation individual in-flight video systems and offers
        centralized electronic distribution of a limited range of programming.
        Since its introduction, the Company has installed approximately 28,000
        units of the B/E 2000 and earlier generation individual-passenger video
        systems for 10 airlines.

        MDDS Family. The Company has developed a family of next-generation,
        individual-passenger in-flight entertainment products, which includes
        the 2000M and the MDDS:

             B/E 2000M . The B/E 2000M is an in-flight entertainment system that
             offers similar functionality to the B/E 2000 but can be upgraded to
             the Company's fully interactive MDDS. Since its introduction in
             1995, the Company has installed approximately 6,000 units.

             MDDS. B/E's MDDS is a state-of-the-art, fully interactive
             individual-passenger in-flight entertainment system which has the
             capacity to offer numerous movies on demand, telecommunications,
             gaming, Nintendo(TM), Sega(TM) and PC-based games, in-flight
             shopping and, in the future, live television, among other services.
             The Company has completed the initial development and testing of
             the MDDS product and delivered the first MDDS product to its launch
             customer, JAL, in April 1998. The Company also completed the
             engineering necessary to enable installation of the MDDS as a line
             fit option on Boeing aircraft in conjunction with the JAL delivery.

           LiveTV(TM). In June 1997, the Company announced a joint venture with
        Harris Corporation to develop and market a system that will allow
        airline passengers to receive in-flight, live broadcast television
        aboard narrowbody commercial aircraft at each individual-passenger seat.
        The Company controls a 51 percent voting interest in the joint venture.
        B/E will provide its individual-seat video distribution system as its
        part of the overall LiveTV(TM) reception system, while Harris
        Corporation will provide the specialized aircraft antenna and receiver
        system to enable in-the-air reception.

- -    PCUs, Wiring and Harness Assemblies. The Company's PCU product line is the
     broadest in the industry, including over 300 different designs that are
     functionally similar but differ widely due to the style preferences and
     technical requirements of the various airlines. Wiring and harness
     assemblies (which stabilize installed wiring) are sold as a package with
     PCUs and vary as widely as PCU types.

- -    Distribution Systems. The Company has manufactured hard-wired audio (since
     1963) and video distribution systems (since 1992) and is currently the
     principal supplier of such systems to the airline industry. The Company
     also offers frequency division multiplex distribution systems, which
     deliver substantially improved audio performance compared to competitors'
     multiplex systems.

Interior Systems Products

   The Company is the world's largest manufacturer of interior systems products
for both narrowbody and widebody aircraft, offering a wide selection of
structures, coffee and beverage makers, water boilers, liquid containers, ovens,
refrigeration equipment, oxygen delivery systems, passenger service units, air
valves, lighting and switches, and a variety of other interior components.
Management estimates that the Company has an aggregate installed base of such
equipment valued at replacement prices, of approximately $1.2 billion.

                                       10
<PAGE>   11
- -    Coffee Makers. The Company is the leading manufacturer of aircraft coffee
     makers, with the Company's equipment currently installed in virtually every
     type of aircraft for almost every major airline. The Company manufactures a
     broad line of coffee makers, coffee warmers and water boilers including the
     Flash Brew Coffee Maker, with the capability to brew 54 ounces of coffee in
     one minute, a Combi(TM) unit which will both brew coffee and boil water for
     tea while utilizing 25% less electrical power than traditional 5,000 watt
     water boilers, and a recently introduced next-generation coffee maker.

- -    Ovens. The Company is the leading supplier of a broad line of specialized
     ovens, including high-heat efficiency ovens, high-heat convection ovens,
     and warming ovens. The Company's newest offering, the DS-2000 Steam Oven,
     represents a new method of preparing food in-flight by maintaining constant
     temperature and moisture in the food. It addresses the airlines' need to
     provide a wider range of foods than can be prepared by convection ovens.

- -    Refrigeration Equipment. The Company is the worldwide industry leader in
     the design, manufacture, and supply of commercial aircraft refrigeration
     equipment. The Company recently introduced a self-contained wine and
     beverage chiller, the first unit specifically designed to rapidly chill
     wine and beverages on board an aircraft.

- -    Galley Structures. Galley structures are generally custom designed to
     accommodate the unique specifications and features required by a particular
     carrier. Galley structures require intensive design and engineering work
     and are among the most sophisticated and expensive of the aircraft's cabin
     interior products. The Company provides a variety of galley structures,
     closets and class dividers, emphasizing sophisticated and higher
     value-added galleys for widebody aircraft.

- -    Oxygen Delivery Systems. The Company is a leading manufacturer of oxygen
     delivery systems, passenger service units, air valves, lighting and
     switches for both commercial and general aviation aircraft. B/E is the only
     manufacturer with the capability to fully integrate its own manufactured
     components with overhead passenger service units with either chemical or
     gaseous oxygen equipment. The Company's oxygen and passenger service unit
     equipment has been approved for use on all Boeing and Airbus aircraft and
     is also found on essentially all general aviation and VIP aircraft.

 General Aviation

- -    General Aviation and VIP Products. The Company entered this line of
     business with its acquisition of AMP in April 1998. By combining AMP's
     substantial presence in the general aviation and VIP aircraft cabin
     interior products industry with that of PBASCO, B/E is now the leading
     manufacturer of a broad product line including a complete line of seating
     products, sidewalls, bulkheads, credenzas, closets, galley structures,
     lavatories, tables, sofas, oxygen delivery systems, air valves and
     lighting. B/E has the capability to provide complete interior packages,
     including all design services, all interior components and program
     management services for executive aircraft interiors. B/E is the preferred
     supplier of seating products at essentially every general aviation airframe
     manufacturer.

Services and Specialty Products

     The Company is an active participant in the growing service and custom
products markets. Management believes that the Company's broad and integrated
product line and close relationships with its airline and leasing customers
position the Company to become a leading service provider in this market. Most
participants in this market are small, and management believes that the Company
is the only major product manufacturer in the industry currently participating
in this market.

- -    Services. The Company provides a comprehensive complement of services for
     cabin interior products on board aircraft either between flights or on an
     overnight basis, or at one of eight service centers in the worldwide
     service network. The spectrum of services includes systems check and
     components repair, parts inventory and management, refurbishment of seating
     products, on-board surveys regarding status and product installations, as
     well as data support functions such as loading and updating of in-flight
     systems entertainment software, direct satellite broadcast systems support
     and systems integration.

                                       11
<PAGE>   12
- -    Specialty Products. The Company manufacturers several specialty products
     for the commercial airline industry including flight attendant seats,
     observer seats and custom products in the passenger seating area. The
     Company maintains a staff of engineers to design and certify various
     modules and kits to accommodate individual-passenger video and
     telecommunications modules in seat backs and center consoles. The Company
     believes it is able to provide such unique custom products more rapidly
     than original manufacturers.

RESEARCH, DEVELOPMENT AND ENGINEERING

   The Company works closely with commercial airlines to improve existing
products and identify customers' emerging needs. B/E's expenditures in research,
development and engineering totaled $45.7 million, $37.1 million, and $58.3
million for the fiscal years ended February 28, 1998, February 22, 1997 and
February 24, 1996, respectively. The increase in expenses during the current
period is the result of the substantial completion of Boeing line-fit
certification activities for MDDS as well as ongoing product development
activity in the Seating Products Group and Interior Systems Group. B/E employs
approximately 500 professionals in the engineering and product development
areas. The Company believes that it has the largest engineering organization in
the cabin interior products industry, with not only software, electronic,
electrical and mechanical design skills, but also substantial expertise in
materials composition and custom cabin interior layout design.

MARKET AND CUSTOMERS

   The Company markets and sells its products directly to virtually all of the
world's major airlines and commercial and general aviation aircraft
manufacturers. The Company markets its general aviation products directly to all
of the world's general aviation airframe manufacturers, modification centers and
operators. B/E has a sales and marketing organization of 110 people, along with
22 independent sales representatives. B/E sales to all customers in foreign
countries were $232.7 million, $203.4 million and $124.5 million for the fiscal
years ended February 28, 1998, February 22, 1997 and February 24, 1996,
respectively, or approximately 43%, 49% and 54%, respectively, of net sales
during such periods.

   Airlines select manufacturers of cabin interior products primarily on the
basis of product quality and performance, custom design capabilities, on-time
delivery, after-sales service and price. B/E believes that its large installed
base, its timely responsiveness in connection with the custom design,
manufacture, delivery and after-sales service of its products and its broad
product line and stringent customer and regulatory requirements all present
barriers to entry for potential new competitors in the cabin interior products
market.

   The Company believes that its integrated worldwide marketing approach,
focused by airline, modification center and general aviation airframe
manufacturer and encompassing the Company's entire product line, is preferred by
its customers. Led by a B/E senior executive, teams representing each product
line serve designated airlines, which together account for approximately 60% of
the purchases of products manufactured by B/E during fiscal 1998. These customer
teams have developed customer-specific strategies to meet each airline's product
and service needs.

   The Company also staffs "on-site" customer engineers at major airlines and
airframe manufacturers to represent its entire product line and work closely
with the customers to develop specifications for each successive generation of
products required by the airlines. These engineers help customers integrate the
wide range of cabin interior products and assist in obtaining the applicable
regulatory certification for each particular product or cabin configuration.
Through its on-site customer engineers, the Company expects to be able to more
efficiently design and integrate products which address the requirements of its
customers. The Company provides program management services, integrating all
on-board cabin interior equipment and systems, including installation and FAA
certification, allowing airlines to substantially reduce costs. The Company
believes that it is the only supplier in the commercial aircraft cabin interior
products industry with the size, resources, breadth of product line and global
product support capability to operate in this manner.

      The Company markets its general aviation products directly to all of the
world's general aviation airframe manufacturers, modification centers and
operators.

                                       12
<PAGE>   13
   During the latter part of fiscal 1997, the Company initiated a program
management discipline under which a program manager is assigned for each
significant contract. The program manager is responsible for all aspects of the
specific contract, including management of change orders and negotiation of
related non-recurring engineering charges, monitoring the progress of the
contract through its scheduled delivery dates, and overall profitability
associated with the contract. The Company believes that it and its customers
derive substantial benefit from its program management approach, including
better on-time delivery and higher service levels. The Company also believes its
program management approach results in better customer satisfaction and higher
profitability over the life of the contract.

      During the fiscal year ended February 28, 1998, one customer accounted for
approximately 18% of the Company's total revenues, and no other customer
accounted for more than 10% of such revenues. There were no major customers in
fiscal 1997 or 1996. Because of differing schedules of various airlines for
purchases of new aircraft and for retrofit and refurbishment of existing
aircraft, the portion of the Company's revenues attributable to particular
airlines varies from year to year.

BACKLOG

      Management estimates that B/E's backlog at February 28, 1998 was
approximately $560 million, approximately 52% of which management believes to be
deliverable in fiscal 1999, compared with a backlog of $420 million on February
22, 1997 (as adjusted for the debooking of the British Airways MDDS program in
August 1997).

CUSTOMER SERVICE

      The Company believes that it provides the highest level of customer
service and product support available in the commercial aircraft cabin interior
products industry and that such service is a critical factor in the Company's
success. The key elements of such service include (i) rapid response to requests
for engineering designs, proposal requests and technical specifications; (ii)
flexibility with respect to customized features; (iii) on-time delivery; (iv)
immediate availability of spare parts for a broad range of products; and (v)
prompt attention to customer problems, including on-site customer training.
Customer service is particularly important to airlines due to the high cost to
the airlines of late delivery, malfunctions and other problems.

WARRANTY AND PRODUCT LIABILITY

      The Company warrants its products, or specific components thereof, for
periods ranging from one to ten years, depending upon product type and
component. The Company generally establishes reserves for product warranty
expense on the basis of the ratio of warranty costs incurred by the product over
the warranty period to sales of the product over the warranty period. Actual
warranty costs reduce the warranty reserve as they are incurred. Management
periodically reviews the adequacy of accrued product warranty reserves and
revisions of such reserves are recognized in the period in which such revisions
are determined.

      The Company also carries product liability insurance. The Company believes
that its insurance is generally sufficient to cover product liability claims.

COMPETITION

      The commercial aircraft cabin interior products market is relatively
fragmented with a number of competitors in each of the individual product
categories. Due to the global nature of the commercial airline industry,
competition in product categories comes from both U.S. and foreign
manufacturers. However, as aircraft cabin interiors have become increasingly
sophisticated and technically complex, airlines have demanded increased levels
of engineering support and customer service than many smaller cabin interior
products suppliers can provide. At the same time, airlines have recognized that
cabin interior product suppliers must be able to integrate a wide range of
products, including sophisticated electronic components, particularly in
widebody aircraft. Management believes that the increasing demands airlines
place upon remaining suppliers will result in a number of suppliers leaving the
cabin interior products industry and a consolidation of those suppliers. The
Company has participated in this consolidation through strategic acquisitions
and internal growth and intends to continue to participate in the consolidation.

                                       13
<PAGE>   14
      The Company's principal competitors for seating products include Group
Zodiac S.A., Keiper Recaro GmbH, and a limited number of other producers in the
European community and Japan. The Company's principal competitors for PESS
products are MAS and Rockwell Collins. The Company's primary competitors for
interior systems products are JAMCO Limited, Britax PLC, Scott Aviation and
Intertechnique.

MANUFACTURING AND RAW MATERIALS

   The Company's manufacturing operations consist of both the in-house
manufacturing of component parts and sub-assemblies and the assembly of Company
specified and designed component parts purchased from outside vendors. The
Company maintains state-of-the-art facilities, and management has an ongoing
strategic manufacturing improvement plan utilizing focused factories and
cellular production technologies. Management expects that continuous improvement
from implementation of this plan for each of its product lines will occur over
the next several years and should lower production costs, cycle times and
inventory requirements and at the same time improve product quality and customer
satisfaction.

GOVERNMENT REGULATION

   The FAA prescribes standards and licensing requirements for aircraft
components and licenses component repair stations within the United States.
Comparable agencies regulate such matters in other countries.

   The Company holds several FAA component certificates and performs component
repairs at a number of its U.S. facilities under FAA repair station licenses.
The Company also holds an approval issued by the U.K. Civil Aviation Authority
to design, manufacture, inspect and test aircraft seating products in Leighton
Buzzard, England and in Kilkeel, Northern Ireland and the necessary approvals to
design, manufacture, inspect, test and repair its interior systems products in
Nieuwegein, The Netherlands and to inspect, test and repair products at its
eight service centers throughout the world.

   In March 1992, the FAA adopted Technical Standard Order C127 requiring that
all seats on certain new generation commercial aircraft installed after such
date be certified to meet a number of new safety requirements, including an
ability to withstand a 16G force. Management understands that the FAA plans to
adopt additional regulations in the near future that will require that within
the next five years all seats, including those on existing older commercial
aircraft that are subject to the FAA's jurisdiction, will have to comply with
similar seat safety requirements. At February 28, 1998, the Company had
developed eleven different seat models meeting these new seat safety
regulations.

PATENTS

      B/E currently holds 52 United States patents and 21 international patents,
covering a variety of products. However, the Company believes that the
termination, expiration or infringement of one or more of such patents would not
have a material adverse effect on the Company.

EMPLOYEES

      As of February 28, 1998, B/E had approximately 3,600 employees.
Approximately 73% of these employees are engaged in manufacturing, 14% in
research, development and engineering, and 13% in sales, marketing, product
support and general administration. Approximately 13% of the employees are
represented by unions. On April 25, 1997, the Company completed negotiations
with its only domestic union which represents 11% of the Company's employees.
This contract, which covers a period of three years, was ratified by the members
of the union on April 26, 1997. B/E considers its employee relations to be good.




                  [Remainder of page intentionally left blank]

                                       14
<PAGE>   15
ITEM 2.  PROPERTIES

      B/E currently has 21 principal facilities, comprising an aggregate of
approximately 1.4 million square feet of space. The following table describes
the principal facilities and indicates the location, function, approximate size
and ownership status of each:


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                    FACILITY
           LOCATION                           PRODUCTS AND FUNCTION                   SIZE                     OWNERSHIP
           --------                           ---------------------                   ----                     ---------
                                                                                   (SQ. FEET)
<S>                           <C>                                                  <C>                    <C>
CORPORATE:
Wellington, Florida           Corporate headquarters, finance, marketing and            17,700                  Owned
                              sales

SEATING PRODUCTS:
Litchfield, Connecticut       Manufacturing, service and warehousing                   147,700                  Owned

Winston-Salem, North          Seating Products Group headquarters, research and        264,800                  Owned
   Carolina                   development, finance, marketing, sales and
                              manufacturing

Leighton Buzzard,             Manufacturing, service, research and development,        114,000              Owned (a)
   England                    sales support, finance and warehousing

Kilkeel, Northern Ireland     Manufacturing, sales support and warehousing              38,500                  Owned

INTERIOR SYSTEMS:
Anaheim,                      Manufacturing,  service, research and development,        57,100                 Leased
California                    sales support, finance and warehousing


Fountain Valley,              Manufacturing, service, research and                       26,000                 Owned
  California                  development, sales support, finance and
                              warehousing

Delray Beach, Florida         Manufacturing, service, research and development,
                              sales support, finance and warehousing; Interior
                              Systems Group headquarters                                 52,000                 Owned

Jacksonville, Florida         Manufacturing, service, engineering, and
                              warehousing                                                75,000                 Owned

Lenexa, Kansas                Manufacturing, service, engineering, and                   80,000                Leased
                              Warehousing

Nieuwegein, The               Manufacturing, service, research and development,
    Netherlands               sales support, finance and warehousing                     39,000                Leased

PESS PRODUCTS:
Irvine, California            Manufacturing, service, research and development,
                              sales support, finance and warehousing; In-flight
                              Entertainment Group headquarters                          106,700                Leased
</TABLE>

                                       15
<PAGE>   16
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                     FACILITY
          LOCATION                            PRODUCTS AND FUNCTION                    SIZE            OWNERSHIP
          --------                            ---------------------                 ----------         ---------
                                                                                    (SQ. FEET)
                                                                                    
<S>                           <C>                                                   <C>                <C>
GENERAL AVIATION AND
VIP PRODUCTS:
Miami, Florida                Manufacturing, service, research and development,            84,300             Leased
                              sales support, finance and warehousing; General              71,700              Owned
                              Aviation Headquarters

SERVICES:
Orange, California            Upgrade, maintenance, inspection and repair,                106,300             Leased
                              finance, sales support and warehousing; Service
                              Group Headquarters

Longwood, Florida             Upgrade, maintenance, inspection and repair                   5,300             Leased

Burnsville, Minnesota         Upgrade, maintenance, inspection and repair                   7,200             Leased

Woodinville, Washington       Upgrade, maintenance, inspection and repair                  26,800             Leased

Chesham, England              Upgrade, maintenance, inspection and repair                  34,000          Owned (a)


Toulouse, France              Upgrade, maintenance, inspection and repair                    400              Leased

Houston, Texas                Upgrade, maintenance, inspection and repair                 45,000               Owned

Schipol, The  Netherlands     Upgrade, maintenance, inspection and repair                  3,600              Leased
</TABLE>



   (a) B/E's owned properties in England are mortgaged to Barclays Bank PLC to
collateralize credit facilities of BE Aerospace (U.K.) Ltd. in aggregate amounts
of up to approximately pound sterling 5.0 million.

      The Company believes that its facilities are suitable for their present
intended purposes and adequate for the Company's present and anticipated level
of operations. As a result of recent conditions in the airline industry as
described in "Industry Overview-Recent Industry Conditions," B/E's facilities
have been substantially underutilized for the past several years. The Company
believes that its ongoing facility integration program, together with
anticipated continued growth in airline profitability, should result in
significant improvement in the degree of utilization in the Company's
facilities.


                  [Remainder of page intentionally left blank]

                                       16
<PAGE>   17
ITEM 3.   LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

   The Company is not a party to litigation or other legal proceedings which the
Company believes could reasonably be expected to have a material adverse effect
on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations.

   In January 1998, the Company resolved a long-running dispute with the U.S.
Government over export sales between 1992 and 1995 to Iran Air. The dispute
centered on shipments of aircraft seats and related spare parts for five
civilian aircraft operated by Iran Air. Iran Air purchased the seats in 1992 and
arranged for them to be installed by a contractor in France. At the time, Iran
was not the subject of a U.S. trade embargo. In connection with its sale of
seats to Iran Air, B/E applied for and was granted a validated export license by
the U.S. Department of Commerce (the "DOC"). The dispute with the U.S.
Government centered on whether seats were delivered to Iran Air before the
formal license was issued by the DOC, some seven months after B/E first applied
for the license. This action resolved all disputes between B/E Aerospace and the
Department of Justice as well as the DOC's Bureau of Export Enforcement. As part
of the settlement, B/E pleaded guilty to a violation of the International
Economic Emergency Powers Act and was placed on probation for a three-year
period. In addition, B/E entered into a consent order with the DOC under which
the DOC has agreed to suspend the imposition of a three-year export denial order
on PTC Aerospace, a member of B/E's U.S. Seating Products Group, provided no
further violations of the export laws occur. The Company recorded a charge of
approximately $4.7 million in the quarter ended February 28, 1998, related to
fines, civil penalties and associated legal fees arising from the settlement.

ITEM 4.  SUBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS

   During the last quarter of the fiscal year covered by this report, the
Company did not submit any matters to a vote of security holders, through the
solicitation of proxies or otherwise.


                  [Remainder of page intentionally left blank]

                                       17
<PAGE>   18
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT

     The following table sets forth information regarding the directors and
executive officers of the Company. Officers of the Company are elected annually
by the Board of Directors.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
    NAME                   AGE                  POSITION
    ----                   ---                  --------
<S>                       <C>       <C>
Amin J. Khoury              59      Chairman of the Board
Robert J. Khoury            56      Vice Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer and Director
Paul E. Fulchino            51      President, Chief Operating Officer and Director
Marco C. Lanza              41      Executive Vice President, Marketing and Product Development
Thomas P. McCaffrey         44      Corporate Senior Vice President of Administration, Chief Financial Officer and
                                    Assistant Secretary
E. Ernest Schwartz          61      Corporate Senior Vice President, Development and Planning
Edmund J. Moriarty          54      Corporate Vice President-Law, General Counsel and Secretary
Jeffrey P. Holtzman         42      Corporate Vice President, Treasurer and Assistant Secretary
Sam G. Ayoub                55      Group Vice President and General Manager, Services Group
Roman G. Ptakowski          49      Group Vice President and General Manager, Interior Systems Products Group
Scott A. Smith              43      Group Vice President and General Manager, In-flight Entertainment Group
Jim C. Cowart               46      Director**
Richard G. Hamermesh        50      Director*
Brian H. Rowe               66      Director**
Hansjoerg Wyss              62      Director*
</TABLE>


*   Member, Audit Committee.
**  Member, Stock Option and Compensation Committee.

      The Company's Restated Certificate of Incorporation provides that the
Board of Directors is classified into three classes, as nearly as equal in
number as possible, so that each director (after a transitional period) will
serve for three years, with one class of directors being elected each year. The
Board is currently comprised of three Class I Directors (Brian H. Rowe, Jim C.
Cowart and Paul E. Fulchino), two Class II Directors (Robert J. Khoury and
Hansjoerg Wyss) and two Class III Directors (Amin J. Khoury and Richard G.
Hamermesh). The terms of the Class I, Class II and Class III Directors expire
upon the election and qualification of successor directors at annual meetings of
stockholders held following the end of fiscal years 1998, 1997 and 1996,
respectively. The executive officers of the Company are elected annually by the
Board of Directors following the annual meeting of stockholders and serve at the
discretion of the Board of Directors.

      Amin J. Khoury has been Chairman of the Board of the Company since July
1987 and was Chief Executive Officer until April 1, 1996. Since 1986, Mr. Khoury
has also been the Managing Director of The K.A.D. Companies, Inc., an
investment, venture capital and consulting firm. Mr. Khoury is currently the
Chairman of the Board of Directors of Applied Extrusion Technologies, Inc., a
manufacturer of oriented polypropylene films used in consumer products labeling
and packaging applications, and a member of the Board of Directors of Brooks
Automation, Inc., the leading manufacturer in the U.S. of vacuum central wafer
handling systems for semiconductor manufacturing. Mr. Khoury is employed by the
Company pursuant to an Employment Agreement extending through December 31, 2001.
Mr. Khoury is the brother of Robert J. Khoury.

      Robert J. Khoury has been a Director of the Company since July 1987. Mr.
Khoury was elected Vice Chairman and Chief Executive Officer effective April 1,
1996; from July 1987 until that date, Mr. Khoury served as the Company's
President and Chief Operating Officer. From 1986 to 1987, Mr. Khoury was Vice
President of The K.A.D. Companies, Inc. The Company has entered into an
Employment Agreement with Mr. Khoury, extending through February 28, 2001. Mr.
Khoury is the brother of Amin J. Khoury.

      Paul E. Fulchino was elected a Director and President and Chief Operating
Officer of the Company effective April 1, 1996. From 1990 to 1996, Mr. Fulchino
served as President and Vice Chairman of Mercer Management Consulting, Inc.
("Mercer"), an international general management consulting firm with over 1,100
employees. In addition to his management responsibilities as President of
Mercer, Mr. Fulchino also had responsibility for advising clients throughout the
world, particularly with respect to the transportation industry, including a
number of

                                       18
<PAGE>   19
major airlines. The Company has entered into an Employment Agreement with Mr.
Fulchino extending through March 31, 1999.

      Marco C. Lanza has been the Executive Vice President, Marketing and
Product Development since January 1994. From March 1992 through January 1994,
Mr. Lanza was Vice President and General Manager of the In-flight Entertainment
Group of the Company. From 1987 through February 1992, Mr. Lanza was Vice
President, Marketing and Product Development of the Company. The Company has
entered into an Employment Agreement with Mr. Lanza extending through December
31, 1999.

      Thomas P. McCaffrey has been Corporate Senior Vice President of
Administration, Chief Financial Officer and Assistant Secretary since May 1993.
From August 1989 through May 1993, Mr. McCaffrey was an Audit Director with
Deloitte & Touche LLP, and from 1976 through 1989 served in several capacities,
including Audit Partner, with Coleman & Grant. The Company has entered into an
Employment Agreement with Mr. McCaffrey extending through December 31, 1999.

      E. Ernest Schwartz has been Corporate Senior Vice President, Development
and Planning since December 1997. From March 1992 through November 1997, Mr.
Schwartz was Group Vice President and General Manager of the Interior Systems
Products Group. From 1986 through February 1992, Mr. Schwartz was President of
Aircraft Products Company, which was acquired by the Company in 1992.

      Edmund J. Moriarty has been Corporate Vice President, General Counsel and
Secretary since November 1995. From 1991 to 1995, Mr. Moriarty served as Vice
President and General Counsel to Rollins, Inc., a national service company. From
1982 through 1991, Mr. Moriarty served as Vice President and General Counsel to
Old Ben Coal Company, a wholly owned coal subsidiary of The Standard Oil
Company.

      Jeffrey P. Holtzman has been Treasurer since September 1993 and Vice
President since November 1996. From June 1986 to July 1993, Mr. Holtzman served
in several capacities at FPL Group, Inc., including Assistant Treasurer and
Manager of Financial Planning. Mr. Holtzman previously worked for Mellon Bank,
Gulf Oil and Arthur Young & Company.

      Sam G. Ayoub has been Group Vice President and General Manager of the
Company's Services Group since May 1996 and from November 1994 through April
1996, was Executive President-Services. From 1984 to 1994 Mr. Ayoub served in
several capacities with AAR Corporation including Corporate Vice President
Marketing and President-Technical Services Division. Prior to that Mr. Ayoub was
with United Airlines for 20 years with his last position being General Manager
of their Cargo Division.

      Roman G. Ptakowski has been the Group Vice President and General Manager
of the Interior Systems Group since December 1997. From September 1995 through
December 1997, Mr. Ptakowski was Vice President, Sales and Marketing of the
Interior Systems Group of the Company. From January 1995 through August 1995,
Mr. Ptakowski served as Senior Vice President, Marketing for Farrel Corporation.
Prior to that he was with the ABB Power T&D Company Inc. and Westinghouse
Electric Corp. for 25 years with his last position being General Manager of
their Protective Relay Division.

      Scott A. Smith has been the Vice President and General Manager of the
In-flight Entertainment Group since April 1998. From December 1995 through March
1998, Mr. Smith was with Toshiba American Information Electronics with his last
position being Senior Vice President, Sales of the Americas. From December 1992
to February 1994, Mr. Smith served as Corporate Vice President of Engineering
and from February 1994 to September 1995 served as the General Manager of the
Desktop and Server Product Division of AST Research. Prior to that, Mr. Smith
was with IBM for 16 years and served in numerous capacities, including Systems
Manager of the engineering team which developed IBM's first PC Server and
advanced desktop, Staff Assistant to the Chairman of the Board and Director of
Visual Subsystems Group.

                                       19
<PAGE>   20
      Jim C. Cowart has been a Director of the Company since November 1989. Mr.
Cowart is currently an independent investor and has been a principal of Cowart &
Co. LLC and EOS Capital, Inc. private capital firms retained by the Company for
strategic planning, competitive analysis, financial relations and other
services. From January 1993 to November 1997, Mr. Cowart was the Chairman of the
Board and Chief Executive Officer of Aurora Electronics Inc. From 1987 until
1991, Mr. Cowart was a founding General Partner of Capital Resource Partners, a
private investment capital manager. Prior to such time, Mr. Cowart held various
positions in investment banking and venture capital with Lehman Brothers,
Shearson Venture Capital and Kidder, Peabody & Co.

      Richard G. Hamermesh has been a Director of the Company since July 1987.
Since August 1987, Dr. Hamermesh has been the Managing Partner of the Center for
Executive Development, an independent management consulting company, and, from
December 1986 to August 1987, Dr. Hamermesh was an independent consultant. Prior
to such time, Dr. Hamermesh was on the faculty at the Harvard Business School.
Dr. Hamermesh is also a Director of Applied Extrusion Technologies, Inc.

      Brian H. Rowe has been a Director of the Company since July 1995. Mr. Rowe
is currently Chairman Emeritus of GE Aircraft Engines, a principal business unit
of the General Electric Company, where he also served as Chairman from September
1993 through January 1995 and as President from 1979 through 1993. From March
1994 to November 1995, Mr. Rowe served as a Director of Astrostructures Hamble
Limited, a manufacturer of military and civil aircraft components. Since March
1995, Mr. Rowe has also been a Director of Atlas Air Inc., an air cargo carrier.
Since January 1980, Mr. Rowe has been a Director of Fifth Third Bank, an Ohio
banking corporation. Since October 1995, Mr. Rowe has been a Director of
Cincinnati Bell Inc., a communications services company. Since December 1996,
Mr. Rowe has also been a Director of Stewart & Stevenson Services, Inc., a
custom packager of engine systems, and Textron Inc., a manufacturer of
mechanical devices for aircraft and other applications. Since January 1996, Mr.
Rowe has served as Executive Vice Chairman of American Regional Aircraft
Industries, Inc.

      Hansjoerg Wyss has been a Director of the Company since October 1989.
Since 1977, Mr. Wyss has been a Director and the Chairman and Chief Executive
Officer of Synthes (U.S.A.) and Synthes (Canada), Ltd., manufacturers and
distributors of orthopedic implants and instruments.

                  [Remainder of page intentionally left blank]

                                       20
<PAGE>   21
                                     PART II

ITEM 5.  MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

      The Company's common stock is quoted on the Nasdaq National Market under
the symbol "BEAV." The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated,
the range of high and low per share closing prices for the Common Stock as
reported by Nasdaq.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                    HIGH            LOW
                                                    ----            ---
<S>                                              <C>             <C>
FISCAL YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 24, 1996
    First Quarter                                  8 5/8          5 1/4
    Second Quarter                                 9 1/4          7 1/4
    Third Quarter                                 9 9/16          7 1/2
    Fourth Quarter                                13 5/8          8 7/8
FISCAL YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 22, 1997
    First Quarter                                 16 1/4          9 7/8
    Second Quarter                                16 3/4         12 3/8
    Third Quarter                                 25 1/8         15 1/2
    Fourth Quarter                                29             22 3/4
FISCAL YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1998
    First Quarter                                 27 1/2         19 1/2
    Second Quarter                                37             23 5/8
    Third Quarter                                 41 1/2         27 1/8
    Fourth Quarter                                32 1/4         20 1/2
</TABLE>

      On May 20, 1998 the closing price of the Common Stock as reported by
Nasdaq was $30.31 per share. As of such date, the Company had 531 shareholders
of record, and management estimates that there are approximately 14,300
beneficial owners of the Company's common stock. The Company has not paid any
cash dividends in the past, and management has no present intention of doing so
in the immediate future. The Company's Board of Directors intends, for the
foreseeable future, to retain any earnings to finance the future growth of the
Company, but expects to review its dividend policy regularly. The Indentures
pursuant to which the Company's 8% and 9 7/8% Senior Subordinated Notes were
issued and the terms of the Company's credit facilities permit the declaration
or payment of cash dividends only in certain circumstances described therein.



                  [Remainder of page intentionally left blank]

                                       21
<PAGE>   22
ITEM 6.  SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
(In thousands, except per share data)

During fiscal 1994, B/E completed the following acquisitions: (i) on April 29,
1993, B/E acquired all of the stock of Royal Inventum, B.V. ("Inventum"); (ii)
on August 23, 1993, B/E acquired all of the stock of Nordskog Industries
("Nordskog"); (iii) on August 26, 1993, B/E acquired all of the stock of Acurex
Corporation ("Acurex"); and (iv) on October 13, 1993, B/E acquired substantially
all of the assets of Philips Airvision ("Airvision"). On January 24, 1996, the
Company acquired all of the stock of Burns Aerospace Corporation ("Burns"). The
financial data as of and for the fiscal years ended February 28, 1998, February
22, 1997, February 24, 1996, February 25, 1995 and February 26, 1994 have been
derived from financial statements which have been audited by B/E's independent
auditors. The following financial information is qualified by reference to, and
should be read in conjunction with, the B/E financial statements, including
notes thereto, and "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition
and Results of Operations" included elsewhere in this Annual Report.


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                    FISCAL YEAR ENDED
                                                        ------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                        Feb. 28,          Feb. 22,       Feb. 24,       Feb. 25,        Feb. 26,
                                                         1998               1997         1996 (c)         1995            1994
                                                         ----               ----         --------         ----            ----
<S>                                                  <C>                <C>            <C>             <C>             <C>
STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS DATA:
Net sales ......................................      $ 487,999          $ 412,379      $ 232,582       $ 229,347       $ 203,364
Cost of sales ..................................        309,094            270,557        160,031         154,863         136,307
                                                      ---------          ---------      ---------       ---------       ---------
Gross profit ...................................        178,905            141,822         72,551          74,484          67,057
Operating expenses:
  Selling, general and administrative ..........         58,622             51,734         42,000          31,787          28,164
  Research, development and engineering ........         45,685             37,083      58,327 (d)         12,860           9,876
  Amortization .................................         11,265             10,607          9,499           9,954           7,599
  Other expenses ...............................          4,664(a)              --      4,170 (e)       23,736 (e)             --
                                                      ---------          ---------      ---------       ---------       ---------
Operating earnings (loss) ......................         58,669             42,398        (41,445)         (3,853)         21,418
Interest expense, net ..........................         22,765             27,167         18,636          15,019          12,581
                                                      ---------          ---------      ---------       ---------       ---------
  Earnings (loss) before income taxes (benefit),
    extraordinary item and cumulative effect of
    accounting change ..........................         35,904             15,231        (60,081)        (18,872)          8,837
Income taxes (benefit) .........................          5,386              1,522             --          (6,806)          3,481
                                                      ---------          ---------      ---------       ---------       ---------
Earnings (loss) before extraordinary item and
    cumulative effect of accounting change .....         30,518             13,709        (60,081)        (12,066)          5,356
Extraordinary item .............................      8,956 (b)                 --             --              --              --
                                                      ---------          ---------      ---------       ---------       ---------
Earnings (loss) before cumulative effect of
   accounting change ...........................         21,562             13,709        (60,081)        (12,066)          5,356
Cumulative effect of accounting change .........             --                 --        (23,332)             --              --
                                                      ---------          ---------      ---------       ---------       ---------
Net earnings (loss) ............................      $  21,562          $  13,709      $ (83,413)      $ (12,066)      $   5,356
                                                      =========          =========      =========       =========       =========
Basic earnings (loss) per share (f):
Earnings (loss) before extraordinary Item and
   cumulative effect of change in accounting
   principle ...................................      $    1.36          $     .77      $   (3.71)      $    (.75)      $     .35
Extraordinary item .............................           (.40)                --             --              --              --
Cumulative effect of accounting change .........             --                 --      (1.44) (d)             --              --
                                                      ---------          ---------      ---------       ---------       ---------
Net earnings (loss) ............................      $     .96          $     .77      $   (5.15)      $    (.75)      $     .35
                                                      =========          =========      =========       =========       =========
Weighted average common  shares ................         22,442             17,692         16,185          16,021          15,438
Diluted earnings (loss) per share (f):
Earnings (loss) before extraordinary Item and
  cumulative effect of change in accounting
  principle ....................................      $    1.30          $     .72      $   (3.71)      $    (.75)      $     .34
Extraordinary item .............................           (.38)                --             --              --              --
Cumulative effect of accounting change .........             --                 --      (1.44) (d)             --              --
                                                      ---------          ---------      ---------       ---------       ---------
Net earnings (loss) ............................      $     .92          $     .72      $   (5.15)      $    (.75)      $     .34
                                                      =========          =========      =========       =========       =========
Weighted average common  shares ................         23,430             19,097         16,185          16,021          15,623
BALANCE SHEET DATA (END OF PERIOD):
Working capital ................................      $ 262,504          $ 122,174      $  41,824       $  76,563       $  76,874
Total assets ...................................        681,757            491,089        433,586         379,954         375,009
Long-term debt .................................        349,557            225,402        273,192         172,693         159,170
Stockholders' equity ...........................        196,775            165,761         44,157         125,331         133,993
</TABLE>

                                       22
<PAGE>   23
                       SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA (CONTINUED)
                               FOOTNOTES TO TABLE

(a)    In fiscal 1998, the Company resolved a long-running dispute with the U.S.
       Government over export sales between 1992 and 1995 to Iran Air. The
       Company recorded a charge of $4,664 in fiscal 1998 related to fines,
       civil penalties and associated legal fees arising from the settlement.

(b)    The Company incurred an extraordinary charge of $8,956 during fiscal 1998
       for unamortized debt issue costs, tender and redemption premiums and fees
       and expenses related to the repurchase of its 9 3/4% Senior Notes.

(c)    On January 24, 1996, the Company acquired all of the stock of Burns, an
       industry leader in commercial aircraft seating. The acquisition of Burns
       was accounted for as a purchase, and the results of Burns are included in
       B/E's historical financial data from the date of acquisition.


(d)    In fiscal 1996, the Company changed its method of accounting relating to
       the capitalization of precontract engineering costs that were previously
       included as a component of inventories and amortized to earnings as the
       product was shipped. Effective February 24, 1995, such costs have been
       charged to research, development and engineering and expensed as incurred
       and, as a result, periods prior to fiscal 1996 are not comparable. In
       connection with such change in accounting, the Company recorded a charge
       to earnings of $23,332. See Note 2 of Notes to Consolidated Financial
       Statements.


(e)    In fiscal 1996, in conjunction with the Company's rationalization of its
       seating business and as a result of the Burns acquisition, the Company
       recorded a charge to earnings of $4,170 related to costs associated with
       the integration and consolidation of the Company's European seating
       operations. In fiscal 1995, the Company charged to earnings $23,736 of
       expenses primarily related to intangible assets and inventories
       associated with the Company's earlier generations of passenger
       entertainment systems.

(f)    During fiscal year 1998, the Company adopted Statement of Financial
       Accounting Standard No. 128, Earnings per Share, and, accordingly, has
       restated earnings per share for all periods presented.

                  [Remainder of page intentionally left blank]

                                       23
<PAGE>   24
ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS
OF OPERATIONS

This Item 7 "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and
Results of Operations" includes forward-looking statements which involve risks
and uncertainties. The Company's actual experience may differ materially from
that anticipated in such statements. Factors that might cause such a difference
include, but are not limited to, those discussed in "Risk Factors" contained in
Exhibit 99.1 hereto, as well as future events that have the effect of reducing
the Company's operating income and available cash balances, such as unexpected
operating losses or delays in the integration of the Company's seating business,
the delivery of the Company's MDDS interactive video system, customer delivery
requirements, new or expected refurbishments, or cash expenditures related to
possible future acquisitions.

(In thousands, except share and per share data)

INTRODUCTION

      B/E is the world's largest manufacturer of interior products for
commercial and general aviation aircraft cabins, serving virtually all major
airlines and general aviation aircraft owners and original equipment
manufacturers with a broad line of products, including aircraft seats, a full
line of food and beverage preparation and storage equipment, Interior Systems
structures, oxygen delivery systems and related products, and in-flight
entertainment systems. In addition, B/E provides upgrade, maintenance and repair
services for the products which it manufactures as well as for those supplied by
other manufacturers.

   B/E's revenues are generally derived from two primary sources: refurbishment
or upgrade programs for the existing worldwide fleets of commercial and general
aviation aircraft, and new aircraft deliveries. B/E believes its large installed
base of products, estimated to be approximately $3.7 billion (valued at
replacement prices as of February 28, 1998), gives it a significant advantage
over competitors in obtaining orders for refurbishment programs, principally due
to the airlines' tendency to purchase equipment for such programs from the
original supplier. With the exception of spare parts sales, B/E's revenues are
generated from programs which may vary significantly from year to year in terms
of size, mix of products and length of delivery. As a result, B/E's revenues and
margins may fluctuate from period to period based upon the size and timing of
the programs and the type of products sold. Historically, B/E experienced
certain trends in its two revenue drivers: as the airlines took deliveries of
large numbers of new aircraft, refurbishment programs as a percentage of
revenues declined and, similarly, when new aircraft deliveries declined,
refurbishment programs tended to increase in number and size. During the most
recent airline industry recession, which ended in 1994, the airlines
significantly depleted their cash reserves and incurred record losses. In an
effort to improve their liquidity, the airlines conserved cash by reducing or
deferring cabin interior refurbishment and upgrade programs and purchases of new
aircraft. As a result, in contrast with historical experience, B/E experienced
declines in the number of both new orders and refurbishments.

   Since early 1994, the airlines have experienced a significant turnaround in
operating results, with the domestic airline industry achieving record operating
earnings during calendar years 1995 through 1997. Consequently, during fiscal
1998, B/E has experienced significant growth in backlog of seating and interior
systems products, and has experienced significant growth in revenues and
operating earnings. This growth is a reflection of the airlines' need to begin
refurbishing worn fleets and their ability to do so as a result of the
strengthening of the airlines' balance sheets.

        B/E has substantially expanded the size, scope and nature of its
business as a result of a number of acquisitions. During the fiscal year ended
February 26, 1994, B/E completed the following acquisitions: (i) on April 29,
1993, the Company acquired, through a Dutch holding company, all of the capital
stock of Inventum, a supplier of galley inserts including ovens, beverage makers
and water boilers to airlines located primarily in Europe and the Pacific Rim;
(ii) on August 23, 1993, the Company acquired all of the capital stock of
Nordskog, an industry pioneer in galley structures and inserts; (iii) on August
26, 1993, the Company acquired all of the capital stock of Acurex, the leading
worldwide supplier of commercial aircraft refrigeration products; and (iv) on
October 13, 1993, the Company acquired substantially all of the assets and
certain of the liabilities of Airvision, a manufacturer of in-flight
entertainment equipment. On January 24, 1996, the Company acquired all of the
stock of Burns, an industry

                                       24
<PAGE>   25
leader in commercial aircraft seating. On April 13, 1998, the Company acquired
substantially all of the assets and assumed certain of the liabilities of
Puritan Bennett Aero Systems Co., the leading manufacturer of commercial
aircraft oxygen delivery systems, a leading manufacturer of passenger service
unit components and systems, and a major supplier of air valves, overhead lights
and switches, crew masks and protective breathing devices. On April 21, 1998,
the Company acquired substantially all of the assets and assumed certain of the
liabilities of Aircraft Modular Products, the leading manufacturer of cabin
interior products for general aviation (business jet) and commercial type VIP
aircraft. While the Company will continue to be susceptible to industry-wide
conditions, management believes that the Company's significantly more
diversified product line and revenue base achieved through acquisitions has
reduced its exposure to demand fluctuations in any one product area.

   The Burns acquisition has had a significant impact on B/E's results of
operations. Burns, with calendar 1995 revenues of $99,800, was one of the three
leading North American suppliers of commercial aircraft passenger seats and had
a base of airline customers that was largely complementary to that of B/E. B/E's
and Burns' approximate share of the worldwide seating products market at the
time of acquisition were approximately 30% and 20%, respectively, based on
fiscal 1995 unit sales. By consolidating engineering, marketing, administration
and manufacturing operations of the two companies, B/E has been able to reduce
fixed costs, thereby enhancing its low-cost position.

   Over the last two fiscal years, the Company's gross margins have improved
substantially, increasing from 31.2% in fiscal 1996 to 34.4% in fiscal 1997 and
to 36.7% in fiscal 1998. The primary reasons for the improvement in gross
margins include: (i) a Company-wide re-engineering program, which has resulted
in higher employee productivity and better manufacturing efficiency; (ii) higher
unit volumes; and (iii) a shift in product mix in all Groups toward higher
margin products and services.

   B/E's business strategy is to maintain its market leadership position through
various initiatives, including new product development. In fiscal 1998,
research, development and engineering expenses totaled $45,685, or 9.4% of net
sales, primarily consisting of costs related to the development of the MDDS and
related Boeing line-fit expenditures, with the balance attributable to its
seating and interior systems products businesses.

                  [Remainder of page intentionally left blank]

                                       25
<PAGE>   26
RESULTS OF OPERATIONS -- YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1998 COMPARED TO YEAR ENDED
FEBRUARY 22, 1997

     Sales for the year ended February 28, 1998 were $487,999 or 18% higher than
sales of $412,379 in the prior year and reflected a 24% increase in product
sales, offset by a $13,305 decline in service revenues (attributable to
discontinued service lines of business). The increase in sales is attributable
to substantially higher unit volume shipments of all the Company's products.

     Gross profit was $178,905 or 36.7% of sales, for the year ended February
28, 1998 and was $37,083 or 26% greater than the prior year's gross profit of
$141,822 which represented 34.4% of sales. The increase in gross profit, while
primarily the result of the higher sales volume, was also positively impacted by
the 230 basis point improvement in gross margin.

     Selling, general and administrative expenses were $58,622 or 12% of sales
for the year ended February 28, 1998. This was $6,888 or 13%, higher than the
selling, general and administrative expenses for the prior year of $51,734
(12.5% of sales) and is primarily due to the higher level of sales and quotation
activity as well as a higher level of customer service, product support and
information technology activities.

     Research, development and engineering expenses were $45,685 or 9.4% of
sales, for the fiscal year ended February 28, 1998. For the prior year,
research, development and engineering expenses were $37,083 or 9.0% of sales.
The increase in research, development and engineering was attributable to B/E's
ongoing new product development programs, including costs related to the
development of the MDDS and related Boeing line-fit expenditures.

     Amortization expense for the fiscal year ended February 28, 1998 of $11,265
was $658 or 6%, higher than the amount recorded in the prior year.

     Other expenses for the fiscal year ended February 28, 1998 consisted of a
non-recurring charge of $4,664 related to the settlement of a dispute with the
U.S. Government over certain export sales between 1992 and 1995. (See Item 3.
"Legal Proceedings")

     Net interest expense was $22,765 for the year ended February, 28, 1998, or
$4,402 less than the net interest expense of $27,167 recorded for the prior
year, and is due to the decrease in the Company's long-term debt.

     The increase in gross profit offset by somewhat higher operating expenses
and lower interest expenses in the current year resulted in earnings before
income taxes, extraordinary item and cumulative effect of change in accounting
principle of $35,904, an increase of $20,673 over the prior year.

     Income taxes for the year ended February 28, 1998 were $5,386 or 15% of
earnings before income taxes as compared to $1,522 or 10% of earnings before
income taxes in the prior year.

     Earnings before extraordinary item were $30,518 or $1.30 per share
(diluted), which includes the $4,664 non-recurring charge related to the
settlement of the dispute with the U.S. government, for the year ended February
28, 1998, as compared to $13,709 or $.72 per share (diluted) for the prior year.

      The Company incurred an extraordinary charge of $8,956 during fiscal 1998
for unamortized debt issue costs, tender and redemption premiums and fees and
expenses related to the repurchase of its 9 3/4% Senior Notes.

     Net earnings were $21,562, or $.96 per share (basic) and $.92 per share
(diluted), for the year ended February 28, 1998 as compared to $13,709, or $.77
per share (basic) and $.72 per share (diluted), for the prior year.

                                       26
<PAGE>   27
RESULTS OF OPERATIONS -- YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 22, 1997 COMPARED TO YEAR ENDED
FEBRUARY 24, 1996

      Sales for the year ended February 22, 1997 were $412,379, or 77% higher
than sales of $232,582 for the comparable period in the prior year. The increase
in sales is attributable to substantially higher volume shipments of all the
Company's products and services as a result of improving industry conditions. Of
the $179,797 increase in sales for the year, $103,800 was due to increased
seating and services revenues directly related to the acquisition of Burns.
Excluding the effect of the Burns acquisition, sales increased 33% year over
year.

      Gross profit was $141,822, or 34.4% of sales, for the year ended February
22, 1997 and was $69,271 higher than gross profit for the comparable period in
the prior year of $72,551, which represented 31.2% of sales. The increase in
gross profit was primarily the result of the higher sales volumes and the mix of
products and services sold.

      Selling, general and administrative expenses were $51,734, or 12.5% of
sales, for the year ended February 22, 1997. This was $9,734 higher than
selling, general and administrative expenses for the prior year of $42,000, or
18.1% of sales, principally due to the substantial increases in revenues and the
acquisition of Burns.

      Research, development and engineering expenses were $37,083, or 9.0% of
sales, for the year ended February 22, 1997. For the comparable period in the
prior year, research and development expense was $58,327, or 25.1% of sales. The
decrease in expenses during the current year is the result of a decrease in the
level of activity associated with the MDDS interactive entertainment system,
offset somewhat by an increase in product development activity in the Seating
Products Group.

      Amortization expense for the year February 22, 1997 of $10,607 was $1,108
more than the amount recorded in fiscal 1996 as a result of the Burns
acquisition.

      Net interest expense was $27,167 for the year ended February 22, 1997, or
$8,531 higher than the net interest expense of $18,636 recorded for the
comparable period in the prior year, and is due to the increase in the Company's
long-term debt outstanding throughout most of fiscal 1997 as a result of the 
9 7/8% Senior Subordinated Notes issued at the time of the Burns acquisition.

      Earnings before income taxes of $15,231 for the year ended February 22,
1997 were $75,312 more than the loss before income taxes of $60,081 in the prior
year.

      Income taxes for the year ended February 22, 1997 were $1,522, or 10% of
earnings before income taxes, as compared to no tax provision in fiscal 1996.

      Net earnings were $13,709, or $.77 per share (basic) and $.72 per share
(diluted), for the year ended February 22, 1997 as compared to a net loss of
$(83,413), or $(5.15) per share (basic and diluted) for the comparable period in
the prior year, which included the cumulative effect of an accounting change of
$23,332.

                                       27
<PAGE>   28
BOOKINGS AND BACKLOG INFORMATION

  On September 15, 1997, British Airways ("BA") notified the Company of its
decision not to conduct a flight trial of B/E's MDDS interactive video system.
BA ultimately selected a competitor's system for their in-flight entertainment
equipment needs.

  As a result of BA's decision not to move forward with the interactive program,
as of August 1997, the Company debooked approximately $155,000 of backlog
related to the MDDS program. At February 28, 1998, the Company's backlog, after
debooking the BA backlog, stood at approximately $560,000, which represents a
year-to-year increase of approximately $140,000 or 33% versus the Company's
backlog at the end of fiscal 1997, as similarly adjusted to exclude the amount
then attributable to the BA MDDS backlog.

  Although the Company has debooked the BA backlog, the Company is continuing to
complete the initial development and testing of the MDDS product and has
completed line fit certification of its MDDS system on Boeing 747-400 aircraft
and has delivered the first MDDS product to its launch customer, JAL, in April
1998. See "Business -- Products and Services."

LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

  The Company's liquidity requirements consist of working capital needs, for
ongoing capital expenditures and scheduled payments of interest on its
indebtedness. B/E's primary requirements for working capital have been directly
related to increased accounts receivable and inventory levels as a result of
revenue growth. B/E's working capital was $262,504 as of February 28,1998
(including approximately $136,000 of cash from the net proceeds from the Senior
Subordinated Notes offering described below), as compared to $122,174 as of
February 22, 1997.

  At February 28,1998 the Company's cash and cash equivalents were $164,685, as
compared to $44,149 at February 22, 1997. Cash provided from operating
activities during fiscal 1998 was $9,598 and cash used in operating activities
during fiscal 1997 was $(10,591). The primary source of cash during fiscal 1998
was net earnings of $21,562, the extraordinary item of $8,956, non-cash charges
for depreciation and amortization of $24,160 and increases in accounts payable
of $3,972, offset by a use of cash of $43,262 related to increases in
inventories and receivables and $31,627 related to net increases in other
current and non-current assets and liabilities.

  In February 1998, the Company sold $250,000 of 8% Senior Subordinated Notes,
(the "8% Notes"). In conjunction with the sale of the 8% Notes, the Company
initiated a tender offer for the $125,000 of 9 3/4% Senior Notes due 2003 (the
"9 3/4% Notes"). The net proceeds from the offering of approximately $240,419
were used (i) for the tender offer (which expired on February 25, 1998) in which
approximately $101,800 of the 9 3/4% Notes were retired, (ii) to call the
remaining 9 3/4% notes on March 16, 1998, and (iii) together with the proceeds
from the Bank Credit Facility, to fund the acquisitions of AMP and PBASCO. The
Company incurred an extraordinary charge of $8,956 for unamortized debt issue
costs, tender and redemption premiums and fees and expenses related to the
repurchase of the 9 3/4% Notes. Long term debt at February 28, 1998 consists of
the remaining 9 3/4% Notes not retired in the tender offer, the 8% Notes and 
9 7/8% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2006.

  In April 1998 the Company amended its credit facilities with The Chase
Manhattan Bank by increasing the aggregate principal amount that may be borrowed
thereunder to $200,000 (the "Bank Credit Facility"). The Bank Credit Facility
consists of a $100,000 revolving credit facility and an acquisition facility of
up to $100,000. The acquisition facility is amortizable over five years
beginning in April 1999; the revolving credit facility expires in April 2004.
The Bank Credit Facility is collateralized by the Company's accounts receivable
and inventories and by substantially all of its other personal property. The
Bank Credit Facility contains customary affirmative covenants, negative
covenants and conditions of borrowing. At February 28, 1998, indebtedness under
the then-existing Bank Credit Facility consisted of letters of credit amounting
to approximately $4,500.

  The Company's capital expenditures were $28,923 and $14,471 during fiscal 1998
and 1997, respectively. The increase in capital expenditures was primarily
attributable to (i) the development of a new management information system to
replace the Company's existing systems, many of which were inherited in
acquisitions, and (ii) expenditures for plant modernization. The management
information system is expected to be installed over the

                                       28
<PAGE>   29
next 18 months and will be year 2000 compliant. The Company anticipates ongoing
annual capital expenditures of approximately $30,000 for the next several years
to be in line with the expanded growth in business and the recent acquisitions.

  The Company believes that the cash flow from operations, proceeds from the 8%
Notes and availability under the Bank Credit Facility will provide adequate
funds for its working capital needs, planned capital expenditures and debt
service requirements through the term of the Bank Credit Facility. The Company
believes that it will be able to refinance the Bank Credit Facility prior to its
termination, although there can be no assurance that it will be able to do so.
The Company's ability to fund its operations, make planned capital expenditures,
make scheduled payments and refinance its indebtedness depends on its future
operating performance and cash flow, which, in turn, are subject to prevailing
economic conditions and to financial, business and other factors, some of which
are beyond its control.

YEAR 2000 COSTS

      The Company has recognized the need to ensure that its computer systems
will not be adversely affected by the upcoming calendar year 2000. The Company
has assessed how it may be impacted by Year 2000 and has formulated and
commenced implementation of a comprehensive plan to address known issues as they
relate to its information systems. The plan, as it relates to information
systems, involves a combination of software modification, upgrades and
replacement. The Company estimates that the cost of Year 2000 compliance for its
information systems will not have a material adverse effect on the future
consolidated results of operations of the Company. However, the Company cannot
measure the impact that the Year 2000 issue will have on its vendors, suppliers,
customers and other parties with which it conducts its business.

INDUSTRY CONDITIONS

  The Company's principal customers are the world's commercial airlines. As a
result, the Company's business is directly dependent upon the conditions in the
commercial airline industry. In the late 1980s and early 1990s the world airline
industry suffered a severe downturn which resulted in record losses and several
air carriers seeking protection under bankruptcy laws. As a consequence, during
such period, airlines sought to conserve cash by reducing or deferring scheduled
cabin interior refurbishment and upgrade programs and delaying purchases of new
aircraft. This led to a significant contraction in the commercial aircraft cabin
interior products industry, and a decline in the Company's business and
profitability. The airline industry has now experienced five consecutive years
of profitability including record profitability in each of the last three
calendar years. This financial turnaround has, in part, been driven by record
load factors, rising fare prices and declining fuel costs. The airlines have
substantially restored their balance sheets through cash generated from
operations and debt and equity placements. As a result, the levels of airline
spending on refurbishment and new aircraft purchases have expanded. However, due
to the volatility of the airline industry there can be no assurance that the
current profitability of the airline industry will continue or that the airlines
will maintain or increase expenditures on cabin interior products for
refurbishments or new aircraft.

  In addition, the airline industry is undergoing a process of consolidation and
significantly increased competition. Such consolidation could result in a
reduction in future aircraft orders as overlapping routes are eliminated and
airlines seek greater economics through higher aircraft utilization. Increased
airline competition may also result in airlines seeking to reduce costs by
producing greater price competition from airline cabin interior products
manufacturers, thereby adversely affecting the Company's margins.

ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

This information required by this section is set forth on pages F-1 through F-20
of this report.

ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND
FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

None.


                                       29
<PAGE>   30
                                    PART III

ITEM 10.  DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT

      Information set forth under the caption "Election of Directors" in the
Proxy Statement to be filed with the Commission in connection with Company's
1998 Annual Meeting of Stockholders (the "Proxy Statement") is incorporated by
reference herein.

      Information relating to the executive officers of the Company is set forth
in Part I of this report under the caption "Executive Officers of the
Registrant."

ITEM 11.  EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

      Information set forth under the caption "Executive Compensation" in the
Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference herein. The Compensation Committee
Report and the Performance Graph included in the Proxy Statement are not
incorporated herein.

ITEM 12.  SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT

      Information set forth under the caption "Beneficial Ownership of Shares"
in the Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference herein.

ITEM 13.  CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS

      Information set forth under the caption "Certain Transactions" in the
Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference herein.

PART IV

ITEM 14.  EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES AND REPORTS ON FORM 8-K

(a) The following documents are filed as part of this report:

1.  Financial Statements (See page F-1).

         Consolidated Balance Sheets, February 28, 1998 and February 22, 1997.

         Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended February 28,
         1998, February 22, 1997 and February 24, 1996.

         Consolidated Statements of Stockholders' Equity for the Years Ended
         February 28, 1998, February 22, 1997 and February 24, 1996.

         Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended February 28,
         1998, February 22, 1997 and February 24, 1996.

         Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for the Years Ended February
         28, 1998, February 22, 1997 and February 24, 1996.

2. Financial Statement Schedules (See page F-20).

         Schedule II - Valuation and Qualifying Accounts for the Years Ended
         February 28, 1998, February 22, 1997 and February 24, 1996.


                                       30
<PAGE>   31
Exhibits - The following is a list of exhibits.

Exhibit Number                        Description

Exhibit 3           Articles of Incorporation and By-Laws


3.1                 Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation (1)


3.2                 Certificate of Amendment of the Restated Certificate of
                    Incorporation (2)


3.3                 Amended and Restated By-Laws


Exhibit 4           Instruments defining the rights of security holders,
                    including debentures


4.1                 Specimen Common Stock Certificate (1)


4.2                 Form of Note for the Registrant's Series B 9-7/8% Senior
                    Subordinated Notes (3)


4.3                 Indenture dated January 24, 1996 between Fleet National
                    Bank, as trustee, and the Registrant relating to the
                    Registrant's 9-7/8% Senior Subordinated Notes and Series B
                    9-7/8% Senior Subordinated Notes (3)


4.4                 Indenture dated February 13, 1998 for the Registrant's issue
                    of 8% Senior Subordinated Notes (4)


4.5                 Form of Note for the Registrant's 8% Senior Subordinated
                    Notes (4)


4.6                 Form of Stockholders' Agreement by and among the Registrant,
                    Summit Ventures II, L.P., Summit Investors II, L.P. and
                    Wedbush Capital Partners (5)


Exhibit 10(i)       Material Contracts


10.1                Supply Agreement dated as of April 17, 1990 between the
                    Registrant and Applied Extrusion Technologies, Inc. (1)


10.2                Amended and Restated Credit Agreement (the "Chase Credit
                    Agreement"), dated as of May 18, 1994 among the Registrant,
                    the banks named therein and The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A.
                    as Agent (6)10.3


10.3                Amendment No. 1 dated May 18, 1994 to the Chase Credit
                    Agreement (7)


10.4                Second Amended and Restated Chase Credit Agreement dated
                    January 19, 1996 (3)


10.5                Third Amended and Restated Chase Credit Agreement dated May
                    29, 1997 (4)

10.6                Fourth Amended and Restated Chase Credit Agreement dated
                    April 3, 1998


                                       31
<PAGE>   32
10.7                Receivables Sales Agreement dated January 24, 1996 among the
                    Registrant, First Trust of Illinois, N.A. and Centrally Held
                    Eagle Receivables Program, Inc. (3)


10.8                Escrow Agreement dated January 24, 1996 among the
                    Registrant, Eagle Industrial Product Corporation and First
                    Trust of Illinois, N.A. as Escrow Agent (3)


10.9                Acquisition Agreement dated as of December 14, 1995 by and
                    among the Registrant, Eagle Industrial Products Corporation,
                    Eagle Industries, Inc. and Great American Management and
                    Investment, Inc. (8)


10.10               Asset Purchase Agreement dated as of April 16, 1998 by and
                    between Stanford Aerospace Group, Inc. and the Registrant
                    (9)


10.11               Stock Purchase Agreement dated as March 31, 1998 by and
                    between the Registrant and Puritan-Bennet Corporation (10)


Exhibit 10(ii)      Leases


10.12               Lease dated May 15, 1992 between McDonnell Douglas Company,
                    as lessor, and the Registrant, as lessee, relating to the
                    Irvine, California property (2)


10.13               Lease dated September 1, 1992 relating to the Wellington,
                    Florida property (2)


10.14               Chesham, England Lease dated October 1, 1973 between
                    Drawheath Limited and The Peninsular and Oriental Steam
                    Navigation Company (assigned in February 1985)


10.15               Utrecht, The Netherlands Lease dated December 15, 1988
                    between the Pension Fund Foundation for Food Supply
                    Commodity Boards and Inventum


10.16               Utrecht, The Netherlands Lease dated January 31, 1992
                    between G.W. van de Grift Onroerend Goed B.V. and Inventum


10.17               Lease dated October 25, 1993 relating to the property in
                    Longwood, Florida (6)


Exhibit 10(iii)     Executive Compensation Plans and Arrangements


10.18               Amended and Restated 1989 Stock Option Plan (11)


10.19               Directors' 1991 Stock Option Plan (11)


10.20               1990 Stock Option Agreement with Richard G. Hamermesh (11)

                                       32
<PAGE>   33
10.21               1990 Stock Option Agreement with B. Martha Cassidy (11)


10.22               1990 Stock Option Agreement with Jim C. Cowart (11)


10.23               1990 Stock Option Agreement with Petros A. Palandjian (11)


10.24               1990 Stock Option Agreement with Hansjorg Wyss (11)


10.25               1991 Stock Option Agreement with Amin J. Khoury (11)


10.26               1991 Stock Option Agreement with Jim C. Cowart (11)


10.27               1992 Stock Option Agreement with Amin J. Khoury (11)


10.28               1992 Stock Option Agreement with Jim C. Cowart (11)


10.29               1992 Stock Option Agreement with Paul W. Marshall (11)


10.30               1992 Stock Option Agreement with David Lahar (11)


10.31               United Kingdom 1992 Employee Share Option Scheme (2)


10.32               1994 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (12)


10.33               Employment Agreement dated as of January 1, 1992 between the
                    Registrant and Amin J. Khoury (the "A. Khoury Agreement")


10.34               Amendment No. 2 dated as of April 1, 1996 to the A. Khoury
                    Agreement (13)


10.35               Employment Agreement dated as of March 1, 1992 between the
                    Registrant and Robert J. Khoury (the "R. Khoury Agreement")


10.36               Amendment No. 2 dated as of January 1, 1996 to the R. Khoury
                    Agreement (13)


10.37               Employment Agreement dated as of March 1, 1992 between the
                    Registrant and Marco Lanza (the "Lanza Agreement")


10.38               Amendment No. 1 dated as of January 1, 1996 to the Lanza
                    Agreement (13)


10.39               Employment Agreement dated as of April 1, 1992 between the
                    Registrant and G. Bernard Jewell


10.40               Employment Agreement dated as of May 1, 1994 between the
                    Registrant and Thomas P. McCaffrey (the "McCaffrey
                    Agreement") (6)


10.41               Amendment No. 1 dated as of January 1, 1996 to the McCaffrey
                    Agreement (13)


10.42               Employment Agreement dated as of May 1, 1994 between the
                    Registrant and Paul E. Fulchino (13)

                                       33
<PAGE>   34
10.43               BE Aerospace, Inc. Savings and Profit Sharing Plan and Trust
                    - - Financial Statements for the Ten Months Ended December
                    31, 1995 and the Year Ended February 28, 1995, Supplemental
                    Schedules and Independent Auditors' Report


10.44               BE Aerospace, Inc. 1994 Employee Stock Purchase Plan --
                    Financial Statements as of February 29, 1996 and February
                    26, 1995; and for the Year Ended February 29, 1996 and the
                    period from May 15, 1994 (inception) to February 28, 1995
                    and Independent Auditors' Report


Exhibit 21          Subsidiaries of the Registrant


Exhibit 23          Consent of Deloitte & Touche LLP


Exhibit 27          Financial Data Schedule for the Fiscal Year Ended
                    February 28, 1998


Exhibit 99.1        Risk Factors


(b) Reports on 
Form 8-K            None


- ------------------------------

(1)      Incorporated by reference to the Company's Registration Statement on
         Form S-1, as amended (No. 33-33689), filed with the Commission on March
         7, 1990.

(2)      Incorporated by reference to the Company's Registrant's Registration
         Statement on Form S-1, as amended (No. 33-54146), filed with the
         Commission on November 3, 1992.

(3)      Incorporated by reference to the Company's Registration Statement on
         Form S-4 (No. 333-00433), filed with the Commission on January 26,
         1996.

(4)      Incorporated by reference to the Company's Registration Statement on
         Form S-4 (No. 333-47649) filed with the Commission on March 10, 1998.

(5)      Incorporated by reference to the Company's Registration Statement on
         Form S-2 (No. 33-66490) filed with the Commission on July 23, 1993.

(6)      Incorporated by reference to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K
         as amended for the Fiscal year ended February 26, 1994, filed with
         Commission on May 25, 1994.

(7)      Incorporated by reference to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K,
         for the Fiscal year ended February 25, 1995, filed with the Commission
         on May 26, 1995.

(8)      Incorporated by reference to the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K
         dated December 14, 1995 filed with the Commission on December 28, 1995.

(9)      Incorporated by reference to the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K
         dated May 8, 1998, filed with the Commission on May 8, 1998.

(10)     Incorporated by reference to the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K
         dated March 31, 1998, filed with the Commission on April 27, 1998.

(11)     Incorporated by reference to the Company's Registration Statement on
         Form S-8 (No. 33-48119), filed with the Commission on May 26, 1992.

(12)     Incorporated by reference to the Company's Registration Statement on
         Form S-8 (No. 33-82894), filed with the Commission on August 16, 1994.

(13)     Incorporated by reference to the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K
         dated March 26, 1996, filed with the Commission on April 5, 1996.


                                       34
<PAGE>   35
                                   SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange
Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its
behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.


                               B/E AEROSPACE, INC.


                               By /s/ Robert J. Khoury
                                  -----------------------------------------
                                  Robert J. Khoury
                                  Vice Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
Dated:  May 27, 1998


Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report
has been signed on May 27, 1998 by the following persons on behalf of the
registrant in the capacities indicated.


     Signature                   Title


/s/ Amin J. Khoury               Chairman
    ----------------------
    Amin J. Khoury


/s/ Robert J. Khoury             Vice Chairman and  Chief Executive Officer
    ----------------------       and Director
    Robert J. Khoury


/s/ Paul E. Fulchino             President and Chief Operating Officer
    ----------------------       and Director
    Paul E. Fulchino


/s/ Thomas P. McCaffrey          Corporate Senior Vice President of
    ----------------------       Administration, Chief Financial Officer and
    Thomas P. McCaffrey          Assistant Secretary (principal financial and
                                 accounting officer)


/s/ Jim C. Cowart                Director
    ----------------------
    Jim C. Cowart


/s/ Richard G. Hamermesh         Director
    ----------------------
    Richard G. Hamermesh


/s/ Brian H. Rowe                Director
    ----------------------
    Brian H. Rowe


/s/ Hansjorg Wyss                Director
    ----------------------
    Hansjorg Wyss


                                       35
<PAGE>   36
                                  EXHIBIT INDEX

Exhibit No.                                 Description                     Page

3.3                 Amended and Restated By-Laws


10.6                Fourth Amended and Restated Chase Credit Agreement dated
                    April 3, 1998


10.14               Chesham, England Lease dated October 1, 1973 between
                    Drawheath Limited and The Peninsular and Oriental Steam
                    Navigation Company (assigned in February 1985)


10.15               Utrecht, The Netherlands Lease dated December 15, 1988
                    between the Pension Fund Foundation for Food Supply
                    Commodity Boards and Inventum


10.16               Utrecht, The Netherlands Lease dated January 31, 1992
                    between G.W. van de Grift Onroerend Goed B.V. and Inventum


10.33               Employment Agreement dated as of January 1, 1992 between the
                    Registrant and Amin J. Khoury (the "A. Khoury Agreement")


10.35               Employment Agreement dated as of March 1, 1992 between the
                    Registrant and Robert J. Khoury (the "R. Khoury Agreement")


10.37               Employment Agreement dated as of March 1, 1992 between the
                    Registrant and Marco Lanza (the "Lanza Agreement")


10.39               Employment Agreement dated as of April 1, 1992 between the
                    Registrant and G. Bernard Jewell


10.43               BE Aerospace, Inc. Savings and Profit Sharing Plan and Trust
                    -- Financial Statements for the Ten Months Ended December
                    31, 1995 and the Year Ended February 28, 1995, Supplemental
                    Schedules and Independent Auditors' Report


10.44               BE Aerospace, Inc. 1994 Employee Stock Purchase Plan --
                    Financial Statements as of February 29, 1996 and February
                    26, 1995; and for the Year Ended February 29, 1996 and the
                    period from May 15, 1994 (inception) to February 28, 1995
                    and Independent Auditors' Report


Exhibit 21          Subsidiaries of the Registrant


Exhibit 23          Consent of Deloitte & Touche LLP


Exhibit 27          Financial Data Schedule for the Fiscal Year Ended
                    February 28, 1998


Exhibit 99.1        Risk Factors


<PAGE>   37
ITEM 8.  INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SCHEDULE.
                                                                            Page


Independent Auditors' Report                                                 F-2

Financial Statements:

                    Consolidated Balance Sheets, February 28, 1998 and
                    February 22, 1997.                                       F-3

                    Consolidated Statements of Operations for the
                    Years Ended February 28, 1998, February 22,
                    1997 and February 24, 1996.                              F-4

                    Consolidated Statements of Stockholders' Equity
                    for the Years Ended February 28, 1998,
                    February 22, 1997 and February 24, 1996.                 F-5

                    Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the
                    Years Ended February 28, 1998, February 22,
                    1997 and February 24, 1996.                              F-6

                    Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for the
                    Years Ended February 28, 1998, February 22,
                    1997 and February 24, 1996.                              F-7

Financial Statement Schedule:

                    Schedule II - Valuation and Qualifying Accounts
                    for the Years Ended February 28, 1998,
                    February 22, 1997 and February 24, 1996.               F-20


                  [Remainder of page intentionally left blank]


                                      F-1
<PAGE>   38
                          INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT



The Board of Directors and Stockholders
B/E Aerospace, Inc.
Wellington, Florida


   We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of B/E
Aerospace, Inc. and subsidiaries as of February 28, 1998 and February 22, 1997,
and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders' equity and
cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended February 28, 1998.
Our audits also included the financial statement schedule on page F-21. These
financial statements and financial statement schedule are the responsibility of
the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these
financial statements and financial statement schedule based on our audits.

   We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

   In our opinion, such consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all
material respects, the financial position of B/E Aerospace, Inc. and
subsidiaries as of February 28, 1998 and February 22, 1997 and the results of
their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period
ended February 28, 1998, in conformity with generally accepted accounting
principles. Also, in our opinion, such financial statement schedule, when
considered in relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole,
presents fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein.


DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP


Costa Mesa, California
April 15, 1998




                                      F-2
<PAGE>   39
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS, FEBRUARY 28, 1998 AND FEBRUARY 22, 1997 
(Dollars in thousands, except share data)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
ASSETS                                                                 1998            1997
- ------                                                                 ----            ----
<S>                                                               <C>            <C>
CURRENT ASSETS:
    Cash and cash equivalents                                     $ 164,685      $   44,149
    Accounts receivable - trade, less allowance for doubtful
       accounts of $2,190 (1998) and $4,864 (1997)                   87,931          73,489
    Inventories, net                                                121,728          92,900
    Other current assets                                              7,869           2,781
                                                                  ---------        --------
       Total current assets                                         382,213         213,319
                                                                  ---------        --------


PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT, net                                         103,821          87,888
INTANGIBLES AND OTHER ASSETS, net                                   195,723         189,882
                                                                  ---------       ---------
                                                                  $ 681,757       $ 491,089
                                                                  =========       =========

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY

CURRENT LIABILITIES:
    Accounts payable                                             $   47,858      $   42,889
    Accrued liabilities                                              38,566          43,837
    Current portion of long-term debt                                33,285           4,419
                                                                 ----------       ---------
       Total current liabilities                                    119,709          91,145
                                                                 ----------       ---------

LONG-TERM DEBT                                                      349,557         225,402
DEFERRED INCOME TAXES                                                 1,207           1,667
OTHER LIABILITIES                                                    14,509           7,114

COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES                                             -               -

STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:
    Preferred stock, $.01 par value; 1,000,000 shares
       authorized; no shares outstanding                                  -               -
    Common stock, $.01 par value; 50,000,000 shares
       authorized; 22,891,918 (1998) and 21,893,392 (1997)
       shares issued and outstanding                                    229             219
    Additional paid-in capital                                      240,289         228,710
    Accumulated deficit                                             (40,724)        (62,286)
    Cumulative foreign exchange translation adjustment               (3,019)           (882)
                                                                 -----------    ------------
       Total stockholders' equity                                   196,775         165,761
                                                                 ----------     -----------
                                                                  $ 681,757      $  491,089
                                                                 ==========     ===========
</TABLE>

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                      F-3
<PAGE>   40
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1998, FEBRUARY 22, 1997 AND FEBRUARY 24, 1996
(Dollars in thousands, except per share data)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                               Year ended
                                                             ---------------------------------------------
                                                             February 28,     February 22,    February 24,
                                                                     1998             1997            1996
                                                                     ----             ----            ----
<S>                                                          <C>              <C>             <C>
NET SALES                                                       $ 487,999        $ 412,379       $ 232,582

COST OF SALES                                                     309,094          270,557         160,031
                                                                ---------        ---------       ---------

GROSS PROFIT                                                      178,905          141,822          72,551
OPERATING EXPENSES:
    Selling, general and administrative                            58,622           51,734          42,000
    Research, development and engineering                          45,685           37,083          58,327
    Amortization of intangible assets                              11,265           10,607           9,499
    Other expenses                                                  4,664             --             4,170
                                                                ---------        ---------       ---------
       Total operating expenses                                   120,236           99,424         113,996
                                                                ---------        ---------       ---------
                                                                                                   

OPERATING EARNINGS (LOSS)                                          58,669           42,398         (41,445)
INTEREST EXPENSE, net                                              22,765           27,167          18,636
                                                                ---------        ---------       ---------

EARNINGS (LOSS) BEFORE INCOME TAXES, EXTRAORDINARY
     ITEM AND CUMULATIVE EFFECT OF CHANGE
     IN ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLE                                       35,904           15,231         (60,081)

INCOME TAXES                                                        5,386            1,522            --
                                                                ---------        ---------       ---------

EARNINGS (LOSS) BEFORE EXTRAORDINARY ITEM AND
     CUMULATIVE EFFECT OF CHANGE IN ACCOUNTING
     PRINCIPLE                                                     30,518           13,709         (60,081)

EXTRAORDINARY ITEM                                                  8,956             --              --
                                                                ---------        ---------       ---------

EARNINGS (LOSS) BEFORE CUMULATIVE EFFECT
    OF CHANGE IN ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLE                              21,562           13,709         (60,081)

CUMULATIVE EFFECT OF CHANGE IN ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLE                  --               --           (23,332)
                                                                ---------        ---------       ---------

NET EARNINGS (LOSS)                                             $  21,562        $  13,709       $ (83,413)
                                                                =========        =========       =========

BASIC EARNINGS (LOSS) PER SHARE:
    Earnings (loss) before extraordinary item and
      cumulative effect of change in accounting principle       $    1.36        $     .77       $   (3.71)
    Extraordinary item                                               (.40)            --              --
    Cumulative effect of change in accounting principle              --               --             (1.44)
                                                                ---------        ---------       ---------
    Net earnings (loss)                                         $     .96        $     .77       $   (5.15)
                                                                =========        =========       =========
    Weighted average common shares                                 22,442           17,692          16,185
                                                                =========        =========       =========

DILUTED EARNINGS (LOSS) PER SHARE:
Earnings (loss) before extraordinary item and
  cumulative effect of change in accounting principle           $    1.30        $     .72       $   (3.71)
Extraordinary item                                                   (.38)         --              --
Cumulative effect of change in accounting principle                  --               --             (1.44)
                                                                ---------        ---------       ---------
Net earnings (loss)                                             $     .92        $     .72       $    5.15)
                                                                =========        =========       =========
Weighted average common shares                                     23,430           19,097          16,185
                                                                =========        =========       =========
</TABLE>

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                      F-4
<PAGE>   41
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
FOR THE YEARS ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1998, FEBRUARY 22, 1997 AND FEBRUARY 24, 1996
(in thousands)


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              Common Stock          Additional       Retained          Currency      Total
                                              ------------            Paid-in        Earnings        Translation  Stockholders'
                                          Shares         Amount       Capital       (Deficit)         Adjustment     Equity
                                          ------         ------     ----------      ---------        -----------  -------------

<S>                                       <C>         <C>            <C>            <C>               <C>            <C>
Balance, February 25, 1995                16,096      $     160      $ 119,209      $   7,418         $  (1,456)      $ 125,331
   Sale of stock under
    employee stock purchase plan              74              1            403             --                --             404
   Exercise of stock options                 121              2            896             --                --             898
   Employee benefit plan
    matching contribution                    102              1            858             --                --             859
   Net loss                                   --             --             --        (83,413)               --         (83,413)
   Foreign currency translation
     adjustment                               --             --             --             --                78              78
                                       ---------      ---------      ---------      ---------         ---------       ---------
Balance, February 24, 1996                16,393            164        121,366        (75,995)           (1,378)         44,157
   Sale of stock under
     employee stock purchase plan             58             --            482             --                --             482
   Exercise of stock options               1,362             14         11,650             --                --          11,664
   Employee benefit plan
    matching contribution                     75              1          1,316             --                --           1,317
   Sale of common stock
     under public offering                 4,005             40         93,896             --                --          93,936
   Net earnings                               --             --             --         13,709                --          13,709
   Foreign currency translation
     adjustment                               --             --             --             --               496             496
                                       ---------      ---------      ---------      ---------         ---------       ---------
Balance, February 22, 1997                21,893            219        228,710        (62,286)             (882)        165,761
   Sale of stock under
    employee stock purchase plan              88              1          1,796             --                --           1,797
   Exercise of stock options                 852              9          8,106             --                --           8,115
   Employee benefit plan
    matching contribution                     59             --          1,677             --                --           1,677
   Net earnings                               --             --             --         21,562                --          21,562
   Foreign currency translation
    adjustment                                --             --             --             --            (2,137)         (2,137)
                                       ---------      ---------      ---------      ---------         ---------       ---------
Balance, February 28, 1998                22,892      $     229      $ 240,289      $ (40,724)        $  (3,019)      $ 196,775
                                       =========      =========      =========      =========         =========       =========

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

</TABLE>

                                      F-5
<PAGE>   42
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1998, FEBRUARY 22, 1997 AND FEBRUARY 24, 1996
(Dollars in thousands)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:                                        1998              1997             1996
                                                                             ----              ----             ----

<S>                                                                       <C>              <C>              <C>       
  Net earnings (loss)                                                     $  21,562        $  13,709        $ (83,413)
    Adjustments to reconcile net earnings (loss) to
      net cash flows provided by (used in) operating activities:
        Extraordinary item                                                    8,956               --               --   
        Cumulative effect of accounting change                                   --               --           23,332
        Depreciation and amortization                                        24,160           24,147           18,435
        Deferred income taxes                                                  (460)             410           (3,453)
        Non cash employee benefit plan contributions                          1,677            1,317              859
    Changes in operating assets and liabilities, net of effects from
      acquisitions:
        Accounts receivable                                                 (14,665)         (19,366)           6,068
        Inventories                                                         (28,597)         (19,536)         (11,929)
        Other current assets                                                 (5,141)           5,059             (638)
        Accounts payable                                                      3,972           (4,767)           3,008
        Accrued and other liabilities                                        (1,866)         (11,564)          13,169
                                                                          ---------        ---------        ---------
Net cash flows provided by (used in) operating activities                     9,598          (10,591)         (34,562)
                                                                          ---------        ---------        ---------

CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
     Payments for purchase of property and equipment                        (28,923)         (14,471)         (13,656)
     Change in intangible and other assets                                  (15,686)          (1,331)          (5,914)
     Acquisitions                                                                --               --          (42,500)
                                                                          ---------        ---------        ---------
Net cash flows used in investing activities                                 (44,609)         (15,802)         (62,070)
                                                                          ---------        ---------        ---------

CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
     Net borrowings (repayments) under revolving lines of credit              5,450          (38,882)           2,000
     Proceeds from issuance of stock, net of expenses                        11,611          106,082            1,302
     Principal payments on long-term debt                                  (101,808)         (11,968)            (942)
     Proceeds from long-term debt                                           240,419             --            101,252
                                                                          ---------        ---------        ---------
Net cash flows provided by financing activities                             155,672           55,232          103,612
                                                                          ---------        ---------        ---------

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash flows                                  (125)             (66)              77
                                                                          ---------        ---------        ---------

Net increase in cash and cash equivalents                                   120,536           28,773            7,057
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year                                 44,149           15,376            8,319
                                                                          ---------        ---------        ---------
Cash and cash equivalents, end of year                                    $ 164,685        $  44,149        $  15,376
                                                                          =========        =========        =========

SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION

Cash paid (received) during year for:
      Interest, net                                                       $  25,065        $  26,097        $  16,967
      Income taxes                                                            5,012            1,209           (3,292)

SCHEDULE OF NON-CASH TRANSACTIONS:


  Liabilities assumed and accrued acquisition
    costs incurred in connection with the
       acquisitions                                                              --               --           27,532
</TABLE>


See notes to consolidated financial statements.


                                      F-6
<PAGE>   43
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1998, FEBRUARY 22, 1997 AND FEBRUARY 24, 1996
(Dollars in thousands, except per share data)

1.     SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

   Organization and Basis of Presentation -- B/E Aerospace, Inc. ("B/E" or the
"Company") operates in a single business segment and designs, manufactures,
sells and services a broad line of commercial aircraft cabin interior products
consisting of a broad range of aircraft seating products, passenger
entertainment and service systems, and interior systems products, including
structures as well as all food and beverage storage and preparation equipment.
The Company's customers are the world's commercial airlines. As a result, the
Company's business is directly dependent upon the conditions in the commercial
airline industry.

   Consolidation -- The accompany consolidated financial statements include the
accounts of B/E Aerospace, Inc., its wholly owned and majority owned
subsidiaries. All intercompany transactions and balances have been eliminated in
consolidation.

   Use of Estimates -- The preparation of financial statements in conformity
with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make
estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of
the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses
during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

   Income Taxes -- In accordance with Statement of Financial Accounting
Standards ("SFAS") No. 109, the Company provides deferred income taxes for
temporary differences between amounts of assets and liabilities recognized for
financial reporting purposes and such amounts recognized for income tax
purposes.

   Warranty Costs -- Estimated costs related to product warranties are accrued
at the time products are sold.

   Revenue Recognition -- Sales of assembled products, equipment or services are
recorded on the date of shipment or, if required, upon acceptance by the
customer. Revenues and costs under certain long-term contracts are recognized
using contract accounting. The Company sells its products primarily to airlines
worldwide, including occasional sales collateralized by letters of credit. The
Company performs ongoing credit evaluations of its customers and maintains
reserves for potential credit losses. Actual losses have been within
management's expectations.

   Cash Equivalents -- The Company considers all highly liquid debt instruments
purchased with an original maturity of three months or less to be cash
equivalents.

   Intangible Assets -- The Company accounts for the impairment and disposition
of long-lived assets in accordance with SFAS No. 121, "Accounting for the
Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to be Disposed Of". In
accordance with SFAS No. 121, long-lived assets to be held are reviewed for
events or changes in circumstances which indicate that their carrying value may
not be recoverable. The Company periodically evaluates the carrying value of the
intangible assets versus the cash benefit expected to be realized and adjusts
for any impairment of value.

   Research and Development -- Research and development expenditures are
expensed as incurred.

   Stock-Based Compensation -- In October 1995, the Financial Accounting
Standards Board ("FASB") issued SFAS No. 123, "Accounting for Stock-Based
Compensation", which became effective for the Company beginning during fiscal
1997. SFAS No. 123 requires extended disclosures of stock-based compensation
arrangements with employees and encourages (but does not require) compensation
cost to be measured based on the fair value of the equity instrument awarded.
Companies are permitted, however, to continue to apply Accounting Principles
Board ("APB") Opinion No. 25, which recognizes compensation cost based on the
intrinsic value of the equity instrument awarded. The Company continues to apply
APB Opinion No. 25 to its stock-based compensation awards to employees and
discloses the required pro forma effect on net income and earnings per share.
See Note 12.


                                      F-7
<PAGE>   44
   Earnings (Loss) Per Share -- In fiscal 1998, the Company adopted SFAS No.
128, "Earnings Per Share". Basic earnings per common share calculations are
determined by dividing earnings available to common shareholders by the weighted
average number of shares of common stock. Diluted earnings per share are
determined by dividing earnings available to common shareholders by the weighted
average number of shares of common stock and dilutive common stock equivalents
outstanding (all related to outstanding stock options discussed in Note 12). The
Company's reported primary earnings per share for fiscal 1997 have been restated
to comply with the requirements of SFAS No. 128. The effect on previously
reported earnings per share for fiscal 1997 was as follows:

     Primary earnings per share as reported                $  .72
     Effect of SFAS No. 128                                   .05
                                                           -------
     Basic EPS as restated                                 $  .77
                                                           ======

SFAS No. 128 had no impact on the Company's reported loss per share for fiscal
1996.

   Comprehensive Income - During 1997 the FASB issued SFAS No. 130, "Reporting
Comprehensive Income", which established standards for the reporting and
displaying of comprehensive income. Comprehensive income is defined as all
changes in a Company's net assets except changes resulting from transactions
with shareholders. It differs from net income in that certain items currently
recorded to equity would be a part of comprehensive income. Comprehensive income
must be reported in a financial statement with the cumulative total presented as
a component of equity. This statement will be adopted by the Company in its
fiscal 1999 quarterly financial statements.

   Segment Information - In June 1997, the FASB issued SFAS No. 131,
"Disclosures about Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information", which
will be effective for the Company beginning March 1, 1998. SFAS No. 131
redefines how operating segments are determined and requires disclosure of
certain financial and descriptive information about a company's operating
segments. The Company believes the segment information required to be disclosed
under SFAS No. 131 will be more comprehensive than previously provided,
including expanded disclosure of income statement and balance sheet items. The
Company has not yet completed its analysis of which operating segments it will
report on.

     Pensions and Other Postretirement Benefits -- In February 1998, FASB issued
SFAS No. 132, "Employers' Disclosure about Pensions and Other Postretirement
Benefits", which is effective for annual and interim periods beginning after
December 15, 1997. This statement standardizes the disclosure requirements for
pensions and other postretirement benefits to the extent practicable, requires
additional information on changes in the benefit obligations and fair values of
plan assets that will facilitate financial analysis and eliminates certain
disclosures that are no longer as useful as they were under previous statements.

   Foreign Currency Translation -- In accordance with the provisions of SFAS No.
52, "Foreign Currency Translation", the assets and liabilities located outside
the United States are translated into U.S. dollars at the rates of exchange in
effect at the balance sheet dates. Income and expense items are translated at
the average exchange rates prevailing during the period. Gains and losses
resulting from foreign currency transactions are recognized currently in income,
and those resulting from translation of financial statements are accumulated as
a separate component of stockholders' equity.

2.     ACCOUNTING CHANGE

   In fiscal 1996, the Company undertook a comprehensive review of the
engineering capitalization policies followed by its competitors and others in
its industry peer group. The results of this study and an evaluation of the
Company's policy led the Company to conclude that it should adopt the accounting
method that it believes is followed by most of its competitors and certain
members of its industry peer group. Previously, the Company had capitalized
precontract engineering costs as a component of inventories, which were then
amortized to earnings as the product was shipped. The Company now expenses such
costs as they are incurred. While the accounting policy for precontract
engineering expenditures previously followed by the Company was in accordance
with generally accepted accounting principles, the changed policy is preferable.


                                      F-8
<PAGE>   45
3.     ACQUISITIONS

   On January 24, 1996, the Company acquired all of the outstanding capital
stock of Burns Aerospace Corporation, which designs, manufactures, sells and
services aircraft seating products to commercial airlines worldwide. The
aggregate acquisition cost of $70,032 includes the payment of $42,500 to the
seller and the assumption of approximately $27,532 of liabilities, including
related acquisition costs and certain liabilities arising from the acquisition.
Funds for the acquisition were obtained from proceeds of the long-term debt
issuance described in Note 8.

   The aggregate purchase price for the Burns acquisition has been allocated to
the net assets acquired based on appraisals and management's estimates as
follows:

      Receivables                                                   $ 11,396
      Inventories                                                     12,624
      Other current assets                                               806
      Property and equipment                                          21,695
      Intangible and other assets                                     23,511
                                                                   ---------
                                                                    $ 70,032
                                                                   =========

4.     INVENTORIES

   Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or market. Cost is determined
using the weighted average cost method. Finished goods and work in process
inventories include material, labor and manufacturing overhead costs.
Inventories consist of the following:

                                                          1998          1997
                                                          ----          ----

      Raw materials                                  $  56,100      $ 45,947
      Work-in-process                                   59,036        39,024
      Finished goods                                     6,592         7,929
                                                     ---------       -------
                                                     $ 121,728      $ 92,900
                                                     =========      ========

                  [Remainder of page intentionally left blank]

                                      F-9
<PAGE>   46
5.     PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT

   Property and equipment are stated at cost and depreciated and amortized
generally on the straight-line method over their estimated useful lives of two
to thirty years (term of lease as to leasehold improvements). Property and
equipment consist of the following:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   Years                1998               1997
                                                                   -----                ----               ----

<S>                                                                <C>           <C>                  <C>      
          Land, buildings and improvements                         10-30         $    45,951          $  42,966
          Machinery                                                 3-13              54,178             45,444
          Tooling                                                   3-10              24,771             17,179
          Furniture and equipment                                   2-10              26,815             18,327
                                                                                  ----------          ---------
                                                                                     151,715            123,916
          Less accumulated depreciation and amortization                             (47,894)           (36,028)
                                                                                  ----------          ---------
                                                                                   $ 103,821          $  87,888
                                                                                   =========          =========
</TABLE>

6.     INTANGIBLES AND OTHER ASSETS

   Intangibles and other assets consist of the following:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                        Straight-line
                                                                         Amortization
                                                                       Period (Years)       1998           1997
                                                                       --------------       ----           ----

<S>                                                                    <C>             <C>            <C>        
                Covenants not-to-compete                                      14       $  10,195      $  10,198
                Product technology, production plans and drawings           7-20          60,577         59,484
                Replacement parts annuity                                     20          29,652         29,778
                Product approvals and technical manuals                       20          22,942         18,331
                Goodwill                                                      30          77,452         78,913
                Debt issue costs                                              10          16,789         13,431
                Trademarks and patents                                        20          10,491         10,820
                Other intangible assets                                     5-20          16,540          7,527
                Other assets                                                               4,277          6,744
                                                                                         -------      ---------
                                                                                         248,915        235,226
                         Less accumulated amortization                                   (53,192)       (45,344)
                                                                                      ----------     ----------
                                                                                       $ 195,723      $ 189,882
                                                                                       =========      =========
</TABLE>

7.     ACCRUED LIABILITIES

   Accrued liabilities consist of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                            1998           1997
                                                                                            ----           ----

<S>                                                                                   <C>            <C>       
           Accrued product warranties                                                 $    4,353     $    5,231
           Accrued salaries, vacation and related benefits                                17,022         12,868
           Accrued acquisition expenses                                                    1,190          5,488
           Accrued interest                                                                2,995          6,585
           Accrued income taxes                                                            5,373          6,563
           Other accrued liabilities                                                       7,633          7,102
                                                                                     -----------     ----------
                                                                                      $   38,566      $  43,837
                                                                                      ==========      =========
</TABLE>



                                      F-10
<PAGE>   47
8.     LONG-TERM DEBT

   Long-term debt consists of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                1998             1997
                                                ----             ----

<S>                                          <C>              <C>    
8% Senior Subordinated Notes                 $ 249,375        $    --
9 7/8% Senior Subordinated Notes               100,000          100,000
9 3/4% Senior Notes                             23,192          124,411
Revolving lines of credit                       10,093            4,419
Other long-term debt                               182              991
                                                              ---------
                                               382,842          229,821
Less current portion of long-term debt         (33,285)          (4,419)
                                             ---------        ---------
                                             $ 349,557        $ 225,402
                                             =========        =========
</TABLE>

8% SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES

   In February 1998, the Company sold $250,000 of 8% Senior Subordinated Notes,
priced to yield 8.02% (the "8% Notes"). In conjunction with the sale of the 8%
Notes, the Company initiated a tender offer for its 9 3/4% Notes. The net
proceeds from the offering of approximately $240,419 were used for the tender
offer (which expired on February 25, 1998) in which approximately $101,808 of
the 9 3/4% Notes were retired; the remaining $23,192 of the 9 3/4% Notes were
called on March 16, 1998. The Company incurred an extraordinary charge of $8,956
for unamortized debt issue costs, tender and redemption premiums and fees and
expenses related to the repurchase of the 9 3/4% Notes.

   The 8% Senior Notes are unsecured senior subordinated obligations of the
Company, are subordinated to all senior indebtedness of the Company and mature
on March 1, 2008. Interest on the 8% Notes is payable semi-annually in arrears
on March 1 and September 1 of each year. The 8% Notes are redeemable at the
option of the Company, in whole or in part, on or after March 1, 2003 at
predetermined redemption prices together with accrued and unpaid interest
through the date of redemption. In addition, at any time prior to March 1, 2001,
the Company may, at predetermined prices together with accrued and unpaid
interest through the date of redemption, redeem up to 35% of the aggregate
principal amount of the Notes originally issued with the net proceeds of one or
more equity offerings, provided that at least 65% of the aggregate principal
amount of the 8% Notes originally issued remains outstanding after the
redemption. Upon a change of control (as defined), each holder of the 8% Notes
may require the Company to repurchase such holder's 8% Notes at 101% of the
principal amount thereof, plus accrued interest to the date of such purchase.
The 8% Notes contain certain covenants, all of which were met by the Company as
of February 28, 1998, including limitations on future indebtedness, restricted
payments, transactions with affiliates, liens, dividends, mergers and transfers
of assets.

9 7/8% SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES

   The 9 7/8% Senior Subordinated Notes (the "9 7/8% Notes") are unsecured
senior subordinated obligations of the Company and are subordinated to all
senior indebtedness of the Company and mature on February 1, 2006. Interest on
the 9 7/8% Notes is payable semi-annually in arrears on February 1 and August 1
of each year. The 9 7/8% Notes are redeemable at the option of the Company, in
whole or in part, at any time after February 1, 2001 at predetermined redemption
prices together with accrued and unpaid interest through the date of redemption.
Upon a change of control (as defined), each holder of the 9 7/8% Notes may
require the Company to repurchase such holder's 9 7/8% Notes at 101% of the
principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest to the date of such
purchase. The 9 7/8% Notes contain certain restrictive covenants, all of which
were met by the Company as of February 28, 1998, including limitations on future
indebtedness, restricted payments, transactions with affiliates, liens,
dividends, mergers and transfers of assets.

9 3/4% SENIOR NOTES

   The 9 3/4% Senior Notes (the "9 3/4% Notes") are senior unsecured obligations
of the Company, ranking equally with any future senior obligations of the
Company. As described above, at February 28, 1998, $101,808 of the 9 3/4% Notes
had been repurchased; the balance of the 9 3/4% Notes were redeemed in March
1998.

                                      F-11
<PAGE>   48
CREDIT FACILITIES

   In April 1998, the Company amended its credit facilities with the Chase
Manhattan Bank by increasing the aggregate principal amount that may be borrowed
thereunder to $200,000 (the "Bank Credit Facility"). The Bank Credit Facility
consists of a $100,000 revolving credit facility and an acquisition facility of
up to $100,000. The acquisition facility is amortizable over five years
beginning April 1999; the revolving facility expires in April 2004. The Bank
Credit Facility is collateralized by the Company's accounts receivable and
inventories and by substantially all of its other personal property. The Bank
Credit Facility contains customary affirmative covenants, negative covenants and
conditions of borrowing, all of which were met by the Company as of February 28,
1998. At February 28, 1998, indebtedness under the then-existing Bank Credit
Facility consisted of letters of credit amounting to approximately $4,500.

   Borrowings under the Bank Credit Facility currently bear interest at LIBOR
plus 1.25% or prime (as defined). The interest to be charged on the Bank Credit
Facility can increase or decrease based upon specified operating performance
criteria set forth in the Bank Credit Facility Agreement. Amounts may be
borrowed or repaid in $1,000 increments.

   FEEL, a subsidiary of the Company, has a short-term revolving line of credit
agreement (the "FEEL Credit Agreement") which is collateralized by substantially
all of the assets of FEEL. Aggregate borrowings outstanding under the FEEL
Credit Agreement were approximately $10,093 as of February 28, 1998. The Company
has guaranteed a portion of the indebtedness outstanding under the FEEL Credit
Agreement.

   Inventum, another subsidiary of the Company, has a revolving line of credit
agreement for approximately $1 million (the "Inventum credit agreement"). The
Inventum Credit Agreement is collateralized by substantially all of the assets
of Inventum. There were no borrowings outstanding under the Inventum Credit
Agreement as of February 28, 1998.

       Maturities of long-term debt are as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
         Fiscal year ending February:
<S>                                                                <C>       
           1999                                                    $   33,285
           2000                                                           182
           2001                                                             -
           2002                                                             -
           2003                                                             -
         Thereafter                                                   349,375
                                                                    ---------
                                                                    $ 382,842
                                                                    =========

</TABLE>

   Interest expense amounted to $25,834, $28,369 and $18,788 for the years ended
February 28, 1998, February 22, 1997 and February 24, 1996, respectively.

9.     INCOME TAXES

   Income tax expense (benefit) consists of the following:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                        1998           1997           1996
                                     -------        -------        -------
<S>                                  <C>            <C>            <C>    
Current:
  Federal                            $  (920)       $  --          $ 1,972
  State                                 --             --              818
  Foreign                              6,766          1,112            663
                                     -------        -------        -------
                                       5,846          1,112          3,453
Deferred:
  Federal                             (3,666)         2,703         (2,635)
  State                                 (716)         1,550           (818)
  Foreign                               (460)           410           --
                                     -------        -------        -------
                                      (4,842)         4,663         (3,453)
 Change in Valuation Allowance         4,382         (4,253)          --
                                     -------        -------        -------
                                     $ 5,386        $ 1,522        $  --
                                     =======        =======        =======
</TABLE>


                                      F-12
<PAGE>   49
   The difference between income tax expense (benefit) and the amount computed
by applying the statutory U.S. federal income tax rate (35%) to the pretax
earnings before change in accounting principle consists of the following:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              1998            1997            1996
                                                          --------        --------        --------

<S>                                                       <C>             <C>             <C>      
Statutory U.S. federal income tax expense (benefit)       $  9,432        $  5,331        $(21,028)
Operating loss (with)/without tax benefit                   (6,114)         (6,164)         14,569
Foreign tax rate differential                                1,309           1,267           3,324
Goodwill amortization                                          537             566             558
Penalties                                                    1,050            --              --
Other, net                                                    (828)            522           2,577
                                                          --------        --------        --------
                                                          $  5,386        $  1,522        $   --
                                                          ========        ========        ========
</TABLE>


   The tax effects of temporary differences and carryforwards that give rise to
the Company's deferred income tax assets and liabilities consist of the
following:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                       1998            1997
                                                   --------        --------

<S>                                                <C>             <C>     
Accrued vacation                                   $  1,172        $  1,117
Inventory reserves                                    3,987           3,145
Acquisition reserves                                 (1,220)         (1,740)
Inventory costs capitalized for tax purposes          1,327           1,236
Bad debt reserves                                       579             948
Warranty reserve                                      2,440           1,452
Other                                                 1,731           1,723
                                                   --------        --------
     Net current deferred income tax asset           10,016           7,881
                                                   --------        --------

Intangible assets                                   (12,576)        (13,565)
Depreciation                                         (1,853)         (2,074)
Net operating loss carryforward                      27,462          26,309
Research credit carryforward                          3,285           2,941
                                                   --------        --------
Net noncurrent deferred income tax asset             16,318          13,611
                                                   --------        --------
Valuation allowance                                 (27,541)        (23,159)
                                                   --------        --------
     Net deferred tax liabilities                  $ (1,207)       $ (1,667)
                                                   ========        ========
</TABLE>

   Due to uncertainty surrounding the realization of the benefits of its net
deferred tax asset, the Company has established a valuation allowance of $27,541
against its otherwise recognizable net deferred tax asset.

   As of February 28, 1998, the Company had approximately $66,104 of federal
operating loss carryforwards, which expire at various dates through 2011,
federal research credit carryforwards of $3,285, which expire at various dates
through 2011, and alternative minimum tax credit carryforwards of $410, which
have no expiration date. Approximately $15,000 of the Company's net operating
loss carryforward related to non-qualified stock options will be credited to
additional paid-in-capital rather than income tax expense when utilized.

   The Company has not provided for any residual U.S. income taxes on the
approximately $6,005 of earnings from its foreign subsidiaries because such
earnings are intended to be indefinitely reinvested. Such residual U.S. income
taxes, if provided for, would be immaterial.

   The Company's federal tax returns for the years ended February 24, 1996 and
February 25, 1995 are currently under examination by the Internal Revenue
Service. Management believes that the resolution of this examination will not
have a material adverse effect on the Company's results of operations or its
financial condition.



                                      F-13
<PAGE>   50
10.    COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

   Leases -- The Company leases certain of its office, manufacturing and service
facilities and equipment under operating leases, which expire at various times
through February 2007. Rent expense for fiscal 1998, 1997 and 1996 was
approximately $8,848, $7,021 and $2,943, respectively. Future payments under
operating leases with terms currently greater than one year are as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
       Year ending February:
<S>                                                      <C>
       1999                                              $  7,658
       2000                                                 6,398
       2001                                                 5,079
       2002                                                 2,495
       2003                                                 2,041
       Thereafter                                             796
                                                         --------
                                                         $ 24,467
                                                         ========
</TABLE>

   Litigation -- The Company is a defendant in various legal actions arising in
the normal course of business, the outcome of which, in the opinion of
management, neither individually nor in the aggregate are likely to result in a
material adverse effect to the Company's financial statements.

   Employment Agreements -- The Company has employment and compensation
agreements with two key officers of the Company. One of the agreements provides
for an officer to earn a minimum of $550 adjusted annually for changes in the
consumer price index (as defined) per year through 2002, as well as a deferred
compensation benefit equal to the aggregate annual compensation earned through
termination and payable thereafter. Such deferred compensation will be payable
in equal monthly installments over the same number of years it was earned. The
other agreement provides for an officer to receive annual minimum compensation
of $550, and an incentive bonus not to exceed 100% of the officer's then-current
salary through 2001. In addition, when the officer terminates his employment,
the Company is obligated to pay the officer annually, as deferred compensation,
an amount equal to 100% of the officer's annual salary (as defined) for a period
of ten years from the date of termination. Such deferred compensation has been
accrued at the present value of the obligation at February 28, 1998.

   The Company has other employment agreements with certain key members of
management that provide for aggregate minimum annual base compensation of $1,825
expiring on various dates through 1999.

   Supply Agreement -- The Company had a supply agreement with Applied
Extrusion Technologies, Inc. ("AET"), a related party by way of common
management. Under this agreement, which was terminated in September 1997, the
Company agreed to purchase its requirements for certain component parts through
March 1998 at a price that results in a 33 1/3% gross margin to AET. The
Company's purchases under this contract for the years ended February 28, 1998,
February 22, 1997 and February 24, 1996, were $1,743, $1,642 and $1,301,
respectively.


                                      F-14
<PAGE>   51
11.    EMPLOYEE RETIREMENT PLAN

   In August 1988, the Company established a non-qualified contributory
profit-sharing plan. This plan was amended to incorporate a 401(k) Plan which
permits the Company to match a portion of employee contributions. Commencing in
1995, the Company's 401(k) Plan, was amended to permit the Company's matching
contribution to be made in common stock of the Company. The Company recognized
expenses of $1,677, $1,317 and $859 related to this plan for the years ended
February 28, 1998, February 22, 1997 and February 24, 1996, respectively.

12.    STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY

   Earnings (Loss) Per Share. The Company adopted No. SFAS No. 128 Earnings Per
Share during fiscal year 1998. SFAS No. 128 establishes standards for computing
and presenting basic and diluted earnings (loss) per share. All prior period
earnings (loss) per share data have been restated to conform with SFAS No. 128.
The following table sets forth the computation of basic and diluted earnings
(loss) per share for the years ended February 28, 1998, February 22, 1997 and
February 26, 996:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              1998           1997           1996
                                                          ========       ========       ======== 

<S>                                                       <C>            <C>            <C>      
Numerator - Net earnings (loss)                           $ 21,562       $ 13,709       $(83,413)
                                                          ========       ========       ========
Denominator:
Denominator for basic earnings (loss) per share -
   Weighted average shares                                  22,442         17,692         16,185
Effect of dilutive securities -
   Employee stock options                                      988          1,405              -
                                                          --------       --------       -------- 
Denominator for diluted earnings (loss) per share -
   Adjusted weighted average shares                         23,430         19,097         16,185
                                                          ========       ========       ======== 
Basic earnings (loss) per share                           $    .96       $    .77       $  (5.15)
                                                          ========       ========       ======== 
Diluted earnings (loss) per share                         $    .92       $    .72       $  (5.15)
                                                          ========       ========       ======== 
</TABLE>



   Stock Option Plans. The Company has various stock option plans, including the
1989 Stock Option Plan, the 1991 Directors Stock Option Plan, the 1992 Share
Option Scheme and the 1996 Stock Option Plan (collectively, the "Option Plans"),
under which shares of the Company's Common Stock may be granted to key employees
and directors of the Company. The Option Plans provide for granting key
employees options to purchase the Company's Common Stock. Options are granted at
the discretion of the compensation and stock option committee of the Board of
Directors. Options granted generally vest at the rate of 25% per year from the
date of grant and are exercisable to the extent vested and the option term
cannot exceed ten years.

   The following table sets forth options granted, canceled, forfeited and
outstanding:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                              February 28, 1998                 February 22, 1997                     February 26, 1996
                         ----------------------------      -----------------------------        ------------------------------


                                          Option Price                       Option Price                          Option Price
                                           Per Share                           Per Share                            Per Share
                          Options        (in dollars)         Options        (in dollars)         Options         (in dollars)
                         ---------       ------------       ----------       ------------        ----------       ------------
<S>                      <C>             <C>                <C>              <C>                 <C>              <C>
Outstanding,
  beginning of           2,447,425         .081-24.93        2,720,350         0.81-13.00        2,871,287         0.81-13.00
  period
Options granted          1,394,250        21.50-31.50        1,313,500        10.25-24.94          731,925         7.37-10.37

Options exercised         (852,174)       0.81-29.875       (1,361,925)       0.81-16.125         (139,750)         0.81-8.75

Options forfeited          (58,000)       7.63-29.875         (224,500)        7.38-16.13         (743,112)        7.00-13.00
                         ---------                          ----------                            --------
Outstanding, end
  of period              2,931,501         7.00-31.50        2,447,425          0.81-24.9         2,720,350         0.81-13.00
                         =========         ==========        =========        ===========         =========         ==========
Exercisable at end
  of year                1,317,503         7.00-31.50        1,374,927           0.81-4.9         2,223,225         0.81-13.00
                         =========         ==========        =========        ===========         =========         ==========
</TABLE>


                                      F-15
<PAGE>   52
   At February 28, 1998, options were available for grant under each of the
Company's option plans.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           Options Outstanding
                                           at February 28, 1998
 --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                    Weighted      Weighted Average        Options
     Range of          Options       Average         Remaining          Exercisable       Weighted Average
  Exercise Price     Outstanding  Exercise Price  Contractual Life  at February 28, 1998   Exercise Price
  --------------     -----------  --------------  ----------------  --------------------   --------------
                                                      (years)

<S>                  <C>          <C>             <C>               <C>                   <C>
$  7.00-$ 8.875       $691,800      $   8.36           5.82               623,675             $   8.35     
$ 10.00-$19.00        $798,826      $  17.27           8.45               313,328             $  18.14   
$ 21.50-$25.8125      $511,625      $  23.02           9.41               149,125             $  23.38   
$ 29.875-$31.50       $929,250      $  29.89           9.46               231,375             $  29.89   
</TABLE>

   The estimated fair value of options granted during fiscal 1998 was $13.56 per
share. The estimated fair value of options granted during fiscal 1997 was $16.60
per share. The Company applies APB Opinion No. 25 and related Interpretations in
accounting for its stock option and purchase plans. Accordingly, no compensation
cost has been recognized for its stock option plans and its stock purchase plan
other than that described above. Had compensation cost for the Company's stock
option plans and its stock purchase plans been determined consistent with SFAS
No. 123, the Company's net earnings and net earnings per share for the year
ended February 28, 1998 and February 22, 1997 would have been reduced to the pro
forma amounts indicated in the following table:


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                1998               1997
                                                ----               ----
<S>                                           <C>                <C>     
Net earnings   -  as reported                 $21,562            $ 13,709
Net earnings   -  pro forma                   $13,232            $ 10,709
Net earnings per share  -  as reported        $   .92            $    .72
Net earnings per share  -  pro forma          $   .56            $    .56
Weighted average and pro forma
     weighted average common shares             23,430             19,097
</TABLE>


   The fair value of each option grant is estimated on the date of grant using
the Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following weighted average
assumptions used for options granted in 1998 and 1997: risk-free interest rates
of 7.0% and 6.4%; expected dividend yields of 0.0%; expected lives of 3 years
and 4 years; and expected volatility of 40% and 43%, respectively.

   The impact of outstanding non-vested stock options granted prior to fiscal
1997 has been excluded from the pro forma calculation; accordingly, the 1998 and
1997 pro forma adjustments are not indicative of future period pro forma
adjustments, when the calculation will apply to all applicable stock options.

13.    EMPLOYEE STOCK PURCHASE PLAN

   The Company has established a qualified Employee Stock Purchase Plan, the
terms of which allow for qualified employees (as defined) to participate in the
purchase of designated shares of the Company's Common Stock at a price equal to
the lower of 85% of the closing price at the beginning or end of each
semi-annual stock purchase period. The Company issued 87,561 and 58,490 shares
of common stock during fiscal 1998 and 1997 pursuant to this plan at an average
price per share of $20.52 and $9.70, respectively.

                                      F-16
<PAGE>   53
14.    EXPORT SALES AND MAJOR CUSTOMERS

   Export sales from the United States to customers in foreign countries
amounted to approximately $132,831, $153,423 and $61,717 in fiscal 1998, 1997
and 1996, respectively. Total sales to all customers in foreign countries
amounted to approximately $232,691, $203,388 and $124,469 in fiscal 1998, 1997
and 1996, respectively. Total sales to Europe amounted to 23%, 29% and 18% in
fiscal 1998, 1997 and 1996, respectively. Total sales to Asia amounted to 18%,
16% and 20% in fiscal 1998, 1997 and 1996, respectively. Major customers (i.e.,
customers representing more than 10% of total sales) change from year to year
depending on the level of refurbishment activity and/or the level of new
aircraft purchases by such customers. During the fiscal year ended February 28,
1998, one customer accounted for approximately 18% of the Company's sales. There
were no major customers in fiscal 1997 or 1996.

15.    OTHER EXPENSES

   In January 1998, the Company resolved a long-running dispute with the U.S.
Government over export sales between 1992 and 1995 to Iran Air. The dispute
centered on shipments of aircraft seats and related spare parts for five
civilian aircraft operated by Iran. Iran Air purchased the seats in 1992 and
arranged for them to be installed by a contractor in France. At the time, Iran
was not the subject of a U.S. trade embargo. In connection with its sale of
seats to Iran Air, B/E applied for and was granted a validated export license by
the U.S. Department of Commerce. Other expenses for the year ended February 28,
1998 relate to fines, civil penalties and associated legal fees arising from the
settlement. Other expenses for the year ended February 24, 1996 relate to costs
associated with the integration and consolidation of the Company's European
seating business.

16.   FOREIGN OPERATIONS

     Geographic Area -- The Company operated principally in two geographic
areas, the United States and Europe during the years ended February 28, 1998,
February 22, 1997 and February 24, 1996. There were no significant transfers
between geographic areas during the period. Identifiable assets are those assets
of the Company that are identified with the operations in each geographic area.

   The following table presents net sales and operating income for the years
ended February 28, 1998, February 22, 1997 and February 24, 1996, and
identifiable assets as of February 28, 1998, February 22, 1997 and February 24,
1996 by geographic area.


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                  1998               1997               1996
                                  ----               ----               ----
<S>                            <C>                <C>                <C>      
Net Sales:

United States                  $ 365,957          $ 312,497          $ 169,830
Europe                           122,042             99,882             62,752
                               ---------          ---------          ---------
Total:                         $ 487,999          $ 412,379          $ 232,582
                               =========          =========          =========

OPERATING EARNINGS (LOSS):


United States                 $   38,928         $   33,834         $ (35,822)
Europe                            19,741              8,564            (5,623)
                               ---------          ---------          ---------
Total:                        $   58,669            $42,398         $ (41,445)
                               =========          =========          =========

IDENTIFIABLE ASSETS:

United States                  $ 541,675          $ 380,273          $ 332,832
Europe                           140,082            110,816            100,754
                               ---------          ---------          ---------
Total:                         $ 681,757          $ 491,089          $ 433,586
                               =========          =========          =========
</TABLE>


                                      F-17
<PAGE>   54
17.    FAIR VALUE INFORMATION

   The following disclosure of the estimated fair value of financial instruments
at February 28, 1998 and February 22, 1997 is made in accordance with the
requirements of SFAS No. 107, "Disclosures about Fair Value of Financial
Instruments". The estimated fair value amounts have been determined by the
Company using available market information and appropriate valuation
methodologies. However, considerable judgment is required in interpreting market
data to develop the estimates of fair value. Accordingly, the estimates
presented herein are not necessarily indicative of the amounts that the Company
could realize in a current market exchange. The use of different market
assumptions and/or estimation methodologies may have a material effect on the
estimated fair value amounts.

   The carrying amounts of cash and cash equivalents, accounts receivable-trade,
and accounts payable are a reasonable estimate of their fair values. At February
28, 1998, the Company's 8% Notes have a carrying value of $249,375 and fair
value of $248,750, while the Company's 9 7/8% Notes have a carrying value of
$100,000 and fair value of $107,500. Additionally, at February 28, 1998, the
Company's 9 3/4% Notes have a carrying value of $23,192 and fair value of
$24,410. The carrying amounts of other long-term debts approximate fair value
because the obligations either bear interest at floating rates or compare
favorably with fixed rate obligations that would be available to the Company.

   The fair value information presented herein is based on pertinent information
available to management as of February 28, 1998. Although management is not
aware of any factors that would significantly affect the estimated fair value
amounts, such amounts have not been comprehensively revalued for purposes of
these consolidated financial statements since that date, and current estimates
of fair value may differ significantly from the amounts presented herein.

18.    SELECTED QUARTERLY DATA (Unaudited)

       Summarized quarterly financial data for fiscal 1998 is as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                Year Ended February 28, 1998
                                             ---------------------------------------------------------------
                                                 First          Second            Third             Fourth
                                                Quarter         Quarter          Quarter            Quarter
                                                -------         -------          -------            -------

<S>                                          <C>               <C>              <C>              <C>        
Sales                                        $   113,846       $ 119,843        $ 128,998        $   125,312
Gross profit                                      41,063          44,149           46,650             47,043
Earnings before extraordinary item                 6,943           8,077            9,432              6,066
Extraordinary item                                   --              --               --              (8,956)
                                             -----------       ---------        ---------        ------------         
Net earnings (loss)                          $     6,943       $   8,077        $   9,432        $    (2,890)
                                             ===========       =========        =========        ============         


Basic net earnings (loss) per share:
    Before extraordinary item                $       .32       $     .36        $     .41        $        27
    Extraordinary item                                              --                --                (.40)
                                             -----------       ---------        ---------        ------------         
    Net earnings (loss) per share            $       .32       $     .36        $     .41        $      (.13)
                                             ===========       =========        =========        ============         

Diluted net earnings (loss) per share:
    Before extraordinary item                $       .30       $     .34              .40        $       .26
    Extraordinary item                              --              --                --                (.38)
                                             -----------       ---------        ---------        ------------         
    Net earnings (loss) per share            $       .30       $     .34              .40               (.12)
                                             ===========       =========        =========        ============         
</TABLE>




          Summarized quarterly financial data for fiscal 1997 is as follows:


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              Year Ended February 22, 1997
                                         ----------------------------------------------------------------
                                             First             Second             Third            Fourth
                                           Quarter            Quarter           Quarter           Quarter
                                         ---------          ---------         ---------         ---------

<S>                                      <C>                <C>               <C>               <C>      
Sales                                    $  97,302          $ 103,026         $ 107,823         $ 104,228
Gross profit                                32,547             34,439            36,510            38,326
Net earnings                                 1,433              1,863             4,131             6,282
Net earnings per share - Basic                 .09                .11               .24               .30
Net earnings per share - Diluted               .08                .10               .22               .29
</TABLE>


                                      F-18
<PAGE>   55
       SUBSEQUENT EVENTS (UNAUDITED)

           On April 13, 1998, the Company completed its acquisition of Puritan
       Bennett Aero Systems Co. ("PBASCO") for approximately $69,700 in cash and
       the assumption of liabilities aggregating approximately $2,810. PBASCO is
       the leading manufacturer of commercial aircraft oxygen delivery systems
       and passenger service unit components and systems, and is a major
       supplier of air valves, overhead lights and switches, crew masks and
       protective breathing devices for both commercial and general aviation
       aircraft. Based upon management's assumptions, a portion of the purchase
       price was allocated to purchased research and development that had not
       reached technological feasibility and had no future alternative use.
       During the first quarter of fiscal 1999, the Company will record a charge
       of approximately $37,000 for the acquisition of in-process research and
       development and acquisition related expenses.

           On April 21, 1998, the Company acquired substantially all of the
       Aircraft Modular Products (AMP) assets for approximately $118,000 in cash
       and assumed certain liabilities aggregating approximately $2,840. AMP is
       the leading manufacturer of cabin interior products for general aviation
       (business jet) and commercial - type VIP aircraft, providing a broad line
       of products including seating, sidewalls, bulkheads, credenzas, closets,
       galley structures, lavatories, tables and sofas; along with related spare
       parts. Based on management's assumptions, a portion of the purchase price
       was allocated to purchased research and development that had not reached
       technological feasibility and had no future alternative use. During the
       first quarter of fiscal 1999, the Company will record a charge of
       approximately $61,000 for the acquisition of in-process research and
       development and acquisition related expenses.


                                     F-19
<PAGE>   56
SCHEDULE II - VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1998, FEBRUARY 22, 1997 AND FEBRUARY 24, 1996
 (Dollars in thousands)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                         BALANCE                                                 BALANCE
                         AT BEGINNING                                            AT END
                         OF YEAR       EXPENSES      OTHER        DEDUCTIONS     OF YEAR
<S>                      <C>           <C>           <C>          <C>            <C>     
DEDUCTED FROM ASSETS:
Allowance for doubtful
  accounts:
1998                     $ 4,864       $   481       $  --          $ 3,155       $ 2,190 
1997                       4,973         2,144           (69)         2,184         4,864 
1996                       4,034           162         1,449 (1)        672         4,973 
                                                                                          
                                                                                          
Reserve for obsolete     
 inventories:             
1998                     $ 8,282       $ 9,973       $  --          $ 7,766       $10,489 
1997                      19,785         4,583         1,758         17,844(2)      8,282 
1996                      10,664         6,022         5,840(1)       2,741        19,785 
                                                                                          
                                                                                          
INCLUDED IN LIABILITIES: 
Accrued product          
 warranties:              
1998                     $ 5,231       $ 3,085       $  --          $ 3,963       $ 4,353 
1997                       3,455         6,325          (156)         4,393         5,231 
1996                       2,969         2,758           936 (1)      3,208         3,455 
</TABLE>

(1) Balances associated with the Burns acquisition.

(2) During fiscal 1997, the Company disposed of substantially all of the
    inventories which were fully reserved in fiscal years 1995 and 1996.


                                     F-20

<PAGE>   1


                                     BY-LAWS

                                       OF

                               BE AEROSPACE, INC.
                             (amended as of 5/27/92)

                  Section 1. LAW, CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION
                                   AND BY-LAWS

         1.1. These by-laws are subject to the certificate of incorporation of
the corporation. In these by-laws, references to law, the certificate of
incorporation and by-laws mean the law, the provisions of the certificate of
incorporation and the by-laws as from time to time in effect.

                             Section 2. STOCKHOLDERS

         2.1. ANNUAL MEETING. The annual meeting of stockholders shall be held
at 10:30 a.m. on the third Wednesday in July in each year, unless that day be a
legal holiday at the place where the meeting is to be held, in which case the
meeting shall be held at the same hour on the next succeeding day not a legal
holiday, or at such other date and time as shall be designated from time to time
by the board of directors and stated in the notice of the meeting, at which they
shall elect a board of directors and transact such other business as may be
required by law or these bylaws or as may property come before the meeting.

         2.2. SPECIAL MEETINGS. A special meeting of the stockholders may be
called at any time by the chairman of the board, if any, the president or the
board of directors. A special meeting of the stockholders shall be called by the
secretary, or in the case of the death, absence, incapacity or refusal of the
secretary, by an assistant secretary or some other officer, upon application of
a majority of the directors. Any such application shall state the purpose or
purposes of the proposed meeting. Any such call shall state the place, date,
hour, and purposes of the meeting.

         2.3. PLACE OF MEETING. All meetings of the stockholders for the
election of directors or for any other purpose shall be held at such place
within or without the State of Delaware as may be determined from time to time
by the chairman of the board, if any, the president or the board of directors.
Any adjourned session of any meeting of the stockholders shall be held at the
place designated in the vote of adjournment.


<PAGE>   2


         2.4. NOTICE OF MEETINGS. Except as otherwise provided by law, a written
notice of each meeting of stockholders stating the place, day and hour thereof
and, in the case of a special meeting, the purposes for which the meeting is
called, shall be given not less than ten nor more than sixty days before the
meeting, to each stockholder entitled to vote thereat, and to each stockholder
who, by law, by the certificate of incorporation or by these by-laws, is
entitled to notice, by leaving such notice with him or at his residence or usual
place of business, or by depositing it in the United States mail, postage
prepaid, and addressed to such stockholder at his address as it appears in the
records of the corporation. Such notice shall be given by the secretary, or by
an officer or person designated by the board of directors, or in the case of a
special meeting by the officer calling the meeting. As to any adjourned session
of any meeting of stockholders, notice of the adjourned meeting need not be
given if the time and place thereof are announced at the meeting at which the
adjournment was taken except that if the adjournment is for more than thirty
days or if after the adjournment a new record date is set for the adjourned
session, notice of any such adjourned session of the meeting shall be given in
the manner heretofore described. No notice of any meeting of stockholders or any
adjourned session thereof need be given to a stockholder if a written waiver of
notice, executed before or after the meeting or such adjourned session by such
stockholder, is filed with the records of the meeting or if the stockholder
attends such meeting without objecting at the beginning of the meeting to the
transaction of any business because the meeting is not lawfully called or
convened. Neither the business to be transacted at, nor the purpose of, any
meeting of the stockholders or any adjourned session thereof need be specified
in any written waiver of notice.

         2.5. QUORUM OF STOCKHOLDERS. At any meeting of the stockholders a
quorum as to any matter shall consist of a majority of the votes entitled to be
cast on the matter, except where a larger quorum is required by law, by the
certificate of incorporation or by these by-laws. Any meeting may be adjourned
from time to time by a majority of the votes properly cast upon the question,
whether or not a quorum is present. If a quorum is present at an original
meeting, a quorum need not be present at an adjourned session of that meeting.
Shares of its own stock belonging to the corporation or to another corporation,
if a majority of the shares entitled to vote in the election of directors of
such other corporation is held, directly or indirectly, by the corporation,
shall neither be entitled to vote nor be counted for quorum purposes; provided,
however, that the foregoing shall not limit the right of any corporation to vote
stock, including but not limited to its own stock, held by it in a fiduciary
capacity.

         2.6. ACTION BY VOTE. When a quorum is present at any meeting, a
plurality of the votes properly cast for election to any office shall elect to
such office and a majority of the votes properly cast upon any question other
than an election to an office shall decide the question, except when a larger
vote is required by law, by the certificate of incorporation or by these
by-laws. No ballot shall be required for any election unless requested by a
stockholder present or represented at the meeting and entitled to vote in the
election.


                                      -2-
<PAGE>   3
         2.7. ACTION WITHOUT MEETINGS. Unless otherwise provided in the
certificate of incorporation, any action required or permitted to be taken by
stockholders for or in connection with any corporate action may be taken without
a meeting, without prior notice and without a vote, if a consent in writing,
setting forth the action so taken, shall be signed by the holders of outstanding
stock having not less than the minimum number of votes that would be necessary
to authorize or take such action at a meeting at which all shares entitled to
vote thereon were present and voted.

         If action is taken by unanimous consent of stockholders, the writing or
writings comprising such unanimous consent shall be filed with the records of
the meetings of stockholders.

         If action is taken by less than unanimous consent of stockholders and
in accordance with the foregoing, there shall be filed with the records of the
meetings of stockholders the writing or writings comprising such less than
unanimous consent. Prompt notice of the taking of the corporate action without a
meeting by less than unanimous written consent shall be given to those who have
not consented in writing and a certificate signed and attested to by the
secretary that such notice was given shall be filed with the records of the
meetings of stockholders.

         In the event that the action which is consented to is such as would
have required the filing of a certificate under any of the provisions of the
General Corporation Law of Delaware, if such action had been voted upon by the
stockholders at a meeting thereof, the certificate filed under such provision
shall state that written consent has been given under Section 228 of said
General Corporation Law, in lieu of stating that the stockholders have voted
upon the corporate action in question, if such last mentioned statement is
required thereby.

         2.8. PROXY REPRESENTATION. Every stockholder may authorize another
person or persons to act for him by proxy in all matters in which a stockholder
is entitled to participate, whether by waiving notice of any meeting, objecting
to or voting or participating at a meeting, or expressing consent or dissent
without a meeting. Every proxy must be signed by the stockholder or by his
attorney-in-fact. No proxy shall be voted or acted upon after three years from
its date unless such proxy provides for a longer period. A duly executed proxy
shall be irrevocable if it states that it is irrevocable and, if, and only as
long as, it is coupled with an interest sufficient in law to support an
irrevocable power. A proxy may be made irrevocable regardless of whether the
interest with which it is coupled is an interest in the stock itself or an
interest in the corporation generally. The authorization of a proxy may but need
not be limited to specified action, provided, however, that if a proxy limits
its authorization to a meeting or meetings of stockholders, unless otherwise
specifically provided such proxy shall entitle the holder thereof to vote at any
adjourned session but shall not be valid after the final adjournment thereof.


                                       -3-
<PAGE>   4
         2.9. INSPECTORS. The directors or the person presiding at the meeting
may, but need not, appoint one or more inspectors of election and any substitute
inspectors to act at the meeting or any adjournment thereof. Each inspector,
before entering upon the discharge of his duties, shall take and sign an oath
faithfully to execute the duties of inspector at such meeting with strict
impartiality and according to the best of his ability. The inspectors, if any,
shall determine the number of shares of stock outstanding and the voting power
of each, the shares of stock represented at the meeting, the existence of a
quorum, the validity and effect of proxies, and shall receive votes, ballots or
consents, hear and determine all challenges and questions arising in connection
with the right to vote, count and tabulate all votes, ballots or consents,
determine the result, and do such acts as are proper to conduct the election or
vote with fairness to all stockholders. On request of the person presiding at
the meeting, the inspectors shall make a report in writing of any challenge,
question or matter determined by them and execute a certificate of any fact
found by them.

         2.10. LIST OF STOCKHOLDERS. The secretary shall prepare and make, at
least ten days before every meeting of stockholders, a complete list of the
stockholders entitled to vote at such meeting, arranged in alphabetical order
and showing the address of each stockholder and the number of shares registered
in his name. The stock ledger shall be the only evidence as to who are
stockholders entitled to examine such list or to vote in person or by proxy at
such meeting.

                         Section 3. BOARD OF DIRECTORS

         3.1. NUMBER. The number of directors which shall constitute the whole
board shall not be less than one in number. Thereafter, within the foregoing
limits, the stockholders at the annual meeting shall determine the number of
directors and shall elect the number of directors as determined. Within the
foregoing limits, the number of directors may be increased at any time or from
time to time by the stockholders or by the directors by vote of a majority of
the directors then in office. The number of directors may be decreased to any
number permitted by the foregoing at any time either by the stockholders or by
the directors by vote of a majority of the directors then in office, but only to
eliminate vacancies existing by reason of the death, resignation or removal of
one or more directors. Directors need not be stockholders.

         3.2. CLASSIFICATION, ELECTION AND TENURE. The directors, other than
those who may be elected by the holders of any class or series of preference
stock voting separately by class or series, shall be classified, with respect to
the duration of the term for which they severally hold office, into three
classes, designated Class I, Class II, and Class III, which shall be as nearly
equal in number as possible and as provided by resolution of the board of
directors in connection with such election.

         Each initial director in Class I shall hold office for a term expiring
at the 1992 annual meeting of stockholders; each initial director of Class II
shall hold office for a term expiring at the 1993 annual meeting of
stockholders; and each initial director of Class III shall hold office


                                       -4-
<PAGE>   5
for a term expiring at the 1994 annual meeting of stockholders. Each director
shall serve until his successor is duly elected and qualified or until his
earlier death, resignation, removal or disqualification. At each annual meeting
of stockholders following the 1991 annual meeting, the stockholders shall elect
the successors to the class of directors whose term expires at that meeting to
hold office for a term expiring at the annual meeting of stockholders held in
the third year following the year of their election and until their successors
have been duly elected and qualified or until their earlier death, resignation,
removal or disqualification.

         The board of directors shall increase or decrease the number of
directors in one or more classes as may be appropriate whenever it increases or
decreases the number of directors pursuant to Section 3.1, in order to ensure
that the three classes shall be as nearly equal in number as possible.

         3.3. POWERS. The business and affairs of the corporation shall be
managed by or under the direction of the board of directors who shall have and
may exercise all the powers of the corporation and do all such lawful acts and
things as are not by law, the certificate of incorporation or these by-laws
directed or required to be exercised or done by the stockholders.

         3.4. VACANCIES. Vacancies and any newly created directorships resulting
from any increase in the number of directors may be filled by vote of the
stockholders at a meeting called for the purpose, or by a majority of the
directors then in office, although less than a quorum, or by a sole remaining
director. When one or more directors shall resign from the board, effective at a
future date, a majority of the directors then in office, including those who
have resigned, shall have power to fill such vacancy or vacancies, the vote or
action by writing thereon to take effect when such resignation or resignations
shall become effective. The directors shall have and may exercise all their
powers notwithstanding the existence of one or more vacancies in their number,
subject to any requirements of law or of the certificate of incorporation or of
these by-laws as to the number of directors required for a quorum or for any
vote or other actions.

         3.5. COMMITTEES. The board of directors may, by vote of a majority of
the whole board, (a) designate, change the membership of or terminate the
existence of any committee or committees, each committee to consist of one or
more of the directors; (b) designate one or more directors as alternate members
of any such committee who may replace any absent or disqualified member at any
meeting of the committee; and (c) determine the extent to which each such
committee shall have and may exercise the powers of the board of directors in
the management of the business and affairs of the corporation, including the
power to authorize the seal of the corporation to be affixed to all papers which
require it and the power and authority to declare dividends or to authorize the
issuance of stock; excepting, however, such powers which by law, by the
certificate of incorporation or by these by-laws they are prohibited from so
delegating. In the absence or disqualification of any member of such committee
and his alternate, if any, the member or members thereof present at any meeting
and not disqualified

                                       -5-
<PAGE>   6


from voting, whether or not constituting a quorum, may unanimously appoint
another member of the board of directors to act at the meeting in the place of
any such absent or disqualified member. Except as the board of directors may
otherwise determine, any committee may make rules for the conduct of its
business, but unless otherwise provided by the board or such rules, its business
shall be conducted as nearly as may be in the same manner as is provided by
these by-laws for the conduct of business by the board of directors. Each
committee shall keep regular minutes of its meetings and report the same to the
board of directors upon request.

         3.6. REGULAR MEETINGS. Regular meetings of the board of directors may
be held without call or notice at such places within or without the State of
Delaware and at such times as the board may from time to time determine,
provided that notice of the first regular meeting following any such
determination shall be given to absent directors. A regular meeting of the
directors may be held without call or notice immediately after and at the same
place as the annual meeting of stockholders.

         3.7. SPECIAL MEETINGS. Special meetings of the board of directors may
be held at any time and at any place within or without the State of Delaware
designated in the notice of the meeting, when called by the chairman of the
board, if any, the president, or by one-third or more in number of the
directors, reasonable notice thereof being given to each director by the
secretary or by the chairman of the board, if any, the president or any one of
the directors calling the meeting.

         3.8. NOTICE. It shall be reasonable and sufficient notice to a director
to send notice by mail at least forty-eight hours or by telegram at least
twenty-four hours before the meeting addressed to him at his usual or last known
business or residence address or to give notice to him in person or by telephone
at least twenty-four hours before the meeting. Notice of a meeting need not be
given to any director if a written waiver of notice, executed by him before or
after the meeting, is filed with the records of the meeting, or to any director
who attends the meeting without protesting prior thereto or at its commencement
the lack of notice to him. Neither notice of a meeting nor a waiver of a notice
need specify the purposes of the meeting.

         3.9. QUORUM. Except as may be otherwise provided by law, by the
certificate of incorporation or by these by-laws, at any meeting of the
directors a majority of the directors then in office shall constitute a quorum;
a quorum shall not in any case be less than one-third of the total number of
directors constituting the whole board. Any meeting may be adjourned from time
to time by a majority of the votes cast upon the question, whether or not a
quorum is present, and the meeting may be held as adjourned without further
notice.

         3.10. ACTION BY VOTE. Except as may be otherwise provided by law, by
the certificate of incorporation or by these by-laws, when a quorum is present
at any meeting the vote of a majority of the directors present shall be the act
of the board of directors.


                                      -6-
<PAGE>   7


         3.11. ACTION WITHOUT A MEETING. Any action required or permitted to be
taken at any meeting of the board of directors or a committee thereof may be
taken without a meeting if all the members of the board or of such committee, as
the case may be, consent thereto in writing, and such writing or writings are
filed with the records of the meetings of the board or of such committee. Such
consent shall be treated for all purposes as the act of the board or of such
committee, as the case may be.

         3.12. PARTICIPATION IN MEETINGS BY CONFERENCE TELEPHONE. Members of the
board of directors, or any committee designated by such board, may participate
in a meeting of such board or committee by means of conference telephone or
similar communications equipment by means of which all persons participating in
the meeting can hear each other or by any other means permitted by law. Such
participation shall constitute presence in person at such meeting.

         3.13. COMPENSATION. In the discretion of the board of directors, each
director may be paid such fees for his services as director and be reimbursed
for his reasonable expenses incurred in the performance of his duties as
director as the board of directors from time to time may determine. Nothing
contained in this section shall be construed to preclude any director from
serving the corporation in any other capacity and receiving reasonable
compensation therefor.

         3.14.  INTERESTED DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS.

         (a) No contract or transaction between the corporation and one or more
of its directors or officers, or between the corporation and any other
corporation, partnership, association, or other organization in which one or
more of the corporation's directors or officers are directors or officers, or
have a financial interest, shall be void or voidable solely for this reason, or
solely because the director or officer is present at or participates in the
meeting of the board or committee thereof which authorizes the contract or
transaction, or solely because his or their votes are counted for such purpose,
if:

         (1) The material facts as to his relationship or interest and as to the
contract or transaction are disclosed or are known to the board of directors or
the committee, and the board or committee in good faith authorizes the contract
or transaction by the affirmative votes of a majority of the disinterested
directors, even though the disinterested directors be less than a quorum; or 

         (2) The material facts as to his relationship or interest and as to the
contract or transaction are disclosed or are known to the stockholders entitled
to vote thereon, and the contract or transaction is specifically approved in
good faith by vote of the stockholders; or

         (3) The contract or transaction is fair as to the corporation as of the
time it is authorized, approved or ratified, by the board of directors, a
committee thereof, or the stockholders.


                                      -7-
<PAGE>   8
         (b) Common or interested directors may be counted in determining the
presence of a quorum at a meeting of the board of directors or of a committee
which authorizes the contract or transaction.

                         Section 4. OFFICERS AND AGENTS

         4.1. ENUMERATION; QUALIFICATION. The officers of the corporation shall
be a president, a treasurer, a secretary and such other officers, if any, as the
board of directors from time to time may in its discretion elect or appoint
including without limitation a chairman of the board, one or more vice
presidents and a controller. The corporation may also have such agents, if any,
as the board of directors from time to time may in its discretion choose. Any
officer may be but none need be a director or stockholder. Any two or more
offices may be held by the same person. Any officer may be required by the board
of directors to secure the faithful performance of his duties to the corporation
by giving bond in such amount and with sureties or otherwise as the board of
directors may determine.

         4.2. POWERS. Subject to law, to the certificate of incorporation and to
the other provisions of these by-laws, each officer shall have, in addition to
the duties and powers herein set forth, such duties and powers as are commonly
incident to his office and such additional duties and powers as the board of
directors may from time to time designate.

         4.3. ELECTION. The officers may be elected by the board of directors at
their first meeting following the annual meeting of the stockholders or at any
other time. At any time or from time to time the directors may delegate to any
officer their power to elect or appoint any other officer or any agents.

         4.4. TENURE. Each officer shall hold office until the first meeting of
the board of directors following the next annual meeting of the stockholders and
until his respective successor is chosen and qualified unless a shorter period
shall have been specified by the terms of his election or appointment, or in
each case until he sooner dies, resigns, is removed or becomes disqualified.
Each agent shall retain his authority at the pleasure of the directors, or the
officer by whom he was appointed or by the officer who then holds agent
appointive power.

         4.5. CHAIRMAN OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS, PRESIDENT AND VICE PRESIDENT.
The chairman of the board, if any, shall have such duties and powers as shall be
designated from time to time by the board of directors. Unless the board of
directors otherwise specifies, the chairman of the board, or if there is none
the chief executive officer, shall preside, or designate the person who shall
preside, at all meetings of the stockholders and of the board of directors.

         Unless the board of directors otherwise specifies, the president shall
be the chief executive officer and shall have direct charge of all business
operations of the corporation and,

                                       -8-
<PAGE>   9
subject to the control of the directors, shall have general charge and
supervision of the business of the corporation.

         Any vice presidents shall have such duties and powers as shall be set
forth in these by-laws or as shall be designated from time to time by the board
of directors or by the president.

         4.6. TREASURER AND ASSISTANT TREASURERS. The treasurer shall be the
chief financial officer of the corporation and shall be in charge of its funds
and valuable papers, and shall have such other duties and powers as may be
designated from time to time by the board of directors or by the president. If
no controller is elected, the treasurer shall also have the duties and powers of
the controller.

         Any assistant treasurers shall have such duties and powers as shall be
designated from time to time by the board of directors, the president or the
treasurer.

         4.7. CONTROLLER AND ASSISTANT CONTROLLERS. If a controller is elected,
he shall be the chief accounting officer of the corporation and shall be in
charge of its books of account and accounting records, and of its accounting
procedures. He shall have such other duties and powers as may be designated from
time to time by the board of directors, the president or the treasurer.

         Any assistant controller shall have such duties and powers as shall be
designated from time to time by the board of directors, the president, the
treasurer or the controller.

         4.8. SECRETARY AND ASSISTANT SECRETARIES. The secretary shall record
all proceedings of the stockholders, of the board of directors and of committees
of the board of directors in a book or series of books to be kept therefor and
shall file therein all actions by written consent of stockholders or directors.
In the absence of the secretary from any meeting, an assistant secretary, or if
there be none or he is absent, a temporary secretary chosen at the meeting,
shall record the proceedings thereof. Unless a transfer agent has been appointed
the secretary shall keep or cause to be kept the stock and transfer records of
the corporation, which shall contain the names and record addresses of all
stockholders and the number of shares registered in the name of each
stockholder. He shall have such other duties and powers as may from time to time
be designated by the board of directors or the president.

         Any assistant secretaries shall have such duties and powers as shall be
designated from time to time by the board of directors, the president or the
secretary.

                      Section 5. RESIGNATIONS AND REMOVALS

         5.1. Any director or officer may resign at any time by delivering his
resignation in writing to the chairman of the board, if any, the president, or
the secretary or to a meeting of the board of directors. Such resignation shall
be effective upon receipt unless specified to be

                                       -9-
<PAGE>   10
effective at some other time, and without in either case the necessity of its
being accepted unless the resignation shall so state. Except as otherwise
provided in the certificate of incorporation or these by-laws relating to the
rights of the holders of any class or series of preference stock, voting
separately by class or series, to elect directors under specified circumstances,
any director or directors may be removed from office at any time, but only for
cause and only by the affirmative vote, at any regular meeting or special
meeting of the stockholders, of not less than two-thirds of the total number of
votes of the then outstanding shares of capital stock of the corporation
entitled to vote generally in the election of directors, voting together as a
single class, but only if notice of such proposal was contained in the notice of
such meeting. Any vacancy in the board of directors resulting from any such
removal may be filed by vote of a majority of the directors then in office,
although less than a quorum, and any director or directors so chosen shall hold
office until the next election of the class for which such directors shall have
been chosen and until their successors shall be elected and qualified or until
their earlier death, resignation or removal. The board of directors may at any
time remove any officer either with or without cause. The board of directors may
at any time terminate or modify the authority of any agent. No director or
officer resigning and (except where a right to receive compensation shall be
expressly provided in a duly authorized written agreement with the corporation)
no director or officer removed shall have any right to any compensation as such
director or officer for any period following his resignation or removal, or any
right to damages on account of such removal, whether his compensation be by the
month or by the year or otherwise; unless, in the case of a resignation, the
directors, or, in the case of removal, the body acting on the removal, shall in
their or its discretion provide for compensation.

                              Section 6. VACANCIES

         6.1. If the office of the president or the treasurer or the secretary
becomes vacant, the directors may elect a successor by vote of a majority of the
directors then in office. If the office of any other officer becomes vacant, any
person or body empowered to elect or appoint that officer may choose a
successor. Each such successor shall hold office for the unexpired term, and in
the case of the president, the treasurer and the secretary until his successor
is chosen and qualified or in each case until he sooner dies, resigns, is
removed or becomes disqualified. Any vacancy of a directorship shall be filled
as specified in Section 3.4 of these by-laws.

                            Section 7. CAPITAL STOCK

         7.1. STOCK CERTIFICATES. Each stockholder shall be entitled to a
certificate stating the number and the class and the designation of the series,
if any, of the shares held by him, in such form as shall, in conformity to law,
the certificate of incorporation and the by-laws, be prescribed from time to
time by the board of directors. Such certificate shall be signed by the chairman
or vice chairman of the board, if any, or the president or a vice president and
by the treasurer or an assistant treasurer or by the secretary or an assistant
secretary. Any of or all

                                      -10-
<PAGE>   11
the signatures on the certificate may be a facsimile. In case an officer,
transfer agent, or registrar who has signed or whose facsimile signature has
been placed on such certificate shall have ceased to be such officer, transfer
agent, or registrar before such certificate is issued, it may be issued by the
corporation with the same effect as if he were such officer, transfer agent, or
registrar at the time of its issue.

         7.2. LOSS OF CERTIFICATES. In the case of the alleged theft, loss,
destruction or mutilation of a certificate of stock, a duplicate certificate may
be issued in place thereof, upon such terms, including receipt of a bond
sufficient to indemnify the corporation against any claim on account thereof, as
the board of directors may prescribe.

                     Section 8. TRANSFER OF SHARES OF STOCK

         8.1. TRANSFER ON BOOKS. Subject to the restrictions, if any, stated or
noted on the stock certificate, shares of stock may be transferred on the books
of the corporation by the surrender to the corporation or its transfer agent of
the certificate therefor properly endorsed or accompanied by a written
assignment and power of attorney properly executed, with necessary transfer
stamps affixed, and with such proof of the authenticity of signature as the
board of directors or the transfer agent of the corporation may reasonably
require. Except as may be otherwise required by law, by the certificate of
incorporation or by these by-laws, the corporation shall be entitled to treat
the record holder of stock as shown on its books as the owner of such stock for
all purposes, including the payment of dividends and the right to receive notice
and to vote or to give any consent with respect thereto and to be held liable
for such calls and assessments, if any, as may lawfully be made thereon,
regardless of any transfer, pledge or other disposition of such stock until the
shares have been properly transferred on the books of the corporation.

         It shall be the duty of each stockholder to notify the corporation of
his post office address.

         8.2. RECORD DATE AND CLOSING TRANSFER BOOKS. In order that the
corporation may determine the stockholders entitled to notice of or to vote at
any meeting of stockholders or any adjournment thereof, or to express consent to
corporate action in writing without a meeting, or entitled to receive payment of
any dividend or other distribution or allotment of any rights, or entitled to
exercise any rights in respect of any change, conversion or exchange of stock or
for the purpose of any other lawful action, the board of directors may fix, in
advance, a record date, which shall not be more than sixty nor less than ten
days (or such longer period as may be required by law) before the date of such
meeting, nor more than sixty days prior to any other action.

         If no record date is fixed:


                                      -11-
<PAGE>   12
         (a) The record date for determining stockholders entitled to notice of
or to vote at a meeting of stockholders shall be at the close of business on the
day next preceding the day on which notice is given, or, if notice is waived, at
the close of business on the day next preceding the day on which the meeting is
held.

         (b) The record date for determining stockholders entitled to express
consent to corporate action in writing without a meeting, when no prior action
by the board of directors is necessary, shall be the day on which the first
written consent is expressed.

         (c) The record date for determining stockholders for any other purpose
shall be at the close of business on the day on which the board of directors
adopts the resolution relating thereto.

         A determination of stockholders of record entitled to notice of or to
vote at a meeting of stockholders shall apply to any adjournment of the meeting;
provided, however, that the board of directors may fix a new record date for the
adjourned meeting.

                           Section 9. CORPORATE SEAL

         9.1. Subject to alteration by the directors, the seal of the
corporation shall consist of a flat-faced circular die with the word "Delaware"
and the name of the corporation cut or engraved thereon, together with such
other words, dates or images as may be approved from time to time by the
directors.




                         Section 10. EXECUTION OF PAPERS

         10.1. Except as the board of directors may generally or in particular
cases authorize the execution thereof in some other manner, all deeds, leases,
transfers, contracts, bonds, notes, checks, drafts or other obligations made,
accepted or endorsed by the corporation shall be signed by the chairman of the
board, if any, the president, a vice president or the treasurer.

                            Section 11. FISCAL YEAR

         11.1. The fiscal year of the corporation shall end on the last Saturday
of February of each year.

                             Section 12. AMENDMENTS

         12.1. These by-laws may be adopted, amended or repealed by vote of a
majority of the directors then in office or by vote of a majority of the stock
outstanding and entitled to vote.

                                      -12-
<PAGE>   13
         Any by-law, whether adopted, amended or repealed by the stockholders or
directors, may be amended or reinstated by the stockholders or the directors.

                                      -13-


<PAGE>   1


                                                           Execution Counterpart


          ************************************************************







                               BE AEROSPACE, INC.


                          -----------------------------


                  FOURTH AMENDED AND RESTATED CREDIT AGREEMENT

                          Dated as of October 29, 1993

                    Amended and Restated as of April 3, 1998


                         ------------------------------



                            THE CHASE MANHATTAN BANK,
                             as Administrative Agent

                               NATIONSBANK, N.A.,
                             as Documentation Agent



          ************************************************************



<PAGE>   2


                                TABLE OF CONTENTS

               This Table of Contents is not part of the Agreement to which it
is attached but is inserted for convenience of reference only.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                              page
                                                                                              ----

<S>                                                                                            <C>
Section 1.     Definitions and Accounting Matters...............................................1

        1.01   Certain Defined Terms............................................................1
        1.02   Accounting Terms and Determinations.............................................19
        1.03   Classes and Types of Loans......................................................20

Section 2.     Commitments, Loans, Notes and Prepayments.......................................20

        2.01   Loans...........................................................................20
        2.02   Borrowings......................................................................21
        2.03   Letters of Credit...............................................................21
        2.04   Changes of Commitments..........................................................25
        2.05   Commitment Fee..................................................................26
        2.06   Lending Offices.................................................................26
        2.07   Several Obligations; Remedies Independent.......................................26
        2.08   Evidence of Debt................................................................26
        2.09   Optional Prepayments and Conversions or Continuations of Loans..................27
        2.10   Mandatory Prepayments and Reductions of Commitments.............................27

Section 3.     Payments of Principal and Interest..............................................29

        3.01   Repayment of Loans..............................................................29
        3.02   Interest........................................................................30

Section 4.     Payments; Pro Rata Treatment; Computations; Etc.................................31

        4.01   Payments........................................................................31
        4.02   Pro Rata Treatment..............................................................31
        4.03   Computations....................................................................32
        4.04   Minimum Amounts.................................................................32
        4.05   Certain Notices.................................................................32
        4.06   Non-Receipt of Funds by the Administrative Agent................................33
        4.07   Sharing of Payments, Etc........................................................34

Section 5.     Yield Protection, Etc...........................................................35

        5.01   Additional Costs................................................................35
        5.02   Limitation on Types of Loans....................................................37
        5.03   Illegality......................................................................38
        5.04   Treatment of Affected Loans.....................................................38
        5.05   Compensation....................................................................39
        5.06   Additional Costs in Respect of Letters of Credit................................40
        5.07   U.S. Taxes......................................................................40
</TABLE>


                                      (i)



<PAGE>   3

<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                            <C>
Section 6.     Conditions Precedent............................................................41

        6.01   Conditions to Effectiveness.....................................................41
        6.02   Initial and Subsequent Extensions of Credit.....................................44

Section 7.     Representations and Warranties..................................................44

        7.01   Corporate Existence.............................................................44
        7.02   Financial Condition.............................................................45
        7.03   Litigation......................................................................45
        7.04   No Breach.......................................................................45
        7.05   Action..........................................................................46
        7.06   Approvals.......................................................................46
        7.07   Use of Credit...................................................................46
        7.08   ERISA...........................................................................46
        7.09   Taxes...........................................................................47
        7.10   Investment Company Act..........................................................47
        7.11   Public Utility Holding Company Act..............................................47
        7.12   Material Agreements and Liens...................................................47
        7.13   Environmental Matters...........................................................48
        7.14   Capitalization..................................................................49
        7.15   Subsidiaries, Etc...............................................................50
        7.16   Title to Assets.................................................................50
        7.17   Compliance with Law.............................................................51
        7.18   True and Complete Disclosure....................................................51
        7.19   Year 2000.......................................................................51

Section 8.     Covenants of the Company........................................................52

        8.01   Financial Statements, Etc.......................................................52
        8.02   Litigation......................................................................55
        8.03   Existence, Etc..................................................................55
        8.04   Insurance.......................................................................56
        8.05   Prohibition of Fundamental Changes..............................................56
        8.06   Limitation on Liens.............................................................57
        8.07   Indebtedness....................................................................58
        8.08   Investments.....................................................................59
        8.09   Restricted Payments.............................................................60
        8.10   Leverage Ratio..................................................................60
        8.11   Adjusted Net Worth..............................................................61
        8.12   Interest Coverage Ratio.........................................................61
        8.13   [Intentionally Omitted.]........................................................62
        8.14   Lines of Business...............................................................62
        8.15   Transactions with Affiliates....................................................62
        8.16   Use of Proceeds.................................................................63
        8.17   Certain Obligations Respecting Subsidiaries.....................................63
        8.18   Modifications of Certain Documents..............................................64
        8.19   Environmental Matters...........................................................64
</TABLE>


                                      (ii)




<PAGE>   4

<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                            <C>
        8.20   Security for Loans..............................................................65
        8.21   Redemption of Senior Subordinated Indebtedness..................................65

Section 9.     Events of Default...............................................................65

Section 10.    The Administrative Agent........................................................68

        10.01  Appointment, Powers and Immunities..............................................68
        10.02  Reliance by Administrative Agent................................................69
        10.03  Defaults........................................................................69
        10.04  Rights as a Lender..............................................................70
        10.05  Indemnification.................................................................70
        10.06  Non-Reliance on Administrative Agent and Other Lenders..........................71
        10.07  Failure to Act..................................................................71
        10.08  Resignation or Removal of Administrative Agent..................................71
        10.09  Consents under Basic Documents..................................................72
        10.10  Collateral Sub-Agents...........................................................72
        10.11  Documentation Agent.............................................................72

Section 11.    Miscellaneous...................................................................72

        11.01  Waiver..........................................................................73
        11.02  Notices.........................................................................73
        11.03  Expenses, Etc...................................................................73
        11.04  Amendments, Etc.................................................................74
        11.05  Successors and Assigns..........................................................75
        11.06  Assignments and Participations..................................................75
        11.07  Survival........................................................................77
        11.08  Captions........................................................................77
        11.09  Counterparts....................................................................77
        11.10  Governing Law; Submission to Jurisdiction.......................................78
        11.11  Waiver of Jury Trial............................................................78
        11.12  Treatment of Certain Information; Confidentiality...............................78
</TABLE>


                                     (iii)
<PAGE>   5


Annex 1          -      Commitments

SCHEDULE I       -      Material Agreements and Liens
SCHEDULE II      -      Hazardous Materials
SCHEDULE III     -      Subsidiaries and Investments
SCHEDULE IV      -      Approvals and Compliance
SCHEDULE V       -      Existing Letters of Credit
SCHEDULE VI      -      Taxes
SCHEDULE VII     -      Transactions with Affiliates

EXHIBIT A-1      -      Form of Security Agreement
EXHIBIT A-2      -      Form of In-Flight Guarantee and Security Agreement
EXHIBIT B        -      Form of Confidentiality Agreement




                                      (iv)

<PAGE>   6


                                       -1-



               FOURTH AMENDED AND RESTATED CREDIT AGREEMENT dated as of October
29, 1993, amended and restated as of April 3, 1998, among: BE AEROSPACE, INC., a
corporation duly organized and validly existing under the laws of the State of
Delaware (the "COMPANY"); each of the lenders that is a signatory hereto
identified under the caption "LENDERS" on the signature pages hereto or which,
pursuant to Section 11.06(b) hereof, shall become a "Lender" hereunder
(individually, a "LENDER" and, collectively, the "LENDERS"); and THE CHASE
MANHATTAN BANK, a New York banking corporation, as agent for the Lenders (in
such capacity, together with its successors in such capacity, the
"ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT").

               The Company, certain Lenders and the Administrative Agent are
party to a Third Amended and Restated Credit Agreement dated as of October 29,
1993, amended and restated as of May 29, 1997 (as modified and supplemented and
in effect immediately prior to the Amendment Effective Date referred to below,
the "EXISTING CREDIT AGREEMENT"). The Company has requested that the Lenders and
the Administrative Agent agree to amend and restate the Existing Credit
Agreement, and the Lenders and the Administrative Agent are willing to amend and
restate the Existing Credit Agreement, all on the terms and conditions herein
set forth.

               Accordingly, the parties hereto agree to amend and restate the
Existing Credit Agreement so that, as amended and restated, it reads in its
entirety as provided herein.

Section 1.     DEFINITIONS AND ACCOUNTING MATTERS.

1.01           CERTAIN DEFINED TERMS.

               As used herein, the following terms shall have the following
meanings (all terms defined in this Section 1.01 or in other provisions of this
Agreement in the singular to have the same meanings when used in the plural and
VICE VERSA):

               "ACQUISITION" shall mean any transaction, or any series of
related transactions, by which the Company and/or any of its Subsidiaries (a)
acquires any ongoing business or all or substantially all of the assets of any
Person, whether through purchase of assets, merger or otherwise, (b) directly or
indirectly acquires control of at least a majority (in number of votes) of the
securities of a corporation which have ordinary voting power for the election of
directors or (c) directly or indirectly acquires control of a majority ownership
interest in any partnership, joint venture or similar arrangement. The terms
"ACQUIRE" and "ACQUIRED" used as a verb shall have a correlative meaning.

               "ADJUSTED NET WORTH" shall mean, as at any date, the sum of (a)
total stockholders' equity of the Company and its Subsidiaries (determined on a
consolidated basis without duplication in accordance with GAAP) PLUS (b) the
aggregate amount of Restricted Payments made since November 29, 1997 in respect
of the purchase, redemption, retirement or other acquisition of any shares of
any class of stock of the Company permitted under Section 8.09 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT






<PAGE>   7
                                      -2-


hereof PLUS (c) the fair market value of any shares of capital stock of the
Company (determined as of the date such shares are issued) issued after November
29, 1997 which are utilized in any business combination accounted for using
pooling of interest accounting PLUS (d) an amount not to exceed $35,000,000 in
the aggregate of the after-tax amount (calculated using the then effective
corporate Federal tax rate, regardless of the after-tax amount determined in
accordance with GAAP) of any nonrecurring noncash write-offs of intangible
assets since November 29, 1997 PLUS (e) the amount of any purchased research and
development and related acquisition costs of a target company to the extent such
costs are or have been expensed after November 29, 1997.

               "ADMINISTRATIVE QUESTIONNAIRE" shall mean an Administrative
Questionnaire in a form supplied by the Administrative Agent.

               "AFFILIATE" shall mean any Person that directly or indirectly
controls, or is under common control with, or is controlled by, the Company and,
if such Person is an individual, any member of the immediate family (including
parents, spouse, children and siblings) of such individual and any trust whose
principal beneficiary is such individual or one or more members of such
immediate family and any Person who is controlled by any such member or trust.
As used in this definition, "CONTROL" (including, with its correlative meanings,
"CONTROLLED BY" and "UNDER COMMON CONTROL WITH") shall mean possession, directly
or indirectly, of power to direct or cause the direction of management or
policies (whether through ownership of securities or partnership or other
ownership interests, by contract or otherwise), PROVIDED that, in any event, any
Person that owns directly or indirectly securities having 5% or more of the
voting power for the election of directors or other governing body of a
corporation or 5% or more of the partnership or other ownership interests of any
other Person (other than as a limited partner of such other Person) will be
deemed to control such corporation or other Person. Notwithstanding the
foregoing, (a) no individual shall be an Affiliate solely by reason of his or
her being a director, officer or employee of the Company or any of its
Subsidiaries and (b) none of the Subsidiaries of the Company shall be
Affiliates.

               "AMENDMENT EFFECTIVE DATE" shall mean the date on which all of
the conditions set forth in Section 6.01 hereof shall have been satisfied or
waived by the Lenders and the Administrative Agent.

               "APPLICABLE LENDING OFFICE" shall mean, for each Lender and for
each Type of Loan, the "Lending Office" of such Lender (or of an affiliate of
such Lender) designated for such Type of Loan in the Administrative
Questionnaire submitted by such Lender or such other office of such Lender (or
of an affiliate of such Lender) as such Lender may from time to time specify to
the Administrative Agent and the Company as the office by which its Loans of
such Type are to be made and maintained.


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT
<PAGE>   8

                                      -3-


               "APPLICABLE MARGIN" shall mean with respect to Base Rate Loans
and Eurodollar Loans, the rate for such Type of Loan for each level period set
forth in the schedule below:


                                        Applicable Margin
      Level Period             Base Rate Loans      Eurodollar Loans
- ------------------------       ---------------      ----------------
Level I Period                      0.00%                0.500%
Level II Period                     0.00%                0.750%
Level III Period                    0.00%                0.875%
Level IV Period                     0.00%                1.000%
Level V Period                      0.00%                1.250%
Level VI Period                     0.25%                1.500%
Level VII Period                    0.75%                2.000%

PROVIDED that notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the Applicable
Margin from the Amendment Effective Date through August 31, 1998 shall not be
less than the rate for a Level V Period.

               "B/E SERVICES" shall mean B/E Services, Inc., a Delaware
corporation and Wholly Owned Subsidiary of the Company.

               "BANKRUPTCY CODE" shall mean the Federal Bankruptcy Code of 1978,
as amended from time to time.

               "BASE RATE" shall mean, for any day, a rate per annum equal to
the higher of (a) the Federal Funds Rate for such day plus 1/2 of 1% and (b) the
Prime Rate for such day. Each change in any interest rate provided for herein
based upon the Base Rate resulting from a change in the Base Rate shall take
effect at the time of such change in the Base Rate.

               "BASE RATE LOANS" shall mean Loans that bear interest at rates
based upon the Base Rate.

               "BASIC DOCUMENTS" shall mean, collectively, this Agreement, the
Notes, the Letter of Credit Documents and the Security Documents.

               "BUSINESS DAY" shall mean any day (a) on which commercial banks
are not authorized or required to close in New York City and (b) if such day
relates to a borrowing of, a payment or prepayment of principal of or interest
on, a Conversion of or into, or an Interest Period for, a Eurodollar Loan or a
notice by the Company with respect to any such borrowing, payment, prepayment,
Conversion or Interest Period, which is also a day on which dealings in Dollar
deposits are carried out in the London interbank market.


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT




<PAGE>   9
                                      -4-


               "CALCULATION PERIOD" shall mean, as at any date, the period of
four consecutive complete fiscal quarters of the Company ending on or most
recently ended prior to such date for which financial statements have been
delivered pursuant to Sections 7.02(a), 8.01(a), 8.01(b) or 8.01(h) hereof.

               "CAPITAL LEASE OBLIGATIONS" shall mean, for any Person, all
obligations of such Person to pay rent or other amounts under a lease of (or
other agreement conveying the right to use) Property to the extent such
obligations are required to be classified and accounted for as a capital lease
on a balance sheet of such Person under GAAP (including Statement of Financial
Accounting Standards No. 13 of the Financial Accounting Standards Board), and,
for purposes of this Agreement, the amount of such obligations shall be the
capitalized amount thereof, determined in accordance with GAAP (including such
Statement No. 13).

               "CASUALTY EVENT" shall mean, with respect to any Property of any
Person, any loss of or damage to, or any condemnation or other taking of, such
Property for which such Person or any of its Subsidiaries receives insurance
proceeds, or proceeds of a condemnation award or other compensation.

               "CHASE" shall mean The Chase Manhattan Bank.

               "CLASS" shall have the meaning assigned to such term in Section
1.03 hereof.

               "CODE" shall mean the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended
from time to time.

               "COLLATERAL ACCOUNT" shall have the meaning assigned to such term
in Section 4.01 of the Security Agreement.

               "COMMITMENT FEE RATE" shall mean (a) 0.2000% for any Level I
Period, (b) 0.2250% for any Level II Period, (c) 0.2500% for any Level III
Period, (d) 0.2750% for any Level IV Period, (e) 0.3250% for any Level V Period,
(f) 0.3750% for any Level VI Period and (e) 0.5000% for any Level VII Period,
PROVIDED that notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the Commitment
Fee Rate from the Amendment Effective Date through August 31, 1998 shall not be
less than the rate for a Level V Period. .

               "COMMITMENTS" shall mean the Series A Commitments and the 
Series B Commitments.

               "CONTINUE", "CONTINUATION" and "CONTINUED" shall refer to the
continuation pursuant to Section 2.09 hereof of a Eurodollar Loan from one
Interest Period to the next Interest Period.

               "CONVERT", "CONVERSION" and "CONVERTED" shall refer to a
conversion pursuant to Section 2.09 hereof of one Type of Loans into another
Type of Loans, which may be 



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   10
                                      -5-


accompanied by the transfer by a Lender (at its sole discretion) of a Loan from
one Applicable Lending Office to another.

               "DEFAULT" shall mean an Event of Default or an event that with
notice or lapse of time or both would become an Event of Default.

               "DISPOSITION" shall mean any sale, assignment, transfer or other
disposition of any Property (whether now owned or hereafter acquired) by the
Company or any of its Subsidiaries to any Person excluding any sale, assignment,
transfer or other disposition of inventory in the ordinary course of business
and on ordinary business terms; PROVIDED that the term "Disposition" shall not
include (i) any Equity Issuance (as such term is defined in this Section 1.01
without giving effect to the proviso therein), (ii) any sale, assignment,
transfer or other disposition of Property by any Subsidiary of the Company to
the Company or to any other Subsidiary of the Company, in each case for
consideration that is not in excess of the fair market value of such Property as
determined in good faith by the chief financial officer of the Company or (iii)
any sale, assignment, transfer or other disposition of Property by the Company
or any Subsidiary of the Company to a joint venture, subject to the proviso in
Section 8.08(h) hereof. The creation of any Lien on any Property permitted under
Section 8.06 hereof shall not constitute a "DISPOSITION" of such Property. The
term "DISPOSE" shall have a correlative meaning.

               "DOLLARS" and "$" shall mean lawful money of the United States of
America.

               "DOMESTIC SUBSIDIARY" shall mean any Subsidiary of the Company
that is incorporated under the law of any State of the United States of America.

               "EBITDA" shall mean, for any period of four consecutive fiscal
quarters of the Company, for the Company and its Subsidiaries (determined on a
consolidated basis without duplication in accordance with GAAP), net operating
earnings (calculated before depreciation and amortization expense, non-recurring
non-cash write-offs of assets (to the extent deducted in computing net operating
earnings), Interest Expense, taxes and extraordinary and unusual items) for such
period.

               "ENVIRONMENTAL CLAIM" shall mean, with respect to any Person, (a)
any written notice, claim, demand or other communication (collectively, a
"CLAIM") by any other Person alleging or asserting such Person's liability for
investigatory costs, cleanup costs, governmental response costs, damages to
natural resources or other Property, personal injuries, fines or penalties
arising out of, based on or resulting from (i) the presence, or Release into the
environment, of any Hazardous Material at any location, whether or not owned by
such Person, or (ii) circumstances forming the basis of any violation, or
alleged violation, of any Environmental Law. The term "Environmental Claim"
shall include, without limitation, any written claim by any governmental
authority for enforcement, cleanup, removal, response, remedial or other actions
or damages pursuant to any applicable Environmental Law, and any written claim
by any third party seeking damages, contribution, indemnification, cost
recovery, compensation or injunctive relief resulting from the presence of
Hazardous Materials or arising from alleged injury or threat of injury to
health, safety or the environment.



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT




<PAGE>   11
                                      -6-


               "ENVIRONMENTAL LAWS" shall mean any and all present and future
Federal, state, local and foreign laws, rules or regulations, and any orders or
decrees, in each case as now or hereafter in effect, relating to the regulation
or protection of human health, safety or the environment or to emissions,
discharges, releases or threatened releases of pollutants, contaminants,
chemicals or toxic or hazardous substances or wastes into the indoor or outdoor
environment, including, without limitation, ambient air, soil, surface water,
ground water, wetlands, land or subsurface strata, or otherwise relating to the
manufacture, processing, distribution, use, treatment, storage, disposal,
transport or handling of pollutants, contaminants, chemicals or toxic or
hazardous substances or wastes.

               "EQUITY ISSUANCE" shall mean (a) any issuance or sale by the
Company or any of its Subsidiaries after the Restatement Date of (i) any capital
stock, (ii) any warrants or options exercisable in respect of capital stock
(other than any warrants or options issued to directors, officers, employees,
agents, consultants or advisors of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries and
any capital stock of the Company issued upon the exercise of such warrants or
options) or (iii) any other security or instrument representing an equity
interest (or the right to obtain any equity interest) in the issuing or selling
Person or (b) the receipt by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries after
November 29, 1997 of any capital contribution (whether or not evidenced by any
equity security issued by the recipient of such contribution); PROVIDED that
Equity Issuance shall not include (x) any such issuance or sale by any
Subsidiary of the Company to the Company or any Wholly Owned Subsidiary of the
Company, (y) any capital contribution by the Company or any Wholly Owned
Subsidiary of the Company to any Subsidiary of the Company or (z) any such
issuance or sale by the Company in connection with a permitted Acquisition under
Section 8.05(b).

               "EQUITY RIGHTS" shall mean, with respect to any Person, any
outstanding subscriptions, options, warrants, commitments, preemptive rights or
agreements of any kind (including, without limitation, any stockholders' or
voting trust agreements) for the issuance, sale, registration or voting of, or
outstanding securities convertible into, any additional shares of capital stock
of any class, or partnership or other ownership interests of any type in, such
Person.

               "ERISA" shall mean the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of
1974, as amended from time to time.

               "ERISA AFFILIATE" shall mean any corporation or trade or business
that is a member of any group of organizations (i) described in Section 414(b)
or (c) of the Code of which the Company is a member and (ii) solely for purposes
of potential liability under Section 302(c)(11) of ERISA and Section 412(c)(11)
of the Code and the lien created under Section 302(f) of ERISA and Section
412(n) of the Code, described in Section 414(m) or (o) of the Code of which the
Company is a member.

               "EURODOLLAR BASE RATE" shall mean, with respect to any Eurodollar
Loan for any Interest Period therefor, the arithmetic mean (rounded upwards, if
necessary, to the nearest 1/100 of 1%) of the respective rates per annum quoted
by each Reference Lender at approximately 



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   12
                                      -7-


11:00 a.m. London time (or as soon thereafter as practicable) on the date two
Business Days prior to the first day of such Interest Period for the offering by
such Reference Lender to leading banks in the London interbank market of Dollar
deposits having a term comparable to such Interest Period and in an amount
comparable to the principal amount of the Eurodollar Loan to be made by such
Reference Lender for such Interest Period. If any Reference Lender is not
participating in any Eurodollar Loan during any Interest Period therefor, the
Eurodollar Base Rate for such Loan for such Interest Period shall be determined
by reference to the amount of the Eurodollar Loan to be made by Chase for such
Interest Period.

               "EURODOLLAR LOANS" shall mean Loans the interest rates on which
are determined on the basis of rates referred to in the definition of
"Eurodollar Base Rate" in this Section 1.01.

               "EURODOLLAR RATE" shall mean, for any Eurodollar Loan for any
Interest Period therefor, a rate per annum (rounded upwards, if necessary, to
the nearest 1/100 of 1%) determined by the Administrative Agent to be equal to
the Eurodollar Base Rate for such Loan for such Interest Period divided by 1
minus the Reserve Requirement for such Loan for such Interest Period.

               "EVENT OF DEFAULT" shall have the meaning assigned to such term
in Section 9 hereof.

               "EXISTING CREDIT AGREEMENT" shall have the meaning assigned to
such term in the recitals hereto.

               "EXISTING LENDERS" shall mean the lenders party to the Existing
Credit Agreement.

               "EXISTING LETTERS OF CREDIT" shall have the meaning assigned to
such term in Section 2.03(l) hereof.

               "FEDERAL FUNDS RATE" shall mean, for any day, the rate per annum
(rounded upwards, if necessary, to the nearest 1/100 of 1%) equal to the
weighted average of the rates on overnight Federal funds transactions with
members of the Federal Reserve System arranged by Federal funds brokers on such
day, as published by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York on the Business Day
next succeeding such day, PROVIDED that (a) if the day for which such rate is to
be determined is not a Business Day, the Federal Funds Rate for such day shall
be such rate on such transactions on the next preceding Business Day as so
published on the next succeeding Business Day and (b) if such rate is not so
published for any Business Day, the Federal Funds Rate for such Business Day
shall be the average rate charged to Chase on such Business Day on such
transactions as determined by the Administrative Agent.

               "FISCAL DATE" shall mean the last day of each fiscal quarterly
period of the Company.

               "FOREIGN SUBSIDIARY" shall mean each Subsidiary of the Company
other than any Domestic Subsidiary.


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT




<PAGE>   13
                                      -8-


               "FUNDED DEBT" shall mean, for any Person: (a) all Indebtedness of
such Person that should be reflected on a balance sheet of such Person in
accordance with GAAP; and (b) all Indebtedness of any other Person that should
be reflected on a balance sheet of such other Person in accordance with GAAP and
that is secured by a Lien on the Property of, is supported by a letter of credit
issued for account of, or is Guaranteed by, such Person.

               "GAAP" shall mean generally accepted accounting principles
applied on a basis consistent with those which, in accordance with the last
sentence of Section 1.02(a) hereof, are to be used in making the calculations
for purposes of determining compliance with this Agreement.

               "GE LEASE AGREEMENT" shall mean the Master Lease Agreement dated
as of October 20, 1997 between the Company and General Electric Capital
Corporation, for itself and as Agent for Certain Participants.

               "GUARANTEE" shall mean a guarantee, an endorsement, a contingent
agreement to purchase or to furnish funds for the payment or maintenance of, or
otherwise to be or become contingently liable under or with respect to, the
Indebtedness, other obligations, net worth, working capital or earnings of any
Person, or a guarantee of the payment of dividends or other distributions upon
the stock or equity interests of any Person, or an agreement to purchase, sell
or lease (as lessee or lessor) Property, products, materials, supplies or
services primarily for the purpose of enabling a debtor to make payment of such
debtor's obligations or an agreement to assure a creditor against loss, and
including, without limitation, causing a bank or other financial institution to
issue a letter of credit or other similar instrument for the benefit of another
Person, but excluding endorsements for collection or deposit in the ordinary
course of business. The terms "GUARANTEE" and "GUARANTEED" used as a verb shall
have a correlative meaning.

               "HAZARDOUS MATERIAL" shall mean, collectively, (a) any petroleum
or petroleum products, flammable explosives, radioactive materials, asbestos in
any form that is or could become friable, urea formaldehyde foam insulation, and
transformers or other equipment that contain dielectric fluid containing
polychlorinated biphenyls (PCB's), (b) any chemicals or other materials or
substances which are now or hereafter become defined as or included in the
definition of "hazardous substances", "hazardous wastes", "hazardous materials",
"extremely hazardous wastes", "restricted hazardous wastes", "toxic substances",
"toxic pollutants", "contaminants", "pollutants" or words of similar import
under any Environmental Law and (c) any other chemical or other material or
substance, exposure to which is now or hereafter prohibited, limited or
regulated under any Environmental Law.

               "INDEBTEDNESS" shall mean, for any Person: (a) obligations
created, issued or incurred by such Person for borrowed money (whether by loan,
the issuance and sale of debt securities or the sale of Property to another
Person subject to an understanding or agreement, contingent or otherwise, to
repurchase such Property from such Person); (b) obligations of such Person to
pay the deferred purchase or acquisition price of Property or services, other
than trade accounts payable (other than for borrowed money) arising, and accrued
expenses incurred, in the ordinary course of business so long as such trade
accounts payable are payable within 90 days of 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   14
                                      -9-


the date the respective goods are delivered or the respective services are
rendered; (c) Indebtedness of others secured by a Lien on the Property of such
Person, whether or not the respective indebtedness so secured has been assumed
by such Person; (d) obligations of such Person in respect of letters of credit
or similar instruments issued or accepted by banks and other financial
institutions for account of such Person; (e) Capital Lease Obligations of such
Person; and (f) Indebtedness of others Guaranteed by such Person.

               "IN-FLIGHT" shall mean In-Flight Entertainment, LLC, a Delaware
limited liability company and Wholly Owned Subsidiary of the Company.

               "IN-FLIGHT GUARANTEE AND SECURITY AGREEMENT" shall mean the
Amended and Restated Guarantee and Security Agreement dated as of the
Restatement Date between In-Flight and the Administrative Agent, substantially
in the form of Exhibit A-2 hereto, as the same shall be modified, supplemented
and in effect from time to time.

               "INFORMATION MEMORANDUM" shall mean the Confidential Information
Memorandum dated March, 1998 distributed to the Lenders.

               "INTEREST COVERAGE RATIO" shall mean, as at any date the ratio of
(i) EBITDA for the relevant Calculation Period to (ii) Interest Expense for such
Calculation Period; PROVIDED that, from and after the date of any Acquisition
occurring after February 28, 1998 until four full fiscal quarters of the Company
have elapsed since the date of such Acquisition, the Interest Coverage Ratio
shall be calculated on a PRO FORMA basis (reflecting, INTER ALIA, any amount
attributable to any operating expense that will be eliminated or cost reduction
that will be realized (in each case, net of any operating expense or other cost
increase) in connection with such Acquisition, as determined in good faith by
the chief financial officer of the Company in accordance with GAAP and the
rules, regulations and guidelines of the Securities and Exchange Commission, as
if such elimination of operating expense or the realization of such cost
reductions were achieved at the beginning of such four-quarter period) as though
such Acquisition had occurred, and any Funded Debt incurred or assumed by the
Company or any of its Subsidiaries in connection with, or in anticipation of,
such Acquisition had been incurred or assumed, on the first day of such
Calculation Period.

               "INTEREST EXPENSE" shall mean, for any period, the sum, for the
Company and its Subsidiaries (determined on a consolidated basis without
duplication in accordance with GAAP), of the following: (a) all interest in
respect of Indebtedness accrued or capitalized during such period (whether or
not actually paid during such period) PLUS (b) the net amounts payable (or MINUS
the net amounts receivable) under Interest Rate Protection Agreements accrued
during such period (whether or not actually paid or received during such period)
MINUS (c) interest income during such period.

               "INTEREST PERIOD" shall mean, with respect to any Eurodollar
Loan, each period commencing on the date such Eurodollar Loan is made or
Converted from a Base Rate Loan or the last day of the next preceding Interest
Period for such Loan and ending on the numerically corresponding day in the
first, second, third or sixth calendar month thereafter, as the Company 



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   15
                                      -10-


may select as provided in Section 4.05 hereof, except that each Interest Period
that commences on the last Business Day of a calendar month (or on any day for
which there is no numerically corresponding day in the appropriate subsequent
calendar month) shall end on the last Business Day of the appropriate subsequent
calendar month. Notwithstanding the foregoing: (i) no Interest Period for any
Series A Loan may end after the Series A Commitment Termination Date; (ii) no
Interest Period for any Series B Loan may commence before and end after any
Series B Principal Payment Date unless, after giving effect thereto, the
aggregate principal amount of the Series B Loans having Interest Periods that
end after such Series B Principal Payment Date shall be equal to or less than
the aggregate principal amount of the Series B Loans scheduled to be outstanding
after giving effect to the payments of principal required to be made on such
Series B Principal Payment Date; (iii) each Interest Period that would otherwise
end on a day which is not a Business Day shall end on the next succeeding
Business Day (or, if such next succeeding Business Day falls in the next
succeeding calendar month, on the next preceding Business Day); and (iv)
notwithstanding clauses (i) and (ii) above, no Interest Period shall have a
duration of less than one month and, if the Interest Period for any Eurodollar
Loan would otherwise be a shorter period, such Eurodollar Loan shall not be
available hereunder for such period.

               "INTEREST RATE PROTECTION AGREEMENT" shall mean, for any Person,
an interest rate swap, cap or collar agreement or similar arrangement between
such Person and one or more financial institutions providing for the transfer or
mitigation of interest risks either generally or under specific contingencies.
For purposes hereof, the "CREDIT EXPOSURE" at any time of any Person under an
Interest Rate Protection Agreement to which such Person is a party shall be
determined at such time in accordance with the standard methods of calculating
credit exposure under similar arrangements as prescribed from time to time by
the Administrative Agent, taking into account potential interest rate movements
and the respective termination provisions and notional principal amount and term
of such Interest Rate Protection Agreement.

               "INVESTMENT" shall mean, for any Person: (a) the acquisition
(whether for cash, Property, services or securities or otherwise) of capital
stock, bonds, notes, debentures, partnership or other ownership interests or
other securities of, or capital contribution to, any other Person or any
agreement to make any such acquisition or capital contribution (including,
without limitation, any "short sale" or any sale of any securities at a time
when such securities are not owned by the Person entering into such short sale);
(b) the making of any deposit with, or advance, loan or other extension of
credit to, any other Person (including the purchase of Property from another
Person subject to an understanding or agreement, contingent or otherwise, to
resell such Property to such Person, but excluding any such advance, loan or
extension of credit having a term not exceeding 90 days representing the
purchase price of inventory or supplies sold by such Person in the ordinary
course of business); (c) the entering into of any Guarantee of, or other
contingent obligation with respect to, Indebtedness or other liability of any
other Person and (without duplication) any amount committed to be advanced, lent
or extended to such Person; or (d) the entering into of any Interest Rate
Protection Agreement.

               "ISSUING LENDER" shall mean Chase, as the issuer of Letters of
Credit under Section 2.03 hereof, together with its successors and assigns in
such capacity.


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   16
                                      -11-


               "LETTER OF CREDIT" shall have the meaning assigned to such term
in Section 2.03 hereof.

               "LETTER OF CREDIT DOCUMENTS" shall mean, with respect to any
Letter of Credit, collectively, any application therefor and any other
agreements, instruments, guarantees or other documents (whether general in
application or applicable only to such Letter of Credit) governing or providing
for (a) the rights and obligations of the parties concerned or at risk with
respect to such Letter of Credit or (b) any collateral security for any of such
obligations, each as the same may be modified and supplemented and in effect
from time to time.

               "LETTER OF CREDIT INTEREST" shall mean, for each Series A Lender,
such Lender's participation interest (or, in the case of the Issuing Lender, the
Issuing Lender's retained interest) in the Issuing Lender's liability under
Letters of Credit and such Lender's rights and interests in Reimbursement
Obligations and fees, interest and other amounts payable in connection with
Letters of Credit and Reimbursement Obligations.

               "LETTER OF CREDIT LIABILITY" shall mean, without duplication, at
any time and in respect of any Letter of Credit, the sum of (a) the undrawn
amount of such Letter of Credit PLUS (b) the aggregate unpaid principal amount
of all Reimbursement Obligations of the Company at such time due and payable in
respect of all drawings made under such Letter of Credit. For purposes of this
Agreement, a Series A Lender (other than the Issuing Lender) shall be deemed to
hold a Letter of Credit Liability in an amount equal to its participation
interest in the related Letter of Credit under Section 2.03 hereof, and the
Issuing Lender shall be deemed to hold a Letter of Credit Liability in an amount
equal to its retained interest in the related Letter of Credit after giving
effect to the acquisition by the Series A Lenders other than the Issuing Lender
of their participation interests under said Section 2.03.

               "LEVEL I PERIOD" shall mean any period during which (a) no Event
of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, and (b) the Leverage Ratio is
less than 2.25 to 1; "LEVEL II PERIOD" shall mean any period, other than a Level
I Period, during which (a) no Event of Default shall have occurred and be
continuing and (b) the Leverage Ratio is greater than or equal to 2.25 to 1 but
less than 2.75 to 1; "LEVEL III PERIOD" shall mean any period, other than a
Level I Period or a Level II Period, during which (a) no Event of Default shall
have occurred and be continuing and (b) the Leverage Ratio is greater than or
equal to 2.75 to 1 but less than 3.25 to 1; "LEVEL IV PERIOD" shall mean any
period, other than a Level I Period, a Level II Period or a Level III Period
during which (a) no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing and
(b) the Leverage Ratio is greater than or equal to 3.25 to 1 but less than 3.75
to 1; "LEVEL V PERIOD" shall mean any period, other than a Level I Period, a
Level II Period, a Level III Period or Level IV Period during which (a) no Event
of Default shall have occurred and be continuing and (b) the Leverage Ratio is
greater than or equal to 3.75 to 1 but less than 4.25 to 1; "LEVEL VI PERIOD"
shall mean any period that is not a Level I Period, a Level II Period, a Level
III Period, a Level IV Period or a Level V Period during which (a) no Event of
Default shall have occurred and be continuing and (b) the Leverage Ratio is
greater than or equal to 4.25 to 1 but less than 4.75; and "LEVEL VII PERIOD"
shall mean any period that is not a Level I Period, a Level II Period, a Level
III Period, a Level IV Period, a Level V Period or a Level VI Period. Any change
in the Applicable Margin 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   17
                                      -12-


for any Type of Loan or any change in the Commitment Fee by reason of a change
in the Leverage Ratio shall become effective on the third Business Day following
receipt by the Administrative Agent of the financial statements of the Company
and its Subsidiaries delivered as required by Sections 8.01(a), (b) or (h)
hereof; PROVIDED that failure to deliver such financial statements as required
by Sections 8.01(a), (b) or (h) hereof shall result in the Applicable Margin and
Commitment Fee Rate being at the rates set forth opposite Level VII Period.

               "LEVERAGE RATIO" shall mean, as at any date, the ratio of Total
Funded Debt at such date to EBITDA for the relevant Calculation Period; PROVIDED
that, from and after the date of any Acquisition occurring after February 28,
1998 until four full fiscal quarters of the Company shall have elapsed since the
date of such Acquisition, the Leverage Ratio shall be calculated on a PRO FORMA
basis (reflecting, INTER ALIA, any amount attributable to any operating expense
that will be eliminated or cost reduction that will be realized (in each case,
net of any operating expense or other cost increase) in connection with such
Acquisition, as determined in good faith by the chief financial officer of the
Company in accordance with GAAP and the rules, regulations and guidelines of the
Securities and Exchange Commission, as if such elimination of operating expense
or the realization of such cost reductions were achieved at the beginning of
such four-quarter period") as though such Acquisition had occurred, any Funded
Debt incurred or assumed by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries in connection
with, or in anticipation of, such Acquisition had been incurred or assumed, on
the first day of such Calculation Period.

               "LIEN" shall mean, with respect to any Property, any mortgage,
lien, pledge, charge, security interest or encumbrance of any kind in respect of
such Property. For purposes of this Agreement and the other Basic Documents, a
Person shall be deemed to own subject to a Lien any Property that it has
acquired or holds subject to the interest of a vendor or lessor under any
conditional sale agreement, capital lease or other title retention agreement
(other than an operating lease) relating to such Property.

               "LOANS" shall mean the Series A Loans and the Series B Loans.

               "MAJORITY LENDERS" shall mean Majority Series A Lenders and
Majority Series B Lenders.

               "MAJORITY SERIES A LENDERS" shall mean Series A Lenders having
more than 50% of the aggregate amount of the Series A Commitments or, if the
Series A Commitments shall have terminated, Lenders holding more than 50% of the
sum of (a) the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Series A Loans PLUS (b)
the aggregate amount of all Letter of Credit Liabilities.

               "MAJORITY SERIES B LENDERS" shall mean Series B Lenders having
more than 50% of the aggregate amount of the Series B Commitments or, if the
Series B Commitments shall have terminated, Lenders holding more than 50% of the
aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Series B Loans.



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   18
                                      -13-


               "MARGIN STOCK" shall mean "margin stock" within the meaning of
Regulations U and X.

               "MATERIAL ADVERSE EFFECT" shall mean a material adverse effect on
(a) the Property, business, operations, financial condition, prospects,
liabilities or capitalization of the Company and its Subsidiaries taken as a
whole, (b) the ability of the Company to perform its obligations under any of
the Basic Documents to which it is a party, (c) the validity or enforceability
of any of the Basic Documents, (d) the rights and remedies of the Lenders and
the Administrative Agent under any of the Basic Documents or (e) the timely
payment of the principal of or interest on the Loans or the Reimbursement
Obligations or other amounts payable in connection therewith.

               "MATERIAL SUBSIDIARY" shall mean at any date any Subsidiary of
the Company whose total assets equal or exceed 2% of the total assets of the
Company and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis as at the most recent
Fiscal Date; PROVIDED that, notwithstanding the above, each of B/E Services and
Royal Inventum B.V. shall at all times constitute a Material Subsidiary of the
Company so long as it is a Subsidiary of the Company.

               "MULTIEMPLOYER PLAN" shall mean a multiemployer plan defined as
such in Section 3(37) of ERISA to which contributions have been made by the
Company or any ERISA Affiliate and which is covered by Title IV of ERISA.

               "NET AVAILABLE PROCEEDS" shall mean:

               (i)   in the case of any Disposition, the amount of Net Cash
        Payments received in connection with such Disposition;

               (ii)  in the case of any Casualty Event, the aggregate amount of
        proceeds of insurance, condemnation awards and other compensation
        received by the Company and its Subsidiaries in respect of such Casualty
        Event net of (A) reasonable expenses incurred by the Company and its
        Subsidiaries in connection therewith and (B) contractually required
        repayments of Indebtedness to the extent secured by a Lien on such
        Property and any income and transfer taxes payable by the Company or any
        of its Subsidiaries in respect of such Casualty Event;

               (iii) in the case of any Equity Issuance, the aggregate amount of
        all cash received by the Company and its Subsidiaries in respect of such
        Equity Issuance net of reasonable expenses incurred by the Company and
        its Subsidiaries in connection therewith; and

               (iv)  in the case of any Reversion, the aggregate amount of all
        cash received by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries in respect of
        such Reversion net of (A) reasonable expenses incurred by the Company
        and its Subsidiaries in connection therewith and (B) any income and
        excise taxes payable by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries in
        respect of such Reversion.



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT




<PAGE>   19

                                      -14-


               "NET CASH PAYMENTS" shall mean, with respect to any Disposition,
the aggregate amount of all cash payments, and the fair market value of any
non-cash consideration, received by the Company and its Subsidiaries directly or
indirectly in connection with such Disposition; PROVIDED that (a) Net Cash
Payments shall be net of (i) the amount of any legal, accounting and other
professional fees, title and recording tax expenses, commissions and other fees
and expenses paid by the Company and its Subsidiaries in connection with such
Disposition and (ii) any Federal, state and local income or other taxes
estimated to be payable by the Company and its Subsidiaries as a result of such
Disposition (but only to the extent that such estimated taxes are in fact paid
to the relevant Federal, state or local governmental authority within three
months of date of such Disposition or the Company or any of its Subsidiaries
uses any applicable tax benefit available to it as set forth on its balance
sheet to reduce such estimated taxes payable within such three month period),
(b) Net Cash Payments shall not include any cash payments of less than $100,000
from any one Disposition or a series of related Dispositions, and (c) Net Cash
Payments shall be net of any repayments by the Company or any of its
Subsidiaries of Indebtedness to the extent that (i) such Indebtedness is secured
by a Lien on the Property that is the subject of such Disposition and (ii) the
transferee of (or holder of a Lien on) such Property requires that such
Indebtedness be repaid as a condition to the purchase of such Property.

               "NOTES" shall mean the promissory notes (if any) executed and
delivered by the Company pursuant to Section 2.08 hereof.

               "PBGC" shall mean the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation or any
entity succeeding to any or all of its functions under ERISA.

               "PERMITTED INVESTMENTS" shall mean any Investment in (i) direct
obligations of the United States of America or any agency thereof, or
obligations guaranteed by the United States of America, or of any agency
thereof; (ii) commercial paper rated at least A-1 by S&P or P-1 by Moody's;
(iii) time deposits with, including certificates of deposit issued by, any
office located in the United States of America of any bank or trust company
which is organized under the laws of the United States of America or any state
thereof and has capital, surplus and undivided profits aggregating at least
$1,000,000,000; (iv) shares of any money market or mutual fund not less than 80%
of the assets of which are invested solely in securities or obligations of the
type described in clauses (i) through (iii) above and (v) repurchase agreements
with respect to securities described in clause (i) above entered into with an
office of a bank or trust company meeting the criteria specified in clause (iii)
above, PROVIDED in each case that such Investment matures within one year from
the date of acquisition thereof by the Company or a Subsidiary of the Company.

               "PERSON" shall mean any individual, corporation, company,
voluntary association, partnership, joint venture, trust, unincorporated
organization or government (or any agency, instrumentality or political
subdivision thereof).

               "PLAN" shall mean an employee benefit plan established or
maintained by the Company or any ERISA Affiliate and that is covered by Title IV
of ERISA, other than a Multiemployer Plan.


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   20
                                      -15-


               "POST-DEFAULT RATE" shall mean, in respect of any principal of
any Loan, any Reimbursement Obligation or any other amount under this Agreement,
any Note or any other Basic Document that is not paid when due (whether at
stated maturity, by acceleration, by optional or mandatory prepayment or
otherwise), a rate per annum during the period from and including the due date
to but excluding the date on which such amount is paid in full equal to 2% PLUS
the Base Rate as in effect from time to time PLUS the Applicable Margin for Base
Rate Loans (PROVIDED that, if the amount so in default is principal of a
Eurodollar Loan and the due date thereof is a day other than the last day of the
Interest Period therefor, the "Post-Default Rate" for such principal shall be,
for the period for and including such due date to but excluding the last day of
the Interest Period, 2% PLUS the interest rate for such Loan as provided in
Section 3.02 hereof and, thereafter, the rate provided for above in this
definition).

               "PRIME RATE" shall mean the rate of interest from time to time
announced by Chase at the Principal Office as its prime commercial lending rate.

               "PRINCIPAL OFFICE" shall mean the principal office of Chase,
located on the date hereof at 270 Park Avenue, New York, New York 10017.

               "PROPERTY" shall mean any right or interest in or to property of
any kind whatsoever, whether real, personal or mixed and whether tangible or
intangible.

               "QUARTERLY DATES" shall mean the quarterly anniversaries of the
Restatement Date; PROVIDED that, if any such date is not a Business Day, the
Quarterly Date shall be the next succeeding Business Day (or, if such next
succeeding Business Day falls in the next succeeding calendar month, the next
preceding Business Day).

               "RECAPTURE DATE" shall mean the last day of the Recapture Period.

               "RECAPTURE PERIOD" shall mean each period (a) commencing on the
later of (i) the Restatement Date and (ii) the day immediately following the
last day of the immediately preceding Recapture Period, and (b) ending on the
date on which the Company and/or its Subsidiaries receives Net Available
Proceeds which, together with all Net Available Proceeds received since the
first day of such Recapture Period, equal or exceeds in the aggregate
$1,000,000.

               "REFERENCE LENDERS" shall mean Chase and NationsBank, N.A.

               "REGULATIONS A, D, U AND X" shall mean, respectively, Regulations
A, D, U and X of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (or any
successor), as the same may be modified and supplemented and in effect from time
to time.

               "REGULATORY CHANGE" shall mean, with respect to any Lender, any
change after the date of this Agreement in Federal, state or foreign law or
regulations (including, without limitation, Regulation D) or the adoption or
making after such date of any interpretation, 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   21
                                      -16-


directive or request applying to a class of banks including such Lender of or
under any Federal, state or foreign law or regulations (whether or not having
the force of law and whether or not failure to comply therewith would be
unlawful) by any court or governmental or monetary authority charged with the
interpretation or administration thereof.

               "REIMBURSEMENT OBLIGATIONS" shall mean, at any time, the
obligations of the Company then outstanding, or which may thereafter arise in
respect of all Letters of Credit then outstanding, to reimburse amounts paid by
the Issuing Lender in respect of any drawings under a Letter of Credit.

               "RELEASE" shall mean any release, spill, emission, leaking,
pumping, injection, deposit, disposal, discharge, dispersal, leaching or
migration into the indoor or outdoor environment, including, without limitation,
the movement of Hazardous Materials through ambient air, soil, surface water,
groundwater, wetlands, land or subsurface strata. The terms "RELEASE" and
"RELEASED" used as a verb shall have a correlative meaning.

               "RESERVE REQUIREMENT" shall mean, for any Interest Period for any
Eurodollar Loan, the average maximum rate at which reserves (including, without
limitation, any marginal, supplemental or emergency reserves) are required to be
maintained during such Interest Period under Regulation D by member banks of the
Federal Reserve System in New York City with deposits exceeding one billion
Dollars against "Eurocurrency liabilities" (as such term is used in Regulation
D). Without limiting the effect of the foregoing, the Reserve Requirement shall
include any other reserves required to be maintained by such member banks by
reason of any Regulatory Change with respect to (i) any category of liabilities
that includes deposits by reference to which the Eurodollar Base Rate is to be
determined as provided in the definition of "Eurodollar Base Rate" in this
Section 1.01 or (ii) any category of extensions of credit or other assets that
includes Eurodollar Loans.

               "RESTATEMENT DATE" shall mean April 3, 1998.

               "RESTRICTED PAYMENT" shall mean, with respect to any Person, (a)
dividends (in cash, Property or obligations) on, or other payments or
distributions on account of, or the setting apart of money for a sinking or
other analogous fund for, or the purchase, redemption, retirement or other
acquisition of, any shares of any class of stock of such Person or of any
warrants (other than of shares of common stock, warrants or options of such
Person as payment for the exercise price of options or warrants to purchase
common stock of such Person having a fair market value equal to such exercise
price), options or other rights to acquire the same (or to make any payments to
any other Person, such as "phantom stock" payments, where the amount thereof is
calculated with reference to the fair market or equity value of such Person or
any of its Subsidiaries), but excluding dividends payable solely in shares of
common stock or in options, warrants or other rights to purchase such common
stock of such Person or (b) any payment (whether made by such Person or any of
its Subsidiaries) on account of the purchase, redemption, prepayment, defeasance
or other acquisition or retirement of value of any Indebtedness (such
Indebtedness, "RETIRED INDEBTEDNESS") that is subordinated in right of payment
to the prior payment of the Loans, except any such payment made from the
proceeds of 



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   22
                                      -17-


(x) the issuance of any equity securities or (y) any additional unsecured
Indebtedness that does not rank senior in right of payment to, and does not
mature or have any mandatory prepayment, which does not include required
prepayments as a result of a change of control or asset sale, prior to the
maturity of, such Retired Indebtedness.

               "REVERSION" shall mean the termination by the Company or any of
its Subsidiaries of a Plan which results in a payment to the Company or any of
its Subsidiaries of any part of the over-funded portion of such Plan.

               "SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT" shall mean the Securities Exchange Act
of 1934, as amended.

               "SECURITY AGREEMENT" shall mean the Amended and Restated Security
Agreement dated as of the Restatement Date between the Company and the
Administrative Agent, substantially in the form of Exhibit A-1 hereto, as the
same shall be modified, supplemented and in effect from time to time.

               "SECURITY DOCUMENTS" shall mean, collectively, the Security
Agreement and the In-Flight Guarantee and Security Agreement.

               "SENIOR SUBORDINATED INDENTURES" shall mean the Senior
Subordinated 1996 Indenture and the Senior Subordinated 1998 Indenture.

               "SENIOR SUBORDINATED 1996 INDENTURE" shall mean the Indenture
dated as of February 1, 1996 between the Company and Fleet National Bank
Connecticut, N.A., as Trustee, as the same shall be modified and supplemented
and in effect from time to time.

               "SENIOR SUBORDINATED 1998 INDENTURE" shall mean the Indenture
dated as of February 13, 1998 between the Company and United States Trust
Company of New York as Trustee, as the same shall be modified and supplemented
and in effect from time to time.

               "SERIES A COMMITMENT" shall mean, for each Series A Lender, the
obligation of such Lender to make Series A Loans in an aggregate amount at any
one time outstanding up to but not exceeding the amount set opposite the name of
such Lender on Annex 1 hereto under the caption "Series A Commitment" (as the
same may be reduced from time to time pursuant to Section 2.04 hereof or
increased or reduced from time to time pursuant to Section 11.06 hereof). The
original aggregate principal amount of the Series A Commitments is $100,000,000.

               "SERIES A COMMITMENT PERCENTAGE" shall mean, with respect to any
Series A Lender, the ratio of (a) the amount of the Series A Commitment of such
Lender to (b) the aggregate amount of the Series A Commitments of all of the
Lenders.

               "SERIES A COMMITMENT TERMINATION DATE" shall mean the sixth
anniversary of the Restatement Date; PROVIDED that if such day is not a Business
Day, the Series A Commitment Termination Date shall be the immediately preceding
Business Day.



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   23
                                      -18-


               "SERIES A LENDERS" shall mean (a) on the Amendment Effective
Date, the Lenders having Series A Commitments as indicated on Annex 1 hereto and
(b) thereafter, the Lenders from time to time holding Series A Loans and Series
A Commitments after giving effect to any assignments thereof permitted by
Section 11.06 hereof.

               "SERIES A LOANS" shall mean the loans provided for by Section
2.01(a) hereof, which may be Base Rate Loans and/or Eurodollar Loans.

               "SERIES A NOTES" shall mean the promissory notes (if any)
provided for by Section 2.08(a) hereof and all promissory notes delivered in
substitution or exchange therefor, in each case as the same shall be modified
and supplemented and in effect from time to time.

               "SERIES B COMMITMENT" shall mean, for each Series B Lender, the
obligation of such Lender to make Series B Loans in an aggregate amount at any
one time outstanding up to but not exceeding the amount set opposite the name of
such Lender on Annex 1 hereto under the caption "Series B Commitment" (as the
same may be reduced from time to time pursuant to Section 2.04 hereof or
increased or reduced from time to time pursuant to Section 11.06 hereof). The
original aggregate principal amount of the Series B Commitments is $100,000,000.

               "SERIES B COMMITMENT TERMINATION DATE" shall mean the date 364
days after the Restatement Date; PROVIDED that if such day is not a Business
Day, the Series B Commitment Termination Date shall be the immediately preceding
Business Day.

               "SERIES B LENDERS" shall mean (a) on the Amendment Effective
Date, the Lenders having Series B Commitments as indicated on Annex 1 hereto and
(b) thereafter, the Lenders from time to time holding Series B Loans and Series
B Commitments after giving effect to any assignments thereof permitted by
Section 11.06 hereof.

               "SERIES B LOANS" shall mean the loans provided for by Section
2.01(b) hereof, which may be Base Rate Loans and/or Eurodollar Loans.

               "SERIES B NOTES" shall mean the promissory notes provided for by
Section 2.08(b) hereof and all promissory notes delivered in substitution or
exchange therefor, in each case as the same shall be modified and supplemented
and in effect from time to time.

               "SERIES B PRINCIPAL PAYMENT DATE" shall mean any Quarterly Date
on which payments of principal of Series B Loan are scheduled to be made
pursuant to Section 3.01(b) hereof.

               "SPECIFIED SUBSIDIARY" shall mean each Subsidiary of the Company
identified as a "Specified Subsidiary" on Schedule III hereto, but only until
all (or, in the case of a Subsidiary that is not a Domestic Subsidiary, 65%) of
its shares that are owned by the Company become subject to the Lien of the
Security Agreement or are otherwise pledged to the Administrative 



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   24
                                      -19-


Agent for the benefit of the Lenders pursuant to documentation in form and
substance reasonably satisfactory to the Majority Lenders.

               "SUBSIDIARY" shall mean, for any Person, any corporation,
partnership or other entity of which at least a majority of the securities or
other ownership interests having by the terms thereof ordinary voting power to
elect a majority of the board of directors or other persons performing similar
functions of such corporation, partnership or other entity (irrespective of
whether or not at the time securities or other ownership interests of any other
class or classes of such corporation, partnership or other entity shall have or
might have voting power by reason of the happening of any contingency) is at the
time directly or indirectly owned or controlled by such Person or one or more
Subsidiaries of such Person or by such Person and one or more Subsidiaries of
such Person. "WHOLLY OWNED SUBSIDIARY" shall mean any such corporation,
partnership or other entity of which all of the equity securities or other
ownership interests (other than, in the case of a corporation, directors'
qualifying shares) are so owned or controlled.

               "TOTAL FUNDED DEBT" shall mean, as at any date, the sum, for the
Company and its Subsidiaries (determined on a consolidated basis without
duplication in accordance with GAAP), of all Funded Debt.

               "TYPE" shall have the meaning assigned to such term in Section
1.03 hereof.

               1.02 ACCOUNTING TERMS AND DETERMINATIONS.

               (a) Except as otherwise expressly provided herein, all accounting
terms used herein shall be interpreted, and all financial statements and
certificates and reports as to financial matters required to be delivered to the
Lenders hereunder shall (unless otherwise disclosed to the Lenders in writing at
the time of delivery thereof in the manner described in subsection (b) below) be
prepared, in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles applied on
a basis consistent with those used in the preparation of the latest financial
statements furnished to the Lenders hereunder (which, prior to the delivery of
the first financial statements under Section 8.01 hereof, shall mean the audited
financial statements as at February 22, 1997 referred to in Section 7.02
hereof). All calculations made for the purposes of determining compliance with
this Agreement shall (except as otherwise expressly provided herein) be made by
application of generally accepted accounting principles applied on a basis
consistent with those used in the preparation of the latest annual or quarterly
financial statements furnished to the Lenders pursuant to Section 8.01 hereof
(or, prior to the delivery of the first financial statements under Section 8.01
hereof, used in the preparation of the audited financial statements as at
February 22, 1997, referred to in Section 7.02 hereof) unless (i) the Company
shall have objected to determining such compliance on such basis at the time of
delivery of such financial statements or (ii) the Majority Lenders shall so
object in writing within 30 days after delivery of such financial statements, in
either of which events such calculations shall be made on a basis consistent
with those used in the preparation of the latest financial statements as to
which such objection shall not have been made (which, if objection is made in
respect of the first financial statements delivered under Section 8.01 hereof,
shall mean the audited financial statements as at February 22, 1997 referred to
in Section 7.02 hereof).


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   25
                                      -20-


               (b) The Company shall deliver to the Lenders at the same time as
the delivery of any annual or quarterly financial statement under Section 8.01
hereof (i) a description in reasonable detail of any material variation between
the application of accounting principles employed in the preparation of such
statement and the application of accounting principles employed in the
preparation of the next preceding annual or quarterly financial statements as to
which no objection has been made in accordance with the last sentence of
subsection (a) above and (ii) reasonable estimates of the difference between
such statements arising as a consequence thereof.

               (c) To enable the ready and consistent determination of
compliance with the covenants set forth in Section 8 hereof, the fiscal year of
the Company shall end on the last Saturday in February of each year, and the
last days of the first three fiscal quarters shall fall on the last Saturday in
each of May, August and November of each year, respectively.

               1.03 CLASSES AND TYPES OF LOANS.

  Loans hereunder are distinguished by "Class" and by "Type". The "Class" of a
Loan (or of a Commitment to make a Loan) refers to whether such Loan is a Series
A Loan or a Series B Loan, each of which constitutes a Class. The "Type" of a
Loan refers to whether such Loan is a Base Rate Loan or a Eurodollar Loan, each
of which constitutes a Type. Loans may be identified by both Class and Type.

               Section 2. COMMITMENTS, LOANS, NOTES AND PREPAYMENTS.

               2.01 LOANS.

               (a) SERIES A LOANS. Each Series A Lender severally agrees, on the
terms and conditions of this Agreement, to make loans to the Company in Dollars
to but not including the Series A Commitment Termination Date in an aggregate
principal amount at any one time outstanding up to but not exceeding the amount
of the Series A Commitment of such Lender as in effect from time to time (such
Loans, together with the "Series A Loans" made under the Existing Credit
Agreement, being herein called "SERIES A LOANS"), PROVIDED that in no event
shall the aggregate principal amount of all Series A Loans, together with the
aggregate amount of all Letter of Credit Liabilities, exceed the aggregate
amount of the Series A Commitments. Subject to the terms and conditions of this
Agreement, the Company may borrow, repay and reborrow the amount of the Series A
Commitments by means of Base Rate Loans and Eurodollar Loans and may Convert
Series A Loans of one Type into Series A Loans of another Type (as provided in
Section 2.09 hereof).

               (b) SERIES B LOANS. Each Series B Lender severally agrees, on the
terms and conditions of this Agreement, to make loans to the Company in Dollars
to but not including the Series B Commitment Termination Date in an aggregate
principal amount up to but not exceeding the amount of the Series B Commitment
of such Lender as in effect from time to time (such Loans being herein called
"SERIES B LOANS"). Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, the
Company may borrow the amount of the Series B Commitments by means of 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   26

                                      -21-


Base Rate Loans and Eurodollar Loans and may Convert Series B Loans of one Type
into Series B Loans of another Type (as provided in Section 2.09 hereof) or
Continue Series B Loans of one Type as Series B Loans of the same Type (as
provided in Section 2.09 hereof). Series B Loans may be prepaid, but they may
not be reborrowed once prepaid.

               (c) LIMIT ON EURODOLLAR LOANS. No more than six separate Interest
Periods in respect of Eurodollar Loans of either Class from each Lender may be
outstanding at any one time.

               2.02 BORROWINGS. The Company shall give the Administrative Agent
(which shall promptly notify the Lenders) notice of each borrowing hereunder as
provided in Section 4.05 hereof. Not later than 1:00 p.m. New York time on the
date specified for each borrowing hereunder, each Lender shall make available
the amount of the Loan or Loans to be made by it on such date to the
Administrative Agent, to the account of the Administrative Agent most recently
designated by it for such purpose by notice to the Lenders, in immediately
available funds, for account of the Company. The amount so received by the
Administrative Agent shall, subject to the terms and conditions of this
Agreement, be made available to the Company by depositing the same, in
immediately available funds, in an account of the Company maintained with Chase
at the Principal Office designated by the Company.

               2.03 LETTERS OF CREDIT. Subject to the terms and conditions of
this Agreement, the Series A Commitments may be utilized, upon the request of
the Company, in addition to the Series A Loans provided for by Section 2.01(a)
hereof, by the issuance by the Issuing Lender of letters of credit
(collectively, "LETTERS OF CREDIT") for account of the Company or any of its
Subsidiaries (as specified by the Company), PROVIDED that in no event shall (i)
the aggregate amount of all Letter of Credit Liabilities, together with the
aggregate principal amount of the Series A Loans, exceed the aggregate amount of
the Series A Commitments as in effect from time to time, (ii) the outstanding
aggregate amount of all Letter of Credit Liabilities exceed $15,000,000 and
(iii) the expiration date of any Letter of Credit extend beyond the earlier of
the Series A Commitment Termination Date and the date twelve months following
the issuance of such Letter of Credit. The following additional provisions shall
apply to Letters of Credit:

               (a) The Company shall give the Administrative Agent at least
three Business Days' irrevocable prior notice (effective upon receipt)
specifying the Business Day (which shall be no later than thirty days preceding
the Series A Commitment Termination Date) each Letter of Credit is to be issued
and the account party or parties therefor and describing in reasonable detail
the proposed terms of such Letter of Credit (including the beneficiary thereof)
and the nature of the transactions or obligations proposed to be supported
thereby (including whether such Letter of Credit is to be a commercial letter of
credit or a standby letter of credit). Upon receipt of any such notice, the
Administrative Agent shall advise the Issuing Lender of the contents thereof.

               (b) On each day during the period commencing with the issuance by
the Issuing Lender of any Letter of Credit and until such Letter of Credit shall
have expired or been terminated, the Series A Commitment of each Series A Lender
shall be deemed to be utilized for 



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   27
                                      -22-


all purposes of this Agreement in an amount equal to such Lender's Series A
Commitment Percentage of the then undrawn face amount of such Letter of Credit.
Each Series A Lender (other than the Issuing Lender) agrees that, upon the
issuance of any Letter of Credit hereunder, it shall automatically acquire a
participation in the Issuing Lender's liability under such Letter of Credit in
an amount equal to such Lender's Series A Commitment Percentage of such
liability, and each Series A Lender (other than the Issuing Lender) thereby
shall absolutely, unconditionally and irrevocably assume, as primary obligor and
not as surety, and shall be unconditionally obligated to the Issuing Lender to
pay and discharge when due, its Series A Commitment Percentage of the Issuing
Lender's liability under such Letter of Credit.

               (c) Upon receipt from the beneficiary of any Letter of Credit of
any demand for payment under such Letter of Credit, the Issuing Lender shall
promptly notify the Company (through the Administrative Agent) of the amount to
be paid by the Issuing Lender as a result of such demand and the date on which
payment is to be made by the Issuing Lender to such beneficiary in respect of
such demand. Notwithstanding the identity of the account party of any Letter of
Credit, the Company hereby unconditionally agrees to pay and reimburse the
Administrative Agent for account of the Issuing Lender for the amount of each
demand for payment under such Letter of Credit at or prior to the date on which
payment is to be made by the Issuing Lender to the beneficiary thereunder,
without presentment, demand, protest or other formalities of any kind.

               (d) Forthwith upon its receipt of a notice referred to in clause
(c) of this Section 2.03, the Company shall advise the Administrative Agent
whether or not the Company intends to borrow hereunder to finance its obligation
to reimburse the Issuing Lender for the amount of the related demand for payment
and, if it does, submit a notice of such borrowing as provided in Section 4.05
hereof. In the event that the Company fails to so advise the Administrative
Agent, or if the Company fails to reimburse the Issuing Lender for a demand for
payment under a Letter of Credit by the date of such payment, the Administrative
Agent shall give each Series A Lender prompt notice of the amount of the demand
for payment, specifying such Lender's Series A Commitment Percentage of the
amount of the related demand for payment.

               (e) Each Series A Lender (other than the Issuing Lender) shall
pay to the Administrative Agent for account of the Issuing Lender at the
Principal Office in Dollars and in immediately available funds, the amount of
such Lender's Series A Commitment Percentage of any payment under a Letter of
Credit upon notice by the Issuing Lender (through the Administrative Agent) to
such Series A Lender requesting such payment and specifying such amount;
PROVIDED that such Series A Lender shall not be obligated to reimburse the
Issuing Bank if such payment is the result of the willful misconduct or gross
negligence of the Issuing Bank in determining that the request or demand for
such payment complied with the terms of such Letter of Credit. Each such Series
A Lender's obligation to make such payments to the Administrative Agent for
account of the Issuing Lender under this clause (e), and the Issuing Lender's
right to receive the same, shall be absolute and unconditional and shall not be
affected by any circumstance whatsoever, including, without limitation, (i) the
failure of any other Series A Lender to make its payment under this clause (e),
the financial condition of the Company (or any 



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   28
                                      -23-


other account party), the existence of any Default or (ii) the termination of
the Commitments. Each such payment to the Issuing Lender shall be made without
any offset, abatement, withholding or reduction whatsoever. If any Series A
Lender shall default in its obligation to make any such payment to the
Administrative Agent for account of the Issuing Lender, for so long as such
default shall continue the Administrative Agent shall at the request of the
Issuing Bank withhold from any payments received by the Administrative Agent
under this Agreement or any Note for account of such Series A Lender the amount
so in default and the Administrative Agent shall pay the same to the Issuing
Lender in satisfaction of such defaulted obligation.

               (f) Upon the making of each payment by a Series A Lender to the
Issuing Lender pursuant to clause (e) above in respect of any Letter of Credit,
such Lender shall, automatically and without any further action on the part of
the Administrative Agent, the Issuing Lender or such Lender, acquire (i) a
participation in an amount equal to such payment in the Reimbursement Obligation
owing to the Issuing Lender by the Company hereunder and under the Letter of
Credit Documents relating to such Letter of Credit and (ii) a participation in a
percentage equal to such Lender's Series A Commitment Percentage in any interest
or other amounts payable by the Company hereunder and under such Letter of
Credit Documents in respect of such Reimbursement Obligation (other than the
commissions, charges, costs and expenses payable to the Issuing Lender pursuant
to clause (g) of this Section 2.03). Upon receipt by the Issuing Lender from or
for account of the Company of any payment in respect of any Reimbursement
Obligation or any such interest or other amount (including by way of setoff or
application of proceeds of any collateral security) the Issuing Lender shall
promptly pay to the Administrative Agent for account of each Series A Lender
entitled thereto, such Series A Lender's Series A Commitment Percentage of such
payment, each such payment by the Issuing Lender to be made in the same money
and funds in which received by the Issuing Lender. In the event any payment
received by the Issuing Lender and so paid to the Series A Lenders hereunder is
rescinded or must otherwise be returned by the Issuing Lender, each Series A
Lender shall, upon the request of the Issuing Lender (through the Administrative
Agent), repay to the Issuing Lender (through the Administrative Agent) the
amount of such payment paid to such Lender, with interest as specified in clause
(j) of this Section 2.03.

               (g) The Company shall pay to the Administrative Agent for account
of the Series A Lenders in respect of each Letter of Credit a letter of credit
fee in an amount equal to the product of the Applicable Margin for Eurodollar
Loans TIMES the daily average undrawn amount of such Letter of Credit for the
period from and including the date of issuance of such Letter of Credit to and
including the date such Letter of Credit is drawn in full, expires or is
terminated (such fee to be non-refundable, to be paid in arrears on each
Quarterly Date and on the Series A Commitment Termination Date and to be
calculated, for any day, after giving effect to any payments made under such
Letter of Credit on such day). In addition, the Company shall pay to the
Administrative Agent for account of the Issuing Lender all commissions, charges,
costs and expenses in the amounts customarily charged by the Issuing Lender from
time to time in like circumstances with respect to the issuance of each Letter
of Credit and drawings and other transactions relating thereto.


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   29

                                      -24-


               (h) Promptly following the end of each calendar month, the
Issuing Lender shall deliver (through the Administrative Agent) to each Series A
Lender and the Company a notice describing the aggregate amount of all Letters
of Credit outstanding at the end of such month. Upon the request of any Series A
Lender from time to time, the Issuing Lender shall deliver any other information
reasonably requested by such Lender with respect to each Letter of Credit then
outstanding.

               (i) The issuance by the Issuing Lender of each Letter of Credit
shall, in addition to the conditions precedent set forth in Section 6 hereof, be
subject to the conditions precedent that (i) such Letter of Credit shall be in
such form, contain such terms and support such transactions as shall be
satisfactory to the Issuing Lender consistent with its then current practices
and procedures with respect to letters of credit of the same type and (ii) the
Company shall have executed and delivered such applications, agreements and
other instruments relating to such Letter of Credit as the Issuing Lender shall
have reasonably requested consistent with its then current practices and
procedures with respect to letters of credit of the same type, provided that in
the event of any conflict between any such application, agreement or other
instrument and the provisions of this Agreement or any Security Document, the
provisions of this Agreement and the Security Documents shall control.

               (j) To the extent that any Series A Lender fails to pay any
amount required to be paid pursuant to clause (e) or (f) of this Section 2.03 on
the due date therefor, such Lender shall pay interest to the Issuing Lender
(through the Administrative Agent) on such amount from and including such due
date to but excluding the date such payment is made (i) during the period from
and including such due date to but excluding the date three Business Days
thereafter, at a rate per annum equal to the Federal Funds Rate (as in effect
from time to time) and (ii) thereafter, at a rate per annum equal to the Base
Rate (as in effect from time to time) plus 2%.

               (k) The issuance by the Issuing Lender of any modification or
supplement to any Letter of Credit hereunder shall be subject to the same
conditions applicable under this Section 2.03 to the issuance of new Letters of
Credit, and no such modification or supplement shall be issued hereunder unless
either (x) the respective Letter of Credit affected thereby would have complied
with such conditions had it originally been issued hereunder in such modified or
supplemented form or (y) each Series A Lender shall have consented thereto.

               (l) Pursuant to Section 2.03 of the Existing Credit Agreement,
Chase has issued the Letters of Credit identified on Schedule V hereto (the
"EXISTING LETTERS OF CREDIT"). Each Series A Lender hereby agrees that each
Existing Letter of Credit shall constitute, on and after the Amendment Effective
Date, a Letter of Credit for all purposes of this Agreement.

The Company hereby indemnifies and holds harmless each Series A Lender and the
Administrative Agent from and against any and all claims and damages, losses,
liabilities, costs or expenses which such Lender or the Administrative Agent may
incur (or which may be claimed against such Lender or the Administrative Agent
by any Person whatsoever) by reason of or in connection with the execution and
delivery or transfer of or payment or refusal to pay by the Issuing Lender under
any Letter of Credit; PROVIDED that the Company shall not be required 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   30
                                      -25-



to indemnify any Lender or the Administrative Agent for any claims, damages,
losses, liabilities, costs or expenses to the extent, but only to the extent,
caused by (x) the willful misconduct or gross negligence of the Issuing Lender
in determining whether a request presented under any Letter of Credit complied
with the terms of such Letter of Credit or (y) in the case of the Issuing
Lender, such Lender's failure to pay under any Letter of Credit after the
presentation to it of a request strictly complying with the terms and conditions
of such Letter of Credit. Nothing in this Section 2.03 is intended to limit the
other obligations of the Company, any Lender or the Administrative Agent under
this Agreement.

               2.04 CHANGES OF COMMITMENTS.

               (a)  SERIES A COMMITMENTS.

               (i) The Series A Commitments shall terminate on the Series A
        Commitment Termination Date.

               (ii) The Company shall have the right at any time or from time to
        time (x) so long as no Series A Loans or Letter of Credit Liabilities
        are outstanding, to terminate the Series A Commitments and (y) to reduce
        the aggregate unused amount of the Series A Commitments (for which
        purpose use of the Series A Commitments shall be deemed to include the
        aggregate amount of Letter of Credit Liabilities); PROVIDED that (A) the
        Company shall give notice of each such termination or reduction as
        provided in Section 4.05 hereof and (B) each partial reduction shall be
        in an aggregate amount at least equal to $5,000,000 or in multiples of
        $1,000,000 in excess thereof.

               (b)  SERIES B COMMITMENTS.

               (i) The Series B Commitments shall terminate on the Series B
        Commitment Termination Date.

               (ii) The Company shall have the right at any time or from time to
        time (x) so long as no Series B Loans are outstanding, to terminate the
        Series B Commitments and (y) to reduce the aggregate amount of the
        Series B Commitments; PROVIDED that (A) the Company shall give notice of
        each such termination or reduction as provided in Section 4.05 hereof;
        (B) each partial reduction shall be in an aggregate amount at least
        equal to $5,000,000 or in multiples of $1,000,000 in excess thereof; and
        (C) to the extent that, after giving effect to any such reduction, the
        aggregate principal amount of the Series B Loans would exceed the Series
        B Commitments, the Company shall prepay the Series B Loans.

               (c) ALL COMMITMENTS. The Commitments once terminated or reduced
may not be reinstated.

               2.05 COMMITMENT FEE. The Company shall pay to the Administrative
Agent for account of (i) each Series A Lender a commitment fee on the daily
average unused amount of 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   31
                                      -26-


such Lender's Series A Commitment (for which purpose Letter of Credit
Liabilities shall be deemed to be a use of any Lender's Series A Commitment) and
(ii) each Series B Lender a commitment fee on the daily average unused amount of
such Lender's Series B Commitment, for the period from and including the
Amendment Effective Date to but not including the date such Commitment is
terminated, at a rate per annum equal to the Commitment Fee Rate. Accrued
commitment fee shall be payable on each Quarterly Date and on the date the
relevant Commitments are terminated.

               2.06 LENDING OFFICES. The Loans of each Type made by each Lender
shall be made and maintained at such Lender's Applicable Lending Office for
Loans of such Type.

               2.07 SEVERAL OBLIGATIONS; REMEDIES INDEPENDENT. The failure of
any Lender to make any Loan to be made by it on the date specified therefor
shall not relieve any other Lender of its obligation to make its Loan on such
date, but neither any Lender nor the Administrative Agent shall be responsible
for the failure of any other Lender to make a Loan to be made by such other
Lender, and no Lender shall have any obligation to the Administrative Agent
(except as provided in Section 4.06 hereof) or any other Lender for the failure
by such Lender to make any Loan required to be made by such Lender.

               2.08 EVIDENCE OF DEBT.

               (a) Each Lender shall maintain in accordance with its usual
practice an account or accounts evidencing the Indebtedness of the Company to
such Lender resulting from each Loan made or continued hereunder by such Lender,
including the amounts of principal and interest payable and paid to such Lender
from time to time hereunder.

               (b) The Administrative Agent shall maintain accounts in which it
shall record (i) the amount of each Loan made or continued hereunder, the Class
and Type thereof and the Interest Period applicable thereto, (ii) the amount of
any principal or interest due and payable or to become due and payable from the
Company to each Lender hereunder and (iii) the amount of any sum received by the
Administrative Agent hereunder for the account of the Lenders and each Lender's
share thereof.

               (c) The entries made in the accounts maintained pursuant to
paragraph (a) or (b) of this Section 2.08 shall be PRIMA FACIE evidence of the
existence and amounts of the obligations recorded therein; PROVIDED that the
failure of any Lender or the Administrative Agent to maintain such accounts or
any error therein shall not in any manner affect the obligation of the Company
to repay the Loans in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.

               (d) Any Lender may request that Loans made or continued by it
hereunder be evidenced by a promissory note(s). In such event, the Company, at
its own expense, shall prepare, execute and deliver to such Lender a promissory
note(s) payable to the order of such Lender (or, if requested by such Lender, to
such Lender and its registered assigns) and in a form approved by the
Administrative Agent and such note(s) shall be evidence of such Loans (and all
amounts payable in respect thereof).


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   32
                                      -27-


               2.09 OPTIONAL PREPAYMENTS AND CONVERSIONS OR CONTINUATIONS OF
LOANS. Subject to Sections 4.04 and 5.05 hereof, the Company shall have the
right to prepay Loans, or to Convert Loans of one Type into Loans of another
Type or Continue Loans of one Type as Loans of the same Type, at any time or
from time to time, PROVIDED that the Company shall give the Administrative Agent
notice of each such prepayment, Conversion or Continuation as provided in
Section 4.05 hereof (and, upon the date specified in any such notice of
prepayment, the amount to be prepaid shall become due and payable hereunder) and
PROVIDED further that any prepayment of the principal of the Series B Loans
shall be applied to reduce the then remaining installments thereof on a pro rata
basis (based on the then remaining principal amount of each such installment).
Notwithstanding the foregoing, and without limiting the rights and remedies of
the Lenders under Section 9 hereof, in the event that any Event of Default shall
have occurred and be continuing, the Administrative Agent may (and at the
request of the Majority Lenders shall) suspend the right of the Company to
Convert any Loan into a Eurodollar Loan, or to Continue any Loan as a Eurodollar
Loan, in which event all Loans shall be Converted (on the last day(s) of the
respective Interest Periods therefor) or Continued, as the case may be, as Base
Rate Loans.

               2.10 MANDATORY PREPAYMENTS AND REDUCTIONS OF COMMITMENTS.

               (a)  [Intentionally Omitted]

               (b) CASUALTY EVENTS. Unless the Company or any of its
Subsidiaries, as the case may be, shall have irrevocably committed to repair or
replace any Property of the Company or such Subsidiary affected by a Casualty
Event, on the date 30 days following the receipt by the Company of the proceeds
of insurance, condemnation award or other compensation in respect of such
Casualty Event affecting such Property (or upon such earlier date as the Company
or such Subsidiary, as the case may be, shall have determined not to repair or
replace the Property affected by such Casualty Event), the Company shall prepay
the Loans (and/or provide cover for Letter of Credit Liabilities as specified in
clause (f) below), and the Commitments shall be subject to automatic reduction,
in an aggregate amount, if any, equal to 75% of the Net Available Proceeds of
such Casualty Event not theretofore applied to the repair or replacement of such
Property (or reserved by the Company for application to such purposes), such
prepayment and reduction to be effected in each case in the manner and to the
extent specified in clause (e) of this Section 2.10. Nothing in this clause (b)
shall be deemed to limit any obligation of the Company or any of its
Subsidiaries pursuant to any of the Security Documents to remit to a collateral
or similar account (including, without limitation, the Collateral Account)
maintained by the Administrative Agent pursuant to any of the Security Documents
the proceeds of insurance, condemnation award or other compensation received in
respect of any Casualty Event.

               (c) RECAPTURE OF PROCEEDS FROM ASSET SALES. In the event of a
Disposition, the Company shall deposit 75% of the Net Available Proceeds
therefrom into the Collateral Account no later than five Business Days after
receipt thereof; PROVIDED that prior to such deposit the Company may invest such
Net Available Proceeds, or after such deposit the Company may withdraw such Net
Available Proceeds from the Collateral Account within 270 days after such


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT




<PAGE>   33

                                      -28-


Disposition so long as immediately thereafter such Net Available Proceeds are
invested, in Property to be used by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries in
the lines of business in which the Company or any of its Subsidiaries is engaged
as of the Restatement Date or in any business related thereto. No later than 270
days following the occurrence of any such Disposition, the Company will deliver
to the Lenders a statement, certified by the chief financial officer of the
Company, in form and detail satisfactory to the Administrative Agent, of the
amount of the Net Available Proceeds of such Disposition not applied as
contemplated by the immediately preceding sentence and, on the first Recapture
Date thereafter, the Company shall withdraw the remaining Net Available Proceeds
from the Collateral Account and prepay the Loans (and/or provide cover for
Letter of Credit Liabilities as specified in clause (f) below), and the
Commitments shall be subject to automatic reduction, in an aggregate amount
equal to 75% of the Net Available Proceeds received or which become available
for prepayment or reduction during such Recapture Period ending on such
Recapture Date, such prepayment and reduction to be effected in each case in the
manner and to the extent specified in clause (e) of this Section 2.10. In
addition to the foregoing, to the extent the remaining 25% of the Net Available
Proceeds from such Disposition would become "Excess Proceeds" (as defined in the
Senior Subordinated Indenture[s]) under clause (b) of Section 1016 of the Senior
Subordinated Indenture[s] (the "REMAINDER AMOUNT"), the Company shall,
immediately prior to such Remainder Amount becoming "Excess Proceeds" as
aforesaid, prepay the Loans (and/or provide cover for Letter of Credit
Liabilities as specified in clause (f) below), and the Commitments shall be
subject to automatic reduction, in an aggregate amount equal to such Remainder
Amount, such prepayment and reduction to be effected in each case in the manner
and to the extent specified in clause (e) of this Section 2.10. Nothing in this
Section 2.10(c) shall be deemed to excuse or otherwise limit the obligation of
the Company to obtain the consent of the Majority Lenders pursuant to Section
8.05 hereof to any Disposition not otherwise permitted hereunder.

               (d) REVERSIONS. Without limiting the obligation of the Company
under Section 8.01(c) hereof, upon any Reversion the Company shall prepay the
Loans (and/or provide cover for Letter of Credit Liabilities as specified in
clause (f) below), and the Commitments shall be subject to automatic reduction,
in an aggregate amount equal to 75% of the Net Available Proceeds thereof, such
prepayment and reduction to be effected in each case in the manner and to the
extent specified in clause (e) of this Section 2.10.

               (e) APPLICATION. Prepayments and reductions of Commitments
described in the above clauses of this Section 2.10 shall be effected as
follows:

               (i) first, the Series B Loans shall be prepaid in an amount equal
        to the prepayment or reduction specified in such clauses (such
        prepayments shall be applied first to Base Rate Loans and then to
        Eurodollar Loans) and shall be applied to the installments of the Series
        B Loans on a pro rata basis (based on the then remaining principal
        amount of each such installment); and

               (ii) second, any excess over the amount referred to in the
        foregoing clause (i) shall automatically reduce the Series A Commitments
        (and to the extent that, after giving effect to such reduction, the
        aggregate principal amount of Series A Loans, together with 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   34
                                      -29-

        the aggregate amount of all Letter of Credit Liabilities, would exceed
        the Series A Commitments, the Company shall, first, prepay Series A
        Loans (such prepayments shall be applied first to Base Rate Loans and
        then to Eurodollar Loans) and, second, provide cover for Letter of
        Credit Liabilities as specified in clause (f) below, in an aggregate
        amount equal to such excess).

               (f) COVER FOR LETTER OF CREDIT LIABILITIES. In the event that the
Company shall be required pursuant to this Section 2.10 to provide cover for
Letter of Credit Liabilities, the Company shall effect the same by paying to the
Administrative Agent immediately available funds in an amount equal to the
required amount, which funds shall be retained by the Administrative Agent in
the Collateral Account (as provided therein as collateral security in the first
instance for the Letter of Credit Liabilities) until such time as the Letters of
Credit shall have been terminated and all of the Letter of Credit Liabilities
paid in full.

               Section 3. PAYMENTS OF PRINCIPAL AND INTEREST.

               3.01 REPAYMENT OF LOANS.

               (a) The Company hereby promises to pay to the Administrative
Agent for account of each Series A Lender the entire outstanding principal
amount of such Lender's Series A Loans, and each Series A Loan shall mature, on
the Series A Commitment Termination Date.

               (b) Subject to Sections 2.09 and 2.10 hereof, the Company hereby
promises to pay to the Administrative Agent for account of each Series B Lender
the principal amount of each of such Lender's Series B Loans in twenty (20)
consecutive quarterly installments, commencing on the Quarterly Date falling
approximately three (3) months after the Series B Commitment Termination Date
and on each of the nineteen (19) Quarterly Dates thereafter, the first eight (8)
of which shall each be in an amount equal to 2.5% of the initial principal
amount of such Series B Loan, the next four (4) of which shall each be in an
amount equal to 4% of the initial principal amount of such Series B Loan, the
next four (4) of which shall each be in an amount equal to 7% of the initial
principal amount of such Series B Loan, and the last four (4) of which shall
each be in an amount equal to 9% of the initial principal amount of such Series
B Loan.

               3.02 INTEREST. The Company hereby promises to pay to the
Administrative Agent for account of each Lender interest on the unpaid principal
amount of each Loan made by such Lender for the period from and including the
date of such Loan to but excluding the date such Loan shall be paid in full, at
the following rates per annum:

               (a) during such periods as such Loan is a Base Rate Loan, the
Base Rate (as in effect from time to time) PLUS the Applicable Margin (if any)
and


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   35

                                      -30-


               (b) during such periods as such Loan is a Eurodollar Loan, for
each Interest Period relating thereto, the Eurodollar Rate for such Loan for
such Interest Period PLUS the Applicable Margin.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Company hereby promises to pay to the
Administrative Agent for account of each Lender interest at the applicable
Post-Default Rate on any principal of any Loan made by such Lender, on any
Reimbursement Obligation held by such Lender and on any other amount payable by
the Company hereunder or under the Notes held by such Lender to or for account
of such Lender, which shall not be paid in full when due (whether at stated
maturity, by acceleration, by mandatory prepayment or otherwise), for the period
from and including the due date thereof to but excluding the date the same is
paid in full. Accrued interest on each Loan shall be payable (i) in the case of
a Base Rate Loan, quarterly on the Quarterly Dates, (ii) in the case of a
Eurodollar Loan, on the last day of each Interest Period therefor and, if such
Interest Period is longer than three months, at three-month intervals following
the first day of such Interest Period, and (iii) in the case of any Loan, upon
the payment or prepayment thereof or the Conversion of such Loan to a Loan of
another Type (but only on the principal amount so paid, prepaid or Converted),
except that interest payable at the Post-Default Rate shall be payable from time
to time on demand. Promptly after the determination of any interest rate
provided for herein or any change therein, the Administrative Agent shall give
notice thereof to the Lenders to which such interest is payable and to the
Company.

               Section 4. PAYMENTS; PRO RATA TREATMENT; COMPUTATIONS; ETC.

               4.01 PAYMENTS.

               (a) Except to the extent otherwise provided herein, all payments
of principal, interest, Reimbursement Obligations and other amounts to be made
by the Company under this Agreement and the Notes, and, except to the extent
otherwise provided therein, all payments to be made by the Company under any
other Basic Document, shall be made in Dollars, in immediately available funds,
without deduction, set-off or counterclaim, to the Administrative Agent to the
account of the Administrative Agent most recently designated by it for such
purpose by notice to the Company, not later than 1:00 p.m. New York time on the
date on which such payment shall become due (each such payment made after such
time on such due date to be deemed to have been made on the next succeeding
Business Day).

               (b) Any Lender for whose account any such payment is to be made
may (but shall not be obligated to) debit the amount of any such payment that is
not made by such time to any ordinary deposit account of the Company with such
Lender (with notice to the Company and the Administrative Agent).

               (c) The Company shall, at the time of making each payment under
this Agreement or any Note for account of any Lender, specify to the
Administrative Agent (which shall so notify the intended recipient(s) thereof)
the Loans, Reimbursement Obligations or other amounts payable by the Company
hereunder to which such payment is to be applied (and in the 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   36

                                      -31-


event that the Company fails to so specify, or if an Event of Default has
occurred and is continuing, the Administrative Agent may distribute such payment
to the Lenders for application in such manner as it or the Majority Lenders,
subject to Section 4.02 hereof, may determine to be appropriate).

               (d) Except to the extent otherwise provided in the last sentence
of Section 2.03(e) hereof, each payment received by the Administrative Agent
under this Agreement or any Note for account of any Lender shall be paid by the
Administrative Agent promptly to such Lender, in immediately available funds,
for account of such Lender's Applicable Lending Office for the Loan or other
obligation in respect of which such payment is made.

               (e) If the due date of any payment under this Agreement or any
Note would otherwise fall on a day that is not a Business Day, such date shall
be extended to the next succeeding Business Day, and interest shall be payable
for any principal so extended for the period of such extension.

               4.02 PRO RATA TREATMENT. Except to the extent otherwise provided
herein: (a) each borrowing of Loans of a particular Class from the Lenders under
Section 2.01 hereof shall be made from the relevant Lenders, each payment of
commitment fee under Section 2.05 hereof in respect of Commitments of a
particular Class shall be made for account of the relevant Lenders, and each
termination or reduction of the amount of the Commitments of a particular Class
under Section 2.04 hereof and under Section 2.10(e) hereof shall be applied to
the respective Commitments of such Class of the relevant Lenders, pro rata
according to the amounts of their respective Commitments of such Class; (b) the
making, Conversion and Continuation of Series A Loans and Series B Loans of a
particular Type (other than Conversions provided for by Section 5.04 hereof)
shall be made pro rata among the relevant Lenders according to the amounts of
their respective Series A and Series B Commitments (in the case of making of
Loans) or their respective Series A and Series B Loans (in the case of
Conversions and Continuations of Loans) and the then current Interest Period for
each Eurodollar Loan shall be coterminous; (c) each payment or prepayment of
principal of Series A Loans or Series B Loans by the Company shall be made for
account of the relevant Lenders pro rata in accordance with the respective
unpaid principal amounts of the Loans of such Class held by them; and (d) each
payment of interest on Series A Loans and Series B Loans by the Company shall be
made for account of the relevant Lenders pro rata in accordance with the amounts
of interest on such Loans then due and payable to the respective Lenders.

               4.03 COMPUTATIONS. Interest on Eurodollar Loans and Reimbursement
Obligations and commitment fee and letter of credit fee shall be computed on the
basis of a year of 360 days and actual days elapsed (including the first day but
excluding the last day) occurring in the period for which payable and interest
on Base Rate Loans shall be computed on the basis of a year of 365 or 366 days,
as the case may be, and actual days elapsed (including the first day but
excluding the last day) occurring in the period for which payable.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, for each date that the Base Rate is calculated by
reference to the Federal Funds Rate, interest on Base Rate Loans shall be
computed on the basis of a year of 360 days and actual days elapsed.


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   37
                                      -32-


               4.04 MINIMUM AMOUNTS. Except for mandatory prepayments made
pursuant to Section 2.10 hereof and Conversions or prepayments made pursuant to
Section 5.04 hereof, (i) each borrowing, Conversion and partial prepayment of
principal of Series A Loans shall be in multiples of $1,000,000 and (ii) each
borrowing, Conversion or partial prepayment of principal of Series B Loans shall
be in multiples of $1,000,000 (borrowings, Conversions or prepayments of or into
Loans of different Types, or, in the case of Eurodollar Loans, having different
Interest Periods at the same time hereunder to be deemed separate borrowings,
Conversions and prepayments for purposes of the foregoing, one for each Type or
Interest Period). Anything in this Agreement to the contrary notwithstanding,
the aggregate principal amount of Eurodollar Loans having the same Interest
Period shall be in an amount at least equal to $5,000,000 or in multiples of
$1,000,000 in excess thereof and, if any Eurodollar Loans would otherwise be in
a lesser principal amount for any period, such Loans shall be Base Rate Loans
during such period.

               4.05 CERTAIN NOTICES. Notices by the Company to the
Administrative Agent of terminations or reductions of the Commitments, of
borrowings, Conversions, Continuations and optional prepayments of Loans and of
Classes of Loans and of Types of Loans and of the duration of Interest Periods
shall be irrevocable and shall be effective only if received by the
Administrative Agent not later than 10:00 a.m. New York time on the number of
Business Days prior to the date of the relevant termination, reduction,
borrowing, Conversion, Continuation or prepayment or the first day of such
Interest Period specified below:

Number of Business Notice                    Days Prior
- -------------------------------------        ----------

Termination or reduction                          3
of Commitments

Borrowing or prepayment of,                       1
or Conversions into,
Base Rate Loans

Borrowing or prepayment of,                       3
Conversions into, Continuations
as, or duration of Interest
Period for, Eurodollar Loans

Each such notice of termination or reduction shall specify the amount and the
Class of the Commitments to be terminated or reduced. Each such notice of
borrowing, Conversion, Continuation or optional prepayment shall specify the
Class of Loans to be borrowed, Converted, Continued or prepaid and the amount
(subject to Section 4.04 hereof) and Type of each Loan to be borrowed,
Converted, Continued or prepaid and the date of borrowing, Conversion,
Continuation or optional prepayment (which shall be a Business Day). Each such
notice of the duration of an Interest Period shall specify the Loans to which
such Interest Period is to relate. The Administrative Agent shall promptly
notify the Lenders of the contents of each such notice. In the event that the
Company fails to select the Type of Loan, or the duration of any Interest Period
for any Eurodollar Loan, within the time period and otherwise as provided in
this Section 4.05, such Loan (if outstanding as a Eurodollar Loan) will be
automatically Converted 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   38

                                      -33-


into a Base Rate Loan on the last day of the then current Interest Period for
such Loan or (if outstanding as a Base Rate Loan) will remain as, or (if not
then outstanding) will be made as, a Base Rate Loan.

               4.06 NON-RECEIPT OF FUNDS BY THE ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT. Unless the
Administrative Agent shall have been notified by a Lender or the Company (the
"PAYOR") prior to the date on which the Payor is to make payment to the
Administrative Agent of (in the case of a Lender) the proceeds of a Loan to be
made by such Lender, or a participation in a Letter of Credit drawing to be
acquired by such Lender, hereunder or (in the case of the Company) a payment to
the Administrative Agent for account of one or more of the Lenders hereunder
(such payment being herein called the "REQUIRED PAYMENT"), which notice shall be
effective upon receipt, that the Payor does not intend to make the Required
Payment to the Administrative Agent, the Administrative Agent may assume that
the Required Payment has been made and may, in reliance upon such assumption
(but shall not be required to), make the amount thereof available to the
intended recipient(s) on such date; and, if the Payor has not in fact made the
Required Payment to the Administrative Agent, the recipient(s) of such payment
shall, on demand, repay to the Administrative Agent the amount so made available
together with interest thereon in respect of each day during the period
commencing on the date (the "ADVANCE DATE") such amount was so made available by
the Administrative Agent until the date the Administrative Agent recovers such
amount at a rate per annum equal to the Federal Funds Rate for such day and, if
such recipient(s) shall fail promptly to make such payment, the Administrative
Agent shall be entitled to recover such amount, on demand, from the Payor,
together with interest as aforesaid, PROVIDED that if neither the recipient(s)
nor the Payor shall return the Required Payment to the Administrative Agent
within three Business Days of the Advance Date, then, retroactively to the
Advance Date, the Payor and the recipient(s) shall each be obligated to pay
interest on the Required Payment as follows:

               (i) if the Required Payment shall represent a payment to be made
        by the Company to the Lenders, the Company and the recipient(s) shall
        each be obligated retroactively to the Advance Date to pay interest in
        respect of the Required Payment at the Post-Default Rate (and, in case
        the recipient(s) shall return the Required Payment to the Administrative
        Agent, without limiting the obligation of the Company under Section 3.02
        hereof to pay interest to such recipient(s) at the Post-Default Rate in
        respect of the Required Payment) and

               (ii) if the Required Payment shall represent proceeds of a loan
        to be made by the Lenders to the Company, the Payor and the Company
        shall each be obligated retroactively to the Advance Date to pay
        interest in respect of the Required Payment at the rate of interest
        provided for such Required Payment pursuant to Section 3.02 hereof (and,
        in case the Company shall return the Required Payment to the
        Administrative Agent, without limiting any claim the Company may have
        against the Payor in respect of the Required Payment).

               4.07 SHARING OF PAYMENTS, ETC.


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   39

                                      -34-


               (a) The Company agrees that, in addition to (and without
limitation of) any right of set-off, banker's lien or counterclaim a Lender may
otherwise have, each Lender shall be entitled, at its option, to offset balances
held by it for account of the Company at any of its offices, in Dollars or in
any other currency, against any principal of or interest on any of such Lender's
Loans, Reimbursement Obligations or any other amount payable to such Lender
hereunder, that is not paid when due (regardless of whether such balances are
then due to the Company), in which case it shall promptly notify the Company and
the Administrative Agent thereof, PROVIDED that such Lender's failure to give
such notice shall not affect the validity thereof.

               (b) If any Lender shall obtain from the Company payment of any
principal of or interest on any Loan of any Class or Letter of Credit Liability
owing to it or payment of any other amount under this Agreement or any other
Basic Document through the exercise of any right of set-off, banker's lien or
counterclaim or similar right or otherwise (other than from the Administrative
Agent as provided herein), and, as a result of such payment, such Lender shall
have received a greater percentage of the principal of or interest on the Loans
of such Class or Letter of Credit Liabilities or such other amounts then due
hereunder or thereunder by the Company to such Lender than the percentage
received by any other Lender, it shall promptly purchase from such other Lenders
participations in (or, if and to the extent specified by such Lender, direct
interests in) the Loans of such Class or Letter of Credit Liabilities or such
other amounts, respectively, owing to such other Lenders (or in interest due
thereon, as the case may be) in such amounts, and make such other adjustments
from time to time as shall be equitable, to the end that all the Lenders shall
share the benefit of such excess payment (net of any expenses that may be
incurred by such Lender in obtaining or preserving such excess payment) pro rata
in accordance with the unpaid principal of and/or interest on the Loans of such
Class or Letter of Credit Liabilities or such other amounts, respectively, owing
to each of the Lender. To such end all the Lenders shall make appropriate
adjustments among themselves (by the resale of participations sold or otherwise)
if such payment is rescinded or must otherwise be restored.

               (c) The Company agrees that any Lender so purchasing such a
participation (or direct interest) may exercise all rights of set-off, banker's
lien, counterclaim or similar rights with respect to such participation as fully
as if such Lender were a direct holder of Loans or other amounts (as the case
may be) owing to such Lender in the amount of such participation.

               (d) Nothing contained herein shall require any Lender to exercise
any such right or shall affect the right of any Lender to exercise, and retain
the benefits of exercising, any such right with respect to any other
indebtedness or obligation of the Company. If, under any applicable bankruptcy,
insolvency or other similar law, any Lender receives a secured claim in lieu of
a set-off to which this Section 4.07 applies, such Lender shall, to the extent
practicable, exercise its rights in respect of such secured claim in a manner
consistent with the rights of the Lenders entitled under this Section 4.07 to
share in the benefits of any recovery on such secured claim.


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   40
                                      -35-



               Section 5. YIELD PROTECTION, ETC.

               5.01 ADDITIONAL COSTS.

               (a) The Company shall pay directly to each Lender from time to
time such amounts as such Lender may determine to be necessary to compensate
such Lender for any costs that such Lender determines are attributable to its
making or maintaining of any Eurodollar Loans or its obligation to make any
Eurodollar Loans hereunder, or any reduction in any amount receivable by such
Lender hereunder in respect of any of such Loans or such obligation (such
increases in costs and reductions in amounts receivable being herein called
"ADDITIONAL COSTS"), resulting from any Regulatory Change that:

               (i) changes the basis of taxation of any amounts payable to such
        Lender under this Agreement or its Notes in respect of any of such Loans
        (other than taxes imposed on or measured by the overall net income of
        such Lender or of its Applicable Lending Office for any of such Loans by
        the jurisdiction in which such Lender has its principal office or such
        Applicable Lending Office); or

               (ii) imposes or modifies any reserve, special deposit or similar
        requirements (other than the Reserve Requirement utilized in the
        determination of the Eurodollar Rate for such Loan) relating to any
        extensions of credit or other assets of, or any deposits with or other
        liabilities of, such Lender (including, without limitation, any of such
        Loans or any deposits referred to in the definition of "Eurodollar Base
        Rate" in Section 1.01 hereof), or any commitment of such Lender
        (including, without limitation, the Commitments of such Lender
        hereunder); or

               (iii) imposes any other condition affecting this Agreement or its
        Notes (or any of such extensions of credit or liabilities) or its
        Commitments.

If any Lender requests compensation from the Company under this Section 5.01(a),
the Company may, by notice to such Lender (with a copy to the Administrative
Agent), suspend the obligation of such Lender thereafter to make or Continue
Eurodollar Loans, or to Convert Base Rate Loans into Eurodollar Loans, until the
Regulatory Change giving rise to such request ceases to be in effect (in which
case the provisions of Section 5.04 hereof shall be applicable), PROVIDED that
such suspension shall not affect the right of such Lender to receive the
compensation so requested.

               (b) Without limiting the effect of the provisions of paragraph
(a) of this Section 5.01, in the event that, by reason of any Regulatory Change,
any Lender either (i) incurs Additional Costs based on or measured by the excess
above a specified level of the amount of a category of deposits or other
liabilities of such Lender that includes deposits by reference to which the
interest rate on Eurodollar Loans is determined as provided in this Agreement or
a category of extensions of credit or other assets of such Lender that includes
Eurodollar Loans or (ii) becomes subject to restrictions on the amount of such a
category of liabilities or assets that it may hold, then, if such Lender so
elects by notice to the Company (with a copy to the 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   41
                                      -36-


Administrative Agent), the obligation of such Lender to make or Continue, or to
Convert Base Rate Loans into, Eurodollar Loans hereunder shall be suspended
until such Regulatory Change ceases to be in effect (in which case the
provisions of Section 5.04 hereof shall be applicable).

               (c) Without limiting the effect of the foregoing provisions of
this Section 5.01 (but without duplication), the Company shall pay directly to
each Lender from time to time on request such amounts as such Lender may
determine to be necessary to compensate such Lender (or, without duplication,
the bank holding company of which such Lender is a subsidiary) for any costs
that it determines are attributable to the maintenance by such Lender (or any
Applicable Lending Office or such bank holding company), pursuant to any law or
regulation or any interpretation, directive or request (whether or not having
the force of law and whether or not failure to complete therewith would be
unlawful) of any court or governmental or monetary authority (i) following any
Regulatory Change or (ii) implementing any risk-based capital guideline or other
requirement (whether or not having the force of law and whether or not the
failure to comply therewith would be unlawful) heretofore or hereafter issued by
any government or governmental or supervisory authority implementing at the
national level the Basle Accord (including, without limitation, the Final
Risk-Based Capital Guidelines of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve
System (12 C.F.R. Part 208, Appendix A; 12 C.F.R. Part 225, Appendix A) and the
Final Risk-Based Capital Guidelines of the Office of the Comptroller of the
Currency (12 C.F.R. Part 3, Appendix A)), of capital in respect of its
Commitments or Loans (such compensation to include, without limitation, an
amount equal to any reduction of the rate of return on assets or equity of such
Lender (or any Applicable Lending Office or such bank holding company) to a
level below that which such Lender (or any Applicable Lending Office or such
bank holding company) could have achieved but for such law, regulation,
interpretation, directive or request). For purposes of this Section 5.01(c) and
Section 5.06 hereof, "BASLE ACCORD" shall mean the proposals for risk-based
capital framework described by the Basle Committee on Banking Regulations and
Supervisory Practices in its paper entitled "International Convergence of
Capital Measurement and Capital Standards" dated July 1988, as amended, modified
and supplemented and in effect from time to time or any replacement thereof.

               (d) Each Lender shall notify the Company of any event occurring
after the Amendment Effective Date entitling such Lender to compensation under
paragraph (a) or (c) of this Section 5.01 as promptly as practicable, but in any
event within 45 days, after such Lender obtains actual knowledge thereof;
PROVIDED that (i) if any Lender fails to give such notice within 45 days after
it obtains actual knowledge of such an event, such Lender shall, with respect to
compensation payable pursuant to this Section 5.01 in respect of any costs
resulting from such event, only be entitled to payment under this Section 5.01
for costs incurred from and after the date 45 days prior to the date that such
Lender does give such notice and (ii) each Lender will designate a different
Applicable Lending Office for the Loans of such Lender affected by such event if
such designation will avoid the need for, or reduce the amount of, such
compensation and will not, in the sole opinion of such Lender, be
disadvantageous to such Lender, except that such Lender shall have no obligation
to designate an Applicable Lending Office located in the United States of
America. Each Lender will furnish to the Company a certificate setting forth the
basis and amount of each request by such Lender for compensation under paragraph
(a) or (c) of this Section 5.01. Determinations and allocations by any Lender
for purposes of this 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   42
                                      -37-


Section 5.01 of the effect of any Regulatory Change pursuant to paragraph (a) or
(b) of this Section 5.01, or of the effect of capital maintained pursuant to
paragraph (c) of this Section 5.01, on its costs or rate of return of
maintaining Loans or its obligation to make Loans, or on amounts receivable by
it in respect of Loans, and of the amounts required to compensate such Lender
under this Section 5.01, shall be conclusive, PROVIDED that such determinations
and allocations are made on a reasonable basis.

               5.02 LIMITATION ON TYPES OF LOANS. Anything herein to the
contrary notwithstanding, if, on or prior to the determination of any Eurodollar
Base Rate for any Interest Period:

               (a) the Administrative Agent reasonably determines, which
determination shall be conclusive, that quotations of interest rates for the
relevant deposits referred to in the definition of "Eurodollar Base Rate" in
Section 1.01 hereof are not being provided in the relevant amounts or for the
relevant maturities for purposes of determining rates of interest for Eurodollar
Loans as provided herein; or

               (b) if the related Loans are Series A Loans, the Majority Series
A Lenders or, if the related Loans are Series B Loans, the Majority Series B
Lenders reasonably determine, which determination shall be conclusive, and
notify the Administrative Agent that the relevant rates of interest referred to
in the definition of "Eurodollar Base Rate" in Section 1.01 hereof upon the
basis of which the rate of interest for Eurodollar Loans for such Interest
Period is to be determined are not likely adequately to cover the cost to such
Lenders of making or maintaining Eurodollar Loans for such Interest Period;

then the Administrative Agent shall give the Company and each Lender prompt
notice thereof and, so long as such condition remains in effect, the Lenders
shall be under no obligation to make additional Eurodollar Loans, to Continue
Eurodollar Loans or to Convert Base Rate Loans into Eurodollar Loans, and the
Company shall, on the last day(s) of the then current Interest Period(s) for the
outstanding Eurodollar Loans, either prepay such Loans or Convert such Loans
into Base Rate Loans in accordance with Section 2.09 hereof.

               5.03 ILLEGALITY. Notwithstanding any other provision of this
Agreement, in the event that it becomes unlawful for any Lender or its
Applicable Lending Office to honor its obligation to make or maintain Eurodollar
Loans hereunder, then such Lender shall promptly notify the Company thereof
(with a copy to the Administrative Agent) and such Lender's obligation to make
or Continue, or to Convert Loans of any other Type into, Eurodollar Loans shall
be suspended until such time as such Lender may again make and maintain
Eurodollar Loans (in which case the provisions of Section 5.04 hereof shall be
applicable).

               5.04 TREATMENT OF AFFECTED LOANS. If the obligation of any Lender
to make Eurodollar Loans or to Continue, or to Convert Base Rate Loans into,
Eurodollar Loans shall be suspended pursuant to Section 5.01 or 5.03 hereof,
such Lender's Eurodollar Loans shall be automatically Converted into Base Rate
Loans on the last day(s) of the then current Interest 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   43
                                      -38-


Period(s) for Eurodollar Loans (or, in the case of a Conversion required by
Section 5.01(b) or 5.03 hereof, on such earlier date as such Lender may specify
to the Company with a copy to the Administrative Agent) and, unless and until
such Lender gives notice as provided below that the circumstances specified in
Section 5.01 or 5.03 hereof that gave rise to such Conversion no longer exist:

               (a) to the extent that such Lender's Eurodollar Loans have been
so Converted, all payments and prepayments of principal that would otherwise be
applied to such Lender's Eurodollar Loans shall be applied instead to its Base
Rate Loans; and

               (b) all Loans that would otherwise be made or Continued by such
Lender as Eurodollar Loans shall be made or Continued instead as Base Rate
Loans, and all Base Rate Loans of such Lender that would otherwise be Converted
into Eurodollar Loans shall remain as Base Rate Loans.

If such Lender gives notice to the Company with a copy to the Administrative
Agent that the circumstances specified in Section 5.01 or 5.03 hereof that gave
rise to the Conversion of such Lender's Eurodollar Loans pursuant to this
Section 5.04 no longer exist (which such Lender agrees to do promptly upon such
circumstances ceasing to exist) at a time when Eurodollar Loans made by other
Lenders are outstanding, such Lender's Base Rate Loans shall be automatically
Converted, on the first day(s) of the next succeeding Interest Period(s) for
such outstanding Eurodollar Loans, to the extent necessary so that, after giving
effect thereto, all Loans held by the Lenders holding Eurodollar Loans and by
such Lender are held pro rata (as to principal amounts, Types and Interest
Periods) in accordance with their respective Commitments.

               5.05 COMPENSATION. The Company shall pay to the Administrative
Agent for account of each Lender, upon the request of such Lender through the
Administrative Agent, such amount or amounts as shall be sufficient (in the
reasonable opinion of such Lender) to compensate it for any loss, cost or
expense incurred by it that such Lender determines is attributable to:

               (a) any payment, mandatory or optional prepayment or Conversion
of a Eurodollar Loan made by such Lender for any reason (including, without
limitation, the acceleration of the Loans pursuant to Section 9 hereof) on a
date other than the last day of the Interest Period for such Loan; or

               (b) any failure by the Company for any reason (including, without
limitation, the failure of any of the conditions precedent specified in Section
6 hereof to be satisfied) to borrow a Eurodollar Loan from such Lender on the
date for such borrowing specified in the relevant notice of borrowing given
pursuant to Section 2.02 hereof.

Without limiting the effect of the preceding sentence, such compensation shall
include an amount equal to the excess, if any, of (i) the amount of interest
that otherwise would have accrued on the principal amount so paid, prepaid or
Converted or not borrowed for the period 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   44
                                      -39-


from the date of such payment, prepayment, Conversion or failure to borrow to
the last day of the then current Interest Period for such Loan (or, in the case
of a failure to borrow, the Interest Period for such Loan that would have
commenced on the date specified for such borrowing) at the applicable rate of
interest for such Loan provided for herein over (ii) the amount of interest that
otherwise would have accrued on such principal amount at a rate per annum equal
to the interest component of the amount such Lender would have bid in the London
interbank market for Dollar deposits of leading banks in amounts comparable to
such principal amount and with maturities comparable to such period (as
reasonably determined by such Lender).

               5.06 ADDITIONAL COSTS IN RESPECT OF LETTERS OF CREDIT. Without
limiting the obligations of the Company under Section 5.01 hereof (but without
duplication), if as a result of any Regulatory Change or any risk-based capital
guideline or other requirement heretofore or hereafter issued by any government
or governmental or supervisory authority implementing at the national level the
Basle Accord there shall be imposed, modified or deemed applicable any tax,
reserve, special deposit, capital adequacy or similar requirement against or
with respect to or measured by reference to Letters of Credit issued or to be
issued hereunder and the result shall be to increase the cost to any Lender or
Lenders of issuing (or purchasing or maintaining participations in) or
maintaining its obligation hereunder to issue (or purchase participations in)
any Letter of Credit hereunder or reduce any amount receivable by any Lender
hereunder in respect of any Letter of Credit (which increases in cost, or
reductions in amount receivable, shall be the result of such Lender's or
Lenders' reasonable allocation of the aggregate of such increases or reductions
resulting from such event), then, upon demand by such Lender or Lenders (through
the Administrative Agent), the Company shall pay immediately to the
Administrative Agent for account of such Lender or Lenders, from time to time as
specified by such Lender or Lenders (through the Administrative Agent), such
additional amounts as shall be sufficient to compensate such Lender or Lenders
(through the Administrative Agent) for such increased costs or reductions in
amount. A statement as to such increased costs or reductions in amount incurred
by any such Lender or Lenders, submitted by such Lender or Lenders to the
Company shall be conclusive in the absence of manifest error as to the amount
thereof, PROVIDED that the determination of such increased costs or reductions
are made on a reasonable basis.

               5.07 U.S. TAXES.

               (a) The Company agrees to pay to each Lender that is not a U.S.
Person such additional amounts as are necessary in order that the net payment of
any amount due to such non-U.S. Person hereunder after deduction for or
withholding in respect of any U.S. Taxes imposed with respect to such payment
(or in lieu thereof, payment of such U.S. Taxes by such non-U.S. Person), will
not be less than the amount stated herein to be then due and payable, PROVIDED
that the foregoing obligation to pay such additional amounts shall not apply:

               (i) to any payment to a Lender hereunder unless such Lender is,
        on the Amendment Effective Date (or on the date it becomes a Lender as
        provided in Section 11.06(b) hereof) and on the date of any change in
        the Applicable Lending Office of such Lender, either entitled to submit
        a Form 1001 (relating to such Lender and entitling it to a complete
        exemption from withholding on all interest to be received by it



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   45
                                      -40-


        hereunder in respect of the Loans) or Form 4224 (relating to all
        interest to be received by such Lender hereunder in respect of the
        Loans), or

               (ii) to any U.S. Taxes imposed solely by reason of the failure by
        such non-U.S. Person to comply with applicable certification,
        information, documentation or other reporting requirements concerning
        the nationality, residence, identity or connections with the United
        States of America of such non-U.S. Person if such compliance is required
        by statute or regulation of the United States of America as a
        precondition to relief or exemption from such U.S. Taxes.

For the purposes of this Section 5.07(a), (w) "FORM 1001" shall mean Form 1001
(Ownership, Exemption, or Reduced Rate Certificate) of the Department of the
Treasury of the United States of America, (x) "FORM 4224" shall mean Form 4224
(Exemption from Withholding of Tax on Income Effectively Connected with the
Conduct of a Trade or Business in the United States) of the Department of the
Treasury of the United States of America (or in relation to either such Form
such successor and related forms as may from time to time be adopted by the
relevant taxing authorities of the United States of America to document a claim
to which such Form relates), (y) "U.S. PERSON" shall mean a citizen, national or
resident of the United States of America, a corporation, partnership or other
entity created or organized in or under any laws of the United States of
America, or any estate or trust that is subject to Federal income taxation
regardless of the source of its income and (z) "U.S. TAXES" shall mean any
present or future tax, assessment or other charge or levy imposed by or on
behalf of the United States of America or any taxing authority thereof or
therein.

               (b) Within 30 days after paying any amount to the Administrative
Agent or any Lender from which it is required by law to make any deduction or
withholding, and within 30 days after it is required by law to remit such
deduction or withholding to any relevant taxing or other authority, the Company
shall deliver to the Administrative Agent for delivery to such non-U.S. Person
evidence satisfactory to such Person of such deduction, withholding or payment
(as the case may be).

               Section 6. CONDITIONS PRECEDENT.

               6.01 CONDITIONS TO EFFECTIVENESS. The effectiveness of the
amendment and restatement of the Existing Credit Agreement provided for hereby
is subject to the receipt by the Administrative Agent of the following
documents, each of which shall be satisfactory to the Administrative Agent (and
to the extent specified below, to each Lender) in form and substance:

               (a) CORPORATE DOCUMENTS. The following documents, each certified
as indicated below:

               (i) a copy of the charter, as amended and in effect, of the
        Company certified as of a recent date by the Secretary of State of the
        State of Delaware (or, if there have been no 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   46
                                      -41-


        modifications to such charter from the copy thereof delivered by the
        Company pursuant to the Existing Credit Agreement, a certificate of the
        Secretary or an Assistant Secretary of the Company to that effect), and
        a certificate from such Secretary of State dated as of a recent date as
        to the good standing of and charter documents filed by the Company;

               (ii) a certificate of the Secretary or an Assistant Secretary of
        the Company, dated the Amendment Effective Date and certifying (A) that
        attached thereto is a true and complete copy of the by-laws of the
        Company as amended and in effect at all times from the date on which the
        resolutions referred to in clause (B) below were adopted to and
        including the date of such certificate (or if there have been no
        modifications to such by-laws from the copy thereof delivered by the
        Company pursuant to the Existing Credit Agreement, a certificate of the
        Secretary or an Assistant Secretary of the Company to that effect), (B)
        that attached thereto is a true and complete copy of resolutions duly
        adopted by the board of directors of the Company authorizing the
        execution, delivery and performance of the amendment and restatement of
        the Existing Credit Agreement and such other of the Basic Documents to
        which the Company is or is intended to be a party and the extensions of
        credit hereunder, and that such resolutions have not been modified,
        rescinded or amended and are in full force and effect, (C) that the
        charter of the Company has not been amended since the date of the
        certification thereto furnished pursuant to clause (i) above, and (D) as
        to the incumbency and specimen signature of each officer of the Company
        executing the amendment and restatement of the Existing Credit Agreement
        and such other of the Basic Documents to which the Company is intended
        to be a party and each other document to be delivered by the Company
        from time to time in connection therewith (and the Administrative Agent
        and each Lender may conclusively rely on such certificate until it
        receives notice in writing from the Company to the contrary); and

               (iii) a certificate of another officer of the Company as to the
        incumbency and specimen signature of the Secretary or Assistant
        Secretary, as the case may be, of the Company.

               (b) OFFICER'S CERTIFICATE. A certificate of a senior officer of
the Company, dated the Amendment Effective Date, to the effect that (i) no
Default shall have occurred and be continuing and (ii) the representations and
warranties made by the Company in Section 7 hereof, and in each of the other
Basic Documents, are true and correct on and as of the Amendment Effective Date
with the same force and effect as if made on and as of such date (or, if any
such representation or warranty is expressly stated to have been made as of a
specific date, as of such specific date).

               (c) OPINION OF COUNSEL TO THE COMPANY. An opinion, dated the
Amendment Effective Date, of Ropes & Gray, counsel to the Company, in form and
substance satisfactory to the Administrative Agent (and the Company hereby
instructs such counsel to deliver such opinions to the Lenders and the
Administrative Agent).


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   47

                                      -42-


               (d) OPINION OF SPECIAL NEW YORK COUNSEL TO CHASE. An opinion,
dated the Amendment Effective Date, of Milbank, Tweed, Hadley & McCloy, special
New York counsel to Chase, in form and substance satisfactory to the
Administrative Agent.

               (e) FINANCIAL INFORMATION. True, correct and complete copies of
the financial statements, projections and other information referred to in
Section 7.02 hereof.

               (f) APPROVALS AND CONSENTS. Evidence that all necessary
governmental and third party filings, licenses, permits, consents and approvals
have been obtained by the Company and are in full force and effect on the
Amendment Effective Date.

               (g) PAYMENT OF FEES AND EXPENSES. Evidence that (i) all principal
of and interest on, and all other amount owing in respect of, the loans made by
the Existing Lenders under the Existing Credit Agreement shall have been paid in
full and (ii) all fees and expenses payable to the Existing Lenders and the
Administrative Agent under the Existing Credit Agreement accrued to the
Amendment Effective Date and unpaid and such fees as the Company shall have
agreed to pay or deliver to the Administrative Agent in connection herewith,
including, without limitation, the reasonable fees and expenses of Milbank,
Tweed, Hadley & McCloy, special New York counsel to Chase in connection with the
negotiation, preparation, execution and delivery of the amendment and
restatement of the Existing Credit Agreement and the Notes and the other Basic
Documents and the extensions of credit hereunder (to the extent that statements
for such fees and expenses have been delivered to the Company) shall have been
paid in full.

               (h) GOVERNMENTAL PROCEEDINGS; ETC. Evidence that no litigation or
similar proceeding is threatened by any governmental agency or authority or any
other person with respect to the execution and delivery of the amendment and
restatement of the Existing Credit Agreement, the Notes and the other Basic
Documents, and the consummation of the transactions herein or therein
contemplated which, in each case, the Lenders shall reasonably determine is
likely to have a material adverse effect on (i) the assets, business,
operations, or condition (financial or otherwise) or prospects of the Company
and its Subsidiaries taken as a whole or (ii) the timely payment of the Loans
and interest thereon or the enforceability of the Basic Documents or the rights
and remedies thereunder.

               (i) LEVERAGE RATIO. A certificate of a senior officer of the
Company, dated the Amendment Effective Date, setting forth the Leverage Ratio as
at the Amendment Effective Date.

               (j) SECURITY DOCUMENTS. The Security Documents duly executed and
delivered by the parties thereto, together with (x) stock certificates
representing all of the shares of each Domestic Subsidiary that is a Material
Subsidiary directly owned by the Company (except for B/E Advanced Thermal
Technologies, Inc.) and not less than 65% of the shares of each Foreign
Subsidiary that is a Material Subsidiary directly owned by the Company, together
with undated stock powers (or the equivalent with respect to the Foreign
Subsidiaries) duly signed in blank, (y) the limited liability company
certificates representing all of the ownership interest in In-


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   48

                                      -43-


Flight Entertainment, LLC, together with an undated transfer power duly signed
in blank and (z) such Uniform Commercial Code financing statements as the
Administrative Agent shall request.

               (k) SENIOR NOTES. A certificate of a senior financial officer of
the Company, dated the Amendment Effective Date, stating that the Company's
9-3/4% Senior Notes due 2003 have been fully redeemed.

               (l) OTHER DOCUMENTS. Such other documents as the Administrative
Agent or any Lender or special New York counsel to Chase may reasonably request.

               6.02 INITIAL AND SUBSEQUENT EXTENSIONS OF CREDIT. The obligation
of the Lenders to make any Loan or otherwise extend any credit to the Company
upon the occasion of each borrowing or other extension of credit hereunder
(including the initial borrowing) is subject to the further conditions precedent
that:

               (a) Both immediately prior to the making of such Loan or other
extension of credit and also after giving effect thereto and to the intended use
thereof: (i) no Default shall have occurred and be continuing; (ii) the
representations and warranties made by the Company in Section 7 hereof, and in
each of the other Basic Documents, shall be true and correct on and as of the
date of the making of such Loan or other extension of credit with the same force
and effect as if made on and as of such date (or, if any such representation or
warranty is expressly stated to have been made as of a specific date, as of such
specific date). Each notice of borrowing or request for the issuance of a Letter
of Credit by the Company hereunder shall constitute a certification by the
Company to the effect set forth in the preceding sentence (both as of the date
of such notice or request and, unless the Company otherwise notifies the
Administrative Agent prior to the date of such borrowing or issuance, as of the
date of such borrowing or issuance); and

               (b) The Administrative Agent shall have received a certificate of
a senior financial officer of the Company setting forth in reasonable detail the
computations necessary to demonstrate that both immediately prior to the making
of such Loan or other extension of credit and immediately after giving effect
thereto, the Company is or will be in compliance with Section 1010 of the Senior
Subordinated Indentures.

               Section 7. REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES. The Company represents
and warrants to the Lenders that:

               7.01 CORPORATE EXISTENCE. Each of the Company and its
Subsidiaries: (a) is a corporation, partnership or other entity duly organized,
validly existing and in good standing under the laws of the jurisdiction of its
organization; (b) has all requisite corporate or other power, and has all
material governmental licenses, authorizations, consents and approvals necessary
to own its assets and carry on its business as now being or as proposed to be
conducted; and (c) is qualified to do business and is in good standing in all
jurisdictions in which 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   49
                                      -44-


the nature of the business conducted by it makes such qualification necessary
and where failure so to qualify could have a Material Adverse Effect.

               7.02 FINANCIAL CONDITION.

               (a) The Company has heretofore furnished to each of the Lenders
(i) the consolidated balance sheet of the Company and its Subsidiaries as at
February 22, 1997 and the related consolidated statements of operations,
stockholders' equity and cash flows of the Company and its Subsidiaries for the
fiscal year ended on said date, with the opinion thereon of Deloitte & Touche,
and (ii) the consolidated balance sheet of the Company and its Subsidiaries as
at November 29, 1997 and the related consolidated statements of earnings,
stockholders' equity and cash flows of the Company and its Subsidiaries for the
fiscal quarters ended on such date and for the three fiscal quarters ended on
such date. All such financial statements present fairly, in all material
respects, the financial position of the Company and its Subsidiaries as at, and
the results of operations for the fiscal year and fiscal quarter, ended on said
date, all in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles and
practices applied on a consistent basis (subject, in the case of such financial
statements as at November 29, 1997, to normal year-end audit adjustments).
Neither the Company nor any of its Subsidiaries has on the Restatement Date any
material contingent liabilities, liabilities for taxes, unusual forward or
long-term commitments or unrealized or anticipated losses from any unfavorable
commitments, except as referred to or reflected or provided for in said balance
sheets as at said dates.

               (b) Since February 22, 1997, there has been no material adverse
change in the financial condition, operations, business or prospects of the
Company and its Subsidiaries from that set forth in said financial statements as
at said date.

               7.03 LITIGATION. Except as disclosed to the Lenders in writing
prior to the Amendment Effective Date, there are no legal or arbitral
proceedings, or any proceedings by or before any governmental or regulatory
authority or agency, now pending or (to the knowledge of the Company) threatened
against the Company or any of its Subsidiaries which, if adversely determined,
could have a Material Adverse Effect.

               7.04 NO BREACH. None of the execution and delivery of this
Agreement and the Notes and the other Basic Documents, the consummation of the
transactions herein and therein contemplated or compliance with the terms and
provisions hereof and thereof will conflict with or result in a breach of, or
require any consent under, the charter or by-laws of the Company, or any
applicable law or regulation, or any order, writ, injunction or decree of any
court or governmental authority or agency, or any agreement or instrument to
which the Company or any of its Subsidiaries is a party (including, without
limitation, the Senior Subordinated Indentures) or by which any of them or any
of their Property is bound or to which any of them is subject, or constitute a
default under any such agreement or instrument, or (except for Liens created
pursuant to the Security Documents) result in the creation or imposition of any
Lien upon any Property of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries pursuant to the
terms of any such agreement or instrument.


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT




<PAGE>   50
                                      -45-


               7.05 ACTION. The Company has all necessary corporate power,
authority and legal right to execute, deliver and perform its obligations under
each of the Basic Documents; the execution, delivery and performance by the
Company of each of the Basic Documents have been duly authorized by all
necessary corporate action on its part (including, without limitation, any
required shareholder approvals); and this Agreement has been duly and validly
executed and delivered by the Company and constitutes, and each of the Notes and
the other Basic Documents to which it is a party when executed and delivered (in
the case of the Notes, for value) will constitute, its legal, valid and binding
obligation, enforceable against the Company in accordance with its terms, except
as such enforceability may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization,
moratorium or similar laws of general applicability affecting the enforcement of
creditors' rights and the application of general principles of equity
(regardless of whether such enforceability is considered in a proceeding in
equity or at law).

               7.06 APPROVALS. No authorizations, approvals or consents of, and
no filings or registrations with, any governmental or regulatory authority or
agency, or any securities exchange, are necessary for the execution, delivery or
performance by the Company of the Basic Documents to which it is a party or for
the legality, validity or enforceability hereof or thereof, except for filings
and recordings in respect of the Liens created pursuant to the Security
Documents.

               7.07 USE OF CREDIT. Neither the Company nor any of its
Subsidiaries is engaged principally, or as one of its important activities, in
the business of extending credit for the purpose, whether immediate, incidental
or ultimate, of buying or carrying Margin Stock, and no part of the proceeds of
any extension of credit hereunder will be used to buy or carry any Margin Stock.

               7.08 ERISA. Each Plan, and, to the knowledge of the Company, each
Multiemployer Plan, is in compliance in all material respects with, and has been
administered in all material respects in compliance with, the applicable
provisions of ERISA, the Code and any other Federal or State law, and no event
or condition has occurred and is continuing as to which the Company would be
under an obligation to furnish a report to the Lenders under Section 8.01(f)
hereof.

               7.09 TAXES. The Company and its Domestic Subsidiaries are members
of an affiliated group of corporations filing consolidated returns for Federal
income tax purposes, of which the Company is the "common parent" (within the
meaning of Section 1504 of the Code) of such group. Except as set forth in
Schedule VI hereto, the Company and its Domestic Subsidiaries have filed all
Federal income tax returns and all other material tax returns that are required
to be filed by them and have paid all taxes due pursuant to such returns or
pursuant to any assessment received by the Company or any of its Domestic
Subsidiaries. The charges, accruals and reserves on the books of the Company and
its Subsidiaries in respect of taxes and other governmental charges are, in the
opinion of the Company, adequate. The Company has not given or been requested to
give a waiver of the statute of limitations relating to the payment of Federal,
state, local and foreign taxes or other impositions.


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   51

                                      -46-


               7.10 INVESTMENT COMPANY ACT. Neither the Company nor any of its
Subsidiaries is an "investment company", or a company "controlled" by an
"investment company", within the meaning of the Investment Company Act of 1940,
as amended.

               7.11 PUBLIC UTILITY HOLDING COMPANY ACT. Neither the Company nor
any of its Subsidiaries is a "holding company", or an "affiliate" of a "holding
company" or a "subsidiary company" of a "holding company", within the meaning of
the Public Utility Holding Company Act of 1935, as amended.

               7.12 MATERIAL AGREEMENTS AND LIENS.

               (a) Part A of Schedule I hereto is a complete and correct list,
as of the Restatement Date, of each credit agreement, loan agreement, indenture,
purchase agreement, guarantee, letter of credit or other arrangement providing
for or otherwise relating to any Indebtedness or any extension of credit (or
commitment for any extension of credit) to, or guarantee by, the Company or any
of its Subsidiaries the aggregate principal or face amount of which equals or
exceeds (or may equal or exceed) $1,000,000, and the aggregate principal or face
amount outstanding or that may become outstanding under each such arrangement is
correctly described in Part A of said Schedule I.

               (b) Part B of Schedule I hereto is a complete and correct list,
as of the Restatement Date, of each Lien securing Indebtedness the aggregate
principal or face amount of which equals or exceeds $1,000,000 of any Person and
covering any Property of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries, and the
aggregate amount of such Indebtedness secured (or which may be secured) by each
such Lien and the Property covered by each such Lien is correctly described in
Part B of said Schedule I.

               7.13 ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS. Except as set forth in Schedule II
hereto, each of the Company and its Subsidiaries has obtained all environmental,
health and safety permits, licenses and other authorizations required under all
Environmental Laws to carry on its business as now being or as proposed to be
conducted, except to the extent failure to have any such permit, license or
authorization would not have a Material Adverse Effect. All of the permits,
licenses and authorizations that have been obtained are in full force and effect
and each of the Company and its Subsidiaries is in compliance with the terms and
conditions thereof, and is also in compliance with all other limitations,
restrictions, conditions, standards, prohibitions, requirements, obligations,
schedules and timetables contained in any applicable Environmental Law or in any
regulation, code, plan, order, decree, judgment, injunction, notice or demand
letter issued, entered, promulgated or approved thereunder, except to the extent
failure to comply therewith would not have a Material Adverse Effect.

               In addition, except as set forth in Schedule II hereto:

               (a) To the Company's knowledge after due inquiry, no written
notice, notification, demand, request for information, citation, summons or
order has been issued, no complaint has been filed, no penalty has been assessed
and no investigation or review is pending 



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   52

                                      -47-


or threatened by any governmental or other entity with respect to any alleged
failure by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries to have any environmental,
health or safety permit, license or other authorization required under any
Environmental Law in connection with the conduct of the business of the Company
or any of its Subsidiaries or with respect to any generation, treatment,
storage, recycling, transportation, discharge or disposal, or any Release of any
Hazardous Materials generated by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries.

               (b) Neither the Company nor any of its Subsidiaries owns,
operates or leases a treatment, storage or disposal facility requiring a permit
under the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act of 1976, as amended, or under
any comparable state or local statute; and

               (i) to the Company's knowledge after due inquiry, no PCB
        Transformers (as defined in the Toxic Substances Control Act, 15 U.S.C.
        ss.1601, et seq., as amended, and the regulations relating thereto) are
        present at any site or facility owned, operated or leased by the Company
        or any of its Subsidiaries;

               (ii) to the Company's knowledge after due inquiry, no asbestos or
        asbestos-containing materials is present at any site or facility owned,
        operated or leased by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries;

               (iii) to the Company's knowledge after due inquiry, there are no
        underground storage tanks or surface impoundments for Hazardous
        Materials, active or abandoned, at any site or facility owned, operated
        or leased by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries; and

               (iv) to the Company's knowledge after due inquiry, no Hazardous
        Materials have been Released by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries
        at, on or under any site or facility now owned, operated or leased by
        the Company or any of its Subsidiaries in a reportable quantity
        established by any Environmental Law.

               (c) To the Company's knowledge after due inquiry, neither the
Company nor any of its Subsidiaries has transported or arranged for the
transportation of any Hazardous Material to any location that is listed on the
National Priorities List ("NPL") under the Comprehensive Environmental Response,
Compensation and Liability Act of 1980, as amended ("CERCLA"), listed for
possible inclusion on the NPL by the Environmental Protection Agency, or listed
in the Comprehensive Environmental Response and Liability Information System, as
provided for by 40 C.F.R. ss. 300.5 ("CERCLIS"), or on any similar state or
local list or that is the subject of Federal, state or local enforcement actions
or other investigations that may lead to Environmental Claims against the
Company or any of its Subsidiaries.

               (d) No Liens are presently recorded with the appropriate land
records under or pursuant to any Environmental Laws on any site or facility
owned, operated or leased by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries, and to the
Company's knowledge no government action has been taken or is in process that
could subject any such site or facility to such Liens. Neither the Company nor
any of its Subsidiaries would be required to place any notice or restriction
relating 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   53
                                      -48-


to the presence of Hazardous Materials at any site or facility owned by it in
any deed to the real property on which such site or facility is located.

               (e) There have been no environmental investigations, written
studies, audits, tests, reviews or other analyses conducted by or that are in
the possession of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries in relation to any site
or facility now or previously owned, operated or leased by the Company or any of
its Subsidiaries which have not been made available to the Lenders.

               7.14 CAPITALIZATION. The authorized capital stock of the Company
consists, on the Restatement Date, of an aggregate of 31,000,000 shares
consisting of (i) 30,000,000 shares of common stock, par value $0.01 per share,
of which 22,891,918 shares were, as at February 28, 1998 duly and validly issued
and outstanding, each of which shares is fully paid and nonassessable and (ii)
1,000,000 shares of preferred stock, par value $0.01 per share, of which no
shares were outstanding as at February 28, 1998. As of the Restatement Date the
Company is registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission under the
Securities Exchange Act, and its shares of common stock are publicly owned and
traded on the NASDAQ National Market System. As of the Restatement Date, (x)
except for options to purchase 2,902,001 shares of the common stock of the
Company, there are no outstanding Equity Rights with respect to the Company and
(y) there are no outstanding obligations of the Company or any of its
Subsidiaries to repurchase, redeem, or otherwise acquire any shares of capital
stock of the Company nor are there any outstanding obligations of the Company or
any of its Subsidiaries to make payments to any Person, such as "phantom stock"
payments, where the amount thereof is calculated with reference to the fair
market value or equity value of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries.

               7.15 SUBSIDIARIES, ETC.

               (a) Set forth in Part A of Schedule III hereto is a complete and
correct list, as of the Restatement Date, of all of the Subsidiaries of the
Company, together with, for each such Subsidiary, (i) the jurisdiction of
organization of such Subsidiary, (ii) each Person holding ownership interests in
such Subsidiary, (iii) the nature of the ownership interests held by each such
Person and the percentage of ownership of such Subsidiary represented by such
ownership interests and (iv) the total book value of the assets of each such
Subsidiary as of November 29, 1997. Except as disclosed in Part A of Schedule
III hereto, (x) each of the Company and its Subsidiaries owns, free and clear of
Liens (other than Liens created pursuant to the Security Documents), and has the
unencumbered right to vote, all outstanding ownership interests in each Person
shown to be held by it in Part A of Schedule III hereto, (y) all of the issued
and outstanding capital stock of each such Person organized as a corporation is
validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable and (z) there are no outstanding
Equity Rights with respect to such Person.

               (b) Set forth in Part B of Schedule III hereto is a complete and
correct list, as of the Restatement Date, of all Investments (other than
Investments disclosed in Part A of said Schedule III hereto) of $1,000,000 or
more held by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries in any Person and, for each
such Investment, (x) the identity of the Person or Persons in which such
Investment has been made, (y) the nature of such Investment and (z) the amount
of such 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   54

                                      -49-


Investment. Except as disclosed in Part B of Schedule III hereto, each of the
Company and its Subsidiaries owns, free and clear of all Liens (other than Liens
created pursuant to the Security Documents), all such Investments.

               (c) Except as set forth in Schedule III hereto, none of the
Subsidiaries of the Company is, on the Restatement Date, subject to any
indenture, agreement, instrument or other arrangement of the type described in
the last sentence of Section 8.17 hereof.

               7.16 TITLE TO ASSETS. The Company owns and has on the Restatement
Date, and will own and have on the Amendment Effective Date, good and marketable
title (subject only to Liens permitted by Section 8.06 hereof) to the Properties
shown to be owned in the most recent financial statements referred to in Section
7.02 hereof (other than Properties disposed of in the ordinary course of
business or otherwise permitted to be disposed of pursuant to Section 8.05
hereof). The Company owns and has on the Restatement Date, and will own and have
on the Amendment Effective Date, good and marketable title to, and enjoys on the
Restatement Date, and will enjoy on the Amendment Effective Date, peaceful and
undisturbed possession of, all Properties (subject only to Liens permitted by
Section 8.06 hereof) that are necessary for the operation and conduct of its
businesses.

               7.17 COMPLIANCE WITH LAW. Except as set forth in Schedule IV
hereto, each of the Company and its Subsidiaries is in compliance with all
applicable laws, rules, regulations and orders of, and all applicable
restrictions imposed by, all governmental authorities or bodies, domestic or
foreign, in respect of the conduct of its business and the ownership of its
Property (including Environmental Laws), except such noncompliance as would not,
in the aggregate, have a Material Adverse Effect on the business, properties,
assets, operations, condition (financial or otherwise), or prospects of the
Company and its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole.

               7.18 TRUE AND COMPLETE DISCLOSURE. The information, reports,
financial statements, exhibits and schedules furnished in writing by or on
behalf of the Company to the Administrative Agent or any Lender prior to the
Amendment Effective Date in connection with the negotiation, preparation or
delivery of this Agreement and the other Basic Documents or included herein or
therein or delivered pursuant hereto or thereto, when taken as a whole (together
with the Information Memorandum which the Lenders acknowledge contains
projections based on certain assumptions therein stated) do not contain any
untrue statement of material fact or omit to state any material fact necessary
to make the statements herein or therein, in light of the circumstances under
which they were made, not misleading. All written information furnished on or
after the Amendment Effective Date by the Company and its Subsidiaries to the
Administrative Agent and the Lenders in connection with this Agreement and the
other Basic Documents and the transactions contemplated hereby and thereby will
be true, complete and accurate in every material respect, or (in the case of
projections) based on reasonable estimates, on the date as of which such
information is stated or certified. There is no fact known to the Company that
could have a Material Adverse Effect that has not been disclosed herein, in the
other Basic Documents or in a report, financial statement, exhibit, 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   55
                                      -50-


schedule, disclosure letter or other writing furnished to the Lenders for use in
connection with the transactions contemplated hereby or thereby.

               7.19 YEAR 2000. Substantially all reprogramming required to
permit the proper functioning, in and following the year 2000, of (i) the
Company's computer systems and (ii) equipment containing embedded microchips
(including systems and equipment supplied by others or with which the Company's
systems interface) and the testing of all such systems and equipment, as so
reprogrammed, will be materially completed by July 1, 1999. The cost to the
Company of such reprogramming and testing and of the reasonable foreseeable
consequences of year 2000 to the Company (including, without limitation,
reprogramming errors and the failure of others' systems or equipment) will not
result in a Default or a Material Adverse Effect. Nothing herein shall preclude
the Company from making the foregoing representation after the making of an
Acquisition of any Person that is not in compliance with the above, so long as
the Company has prepared a plan prior to such Acquisition that sets forth, in
the reasonable judgment of the chief financial officer of the Company, the
action that the Company has taken or proposes to take to bring such Person into
compliance with the above.

               Section 8. COVENANTS OF THE COMPANY. The Company covenants and
agrees with the Lenders and the Administrative Agent that, so long as any
Commitment, Loan or Letter of Credit Liability is outstanding and until payment
in full of all amounts payable by the Company hereunder:

               8.01 FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, ETC. The Company shall deliver to each
of the Lenders:

               (a) as soon as available and in any event within 60 days after
the end of each of the first three quarterly fiscal periods of each fiscal year
of the Company, consolidated statements of earnings, stockholders' equity and
cash flows of the Company and its Subsidiaries, for such period and for the
period from the beginning of the respective fiscal year to the end of such
period, setting forth in each case in comparative form the corresponding
consolidated figures for the corresponding period in the preceding fiscal year,
and the related consolidated balance sheet of the Company and its Subsidiaries,
as at the end of such period, setting forth in comparative form the
corresponding consolidated figures for the last day of the preceding fiscal
year, accompanied by a certificate of a senior financial officer of the Company,
which certificate shall state that said consolidated financial statements
present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial condition
and results of operations of the Company and its Subsidiaries, in accordance
with generally accepted accounting principles, consistently applied, as at the
end of, and for, such period (subject to normal year-end audit adjustments);

               (b) as soon as available and in any event within 105 days after
the end of each fiscal year of the Company, consolidated and consolidating
statements of operations and stockholders' equity of the Company and its
Subsidiaries, and consolidated statements of cash flows of the Company and its
Subsidiaries, for such fiscal year and the related consolidated and
consolidating balance sheets of the Company and its Subsidiaries as at the end
of such fiscal




                                CREDIT AGREEMENT

<PAGE>   56

                                      -51-


year, setting forth in each case in comparative form the corresponding
consolidated and consolidating figures for the preceding fiscal year, and
accompanied, (i) in the case of said consolidated statements and balance sheet
of the Company, by an opinion thereon of independent certified public
accountants of recognized national standing, which opinion shall state that said
consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the
consolidated financial condition and results of operations of the Company and
its Subsidiaries as at the end of, and for, such fiscal year in accordance with
generally accepted accounting principles, and a report of such accountants
stating that, in making the examination necessary for their opinion, nothing
came to their attention, except as specifically stated, that caused them to
believe that the Company had failed to comply with Sections 8.09, 8.10, 8.11 and
8.12 hereof, or any other provisions hereof, insofar as they relate to
accounting matters, and (ii) in the case of said consolidating statements and
balance sheets, by a certificate of a senior financial officer of the Company
which certificate shall state that said consolidating financial statements
fairly present the respective individual unconsolidated financial condition and
results of operations of the Company and of each of its Subsidiaries, in each
case in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, consistently
applied, as at the end of, and for, such fiscal year;

               (c) as soon as available and in any event within 105 days after
the end of each fiscal year of the Company, statements of information concerning
net sales, operating earnings, depreciation and amortization of each division of
the Company and its Subsidiaries (including, without limitation, the Seating
Products Division, Galley Products Division, In-Flight Entertainment Division
and Service Division) for such period setting forth in each case in comparative
form the corresponding figures for the preceding fiscal year;

               (d) promptly upon their becoming available, copies of all
registration statements and regular periodic reports, if any, which the Company
shall have filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (or any
governmental agency substituted therefor) or any national securities exchange;

               (e) promptly upon the mailing thereof to the shareholders of the
Company generally, copies of all financial statements, reports and proxy
statements so mailed;

               (f) as soon as possible, and in any event within ten days after
the Company knows or has reason to believe that any of the events or conditions
specified below with respect to any Plan or Multiemployer Plan has occurred or
exists, a statement signed by a senior financial officer of the Company setting
forth details respecting such event or condition and the action, if any, that
the Company or its ERISA Affiliate proposes to take with respect thereto (and a
copy of any report or notice required to be filed with or given to PBGC by the
Company or an ERISA Affiliate with respect to such event or condition):

               (i) any reportable event, as defined in Section 4043(b) of ERISA
        and the regulations issued thereunder, with respect to a Plan, as to
        which PBGC has not by regulation waived the requirement of Section
        4043(a) of ERISA that it be notified within 30 days of the occurrence of
        such event (PROVIDED that a failure to meet the minimum funding standard
        of Section 412 of the Code or Section 302 of ERISA, including, without



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   57

                                      -52-


        limitation, the failure to make on or before its due date a required
        installment under Section 412(m) of the Code or Section 302(e) of ERISA,
        shall be a reportable event regardless of the issuance of any waivers in
        accordance with Section 412(d) of the Code); and any request for a
        waiver under Section 412(d) of the Code for any Plan;

               (ii) the distribution under Section 4041 of ERISA of a notice of
        intent to terminate any Plan or any action taken by the Company or an
        ERISA Affiliate to terminate any Plan;

               (iii) the institution by PBGC of proceedings under Section 4042
        of ERISA for the termination of, or the appointment of a trustee to
        administer, any Plan, or the receipt by the Company or any ERISA
        Affiliate of a notice from a Multiemployer Plan that such action has
        been taken by PBGC with respect to such Multiemployer Plan;

               (iv) the complete or partial withdrawal from a Multiemployer Plan
        by the Company or any ERISA Affiliate that results in liability under
        Section 4201 or 4204 of ERISA (including the obligation to satisfy
        secondary liability as a result of a purchaser default) or the receipt
        by the Company or any ERISA Affiliate of notice from a Multiemployer
        Plan that it is in reorganization or insolvency pursuant to Section 4241
        or 4245 of ERISA or that it intends to terminate or has terminated under
        Section 4041A of ERISA;

               (v) the institution of a proceeding by a fiduciary of any
        Multiemployer Plan against the Company or any ERISA Affiliate to enforce
        Section 515 of ERISA, which proceeding is not dismissed within 30 days;
        and

               (vi) the adoption of an amendment to any Plan that, pursuant to
        Section 401(a)(29) of the Code or Section 307 of ERISA, would result in
        the loss of tax-exempt status of the trust of which such Plan is a part
        if the Company or an ERISA Affiliate fails to timely provide security to
        the Plan in accordance with the provisions of said Sections;

               (g) promptly after the Company knows or has reason to believe
that any Default has occurred, a notice of such Default describing the same in
reasonable detail and, together with such notice or as soon thereafter as
possible, a description of the action that the Company has taken or proposes to
take with respect thereto;

               (h) Within 10 Business Days after the date of any Acquisition and
at the time of delivery of the financial statements for the first four Fiscal
Dates thereafter, PRO FORMA consolidated statements of earnings of the Company
and its Subsidiaries for the relevant Calculation Period and related PRO FORMA
consolidated balance sheet items necessary for the PRO FORMA calculation of
compliance with the covenants in this Agreement of the Company and its
Subsidiaries as of the last day of each fiscal quarter of the Company occurring
during such Calculation Period, prepared as though such Acquisition had
occurred, and any Funded Debt 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   58

                                      -53-


incurred or assumed by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries in connection with
such Acquisition had been incurred or assumed, on the first day of such
Calculation Period;

               (i) with the delivery of the financial statements pursuant to
Sections 8.01(a) and 8.01(b) hereof, a statement of a senior financial officer
of the Company (A) listing each Disposition by the Company and its Subsidiaries
that occurred during the quarterly fiscal period ending on the date of such
financial statements if the Net Available Proceeds thereof exceeded $100,000 and
(B) setting forth in reasonable detail the Net Available Proceeds of each such
Disposition and the aggregate Net Available Proceeds since the first day of the
then current Recapture Period; and

               (j) from time to time such other information regarding the
financial condition, operations, business or prospects of the Company or any of
its Subsidiaries (including, without limitation, any Plan or Multiemployer Plan
and any reports or other information required to be filed under ERISA) as any
Lender or the Administrative Agent may reasonably request.

The Company will furnish to each Lender, at the time it furnishes each set of
financial statements pursuant to paragraph (a), (b) or (h) above, a certificate
of a senior financial officer of the Company (i) to the effect that no Default
has occurred and is continuing (or, if any Default has occurred and is
continuing, describing the same in reasonable detail and describing the action
that the Company has taken or proposes to take with respect thereto) and (ii)
setting forth in reasonable detail (x) the computations necessary to determine
whether the Company is in compliance with Sections 8.07(e), 8.07(g), 8.08(f),
8.08(h), 8.09, 8.10, 8.11 and 8.12 hereof, and (y) the Interest Coverage Ratio
and the Leverage Ratio as of the end of the respective quarterly fiscal period,
fiscal year or Calculation Period.

               8.02 LITIGATION. The Company will promptly give to each Lender
notice of all legal or arbitral proceedings, and of all proceedings by or before
any governmental or regulatory authority or agency, and any material development
in respect of such legal or other proceedings, affecting the Company or any of
its Subsidiaries, except proceedings which, if adversely determined, would not
have a Material Adverse Effect. Without limiting the generality of the
foregoing, the Company will give to each Lender notice of the assertion of any
Environmental Claim by any Person against, or with respect to the activities of,
the Company or any of its Subsidiaries and notice of any alleged violation of or
non-compliance with any Environmental Laws or any permits, licenses or
authorizations, other than any Environmental Claim or alleged violation which,
if adversely determined, would not have a Material Adverse Effect.

               8.03 EXISTENCE, ETC. The Company will, and will cause each of its
Subsidiaries to:

               (a) preserve and maintain its legal existence and all of its
material rights, privileges, licenses and franchises (PROVIDED that nothing in
this Section 8.03 shall prohibit any transaction expressly permitted under
Section 8.05 hereof);



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   59

                                      -54-


               (b) comply with the requirements of all applicable laws, rules,
regulations and orders of governmental or regulatory authorities if failure to
comply with such requirements could have a Material Adverse Effect;

               (c) pay and discharge all taxes, assessments and governmental
charges or levies imposed on it or on its income or profits or on any of its
Property prior to the date on which penalties attach thereto, except for any
such tax, assessment, charge or levy the payment of which is being contested in
good faith and by proper proceedings and against which adequate reserves are
being maintained;

               (d) maintain all of its Properties used or useful in its business
in good working order and condition, ordinary wear and tear excepted;

               (e) keep adequate records and books of account, in which complete
entries will be made in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles
consistently applied; and

               (f) permit representatives of any Lender or the Administrative
Agent, during normal business hours, to examine, copy and make extracts from its
books and records, to inspect any of its Properties, and to discuss its business
and affairs with its officers, all to the extent reasonably requested by such
Lender or the Administrative Agent (as the case may be).

               8.04 INSURANCE. The Company will, and will cause each of its
Subsidiaries to, keep insured by financially sound and reputable insurers all
Property of a character usually insured by corporations engaged in the same or
similar business similarly situated against loss or damage of the kinds and in
the amounts customarily insured against by such corporations and carry such
other insurance as is usually carried by such corporations.

               8.05 PROHIBITION OF FUNDAMENTAL CHANGES. The Company will not,
nor will it permit any of its Subsidiaries to, enter into any transaction of
merger or consolidation or amalgamation, or liquidate, wind up or dissolve
itself (or suffer any liquidation or dissolution) or Dispose of all or
substantially all of its Property. The Company will not, nor will it permit any
of its Subsidiaries to, to make any Acquisition except for Investments permitted
under Section 8.08 hereof. Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this
Section 8.05:

               (a) any Subsidiary of the Company may be merged or consolidated
with or into: (i) the Company if the Company shall be the continuing or
surviving corporation or (ii) any other such Subsidiary; PROVIDED that (x) if
any such transaction shall be between a Subsidiary and a Wholly Owned
Subsidiary, the Wholly Owned Subsidiary shall be the continuing or surviving
corporation;

               (b) subject to Section 8.14 hereof, the Company or any Subsidiary
of the Company may make any Acquisition; PROVIDED that immediately prior to and
after giving effect to any such Acquisition, (i) no Default shall have occurred
and be continuing, (ii) not more than $25,000,000 of the proceeds of the Series
A Loans then outstanding shall have been applied, 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   60

                                      -55-


directly by the Company or indirectly through a Subsidiary, to the purchase
price of one or more Acquisitions; and

               (c) the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company may make any
Acquisition from any Subsidiary of the Company in each case for consideration
that is not in excess of the fair market value of the Property acquired in such
Acquisition as determined in good faith by the chief financial officer of the
Company.

               8.06 LIMITATION ON LIENS. The Company will not, nor will it
permit any of its Domestic Subsidiaries to, create, incur, assume or suffer to
exist any Lien upon any of its Property, whether now owned or hereafter
acquired, except:

               (a)  Liens created pursuant to the Security Documents;

               (b) Liens outstanding on the Restatement Date and listed in Part
B of Schedule I hereto;

               (c) Liens imposed by any governmental authority for taxes,
assessments or charges not yet due or which are being contested in good faith
and by appropriate proceedings if, unless the amount thereof is not material
with respect to it or its financial condition, adequate reserves with respect
thereto are maintained on the books of the Company or the affected Domestic
Subsidiaries, as the case may be, in accordance with GAAP;

               (d) carriers', warehousemen's, mechanics', materialmen's,
repairmen's or other like Liens arising in the ordinary course of business which
are not overdue for a period of more than 30 days or which are being contested
in good faith and by appropriate proceedings and Liens securing judgments but
only to the extent, for an amount and for a period not resulting in an Event of
Default under Section 9(h) hereof;

               (e) pledges or deposits under worker's compensation, unemployment
insurance and other social security legislation;

               (f) deposits to secure the performance of bids, trade contracts
(other than for borrowed money), leases, statutory obligations, surety and
appeal bonds, performance bonds and other obligations of a like nature incurred
in the ordinary course of business;

               (g) easements, rights-of-way, restrictions and other similar
encumbrances incurred in the ordinary course of business and encumbrances
consisting of zoning restrictions, easements, licenses, restrictions on the use
of Property or minor imperfections in title thereto which, in the aggregate, are
not material in amount, and which do not in any case materially detract from the
value of the Property subject thereto or interfere with the ordinary conduct of
the business of the Company or any of its Domestic Subsidiaries;


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT




<PAGE>   61

                                      -56-


               (h) Liens on Property of any corporation which becomes a Domestic
Subsidiary of the Company after the Restatement Date, PROVIDED that such Liens
are in existence at the time such corporation becomes a Domestic Subsidiary of
the Company and were not created in anticipation thereof;

               (i) subject to the restrictions contained in the Security
Documents, Liens upon real and/or tangible personal Property and/or software and
license rights with respect to software (including, without limitation, software
and license rights with respect to software under the GE Lease Agreement)
acquired after the Restatement Date (by purchase, construction or otherwise) by
the Company or any of its Domestic Subsidiaries other than in connection with
any Acquisition by the Company or any of its Domestic Subsidiaries, each of
which Liens either (A) existed on such Property before the time of its
acquisition and was not created in anticipation thereof, or (B) was created
solely for the purpose of securing Indebtedness representing, or incurred to
finance, refinance or refund, the cost (including the cost of construction) of
such Property; PROVIDED that no such Lien shall extend to or cover any Property
of the Company or such Domestic Subsidiary other than the Property so acquired
and improvements thereon; and PROVIDED, FURTHER, that the principal amount of
Indebtedness secured by any such Lien shall at no time exceed 100% of the fair
market value (as determined in good faith by a senior financial officer of the
Company) of such Property at the time it was acquired (by purchase, construction
or otherwise);

               (j) additional Liens upon real and/or tangible personal Property
of the Company or any of its Domestic Subsidiaries created after the Restatement
Date, PROVIDED that the aggregate Indebtedness secured thereby and incurred on
and after the Restatement Date shall not exceed $20,000,000 in the aggregate at
any one time outstanding; and

               (k) any extension, renewal or replacement of the foregoing,
PROVIDED, however, that the Liens permitted hereunder shall not be spread to
cover any additional Indebtedness or Property (other than a substitution of like
Property).

               8.07 INDEBTEDNESS. The Company will not, nor will it permit any
of its Subsidiaries to, create, incur or suffer to exist any Indebtedness
except:

               (a) Indebtedness to the Lenders hereunder;

               (b) Indebtedness outstanding or committed on the Restatement Date
and, if equal to or in excess of $1,000,000, listed in Part A of Schedule I
hereto and any extension, renewal or replacement thereof;

               (c) Indebtedness of Subsidiaries of the Company to the Company to
the extent contemplated by Section 8.08(d) hereof;

               (d) Indebtedness of the Company to its Subsidiaries and
Indebtedness of Subsidiaries of the Company to other Subsidiaries of the
Company;


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   62

                                      -57-


               (e) Indebtedness of the Company and its Subsidiaries secured by
Liens permitted under Sections 8.06(i) and 8.06(j) hereof;

               (f) Guarantees by any Subsidiary of the Company of Indebtedness
of the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company;

               (g) unsecured Indebtedness that has no regularly scheduled
maturity or mandatory prepayments on or before the Series A Commitment
Termination Date, that does not include required prepayments (including, without
limitation, as a result of a change of control or asset sale) on terms less
favorable to the Lenders than the Senior Subordinated Indentures, and that is
subordinated in right of payment to the Loans at least to the extent provided in
the Senior Subordinated Indentures; and

               (h) additional unsecured Indebtedness of the Company and its
Subsidiaries up to but not exceeding in the aggregate $40,000,000 at any one
time outstanding; PROVIDED that any such Indebtedness of any such individual
Subsidiary may not exceed $10,000,000 in the aggregate at any one time
outstanding.

               8.08 INVESTMENTS. The Company will not, nor will it permit any of
its Subsidiaries to, make or permit to remain outstanding any Investments
except:

               (a) Investments outstanding on the Restatement Date and
identified in Schedule III Part B hereto;

               (b) operating deposit accounts with banks;

               (c) Permitted Investments;

               (d) Investments by the Company in Subsidiaries of the Company in
the ordinary course of business; PROVIDED that the aggregate amount of the
Investments by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries in the Specified
Subsidiaries shall not exceed $5,000,000 at any one time outstanding; PROVIDED
FURTHER, that the Company will not at any time transfer any Property to any one
or more Subsidiaries which, together with all Property so transferred since the
Restatement Date, has a book value at the time of such transfer in excess of 5%
of Adjusted Net Worth as of the most recent Fiscal Date (not including Property
that is subject to a Lien in favor of the Administrative Agent for the benefit
of the Lenders);

               (e) subject to the first proviso to clause (d) above, Investments
by Subsidiaries of the Company in other Subsidiaries of the Company and in the
Company in the ordinary course of business;

               (f) Interest Rate Protection Agreements so long as the aggregate
credit exposure under all Interest Rate Protection Agreements calculated at the
time any Interest Rate Protection Agreement is entered into does not exceed
$10,000,000;


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   63
                                      -58-


               (g) Investments permitted by clause (b) of the last sentence of
Section 8.05 hereof; and

               (h) Investments of the Company and its Subsidiaries (i) in
corporations, companies, limited liability companies, partnerships and other
entities in each case that are not, or do not thereby become, Subsidiaries of
the Company ("Minority-Owned Entities") or (ii) representing obligations of
customers owing to the Company and its Subsidiaries in respect of the deferred
purchase price of products or services sold or the leasing of products to
customers ("Customer Obligations"), in each case in the ordinary course of
business of the Company and its Subsidiaries as provided for in Section 8.14
hereof and on such terms as the management of the Company may determine in its
reasonable business judgment, PROVIDED that the aggregate amount of such
Customer Obligations that are not fully secured (whether by a perfected Lien on,
or an indefeasible title retention to, the products so sold or leased, or
otherwise) PLUS the aggregate fair market value of all Property (whether now
owned or hereafter acquired) of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries (as
determined in good faith by the chief financial officer of the Company) sold,
assigned, transferred or otherwise disposed of on or after the Restatement Date
to any such Minority-Owned Entities shall not exceed in the aggregate at any one
time outstanding the greater of (i) $25,000,000 and (ii) 5% of Adjusted Net
Worth.

               8.09 RESTRICTED PAYMENTS. The Company will not, nor will it
permit any of its Subsidiaries to, declare or make any Restricted Payment at any
time; PROVIDED that (i) the Company may make Restricted Payments in an amount up
to but not exceeding (A) $25,000,000 in the aggregate PLUS (B) in any fiscal
year of the Company, an aggregate amount up to but not exceeding 25% of the net
earnings of the Company for the immediately preceding fiscal year ("AVAILABLE
NET EARNINGS"), PROVIDED that any portion of Available Net Earnings not used for
Restricted Payments in any fiscal year (the "CARRY-OVER AMOUNT") may be used for
Restricted Payments in the immediately succeeding fiscal year only, for which
purpose Restricted Payments in any fiscal year shall be deemed to have been made
first from Available Net Earnings, and only thereafter from any Carry-Over
Amount, such Restricted Payments set forth in clauses (i)(A) and (B) hereof not
to exceed $50,000,000 in the aggregate, and (ii) any Subsidiary of the Company
may make Restricted Payments to the Company from time to time.

               8.10 LEVERAGE RATIO. The Company will not permit the Leverage
Ratio to exceed the following respective ratios at any time during the following
respective periods:



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   64

                                      -59-


                Period                               Ratio
                ------                               -----

        From (but not including) the
          Fiscal Date in November 1997
          through the Fiscal Date in
          August 1998                              5.25 to 1

        From (but not including) the
          Fiscal Date in August 1998
          through the Fiscal Date in
          February 1999                            4.90 to 1

        From (but not including) the
          Fiscal Date in February 1999
          through the Fiscal Date in
          February 2000                            4.50 to 1

        From (but not including) the
          Fiscal Date in February 2000
          through the Fiscal Date in
          February 2001                            4.00 to 1

        Thereafter                                 3.50 to 1

               8.11 ADJUSTED NET WORTH. The Company will not at any date permit
Adjusted Net Worth to be less than the sum of (a) $150,000,000 PLUS (b) 75% of
the aggregate amount of Net Available Proceeds of Equity Issuances received
after November 29,1997 PLUS (c) 75% of the sum of consolidated net earnings of
the Company and its Subsidiaries (determined on a consolidated basis without
duplication in accordance with GAAP) for each fiscal quarter of the Company
ending after November 29, 1997; PROVIDED that consolidated net earnings for any
fiscal quarter in which there is a consolidated net loss shall be deemed to be
zero.

               8.12 INTEREST COVERAGE RATIO. The Company will not permit the
Interest Coverage Ratio to be less than the following respective ratios during
the following respective periods:



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   65
                                      -60-


                Period                               Ratio
                ------                               -----

        From (but not including) the
          Fiscal Date in November 1997
          through the Fiscal Date in
          August 1998                              2.00 to 1

        From (but not including) the
          Fiscal Date in August 1998
          through the Fiscal Date in
          February 1999                            2.25 to 1

        From (but not including) the
          Fiscal Date in February 1999
          through the Fiscal Date in
          February 2000                            2.50 to 1

        From (but not including) the
          Fiscal Date in February 2000
          through the Fiscal Date in
          February 2001                            2.75 to 1

        Thereafter                                 3.00 to 1

               8.13 [INTENTIONALLY OMITTED.]

               8.14 LINES OF BUSINESS. Neither the Company nor any of its
Subsidiaries shall engage to any substantial extent in any line or lines of
business activity other than the business of designing, manufacturing,
distributing, selling, leasing and servicing products used in the interior of
airplanes, buses and trains and servicing and acting as a broker in the sales
and leases of such products together with any other business reasonably related
to the foregoing.

               8.15 TRANSACTIONS WITH AFFILIATES. Except as set forth in
Schedule VII hereto or as expressly permitted by this Agreement, the Company
will not, nor will it permit any of its Subsidiaries to, directly or indirectly:
(a) make any Investment in an Affiliate; (b) transfer, sell, lease, assign or
otherwise dispose of any Property to an Affiliate; (c) merge into or consolidate
with or purchase or acquire Property from an Affiliate; or (d) enter into any
other transaction directly or indirectly with or for the benefit of an Affiliate
(including, without limitation, guarantees and assumptions of obligations of an
Affiliate); PROVIDED that (x) any Affiliate who is an individual may serve as a
director, officer or employee of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries and
receive reasonable compensation for his or her services in such capacity and (y)
the Company and its Subsidiaries may enter into transactions (other than
extensions of credit by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries to an Affiliate)
providing for the leasing of Property, the rendering or receipt of services or
the purchase or sale of inventory and other Property in the 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   66
                                      -61-



ordinary course of business if the monetary or business consideration arising
therefrom would be substantially as advantageous to the Company and its
Subsidiaries as the monetary or business consideration which would obtain in a
comparable transaction with a Person not an Affiliate.

               8.16 USE OF PROCEEDS. The Company will use the proceeds of (i)
the Series A Loans hereunder solely to finance ongoing working capital and other
capital requirements of the Company and to finance Acquisitions (subject to
clause (b) of the last sentence of Section 8.05) (in compliance with all
applicable legal and regulatory requirements) and (ii) the Series B Loans
hereunder solely to finance Acquisitions (subject to clause (b) of the last
sentence of Section 8.05); provided that neither the Administrative Agent nor
any Lender shall have any responsibility as to the use of any of such proceeds.

               8.17 CERTAIN OBLIGATIONS RESPECTING SUBSIDIARIES.

               (a) The Company will, and will cause each of its Subsidiaries to,
take such action from time to time as shall be necessary to ensure that the
Company and each of its Subsidiaries at all times owns (subject only to the Lien
of the Security Documents) at least the same percentage of the issued and
outstanding shares of each class of stock or partnership or other ownership
interest of each of its Subsidiaries as is owned on the Restatement Date (or,
with respect to any Subsidiary acquired or organized after the date hereof, as
of the date of such acquisition or organization). Without limiting the
generality of the foregoing, none of the Company nor any of its Subsidiaries
shall sell, transfer, pledge or otherwise dispose of any shares of stock or
partnership or other ownership interest in any Subsidiary owned by them, nor
permit any Subsidiary to issue any shares of stock of any class or partnership
or other ownership interest whatsoever to any Person (other than to the Company
or the immediate parent of such Subsidiary which is a Wholly Owned Subsidiary of
the Company). In the event that (a) any such additional shares of stock or
partnership or other ownership interest shall be issued by any such Subsidiary
or (b) the Company shall directly or indirectly create any new Material
Subsidiary or Acquire any additional Material Subsidiary and shall thereby
become the owner, directly or indirectly, of the shares of capital stock or
partnership or other ownership interest of such new or additional Material
Subsidiary, the Company agrees forthwith to deliver to the Administrative Agent
pursuant to security documents satisfactory to the Banks, any shares,
certificates of ownership, membership interests or other evidence of ownership,
or other securities received as a result therefrom (together with undated stock
or other powers executed in blank) and shall give, execute, deliver, file and/or
record any financing statement, notice, instrument, document, agreement or other
papers that may be necessary or desirable (in the judgment of the Administrative
Agent) to create, preserve or validate the security interest created therein,
including, without limitation, causing any or all of the Collateral (as defined
in the Security Agreement and the In-Flight Guarantee and Security Agreement,
respectively) to be transferred of record into the name of the Administrative
Agent; PROVIDED that if any such Material Subsidiary is organized under the laws
of a jurisdiction other than the United States of America or a State thereof,
the Company need not pledge to the Administrative Agent more than 65% of the
capital stock, partnership or other ownership interest in such Material
Subsidiary.


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   67

                                      -62-


               (b) The Company will not permit any of its Subsidiaries to enter
into, after the Restatement Date, any indenture, agreement, instrument or other
arrangement that, directly or indirectly, prohibits or restrains, or has the
effect of prohibiting or restraining, or imposes materially adverse conditions
upon, the incurrence or payment of Indebtedness, the granting of Liens, the
declaration or payment of dividends, the making of loans, advances or
Investments or the sale, assignment, transfer or other disposition of Property.

               8.18 MODIFICATIONS OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS. The Company will not
consent to (i) any modification, supplement or waiver of any of the provisions
of the Senior Subordinated Indentures or (ii) to the creation of any class of
preferred stock that has a mandatory dividend or redemption date prior to the
Series A Commitment Termination Date; PROVIDED that any Senior Subordinated
Indenture may be amended in connection with, and to facilitate, the purchase,
redemption, prepayment, defeasance or other retirement in full of the
Indebtedness issued pursuant thereto, which purchase, redemption, prepayment,
defeasance or other retirement is permitted hereunder.

               8.19 ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS.

               (a) The Company will, and will cause each of its Subsidiaries to,
comply with all Environmental Laws applicable to the Company and each of its
Subsidiaries, except to the extent that failure to comply with such laws would
not have a Material Adverse Effect, and shall obtain, at or prior to the time
required by applicable Environmental Laws, all environmental, health and safety
permits, licenses and other authorizations necessary for its operations and
maintain such authorizations in full force and effect.

               (b) If the Company discovers evidence of the presence of any
Hazardous Materials in any amount that is required to be reported under
Environmental Law, the Company will promptly clean-up such Hazardous Materials
or take such other remedial action as is (a) required by law or (b) deemed
necessary by the Company in its reasonable determination, such determination to
be based in part on the advice of independent environmental consultants
acceptable to the Company and the Administrative Agent.

               (c) The Company shall promptly furnish to the Administrative
Agent all written notices of any Environmental Claims received by the Company or
any of its Subsidiaries with respect to any alleged violation of or
non-compliance with any Environmental Laws or any permits, licenses or
authorizations issued thereunder in connection with the ownership, operation or
use of any site or facility or the operation of their businesses or the presence
or Release of Hazardous Substances, which Environmental Claim if determined
adversely to the Company would have a Material Adverse Effect.

               8.20 SECURITY FOR LOANS. The Company shall, no later than 90 days
following the request by the Majority Lenders, file in each governmental office
or agency in each appropriate jurisdiction as owner of record of each of the
Foreign Trademarks identified on Annex 4 to the Security Agreement.


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   68
                                      -63-



               8.21 REDEMPTION OF SENIOR SUBORDINATED INDEBTEDNESS. Except as
permitted by Section 8.09 hereof, the Company will not prepay, redeem, effect a
defeasance or covenant defeasance or otherwise retire any of the Indebtedness
issued pursuant to the Senior Subordinated Indentures.

               Section 9. EVENTS OF DEFAULT. If one or more of the following
events (herein called "EVENTS OF DEFAULT") shall occur and be continuing:

               (a) The Company shall (i) default in the payment of any principal
of any Loan or any Reimbursement Obligation when due (whether at stated maturity
or upon mandatory or optional prepayment) or (ii) default in the payment of any
interest on any Loan, any fee or any other amount payable by it hereunder or
under any other Basic Document when due (whether at stated maturity or upon
mandatory or optional prepayment or otherwise) and such default shall have
continued unremedied for three or more Business Days; or

               (b) The Company or any of its Subsidiaries shall default in the
payment when due of any principal of or interest on any of its other
Indebtedness aggregating $5,000,000 or more, or in the payment when due of any
amount aggregating $5,000,000 or more under any Interest Rate Protection
Agreement; or any event specified in any note, agreement, indenture or other
document evidencing or relating to any such Indebtedness or any event specified
in any Interest Rate Protection Agreement shall occur if the effect of such
event is to cause, or (with the giving of any notice or the lapse of time or
both) to permit the holder or holders of such Indebtedness (or a trustee or
agent on behalf of such holder or holders) to cause, such Indebtedness to become
due, or to be prepaid in full (whether by redemption, purchase, offer to
purchase or otherwise), prior to its stated maturity or to have the interest
rate thereon reset to a level so that securities evidencing such Indebtedness
trade at a level specified in relation to the par value thereof or, in the case
of an Interest Rate Protection Agreement, to permit the payments owing under
such Interest Rate Protection Agreement to be liquidated in an amount
aggregating $5,000,000 or more; or

               (c) Any representation, warranty or certification made or deemed
made herein or in any other Basic Document (or in any modification or supplement
hereto or thereto) by the Company, or any certificate furnished to any Lender or
the Administrative Agent pursuant to the provisions hereof or thereof shall
prove to have been false or misleading in any material respect as of the time
made or furnished; or

               (d) The Company shall default in the performance of any of its
obligations under any of Sections 8.01(g), 8.05, 8.06, 8.07, 8.08, 8.09, 8.10,
8.11 or 8.12 hereof or the Company shall default in the performance of any of
its obligations under Section 5.02 of the Security Agreement; or the Company
shall default in the performance of any of its other obligations in this
Agreement or any other Basic Document and such default shall continue unremedied
for a period of thirty days after notice thereof to the Company by the
Administrative Agent or any 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   69

                                      -64-


Lender (through the Administrative Agent); or In-Flight shall default in the
performance of any of its obligations under Section 6.02 of the In-Flight
Guarantee and Security Agreement; or

               (e) The Company or any of its Subsidiaries shall admit in writing
its inability to, or be generally unable to, pay its debts as such debts become
due; or

               (f) The Company or any of its Subsidiaries shall (i) apply for or
consent to the appointment of, or the taking of possession by, a receiver,
custodian, trustee, examiner or liquidator of itself or of all or a substantial
part of its Property, (ii) make a general assignment for the benefit of its
creditors, (iii) commence a voluntary case under the Bankruptcy Code, (iv) file
a petition seeking to take advantage of any other law relating to bankruptcy,
insolvency, reorganization, liquidation, dissolution, arrangement or winding-up,
or composition or readjustment of debts, (v) fail to controvert in a timely and
appropriate manner, or acquiesce in writing to, any petition filed against it in
an involuntary case under the Bankruptcy Code or (vi) take any corporate action
for the purpose of effecting any of the foregoing; or

               (g) A proceeding or case shall be commenced, without the
application or consent of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries, in any court
of competent jurisdiction, seeking (i) its reorganization, liquidation,
dissolution, arrangement or winding-up, or the composition or readjustment of
its debts, (ii) the appointment of a receiver, custodian, trustee, examiner,
liquidator or the like of the Company or such Subsidiary or of all or any
substantial part of its Property, or (iii) similar relief in respect of the
Company or such Subsidiary under any law relating to bankruptcy, insolvency,
reorganization, winding-up, or composition or adjustment of debts, and such
proceeding or case shall continue undismissed, or an order, judgment or decree
approving or ordering any of the foregoing shall be entered and continue
unstayed and in effect, for a period of 60 or more days; or an order for relief
against the Company or such Subsidiary shall be entered in an involuntary case
under the Bankruptcy Code; or

               (h) A final judgment or judgments for the payment of money in
excess of $5,000,000 in the aggregate (exclusive of judgment amounts fully
covered by insurance where the insurer has admitted liability in respect of such
judgment) or in excess of $20,000,000 in the aggregate (regardless of insurance
coverage) shall be rendered by one or more courts, administrative tribunals or
other bodies having jurisdiction against the Company or any of its Subsidiaries
and the same shall not be discharged (or provision shall not be made for such
discharge), or a stay of execution thereof shall not be procured, within 30 days
from the date of entry thereof and the Company or the relevant Subsidiary shall
not, within said period of 30 days, or such longer period during which execution
of the same shall have been stayed, appeal therefrom and cause the execution
thereof to be stayed during such appeal; or

               (i) An event or condition specified in Section 8.01(f) hereof
shall occur or exist with respect to any Plan or Multiemployer Plan and, as a
result of such event or condition, together with all other such events or
conditions, the Company or any ERISA Affiliate shall incur or in the opinion of
the Majority Lenders shall be reasonably likely to incur a liability to a Plan,
a Multiemployer Plan or PBGC (or any combination of the foregoing) which would
constitute, in the determination of the Majority Lenders, a Material Adverse
Effect; or


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   70
                                      -65-


               (j) A reasonable basis shall exist for the assertion against the
Company or any of its Subsidiaries of (or there shall have been asserted against
the Company or any of its Subsidiaries) claims or liabilities, whether accrued,
absolute or contingent, based on or arising from the generation, storage,
transport, handling or disposal of Hazardous Materials by the Company or any of
its Subsidiaries or Affiliates, or any predecessor in interest of the Company or
any of its Subsidiaries or Affiliates, or relating to any site or facility
owned, operated or leased by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries or
Affiliates, which claims or liabilities (insofar as they are payable by the
Company or any of its Subsidiaries but after deducting any portion thereof which
is reasonably expected to be paid by other creditworthy Persons jointly and
severally liable therefor), in the judgment of the Majority Lenders are
reasonably likely to be determined adversely to the Company or any of its
Subsidiaries, and the amount thereof is, singly or in the aggregate, reasonably
likely to have a Material Adverse Effect; or

               (k) Any "person" or "group" (as such terms are defined in
Sections 13(d) and 14(d) of the Securities Exchange Act (other than Amin or
Robert Khoury, their lineal descendants or trusts established by such Persons
for their respective lineal descendants)) is or becomes the "beneficial owner"
(as defined in Rules 13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Exchange Act, except that a
person shall be deemed to have "beneficial ownership" of all shares that any
such person has the right to acquire, whether such right is exercisable
immediately or only after the passage of time), directly or indirectly, of 30%
or more of the aggregate voting rights of the outstanding capital stock of the
Company (on a fully diluted basis); or during any consecutive 25-month period,
individuals who at the beginning of such period constituted the Board of
Directors of the Company (together with any new directors whose election by the
stockholders of the Company was approved by a vote of 66-2/3% of the directors
then still in office who were either directors at the beginning of such period
or whose election or nomination for election was previously so approved) cease
for any reason to constitute a majority of the Board of Directors of the Company
then in office; or

               (l) Except for expiration in accordance with its terms, any of
the Security Documents shall be terminated or shall cease to be in full force
and effect, for whatever reason;

THEREUPON: (1) in the case of an Event of Default other than one referred to in
clause (f) or (g) of this Section 9 with respect to the Company, the
Administrative Agent may, by notice to the Company, terminate the Commitments
and/or declare the principal amount then outstanding of, and the accrued
interest on, the Loans, the Reimbursement Obligations and all other amounts
payable by the Company hereunder and under the Notes (including, without
limitation, any amounts payable under Section 5.05 or 5.06 hereof) to be
forthwith due and payable (PROVIDED that (x) if so requested by the Majority
Series A Lenders, the Administrative Agent shall take such action with respect
to the Series A Commitments and/or the Series A Loans, Reimbursement Obligations
and such interest and other amounts to the extent owed to the Series A Lenders
and (y) if so requested by the Majority Series B Lenders, the Administrative
Agent shall take such action with respect to the Series B Commitments and the
Series B Loans and such interest and other amounts to the extent owed to the
Series B Lenders), whereupon such amounts shall be immediately due and payable
without presentment, demand, protest or other formalities 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   71

                                      -66-


of any kind, all of which are hereby expressly waived by the Company; and (2) in
the case of the occurrence of an Event of Default referred to in clause (f) or
(g) of this Section 9 with respect to the Company, the Commitments shall
automatically be terminated and the principal amount then outstanding of, and
the accrued interest on, the Loans, the Reimbursement Obligations and all other
amounts payable by the Company hereunder and under the Notes (including, without
limitation, any amounts payable under Section 5.05 or 5.06 hereof) shall
automatically become immediately due and payable without presentment, demand,
protest or other formalities of any kind, all of which are hereby expressly
waived by the Company.

               In addition, upon the occurrence and during the continuance of
any Event of Default (if the Administrative Agent has declared the principal
amount then outstanding of, and accrued interest on, the Series A Loans and all
other amounts payable by the Company hereunder and under the Notes to be due and
payable), the Company agrees that it shall, if requested by the Administrative
Agent or the Majority Series A Lenders through the Administrative Agent (and, in
the case of any Event of Default referred to in clause (f) or (g) of this
Section 9 with respect to the Company, forthwith, without any demand or the
taking of any other action by the Administrative Agent or such Lenders) provide
cover for the Letter of Credit Liabilities by paying to the Administrative Agent
immediately available funds in an amount equal to the then aggregate undrawn
face amount of all Letters of Credit, which funds shall be held by the
Administrative Agent in the Collateral Account as collateral security in the
first instance for the Letter of Credit Liabilities and be subject to withdrawal
only as therein provided.

               Section 10. THE ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT.

               10.01 APPOINTMENT, POWERS AND IMMUNITIES. Each Lender hereby
irrevocably appoints and authorizes the Administrative Agent to act as its agent
hereunder and under the other Basic Documents with such powers as are
specifically delegated to the Administrative Agent by the terms of this
Agreement and of the other Basic Documents, together with such other powers as
are reasonably incidental thereto. The Administrative Agent (which term as used
in this sentence and in Section 10.05 and the first sentence of Section 10.06
hereof shall include reference to its affiliates and its own and its affiliates'
officers, directors, employees and agents): (a) shall have no duties or
responsibilities except those expressly set forth in this Agreement and in the
other Basic Documents, and shall not by reason of this Agreement or any other
Basic Document be a trustee for any Lender; (b) shall not be responsible to the
Lenders for any recitals, statements, representations or warranties contained in
this Agreement or in any other Basic Document, or in any certificate or other
document referred to or provided for in, or received by any of them under, this
Agreement or any other Basic Document, or for the value, validity,
effectiveness, genuineness, enforceability or sufficiency of this Agreement, any
Note or any other Basic Document or any other document referred to or provided
for herein or therein or for any failure by the Company or any other Person to
perform any of its obligations hereunder or thereunder; (c) shall not be
required to initiate or conduct any litigation or collection proceedings
hereunder or under any other Basic Document; and (d) shall not be responsible
for any action taken or omitted to be taken by it hereunder or under any other
Basic Document or under any other document or instrument referred to or provided
for herein or therein or in 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   72

                                      -67-


connection herewith or therewith, except for its own gross negligence or willful
misconduct. The Administrative Agent may deem and treat the payee of any Note as
the holder thereof for all purposes hereof unless and until a notice of the
assignment or transfer thereof shall have been filed with the Administrative
Agent, together with the consent of the Company to such assignment or transfer
(to the extent provided in Section 11.06(b) hereof).

               10.02 RELIANCE BY ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT. The Administrative Agent
shall be entitled to rely upon any certification, notice or other communication
(including, without limitation, any thereof by telephone, telecopy, telex,
telegram or cable) believed by it to be genuine and correct and to have been
signed or sent by or on behalf of the proper Person or Persons, and upon advice
and statements of legal counsel, independent accountants and other experts
selected by the Administrative Agent. As to any matters not expressly provided
for by this Agreement or any other Basic Document, the Administrative Agent
shall in all cases be fully protected in acting, or in refraining from acting,
hereunder or thereunder in accordance with instructions given by the Majority
Lenders or, if provided herein, in accordance with the instructions given by the
Majority Series A Lenders, the Majority Series B Lenders or all of the Lenders
as is required in such circumstance, and such instructions of such Lenders and
any action taken or failure to act pursuant thereto shall be binding on all of
the Lenders.

               10.03 DEFAULTS. The Administrative Agent shall not be deemed to
have knowledge or notice of the occurrence of a Default unless the
Administrative Agent has received notice from a Lender or the Company specifying
such Default and stating that such notice is a "Notice of Default". In the event
that the Administrative Agent receives such a notice of the occurrence of a
Default, the Administrative Agent shall give prompt notice thereof to the
Lenders. The Administrative Agent shall (subject to Section 10.07 hereof) take
such action with respect to such Default as shall be directed by the Majority
Lenders or, if provided herein, the Majority Series A Lenders or the Majority
Series B Lenders, PROVIDED that, unless and until the Administrative Agent shall
have received such directions, the Administrative Agent may (but shall not be
obligated to) take such action, or refrain from taking such action, with respect
to such Default as it shall deem advisable in the best interest of the Lenders
except to the extent that this Agreement expressly requires that such action be
taken, or not be taken, only with the consent or upon the authorization of the
Majority Lenders, the Majority Series A Lenders, the Majority Series B Lenders
or all of the Lenders.

               10.04 RIGHTS AS A LENDER. With respect to its Commitments and the
Loans made by it, Chase (and any successor acting as Administrative Agent) in
its capacity as a Lender hereunder shall have the same rights and powers
hereunder as any other Lender and may exercise the same as though it were not
acting as the Administrative Agent, and the term "Lender" or "Lenders" shall,
unless the context otherwise indicates, include the Administrative Agent in its
individual capacity. Chase (and any successor acting as Administrative Agent)
and its affiliates may (without having to account therefor to any Lender) accept
deposits from, lend money to, make investments in and generally engage in any
kind of banking, trust or other business with the Company (and any of its
Subsidiaries or Affiliates) as if it were not acting as the Administrative
Agent, and Chase and its affiliates may accept fees and other consideration 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   73
                                      -68-


from the Company for services in connection with this Agreement or otherwise
without having to account for the same to the Lenders.

               10.05 INDEMNIFICATION. The Lenders agree to indemnify the
Administrative Agent (to the extent not reimbursed under Section 11.03 hereof,
but without limiting the obligations of the Company under said Section 11.03,
and including in any event any payments under any indemnity that the
Administrative Agent is required to issue to any bank referred to in Section
4.02 of the Security Agreement or Section 5.02 of the In-Flight Guarantee and
Security Agreement to which remittances in respect of Accounts, as defined
therein, are to be made) ratably in accordance with the aggregate principal
amount of the Loans and Reimbursement Obligations held by the Lenders (or, if no
Loans or Reimbursement Obligations are at the time outstanding, ratably in
accordance with their respective Commitments), for any and all liabilities,
obligations, losses, damages, penalties, actions, judgments, suits, costs,
expenses or disbursements of any kind and nature whatsoever that may be imposed
on, incurred by or asserted against the Administrative Agent (including by any
Lender) arising out of or by reason of any investigation in or in any way
relating to or arising out of this Agreement or any other Basic Document or any
other documents contemplated by or referred to herein or therein or the
transactions contemplated hereby or thereby (including, without limitation, the
costs and expenses that the Company is obligated to pay under Section 11.03
hereof, and including also any payments under any indemnity that the
Administrative Agent is required to issue to any bank referred to in Section
4.02 of the Security Agreement or Section 5.02 of the In-Flight Guarantee and
Security Agreement to which remittances in respect of Accounts, as defined
therein, are to be made, but excluding, unless a Default has occurred and is
continuing, normal administrative costs and expenses incident to the performance
of its agency duties hereunder) or the enforcement of any of the terms hereof or
thereof or of any such other documents, PROVIDED that no Lender shall be liable
for any of the foregoing to the extent they arise from the gross negligence or
willful misconduct of the party to be indemnified.

               10.06 NON-RELIANCE ON ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT AND OTHER LENDERS.
Each Lender agrees that it has, independently and without reliance on the
Administrative Agent or any other Lender, and based on such documents and
information as it has deemed appropriate, made its own credit analysis of the
Company and its Subsidiaries and decision to enter into this Agreement and that
it will, independently and without reliance upon the Administrative Agent or any
other Lender, and based on such documents and information as it shall deem
appropriate at the time, continue to make its own analysis and decisions in
taking or not taking action under this Agreement. The Administrative Agent shall
not be required to keep itself informed as to the performance or observance by
the Company of this Agreement or any of the other Basic Documents or any other
document referred to or provided for herein or therein or to inspect the
Properties or books of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries. Except for
notices, reports and other documents and information expressly required to be
furnished to the Lenders by the Administrative Agent hereunder, the
Administrative Agent shall not have any duty or responsibility to provide any
Lender with any credit or other information concerning the affairs, financial
condition or business of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries (or any of their
affiliates) that may come into the possession of the Administrative Agent or any
of its affiliates.


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   74


                                      -69-


               10.07 FAILURE TO ACT. Except for action expressly required of the
Administrative Agent hereunder and under the other Basic Documents, the
Administrative Agent shall in all cases be fully justified in failing or
refusing to act hereunder and thereunder unless it shall receive further
assurances to its satisfaction from the Lenders of their indemnification
obligations under Section 10.05 hereof against any and all liability and expense
that may be incurred by it by reason of taking or continuing to take any such
action.

               10.08 RESIGNATION OR REMOVAL OF ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT. Subject to
the appointment and acceptance of a successor Administrative Agent as provided
below, the Administrative Agent may resign at any time by giving notice thereof
to the Lenders and the Company, and the Administrative Agent may be removed at
any time with or without cause by the Majority Lenders. Upon any such
resignation or removal, the Majority Lenders shall have the right to appoint a
successor Administrative Agent. If no successor Administrative Agent shall have
been so appointed by the Majority Lenders and shall have accepted such
appointment within 30 days after the retiring Administrative Agent's giving of
notice of resignation or the Majority Lenders' removal of the retiring
Administrative Agent, then the retiring Administrative Agent may, on behalf of
the Lenders, after consultations with the Company, appoint a successor
Administrative Agent, that shall be a bank which has an office in New York, New
York with a combined capital and surplus of at least $500,000,000. Upon the
acceptance of any appointment as Administrative Agent hereunder by a successor
Administrative Agent, such successor Administrative Agent shall thereupon
succeed to and become vested with all the rights, powers, privileges and duties
of the retiring Administrative Agent, and the retiring Administrative Agent
shall be discharged from its duties and obligations hereunder. After any
retiring Administrative Agent's resignation or removal hereunder as
Administrative Agent, the provisions of this Section 10 shall continue in effect
for its benefit in respect of any actions taken or omitted to be taken by it
while it was acting as the Administrative Agent.

               10.09 CONSENTS UNDER BASIC DOCUMENTS. Except as otherwise
provided in Section 11.04 hereof with respect to this Agreement, the
Administrative Agent may, with the prior consent of the Majority Lenders (but
not otherwise), consent to any modification, supplement or waiver under any of
the Basic Documents, PROVIDED that, without the consent of each Lender, the
Administrative Agent shall not (except as provided herein or in the Security
Documents) release any collateral or otherwise terminate any Lien under the
Security Agreement, or agree to additional obligations being secured by such
collateral security (unless the Lien for such additional obligations shall be
junior to the Lien in favor of the other obligations secured by such Security
Documents), except that no such consent shall be required, and the
Administrative Agent is hereby authorized, to release any Lien covering Property
which (a) is the subject of a Disposition of Property permitted hereunder or to
which the Majority Lenders have consented, (b) consists of the membership
interests in In-Flight to which release the Majority Lenders have consented or
(c) consists of shares of any Subsidiary of the Company that is no longer a
Material Subsidiary.

               10.10 COLLATERAL SUB-AGENTS. Each Lender by its execution and
delivery of this Agreement agrees, as contemplated by Section 4.03 of the
Security Agreement and Section 5.02 of the In-Flight Guarantee and Security
Agreement, that, in the event it shall hold any Permitted 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   75

                                      -70-



Investments referred to therein, such Permitted Investments shall be held in the
name and under the control of such Lender, and such Lender shall hold such
Permitted Investments as a collateral sub-agent for the Administrative Agent
thereunder. The Company by its execution and delivery of this Agreement hereby
consents to the foregoing.

               10.11 DOCUMENTATION AGENT. The Documentation Agent identified on
the front cover page of this Agreement shall have no duties or responsibilities
hereunder other than as a Bank hereunder.

               Section 11. MISCELLANEOUS.

               11.01 WAIVER. No failure on the part of the Administrative Agent
or any Lender to exercise and no delay in exercising, and no course of dealing
with respect to, any right, power or privilege under this Agreement or any Note
shall operate as a waiver thereof, nor shall any single or partial exercise of
any right, power or privilege under this Agreement or any Note preclude any
other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, power or
privilege. The remedies provided herein are cumulative and not exclusive of any
remedies provided by law.

               11.02 NOTICES. All notices, requests and other communications
provided for herein and under the Security Documents (including, without
limitation, any modifications of, or waivers or consents under, this Agreement)
shall be given or made in writing (including, without limitation, by telecopy)
delivered to the intended recipient at (i) in the case of the Company and the
Administrative Agent, the "Address for Notices" specified below its name on the
signature pages hereof) and (ii) in the case of each of the Lenders, the address
(or telecopy number) set forth in its Administrative Questionnaire; or, as to
any party, at such other address as shall be designated by such party in a
notice to each other party. Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, all
such communications shall be deemed to have been duly given when transmitted by
telecopier or personally delivered or, in the case of a mailed notice, upon
receipt, in each case given or addressed as aforesaid.

               11.03 EXPENSES, ETC. The Company agrees to pay or reimburse each
of the Lenders and the Administrative Agent for paying: (a) all reasonable
out-of-pocket costs and expenses of the Administrative Agent (including, without
limitation, the reasonable fees and expenses of Milbank, Tweed, Hadley & McCloy,
special New York counsel to Chase), in connection with (i) the negotiation,
preparation, execution and delivery of this Agreement and the other Basic
Documents and the extension of credit hereunder and (ii) any modification,
supplement or waiver of any of the terms of this Agreement or any of the other
Basic Documents; (b) all reasonable costs and expenses of the Lenders and the
Administrative Agent (including, without limitation, reasonable counsels' fees)
in connection with (i) any Default and any enforcement or collection proceedings
resulting therefrom or in connection with the negotiation of any restructuring
or "work-out" (whether or not consummated), or the obligations of the Company
hereunder and (ii) the enforcement of this Section 11.03; and (c) all transfer,
stamp, documentary, intangibles or other similar taxes, assessments or charges
levied by any 



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   76

                                      -71-


governmental or revenue authority in respect of this Agreement or any of the
other Basic Documents or any other document referred to herein or therein and
all costs, expenses, taxes, assessments and other charges incurred in connection
with any filing, registration, recording or perfection of any security interest
contemplated by any Basic Document or any other document referred to therein.

               The Company hereby agrees (i) to indemnify the Administrative
Agent and each Lender and their respective directors, officers, employees,
attorneys and agents from, and hold each of them harmless against, any and all
losses, liabilities, claims, damages or expenses incurred by any of them
(including, without limitation, any and all losses, liabilities, claims, damages
or expenses incurred by the Administrative Agent to any Lender, whether or not
the Administrative Agent or any Lender is a party thereto) arising out of or by
reason of any investigation or litigation or other proceedings (including any
threatened investigation or litigation or other proceedings) relating to the
extensions of credit hereunder or any actual or proposed use by the Company or
any of its Subsidiaries of the proceeds of any of the extensions of credit
hereunder, including, without limitation, the reasonable fees and disbursements
of counsel incurred in connection with any such investigation or litigation or
other proceedings (but excluding any such losses, liabilities, claims, damages
or expenses incurred by reason of the gross negligence or willful misconduct of
the Person to be indemnified) and (ii) not to assert any claim against the
Administrative Agent, any Lender, any of their affiliates, or any of their
respective directors, officers, employees, attorneys and agents, on any theory
of liability, for special, indirect, consequential or punitive damages arising
out of or otherwise relating to any of the transactions contemplated herein or
in any other Basic Document. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing,
the Company will (x) indemnify the Administrative Agent for any payments that
the Administrative Agent is required to make under any indemnity issued to any
bank referred to in Section 4.02 of the Security Agreement or Section 5.02 of
the In-Flight Guarantee and Security Agreement to which remittances in respect
to Accounts, as defined therein, are to be made and (y) indemnify the
Administrative Agent and each Lender from, and hold the Administrative Agent and
each Lender harmless against, any losses, liabilities, claims, damages or
expenses described in the preceding sentence (but excluding, as provided in the
preceding sentence, any loss, liability, claim, damage or expense incurred by
reason of the gross negligence or willful misconduct of the Person to be
indemnified) arising under any Environmental Law as a result of the past,
present or future operations of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries (or any
predecessor in interest to the Company or any of its Subsidiaries), or the past,
present or future condition of any site or facility owned, operated or leased by
the Company or any of its Subsidiaries (or any such predecessor in interest), or
any Release or threatened Release of any Hazardous Materials from any such site
or facility, including any such Release or threatened Release which shall occur
during any period when the Administrative Agent or any Lender shall be in
possession of any such site or facility following the exercise by the
Administrative Agent or any Lender of any of its rights and remedies hereunder
or under any of the Security Documents but only to the extent that such Release
or threatened Release is directly or indirectly attributable to facts,
circumstances or Releases of Hazardous Materials existing prior to the date of
such possession.


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT




<PAGE>   77

                                      -72-


               11.04 AMENDMENTS, ETC. Except as otherwise expressly provided in
this Agreement, any provision of this Agreement may be modified or supplemented
only by an instrument in writing signed by the Company, the Administrative Agent
and the Majority Lenders, or by the Company and the Administrative Agent acting
with the consent of the Majority Lenders, and any provision of this Agreement
may be waived by the Majority Lenders or by the Administrative Agent acting with
the consent of the Majority Lenders; PROVIDED that: (a) no modification,
supplement or waiver shall, unless by an instrument signed by all of the Lenders
or by the Administrative Agent acting with the consent of all of the Lenders:
(i) increase, or extend the term of any of the Commitments, or extend the time
or waive any requirement for the reduction or termination of any of the
Commitments, (ii) extend the date fixed for the payment of principal of or
interest on any Loan, the Reimbursement Obligations or any fee hereunder, (iii)
reduce the amount of any such payment of principal, (iv) reduce the rate at
which interest is payable thereon or any fee is payable hereunder, (v) alter the
rights or obligations of the Company to prepay Loans, (vi) alter the terms of
this Section 11.04, (vii) modify the definition of the term "Majority Lenders",
"Majority Series A Lenders" or "Majority Series B Lenders", or modify in any
other manner the number or percentage of the Lender required to make any
determinations or waive any rights hereunder or to modify any provision hereof,
or (viii) waive any of the conditions precedent set forth in Section 6 hereof;
(b) any modification or supplement of Section 10 hereof shall require the
consent of the Administrative Agent; and (c) notwithstanding the above, (i)
Sections 2.01(a), 2.03, 2.04(a), 2.05(i) and 5.06, may be modified or
supplemented only by an instrument in writing signed by the Company, the
Administrative Agent and the Series A Lenders, or by the Company and the
Administrative Agent acting with the consent of the Series A Lenders, and any
such provision may be waived by the Series A Lenders or by the Administrative
Agent acting with the consent of the Series A Lenders, and (ii) Sections
2.01(b), 2.04(b) and 2.05(ii) may be modified or supplemented only by an
instrument in writing signed by the Company, the Administrative Agent and the
Series B Lenders, or by the Company and the Administrative Agent acting with the
consent of the Series B Lenders, and any such provision may be waived by the
Series B Lenders or by the Administrative Agent acting with the consent of the
Series B Lenders.

               11.05 SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS. This Agreement shall be binding
upon and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective
successors and permitted assigns.

               11.06 ASSIGNMENTS AND PARTICIPATIONS.

               (a) The Company may not assign any of its rights or obligations
hereunder or under the Notes without the prior consent of all of the Lenders and
the Administrative Agent.

               (b) Each Lender may assign any of its Loans, its Notes, its
Commitments, and, if such Lender is a Series A Lender, its Letter of Credit
Interest (but only with the consent of the Company and the Administrative Agent
and, in the case of a Series A Commitment or a Letter of Credit Interest, the
Issuing Lender, which consents in the case of the Company and the Administrative
Agent shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed); PROVIDED that (i) any such
consent by the Company shall not be unreasonably withheld, (ii) no such consent
by the Company or the Administrative Agent shall be required in the case of any
assignment to another 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT
<PAGE>   78

                                      -73-


Lender; (iii) any such partial assignment shall be in an amount at least equal
to $5,000,000; (iv) unless the Company and the Administrative Agent shall
otherwise consent (which consents shall not be unreasonably withheld or
delayed), each such assignment by a Lender of its Series A Loans, Series A Note,
Series A Commitment or Letter of Credit Interest shall be made in such manner so
that the same percentage of its Series A Loans, Series A Note, Series A
Commitment and Letter of Credit Interest, Series B Loans, Series B Note and
Series B Commitment is assigned to the respective assignee; and (v) unless the
Company and the Administrative Agent shall otherwise consent (which consents
shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed), each such assignment by a Lender
of its Series B Loans, Series B Note or Series B Commitment shall be made in
such manner so that the same percentage of its Series B Loans, Series B Note and
Series B Commitment, Series A Loans, Series A Note, Series A Commitment and
Letter of Credit Interest is assigned to the respective assignee. Upon execution
and delivery by the assignee to the Company, the Administrative Agent and the
Issuing Lender of an instrument in writing pursuant to which such assignee
agrees to become a "Lender" hereunder (if not already a Lender) having the
Commitment(s), Loans, and, if applicable, Letter of Credit Interest specified in
such instrument, and upon consent thereto by the Company, the Administrative
Agent and the Issuing Lender, to the extent required above, the assignee shall
have, to the extent of such assignment (unless otherwise provided in such
assignment with the consent of the Company, the Administrative Agent and the
Issuing Lender), the obligations, rights and benefits of a Lender hereunder
holding the Commitment(s), Loans and, if applicable, Letter of Credit Interest
(or portions thereof) assigned to it (in addition to the Commitment(s), Loans
and Letter of Credit Interest, if any, theretofore held by such assignee) and
the assigning Lender shall, to the extent of such assignment, be released from
the Commitment(s) (or portion(s) thereof) so assigned. Upon each such assignment
the assigning Lender shall pay the Administrative Agent an assignment fee of
$3,000.

               (c) A Lender may sell or agree to sell to one or more other
Persons a participation in all or any part of any Loans or Letter of Credit
Interest held by it, or in its Commitments, in which event each purchaser of a
participation (a "PARTICIPANT") shall be entitled to the rights and benefits of
the provisions of Section 8.01(j) hereof with respect to its participation in
such Loans, Letter of Credit Interest and Commitments as if (and the Company
shall be directly obligated to such Participant under such provisions as if)
such Participant were a "Lender" for purposes of said Section, but, except as
otherwise provided in Section 4.07(c) hereof, shall not have any other rights or
benefits under this Agreement or any Note or any other Basic Document (the
Participant's rights against such Lender in respect of such participation to be
those set forth in the agreements executed by such Lender in favor of the
Participant). All amounts payable by the Company to any Lender under Section 5
hereof in respect of Loans, Letter of Credit Interest held by it, and its
Commitments, shall be determined as if such Lender had not sold or agreed to
sell any participations in such Loans, Letter of Credit Interest and
Commitments, and as if such Lender were funding each of such Loan, Letter of
Credit Interest and Commitments in the same way that it is funding the portion
of such Loan, Letter of Credit Interest and Commitments in which no
participations have been sold. In no event shall a Lender that sells a
participation agree with the Participant to take or refrain from taking any
action hereunder or under any other Basic Document except that such Lender may
agree with the Participant that it will not, without the consent of the
Participant, agree to (i) increase or extend the term, or extend the time or
waive 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   79

                                      -74-





any requirement for the reduction or termination, of such Lender's related
Commitment, (ii) extend the date fixed for the payment of principal of or
interest on the related Loan or Loans, Reimbursement Obligations or any portion
of any fee hereunder payable to the Participant, (iii) reduce the amount of any
such payment of principal, (iv) reduce the rate at which interest is payable
thereon, or any fee hereunder payable to the Participant, to a level below the
rate at which the Participant is entitled to receive such interest or fee, (v)
alter the rights or obligations of the Company to prepay the related Loans or
(vi) consent to any modification, supplement or waiver hereof or of any of the
other Basic Documents to the extent that the same, under Section 10.10 or 11.04
hereof, requires the consent of each Lender.

               (d) In addition to the assignments and participations permitted
under the foregoing provisions of this Section 11.06, any Lender may assign and
pledge all or any portion of its Loans and its Notes to any Federal Reserve Bank
as collateral security pursuant to Regulation A and any Operating Circular
issued by such Federal Reserve Bank. No such assignment shall release the
assigning Lender from its obligations hereunder.

               (e) A Lender may furnish any information concerning the Company
or any of its Subsidiaries in the possession of such Lender from time to time to
assignees and participants (including prospective assignees and participants),
subject, however, to the provisions of Section 11.12(b) hereof.

               (f) Anything in this Section 11.06 to the contrary
notwithstanding, no Lender may assign or participate any interest in any Loan or
Reimbursement Obligation held by it hereunder to the Company or any of its
Affiliates or Subsidiaries without the prior written consent of each Lender.

               11.07 SURVIVAL. The obligations of the Company under Sections
5.01, 5.05, 5.06, 5.07 and 11.03 hereof and the obligations of the Lenders under
Sections 10.05 and 11.12 hereof shall survive the repayment of the Loans and
Reimbursement Obligations and the termination of the Commitments. In addition,
each representation and warranty made, or deemed to be made by a notice of any
extension of credit (whether by means of a Loan or a Letter of Credit), herein
or pursuant hereto shall survive the making of such representation and warranty,
and no Lender shall be deemed to have waived, by reason of making any extension
of credit hereunder (whether by means of a Loan or a Letter of Credit), any
Default which may arise by reason of such representation or warranty proving to
have been false or misleading, notwithstanding that such Lender or the
Administrative Agent may have had notice or knowledge or reason to believe that
such representation or warranty was false or misleading at the time such
extension of credit was made.

               11.08 CAPTIONS. The table of contents and captions and section
headings appearing herein are included solely for convenience of reference and
are not intended to affect the interpretation of any provision of this
Agreement.




                                CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   80

                                      -75-




               11.09 COUNTERPARTS. This Agreement may be executed in any number
of counterparts, all of which taken together shall constitute one and the same
instrument and any of the parties hereto may execute this Agreement by signing
any such counterpart.

               11.10 GOVERNING LAW; SUBMISSION TO JURISDICTION. This Agreement
and the Notes shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the law of
the State of New York. The Company hereby submits to the nonexclusive
jurisdiction of the United States District Court for the Southern District of
New York and of the Supreme Court of the State of New York sitting in New York
County (including its Appellate Division), and any other appellate court in the
State of New York, for the purposes of all legal proceedings arising out of or
relating to this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby. The Company
irrevocably waives, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, any
objection which it may now or hereafter have to the laying of the venue of any
such proceeding brought in such a court and any claim that any such proceeding
brought in such a court has been brought in an inconvenient forum.

               11.11 WAIVER OF JURY TRIAL. EACH OF THE COMPANY, THE
ADMINISTRATIVE AGENT AND THE LENDERS HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST
EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, ANY AND ALL RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY
LEGAL PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR THE
TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY.

               11.12 TREATMENT OF CERTAIN INFORMATION; CONFIDENTIALITY.

               (a) The Company acknowledges that from time to time financial
advisory, investment banking and other services may be offered or provided to
the Company or one or more of its Subsidiaries (in connection with this
Agreement or otherwise) by any Lender or by one or more subsidiaries or
affiliates of such Lender and the Company hereby authorizes each Lender to share
any information delivered to such Lender by the Company and its Subsidiaries
pursuant to this Agreement, or in connection with the decision of such Lender to
enter into this Agreement, to any such subsidiary or affiliate, it being
understood that any such subsidiary or affiliate receiving such information
shall be bound by the provisions of clause (b) below as if it were a Lender
hereunder.

               (b) Each Lender and the Administrative Agent agrees (on behalf of
itself and each of its affiliates, directors, officers, employees and
representatives) to use reasonable precautions to keep confidential, in
accordance with their customary procedures for handling confidential information
of this nature and in accordance with safe and sound banking practices, any
non-public information supplied to it by the Company pursuant to this Agreement
which is identified by the Company as being confidential at the time the same is
delivered to the Lenders or the Administrative Agent, PROVIDED that nothing
herein shall limit the disclosure of any such information (i) to the extent
required by statute, rule, regulation or judicial process, (ii) to counsel for
any of the Lenders or the Administrative Agent, (iii) to bank examiners,
auditors or accountants, (iv) to the Administrative Agent or any other Lender
(or to Chase Securities Inc.), (v) in connection with any litigation to which
any one or more of the Lenders or the 


                                CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   81
                                      -76-


Administrative Agent is a party, (vi) to a subsidiary or affiliate of such
Lender as provided in clause (a) above or (vii) to any assignee or participant
(or prospective assignee or participant) so long as such assignee or participant
(or prospective assignee or participant) first executes and delivers to the
respective Lender a Confidentiality Agreement substantially in the form of
Exhibit B hereto; PROVIDED, FURTHER, that (x) unless specifically prohibited by
applicable law or court order, each Lender and the Administrative Agent shall,
prior to disclosure thereof, notify the Company of any request for disclosure of
any such non-public information (A) by any governmental agency or representative
thereof (other than any such request in connection with an examination of the
financial condition of such Lender by such governmental agency) or (B) pursuant
to legal process and (y) in no event shall any Lender or the Administrative
Agent be obligated or required to return any materials furnished by the Company.





                                CREDIT AGREEMENT
<PAGE>   82
                                      -77-



               IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Agreement
to be duly executed and delivered as of the day and year first above written.

                                    BE AEROSPACE, INC.


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:

                                    Address for Notices:

                                    BE Aerospace, Inc.
                                    1400 Corporate Center Way
                                    Wellington, Florida  33414

                                    Attention: Jeffrey P. Holtzman,
                                                 Vice President and Treasurer

                                    Telecopier No.: (561) 791-3966

                                    Telephone No.: (561) 791-5000

                                    with a copy to:

                                    Ropes & Gray
                                    One International Place
                                    Boston, MA 02110

                                    Attention: Winthrop G. Minot, Esq.

                                    Telecopier No.: (617) 951-7050

                                    Telephone No.: (617) 951-7000




                                CREDIT AGREEMENT
<PAGE>   83

                                      -78-



                                   LENDERS

                                    THE CHASE MANHATTAN BANK


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:



                                    NATIONSBANK, N.A.


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:



                                    CREDIT LYONNAIS ATLANTA AGENCY


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:



                                    LASALLE BUSINESS CREDIT, INC.


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:




                                CREDIT AGREEMENT
<PAGE>   84

                                      -79-



                                    THE LONG-TERM CREDIT BANK OF JAPAN, LTD.


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:


                                    THE FUJI BANK  AND TRUST COMPANY


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:


                                    WACHOVIA BANK, N.A.


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:


                                    AMSOUTH BANK


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:


                                    THE BANK OF NEW YORK


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT
<PAGE>   85

                                      -80-



                                    DG BANK DEUTSCHE GENOSSENSCHAFTSBANK,
                                        CAYMAN ISLAND BRANCH


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:


                                    FIRST UNION NATIONAL BANK


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:


                                    SUNTRUST BANK, SOUTH FLORIDA, N.A.


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:


                                    ABN AMRO BANK N.V.


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:



                                CREDIT AGREEMENT
<PAGE>   86
                                      -81-


                                    THE CHASE MANHATTAN BANK,
                                      as Administrative Agent


                                    By________________________________
                                      Title:


                                    Address for Notices to
                                      Chase as Administrative Agent:

                                    The Chase Manhattan Bank
                                    Loan and Agency Services Group
                                    1 Chase Manhattan Plaza
                                    New York, New York  10081








                                CREDIT AGREEMENT

<PAGE>   87







                                                                         Annex 1

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                             Series A                 Series B                   Total
Bank                                        Commitment               Commitment               Commitments
- ----                                       ------------             ------------             ------------

<S>                                        <C>                      <C>                      <C>         
The Chase Manhattan Bank                   $ 11,000,000             $ 11,000,000             $ 22,000,000

NationsBank, N.A                           $ 10,000,000             $ 10,000,000             $ 20,000,000

Credit Lyonnais Atlanta Agency             $  9,500,000             $  9,500,000             $ 19,000,000

LaSalle Business Credit, Inc.              $  9,500,000             $  9,500,000             $ 19,000,000

The Long-Term Credit Bank                  $  9,500,000             $  9,500,000             $ 19,000,000
  of Japan, Ltd. 

The Fuji Bank and Trust Company            $  9,500,000             $  9,500,000             $ 19,000,000

Wachovia Bank, N.A                         $  9,500,000             $  9,500,000             $ 19,000,000

Amsouth Bank                               $  6,000,000             $  6,000,000             $ 12,000,000

The Bank of New York                       $  6,000,000             $  6,000,000             $ 12,000,000

DG Bank Deutsche Genossenschaftsbank       $  6,000,000             $  6,000,000             $ 12,000,000
  Cayman Island Branch

First Union National Bank                  $  6,000,000             $  6,000,000             $ 12,000,000

SunTrust Bank, South Florida, N.A          $  6,000,000             $  6,000,000             $ 12,000,000

ABN Amro Bank N.V                          $  1,500,000             $  1,500,000             $  3,000,000


Total                                      $100,000,000             $100,000,000             $200,000,000
</TABLE>





                           ANNEX 1 TO CREDIT AGREEMENT

<PAGE>   88





                                                                      SCHEDULE I


                          MATERIAL AGREEMENTS AND LIENS

                         [SEE SECTIONS 7.12 AND 8.07(b)]

Part A - MATERIAL AGREEMENTS

1.      [Intentionally Omitted]

2.      Loan agreements dated February 24, 1993 between the Company's subsidiary
        Flight Equipment and Engineering Limited, an English corporation
        ("FEEL"), and Barclays Bank PLC ("BARCLAYS"), as amended, providing for
        an overdraft facility in the aggregate principal amount of
        (pound)3,000,000.

3.      Guarantee dated February 24, 1993 by the Company to Barclays limited to
        (pound)2,750,000 of the Indebtedness of FEEL described in Item 2 above.

4.      Guarantee as of March 1, 1993 of Aircraft Furnishing Limited ("AFL") in
        an unlimited amount of the Indebtedness of FEEL described in described
        in Item 2 above.

5.      Loan agreement between Royal Inventum B.V. and ING Bank dated July 14,
        1993 in the aggregate principal amount of Dfl. 2,000,000.

6.      Demand Promissory Note dated August 27, 1993 from Aero Holdings
        Acquisition Corp. (now known as Acurex Corporation) to the Company in
        the aggregate principal amount of approximately $2,000,000.

7.      Acquisition Agreement among the Company, Elinor T. Nordskog and Nordskog
        Industries, Inc. dated July 27, 1993. (Acquisition purchase price
        adjustments unknown)

8.      Purchase Agreement dated October 26, 1993 between the Company and Thomas
        P. McCaffrey and Kerry J. McCaffrey, Trustees of the Thomas P. and Kerry
        J. McCaffrey Living Trust, Dated August 3, 1990 pursuant to which the
        trust sold certain residential property located in San Clemente,
        California to the Company, and the Company, among other things, assumed
        Indebtedness which, as of the date hereof, is outstanding to Countrywide
        Funding Corporation in the aggregate principal amount of $457,484.

9.      Capitalized lease obligations of FEEL and AFL for machinery and
        equipment in the aggregate amount of $945,000.

10.     Indebtedness of FEEL to the Company in an aggregate principal amount not
        in excess of (pound)3,369,541.

11.     Indebtedness of BE Aerospace (Netherlands) B.V. to the Company in an
        aggregate principal amount not in excess of Dfls. 49,385,000.



                         SCHEDULE I TO CREDIT AGREEMENT



<PAGE>   89
                                      -2-


12.     Indenture dated as of January 24, 1996 between the Company and First
        National Bank of Connecticut, as trustee, in connection with
        $100,000,000 of 9-7/8% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2006.

13.     Acquisition Agreement dated as of December 14, 1995, among the Company,
        Burns Aerospace Corporation, Eagle Industrial Products Corporation,
        Eagle Industries, Inc. and Great American Management and Investment,
        Inc. (Acquisition purchase price adjustment unknown.)














                         SCHEDULE I TO CREDIT AGREEMENT
<PAGE>   90
                                      -3-



Part B - LIENS


















                         SCHEDULE I TO CREDIT AGREEMENT

<PAGE>   91




                                                                     SCHEDULE II

                               HAZARDOUS MATERIALS

                               [SEE SECTION 7.13]




















                         SCHEDULE II TO CREDIT AGREEMENT
<PAGE>   92






                                                                    SCHEDULE III

                          SUBSIDIARIES AND INVESTMENTS

                         [SEE SECTIONS 7.17 AND 8.08(a)]

Part A - SUBSIDIARIES

                              Jurisdiction
                                   of                             Percentage
Subsidiary                    Organization    Owners             Of Ownership
- ----------                    ------------    ------             ------------

BE Aerospace                  Barbados        BEA                     100%
International, Ltd.

BE Aerospace (UK)             England         BEA                     100%
Limited ("BEA-UK")

Flight Equipment and          England         BEA-UK                  100%
Engineering Limited

BE Aerospace                  England         BEA-UK                  100%
(Services), Limited

Aircraft Furnishing           England         AFL                   99.00%
Limited ("AFL")                                                      1.00%

Fort Hill Aircraft            Northern        AFL                     100%
Limited ("AFL")               Ireland

AFI Holdings                  Northern        AFL                     100%
Limited                       Ireland

BE Aerospace                  France          BEA                   98.00%
(France) S.A.R.L.                             K.A.D.                 1.00%
                                              Companies, Inc.        1.00%
                                              Marc Leveille
                                              (director)

BE Aerospace                  Delaware        BEA                     100%
(U.S.A.), Inc.

BE Aerospace                  Netherlands     BEA                      90%
(Netherlands) B.V.                            BEA (U.S.A.)             10%
("BEA-NETH")




                        SCHEDULE III TO CREDIT AGREEMENT
<PAGE>   93
                                      -2-


Royal Inventum B.V.           Netherlands     BEA-Neth              96.60%*

Tepaco Properties B.V.        Netherlands     BEA-Neth                100%
Acurex Corporation            Delaware        BEA                     100%

Nordskog Industries,          California      BEA                     100%
Inc.


- --------------------
*       The balance of these shares were lost prior to the sale of the shares of
        this entity to BEA.




                        SCHEDULE III TO CREDIT AGREEMENT

<PAGE>   94
                                      -3-




Part B - INVESTMENTS

               In addition to the Investments set forth in Part A above, as of
the date hereof the Company has the following outstanding Investments:

        a.     an Investment in a Middle East sales office in an amount not to
               exceed $200,000;

        b.     an Investment in a residential property in San Clemente,
               California in an amount of approximately $600,000; and

        c.     Money Market Funds in the amount, as of May 23, 1997, of
               approximately $35M.

               Finally, each of the matters described in Items 3, 5, 9 and 10 of
Part A of Schedule I constitutes an Investment in or by FEEL, AFL and the
Company, as the case may be.






                        SCHEDULE III TO CREDIT AGREEMENT
<PAGE>   95






                                                                     SCHEDULE IV

                            APPROVALS AND COMPLIANCE

               None, except compliance with certain Environmental Laws disclosed
in the materials set forth in Schedule II hereto.


















                         SCHEDULE IV TO CREDIT AGREEMENT
<PAGE>   96




                                                                      SCHEDULE V

                           EXISTING LETTERS OF CREDIT



        Letter of Credit No.       Amount Outstanding     Expiry Date
        --------------------       ------------------     -----------






        Total Letters of Credit
        Outstanding                   $
















                         SCHEDULE V TO CREDIT AGREEMENT
<PAGE>   97






                                                                     SCHEDULE VI


                                      TAXES

               None.














                         SCHEDULE VI TO CREDIT AGREEMENT
<PAGE>   98






                                                                    SCHEDULE VII

                          TRANSACTIONS WITH AFFILIATES

               Under a Supply Agreement dated April 17, 1990 with Applied
Extrusion Technologies, Inc., a Delaware corporation ("AET"), the Company
purchases from AET its requirements of injection-molded plastic parts for use in
the manufacture of passenger control units and other products for installation
in commercial aircraft for the period ending March 31, 1998. Under that
agreement, AET has agreed to use its best efforts at all times to maintain
available and in good working order a sufficient number and variety of injection
molding machines to satisfy the Company's orders as received and to use its best
efforts to initiate production within three days of receipt of an order or, in
emergency situations, on the date on which the order is received. The price to
be paid by the Company to AET for products purchased under the Supply Agreement
is an amount which results in a 33-1/3% gross margin to AET, after including in
AET's standard cost for such products, all direct and indirect costs of labor,
materials, equipment and overhead. Purchases by the Company under this agreement
for the fiscal year ended on February 22, 1997 were approximately $1,642,000.
Mr. Amin J. Khoury is a director and significant stockholder of AET and serves
as its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer. Messrs. Richard G. Hamermesh and
Hansjoerg Wyss, directors of BE Aerospace, Inc.

are also directors of AET.










                        SCHEDULE VII TO CREDIT AGREEMENT


<PAGE>   1
         THIS LEASE made the first day of October One thousand nine hundred and
seventy-three BETWEEN Drawheath LIMITED whose registered office is at 15 London
EC2 (hereinafter called "the Lessor" on the one part and THE PENINSULAR AND
ORIENTAL STEAM NAVIGATION COMPANY whose principal office is at P & O Building
Leadenhall Street, London EC3 (hereinafter called "the Lessee") of the other
part.

         WITNESSETH as follows:--

1.       (a) UNLESS the contract otherwise requires the following expressions
bear the meanings assigned to them as follows:-- 

         "The Lessor" means the estate owner of the reversion immediately
expectant on the term hereby granted;

         "The Lessee" includes the Lessee's successors in title and permitted
assigns;

         "The demised premises" means the land described in the First Schedule
hereto and each and every part thereof together with any buildings and each and
every part thereof now or hereafter erected or in the course of erection thereon
or on any part thereof and includes the appurtenances fixtures fittings and
rights hereby demised;

         "The Town and Country Planning Acts" means the Town and Country
Planning Act 1971 the Town and Country Planning (Amendment) Act 1972 and any Act
or Acts for


                                      -1-

<PAGE>   2
the time being in force amending or replacing the same and includes any order
instrument regulation direction or plan made or issued thereunder or deriving
validity therefrom and any future legislation or items such as aforesaid of a
like nature or effect; and

         "These presents" means this Lease;

         (b) These presents shall unless the context otherwise requires be
construed as follows:

         Where there is more than one person for the time being included in the
expression "the Lessee" covenants and obligations at any time expressed to be
made or assumed by the party in question are made and are to be construed as
made by all such persons jointly and severally and covenants and obligations
made or assumed by any party shall be binding on and enforceable against his
personal representatives. And the term hereby granted shall be computed for all
purposes from the date of commencement specified in Clause 2 hereof.

2.      IN consideration of the rent and covenants on the part of the Lessee and
conditions hereinafter reserved and contained the Lessor HEREBY DEMISES unto
the Lessee ALL THAT the land and premises described in the First Schedule
hereto TOGETHER with the appurtenances thereto belonging and the fixtures and
fittings thereon in the nature of Landlord's fixtures and fittings TO HOLD the
same unto the Lessee SUBJECT to and with the benefit as far as the Lessor has
power to grant the same of the provisions contained in the document specified
or referred

                                      -2-
<PAGE>   3
to in the Second Schedule hereto for the term of Twenty-five years from the
First day of September One thousand nine hundred and seventy-three YIELDING AND
PAYING therefor during the said term and so in proportion for any less time than
a year the clear yearly rent of FORTY THOUSAND POUNDS (L40,000) (subject to
revision and increase in accordance with the provisions in that behalf
hereinafter contained) such rent to be paid in advance without any deductions
(except such as may be obligatory by Statute or Order) by equal quarterly
payments on the usual quarter days the first payment being a proportionate
amount in respect of the period from and including the Eighth day of September
One thousand nine hundred and seventy three to the quarter day next
following to be made on the execution hereof.

3. The Lessee HEREBY COVENANTS with the Lessor as follows:

         (1) To pay the rent hereby reserved and made payable and as from time
to time so revised and increased (if such be the case) at the times and in
manner aforesaid without any deductions (except as aforesaid);

         (2) To pay and discharge all existing and future rates taxes duties
charges assessments impositions and outgoings whatsoever of an annual or
recurring and non-capital nature (whether parliamentary parochial local or of
any other description) which are new or may at any time hereafter be assessed
charged levied or imposed upon or payable in respect of the demised premises or
assessed charged

                                      -3-
<PAGE>   4


levied or imposed upon or payable by any estate owner landlord tenant or
occupier in respect thereof;

         (3) To comply at the Lessee's expense with every notice order
requisition direction or other thing given made or issued by a competent
authority affecting the demised premises or the user of the demised premises by
the Lessee whether the same is addressed to or served upon the Lessor or
Lessee or any other landlord tenant or occupier or any other person whatsoever
and of which the Lessee becomes aware;

         (4) To deliver to the Lessor free of charge a copy of every notice
order requisition direction or other thing given made or issued to or by a
competent authority affecting the demised premises or the user of the demised
premises as soon as the Lessee becomes aware thereof;

         (5) To paint all the outside wood iron and other work of the demised
premises previously or usually painted or which ought to be painted with two
coats at least of good quality oil or synthetic paint in a proper and
workmanlike manner on such occasions as the Lessor may reasonably require and
not less than once in every third year of the said term and during the last year
thereof (however-determined) and at the same time with every such painting to
clean make good and treat with a suitable preservative the rough cast

                                      -4-
<PAGE>   5
metal or stucco work wherever necessary in like manner;

         (6) To paint all the inside wood iron and other work of the demised
premises previously or usually painted with two coasts at least of good quality
oil or synthetic paint in a proper and workmanlike manner on such occasions as
the Lessor may reasonably require and not less than once in every fifth year of
the said term and during the last year thereof (however determined) and at the
same times with every such painting in like manner to wash stop paper whitewash
distamper colour and decorate the parts of the interior of the demised premises
previously or usually so treated;

         (7) To cleanse and keep in good and tenantable repair and condition and
as to the whole or part rebuild as appropriate and keep clean the demised
premises (including the exterior and structure) and the water ventilation
sanitary and central heating apparatus and the walls fences roads sewers drains
and appurtenances thereof with all necessary reparations and cleansing and
rebuilding works and amendments whatsoever;

         (8) To keep and maintain the land of the demised premises not covered
by buildings in a neat and tidy condition clear of all rubbish and free from
weeds including the cutting or grassed areas and maintenance of borders and to
lop top and cut back roots or fell and grub up roots of all trees on the demised
premises as may from time to time be



                                      -5-
<PAGE>   6
necessary in the proper management of the demised premises and also well and
substantially to maintain the fences erected along the boundaries of the
demised premises marked "T" within such boundaries on the plan (if any)
thereof;

         (9)  To pay all reasonable expenses (including Solicitors' costs and
Surveyors and other professional fees) which may be incurred by the Lessor in 
the preparation and service of a notice under Section 148 or 147 of the Law of
Property Act 1925 or any statutory modification or re-enactment thereof for the
time being in force notwithstanding that forfeiture (if applicable) be avoided
otherwise than by relief granted by the Court;

         (10)  To yield up unto the Lessor at the expiration or sooner
determination of the said term so painted treated repaired cleansed maintained
amended and kept as aforesaid the demised premises and the keys and all
additions and improvements made thereto in the meantime and all fixtures of
every king in or upon the demised premises or which during the said term may be
affixed or fastened to or upon the same except Tenant's or trade fixtures and in
accordance also with the covenants and conditions contained or imposed in or by
virtue of any licence granted by the Lessor hereunder and prior to the
expiration or sooner determination of the said term in case any


                                      -6-
<PAGE>   7
of the Lessor's  fixtures and fittings shall be missing broken damaged or
destroyed forthwith to replace them with others of a similar character and of 
equal value and in the event of any alterations having been made during the said
term to the demised premises to reinstate the demised premises (if and as so 
required by the Lessor) to the condition in which they were prior to the making 
of such alterations and in any event to remove any moulding sign writing or 
painting of the name or business of the Lessee and other persons from the 
demised premises and make good any damage caused to the demised premises by such
removal or removal of the Lessee's fixtures fittings furniture and effects;

         (11) To permit the Lessor and its agents at any reasonable time or
times by prior appointment in writing with the Lessee (except in case of
emergency) to enter and examine the demised premises to ensure that nothing has
been done therein which constitutes or may in the reasonable opinion of the
Lessor tend to constitute a breach of any of the covenants contained in these
presents and to examine the state and condition of the demised premises;

         (12) Duly and immediately to remedy repair and make good all breaches
and defects of which notice in writing shall be given by the Lessor to the
Lessee and which the Lessee shall be liable to remedy repair or make good under
the covenants contained


                                      -7-
<PAGE>   8
in these presents. And in case the Lessee shall make default in so doing within
three calendar months after the date of any such notice it shall be lawful (but
not obligatory) for the Lessor without prejudice to the right of re-entry
hereinafter contained to enter upon the demised premises and to remedy repair
and make good the same at the cost of the Lessee which cost together with the
Lessor's proper expenses (including Surveyors' and other professional fees)
thereby incurred shall be paid by the Lessee to the Lessor on demand;

         (13) To permit the Lessor and its agents at any reasonable time or
times by prior appointment in writing with the Lessee to enter the demised
premises and to take schedules or inventories of the fixtures and things to be
yielded up at the expiration or determination of the said term;

         (14) To permit the Lessor and its agents and workmen and (if authorised
by the Lessor the tenants and occupiers of any adjoining or neighbouring
premises or their respective agents and workmen at any reasonable time or times
to enter upon the demised premises by prior appointment in writing with the
Lessee (except in case of emergency) for executing repairs additions or
alterations to or upon any adjoining or neighbouring premises or for making
repairing maintaining renewing connecting or cleansing any pipes drains channels
watercourses sewers wires or cables belonging to or leading to or from the same
the person entering making good to the
   
                                      -8-
<PAGE>   9
Lessee all damage thereby occasioned to the demised premises (but no liability
save in respect of such entry by the Lessor shall accrue against the Lessor);

         (15) To permit the Lessor at any time during the last six months of
the said term (howsoever determined) if it so desires to affix and retain
without interference upon any suitable parts of the demised premises in a
conspicuous place notices for re-letting or selling the same (causing thereby
as little interference as possible with the Lessee's business) and to permit all
persons with written authority from the Lessor or the Lessor's agents at
reasonable times of the day by prior appointment with the Lessee to view the
demised premises;

         (16) (a) Not without the Lessor's consent to erect or permit or suffer
to be erected any new building or erection on the demised premises;

              (b) Not without the Lessor's consent (such consent not to be
unreasonably withheld) to make or permit or suffer to be made any alterations
or additions in or to the said land and premises or any building or erection
which may be erected thereon other than such as in the opinion of the Lessor
constitute internal and non-structural alterations or additions to be said
premises;
  
         (17) Not to use or permit or suffer the demised premises to be used
for residential purposes or as sleeping accommodation or as agricultural land as

                                     -9-
<PAGE>   10
defined by the Agricultural Holdings Act 1948 or any Act or Acts for the time
being in force amending or replacing the same;

         (18) Not to use or permit or suffer the demised  premises to be used
for any noisy noisome offensive or dangerous trade art manufacture business or
occupation or for any illegal or immoral purpose nor to do or permit or suffer
to be done on the demised premises any act matter or thing whatsoever which may
be or in the opinion of the Lessor's Managing Agents tend to become an
annoyance nuisance damage disturbance inconvenience or to the prejudice of the
Lessor or the owners or occupiers of any adjoining or neighbouring premises or
the neighbourhood and without prejudice to the generality of the foregoing not
to use or permit the demised premises to be used otherwise then as an
Industrial Building with ancillary offices. Provided that no representation or
warranty is or has prior to the date hereof been given or made by or on behalf
of the Lessor that any such use is or will be or will remain a permitted use
under the Town and Country Planning Acts nor shall any consent which the Lessor
may in its discretion give to any change of use be taken as including any such
representation or warranty. And to notify the Lessor of any proposed change of
user of the demised premises or any part thereof within the 

                                     - 10 -
<PAGE>   11
category of user hereby authorised;

         (19) Not without the consent in writing of the Lessor first obtained
(such consent not to be unreasonably withheld) to affix place or display or
permit or suffer anything to be fixed placed or displayed to or on the
forecourts or roofs of the demised premises;

         (20) Subject and without prejudice to sub-Clause (17) of this Clause:--

         (a) not to do or omit or permit or suffer to be done or omitted any act
or thing on or in relation to the demised premises or the user of the demised
premises the doing or omission of which shall be or may in the reasonable
opinion of the Lessor constitute a contravention of the Town and Country
Planning Acts;

         (b) to comply with the requirements of the Factories Act 1961 and/or
the Offices Shops and Railway Premises Act, 1963 (as the case may be) or any Act
or Acts of Parliament amending or replacing the same in respect of the demised
premises or the user thereof whether the obligation to comply be imposed upon
the Lessor or Lessee and at all times to indemnify and the Lessee accordingly
hereby indemnifies the Lessor against any breach or non-observance thereof; and

         (c) unless the Lessor shall otherwise direct to execute not later than
in the last year of the said term (howsoever determined) or sooner if requisite
all such works as are or may under or  

                                     - 11 -

 
<PAGE>   12




in pursuance of the Town and Country Planning Acts or any other Act or Acts of
Parliament already or hereafter to be passed be directed or required by any
Borough Council or local public or other competent authority to be executed at
any time upon or in respect of the demised premises or the user thereof
(including without prejudice to the generality of the foregoing the provision
and maintenance of fire escapes and toilet facilities and elimination of smoke
effluvia vapour and grit) And at all times to conform in all respects with the
provisions of any regulations made under any general or local Act of Parliament
which may be applicable to the demised premises or the user thereof And not to
do or omit or permit or suffer to be done or omitted on the demised premises
any act or thing whereby the Lessor may become liable to pay any penalty
imposed or to bear the whole or part of nay expense incurred under any such
direction requirement Act or regulation as aforesaid.

         (21) Not to carry on or suffer upon the demised premises any trade
business or occupation in any manner or do or suffer any other thing which may
make void or voidable any policy for the insurance of the demised premises
against fire or any other risk for the time being required by the Lessor to be
covered by the policy hereinafter referred to or render any increased or extra
premium payable for such insurance


                                      -12-
<PAGE>   13
(without in the latter event first having paid every such increased or extra
premium) And to carry out in accordance with the directions of the insurers of
the demised premises such works as may reasonably be required by them for the
better protection of the demised premises;

         (22) In the event of the demised premises being destroyed or damaged to
give notice thereof immediately to the Lessor stating whether and to what extent
such destruction or damage was brought about directly or indirectly by any of
the perils in respect of which the Leasee shall or ought to affect insurance
pursuant to these presents;

         (23) To insure and keep the demised praises insured at the Leasee's own
expense but as agent for the Lessor in the joint names of the Lessor and the
Lessee and such other names (if any) as the Lessor shall require against loss or
damage by fire aircraft flood impact and such other rises as the Lessor may from
time to time require in the full reinstatement value thereof for the time being
including cost of site clearance (the sum insured to be in any event not less
than such amount as shall from time to time be notified to the Leasee by the
Lessor as representing in their opinion the sum in which the demised premises
ought for the time being to be insured but if such sum should be an undervalue
the liability of the Lessee to insure for the full value shall not

                                      -13-
<PAGE>   14



be affected) with professional fees on such value at the scales for time being
in force of the Royal Institute of British Architects and the Royal Institution
of Chartered Surveyors and also against less of three years' rent of the demised
premises at the rate of the time being payable (but if the same is subject to
review at such rate as shall be required by the Lessor in respect of the years
for which the same is to be reviewed) and against damage or breakage of plate
glass third party risks and property owner's liability as shall for the time
being be appropriate with the Friends' Provident Life Office of 7 Leadenhall
Street London EC3 or such other insurers and through such agency as shall be
nominated by the Lessor from time to time under a policy including a
reinstatement clause and free from any condition of avoidance on breach of
warranty And whenever and wheresoever the Lessor shall reasonably so require to
produce to the Lessor the policy of insurance (and provide the Lessor with a
duplicate thereof if so requested) and the receipt for the current year's
premium And forthwith as agent for the Lessor to lay out all moneys received
under such insurance (except in respect of less of rent) and at the Lessee's own
expense such other money as shall be necessary in well and substantially
rebuilding and reinstating the demised premises in a workmanlike manner to the
reasonable satisfaction of the Lessor and in accordance with drawings and


                                      -14-
<PAGE>   15
specifications submitted to and approved by the Lessor. And the costs of any
independent professional valuation of the demised premises which may in case of
dispute be required by the Lessor for the purpose of this sub-clause (but not
oftener than once in any five consecutive years) shall be paid by the Lessor to
the Lessor on demand. PROVIDED ALWAYS that if the demised premises shall be
destroyed or damaged by any of the insured risks than (unless the insurance
shall be vitiated by some act or default of the Lessee) the whole or a
proportionate part of the rent hereby reserved according to the nature and
extent of the damage sustained shall be suspended until the demised premises
shall have been reinstated and made ready for use and occupation and a fair
proportion of the rent for the quarter in which such damage or destruction
shall occur shall be refunded to the Lessee such refund to be calculated on a
day to day basis and if any dispute shall arise between the Lessor and the
Lessee in regard to the amount of the abatement to be made in the said rent or
the period for which the said rent or any part thereof shall be suspended the
same shall be referred to the arbitration or decision of an independent
surveyor to be nominated by the parties hereto or (in default of agreement) by
the President for the time being of the Royal Institution of Chartered
Surveyors on the application of either party and such reference shall be deemed
to be a submission to Arbitration under the provisions of the Arbitration Act
1950 or any


                                      -15-
<PAGE>   16




statutory modification or re-enactment thereof for the time being in force;

         (24) Not without the consent in writing of the Lessor first obtained to
hold or permit or suffer to be held upon the demised premises any sale by
auction public exhibition political meeting show spectacle or gambling;

         (25) Not to keep or permit or suffer to be kept on the demised premises
any material of a dangerous combustible explosive radio-active or offensive
nature except in accordance with the provisions of any relevant Act or Acts of
Parliament for the time being in force and after due notice to the insurers of
the demised premises and payment of every increased or extra insurance premium
which ought to be paid;

         (26) Not to fix to or place upon or permit or suffer to be fixed to or
placed upon the demised premises any machinery article or substance which in the
opinion of the Lessor may be liable to damage or overload the structure or
floors of the buildings included in the demised premises or any adjoining or
neighbouring buildings;

         (27) Not without the consent in writing of the Lessor first obtained
(such consent not to be unreasonably withheld) to affix or display or permit or
suffer to be affixed or displayed to or on the demised premises any sign
boarding poster placard or advertisement whatsoever which shall be visible from
the outside of the demised premises except such means of identification and
other

                                      -16-
<PAGE>   17
notices as aforesaid as shall in the opinion of the Lessor be reasonably
necessary in connection with the use and occupation of the demised premises for
the time being. Provided that it is and shall be the sole responsibility of the
Lessee irrespective of consent having been given (or waived) by the Lessor to
apply for and obtain the consent of the appropriate planning authority and
every other consent necessary for any sign boarding poster placard or
advertisement whatsoever which from time to time shall require any such consent;
         (28) Not to permit or suffer any owner of any adjoining or
neighbouring property to acquire any rights of way light or air or other
easements over the demised premises but as soon as the Lessee becomes aware
thereof to inform the Lessor of any act or thing which might result in the
acquisition of any right or privilege over the demised premises (for the
purpose of enabling the Lessor if the Lessor thinks fit to do anything
necessary for preventing the acquisition of any such right or privilege and to
permit the Lessor and its agents to enter and examine the demised premises
accordingly) and at the request and cost of the Lessor to take consent to or
join with the Lessor in taking such steps or action as may be reasonably
required by the Lessor for preventing any such right or privilege from being
acquired;
         (29) (a) Not to assign or underlet the demised premises in any part
less than the whole;
              (b) Not to underlet the demised premises except


                                     - 17 -
<PAGE>   18



at the full rack rental value for the time being without taking a fine or
premium or any other similar consideration;

         (c) Not to permit the occupation or possession of the demised premises
or any part thereof at a rent or for a payment or consideration less than the
full rack rental value for the time being;

         (d) To procure that any intended assignee of the demised premises shall
covenant as a lessee by Deed supplemental hereto direct with the Lessor to pay
the rent and observe and perform all the covenants on the part of the Lessee and
conditions reserved and contained in these presents;

         (e) To ensure that in any permitted mediate or immediate underlease (i)
the rent shall be subject to review in an upward direction only at such times as
to coincide with the rent review provided for under this Lease and (ii) the
underlessee shall covenant in such manner as to be enforceable by the Lessor not
to deal in any manner with the premises therein comprised or any part thereof or
permit any dealing therewith which shall be inconsistent with the provisions of
this sub-clause and (iii) the covenants on the part of the Lessee herein
contained (save for payment of rent) so far as the same affect the demised
premises or part thereof comprised in any such mediate or immediate underlease
shall be enforceable by the Lessor in case of default as 


                                      -18-
<PAGE>   19
well against the underlessee as against the Lessee;

         (f)  Upon every application for consent required by this sub-clause to
disclose to the Lessor such information as to the terms proposed as the Lessor
may require;

         (g)  Subject to and without prejudice to the generality of the
foregoing not to assign transfer underlet share or part with the possession of
the demised premises or permit the creation or assignment of any sub-underlease
or other derivative mediate or immediate estate or interest whatsoever or permit
any sharing or parting with possession of or under any such mediate or immediate
estate or interest in the demised premises subject for the time being to a
permitted mediate or immediate underlease thereof without in each and every such
case the previous consent in writing of the Lessor which shall not be
unreasonably withheld PROVIDED ALWAYS that nothing contained in this sub-clause
(29) shall prevent the Lessee from subletting the demised premises to or
permitting the same to be occupied by Scott Parking and Warehousing Co. Limited
or any other subsidiary or associated company of the Lessee;

         (30)  Within one month of every assignment transfer underlease or
charge affecting the demised premises or any devolution of the estate of the
Lessee therein or two months of the like affecting and every surrender
terminating any derivative mediate or immediate estate or interest in the
demised premises or any part thereof or any devolution of such estate or
interest to give notice


                                      -19-

<PAGE>   20
in writing with particulars thereof to the Lessor and produce such assignment
transfer underlease or charge or the Probate of the Will or Letters of
Administration or other document or evidence of such devolution or surrender or
a certified copy thereof (if and as they so require) and pay to them in respect
of every such assignment transfer underlease change devolution or surrender a
registration fee of Two pounds ten pence;

         (31) To keep the Lessor fully and effectually indemnified at all times
and the Lessee hereby indemnifies the Lessor accordingly against all costs
claims liabilities actions and expenses (whether alleged or demanded by the
owners or occupiers of any adjoining or neighbouring properties or other
parties) arising through the Lessee's use or occupation of the demised premises
the existence of any articles belonging to the Lessee in or about the demised
premises or the execution of any works by the Lessee upon the demised premises
except in so far as the same may be due solely to the Lessor's own act or
default or the act or default of the Lessor's agents thereunto duly and
specifically authorised acting as such within the scope of such authority;

         (32) To perform and observe all the covenants conditions and
provisions relating to the demised premises referred to in the Second Schedule
hereto;

         (33) To pay to the Lessor upon the commencement of the term hereby
created the Lessor's Solicitors' costs and expenses in connection with the
preparation and completion of 

                                     - 20 -
<PAGE>   21
these presents including the Counterpart and all stamp duties thereon;

         THE Lessor HEREBY COVENANTS that the Lessee paying the rent hereby
reserved and made payable and as from time to time revised and increased (if
such be the case) and performing and observing the several covenants conditions
and agreements herein contained and on the Lessee's part to be performed and
observed shall and may peaceably and quietly hold and enjoy the demised
premises during the term hereby granted without any lawful interruption or
disturbance from or by the Lessor or any person claiming under or in trust for
the Lessor.

6.      PROVIDED ALWAYS AND IT IS HEREBY EXPRESSLY AGREED as follows:-

         (1) (a) That the Lessor shall be entitled by notice in writing given to
the Lessee at any time during the review period (as hereinafter defined) to call
for a review of the yearly rent payable to the Lessor in respect of the demised
premises and if upon review it shall be found that the commercial yearly rent
(as hereinafter defined) of the demised premises at the review date (as
hereinafter defined) next following the commencement of the review period in
question shall on the occasion of such review be greater in amount then the
yearly rent hereinbefore reserved (as revised and increased if such be the case
on any previous review) and for the time being payable then as from the review

                                     - 21 -
<PAGE>   22



date in question the amount of the yearly rent payable to the Lessor in respect
of the demised premises shall be increased in manner following and thenceforth
the said rent shall be paid by the Lessee at such increased rate to the Lessor;

         (b) for the purposes of this sub-Clause the following expressions bear
the meanings assigned to them as follows:-

              "The review period" means in the first instance the period
         commencing twelve months immediately preceding the expiration of the
         Fifth year of the said term and in the second instance and successively
         thereafter the period commencing twelve months immediately preceding
         the expiration of every following Fifth year of the said term and
         includes (as the context admits) all or any one or more of such
         periods;

              "The review date" means in he first instance the date of
         expiration of the Fifth year of the said term and thereafter
         successively the date of expiration of each and every subsequent Fifth
         year of the said term;

              "The commercial yearly rent" means the clear yearly rent at which
         the demised premises assuming the due performance and observance of the
         covenants on the part of the Lessees and conditions contained in these
         premises might reasonably be expected to be let at the review date by a
         willing landlord in the open market with vacant possession and without
         premium or any other consideration than that evidence by execution of a
         lease thereof to

                                      -22-
<PAGE>   23
         a willing tenant for a term equal to the residue then unexpired of the
         term hereby granted by a lease in the same terms in all other respects
         as these presents (including this sub-clause) there being disregarded:

              (i) any effect on rent of the fact that the Lessee or any other
         person may have been in occupation of the demised premises; and

              (ii) any goodwill attached to the demised premises by reason of
         the user of the demised premises by the Lessee or any other person or
         the purposes for which the demised premises may have been used; and

              (iii) any effect on rent of any improvement of the demised
         premises or any part thereof carried out by the Lessee at the Lessee's
         expense otherwise than in pursuance of any obligation imposed by
         Statute or by the terms of this Lease.

         (c) With effect from the review date the amount of the yearly rent
payable under this Lease shall be increased to the amount of the commercial
yearly rent PROVIDED ALWAYS AND IT IS HEREBY AGREED that the yearly rent payable
hereunder from and after the review date during the residue of the term hereby
granted shall at no time be less in amount than the yearly rent for the time
being subject to review;

         (d) Such review as aforesaid shall first be made by the Lessor and the
Lessee or their respective Surveyors in collaboration but if no agreement as to
the amount of the increase (if any) to be made in the said



                                      -23-
<PAGE>   24




yearly rent shall have been reached between the parties within the months after
the date of the Lessor's notice calling for such review the question whether
there shall be an increase in the said yearly rent and if so what will be the
amount of the increased yearly rent shall be referred at the request of either
party to the decision of an independent Surveyor (who shall act and be deemed
to act as an expert and not as an arbitrator) to be appointed (in default of
agreement between the parties) on the request of either party by the President
for the time being of the Royal Institution of Chartered Surveyors and whose
fees shall be borne and paid by the parties hereto in such shares and in such
manner as the said Surveyor shall determine;

         (e) Should the amount of the increase (if any) to be made in the said
yearly rent not be agreed or decided before the review date in question the
Lessee shall pending such agreement or decision continue to pay rent at the rate
for the time being applicable and subject to review and on such agreement or
decision being reached or made any necessary adjustment shall forthwith be made
retrospectively in favour of the Lessor from such review date and the difference
between the amount of rent actually received and the amount so due to the Lessor
in respect of the period down to the date of payment of such difference to the 


                                      -24-
<PAGE>   25
Lessor shall be paid by the Lessee to the Lessor on the due date for payment of
rent next following the demand made;

         (f) The Lessor and the Lessee HEREBY MUTUALLY COVENANT that if and
whenever it shall be agreed or decided that the yearly rent payable hereunder
shall be increased they shall if required by and at the expense of the Lessor
forthwith execute a Deed supplemental hereto specifying and confirming the
revised rent payable hereunder and that with affect from the relevant review
date the Lessee will pay the yearly rent as so varied; and

         (g) Should any such review at any time be restrained or restricted by
any Act of Parliament instrument regulation order or public or local policy
than upon the same being raised relaxed or modified and on every such occasion
the Lessor shall be at liberty to call for an intermediate review in manner
hereinbefore provided mutatis mutandis by not less than three months notice in
writing to the Lessee for which purpose the date of service of such notice
shall constitute the commencement of the review period and the date of
expiration thereof shall constitute the review date;

         (h) Notwithstanding the prior provisions of this Clause if the yearly
rent hereinbefore reserved and for the time being payable hereunder shall not
have been reviewed at a review date than the Lessor shall at any time thereafter
have the right to review the said rent upon giving to the


                                      -25-
<PAGE>   26



Lessee not less than one month's notice in writing of its intention so to do
and if the Lessor shall give to the Lessee a notice as aforesaid then from and
after the date therein specified (which shall be a date not earlier than one
month from the date of service of the said notice) the year rent shall be
increased to an amount which shall represent the commercial yearly rent of the
demised premises at the date specified in the said notion and the amount
thereof shall be agreed between the Lessor and the Lessee or determined in
accordance with sub-Clause (d) or this Clause;

         (2) Any notice shall be sufficiently serviced on the Lessee if left
addressed to the Lessee at the demised premises or the Lessee's last known
address or registered office or if it shall be sent by prepaid registered or
recorded delivery post addressed to the Lessee there. Any notice shall be
sufficiently served on the Lessor if left addressed or sent by prepaid
registered or recorded delivery post to it at its registered office. Any notice
sent by post as aforesaid shall be deemed to be received by the addressee at the
time when it ought in due course of post to be delivered and subject as
aforesaid the provisions of Section 195 of the Law of Property Act 1925 as
amended by the Recorded Delivery Service Act 1952 shall apply to all notices
hereunder;

         (3) If the rent hereby reserved or any part thereof shall be in arrear
for Twenty one days after the same shall become due (whether legally demanded or
not) or if there


                                      -26-
<PAGE>   27
shall be a breach of any of the covenants or agreements on part of the Lessee
or conditions contained in these presents or if the Lessee shall go into
liquidation (other than a voluntary liquidation for the purpose of amalgamation
or reconstruction) or have a winding up order made against it or shall enter
into a composition with its creditors have a Receiving Order made against it or
be adjudicated a bankrupt or if the Lessee shall suffer any distress or
execution to be levied on the demised premises or the contents thereof or shall
take the benefit of any Act for the relief of debtors then and in any such case
the Lessor or its agents may forthwith (or at any time thereafter) re-enter
upon the demised premises or any part thereof in the name of the whole
whereupon the said term shall absolutely determine without prejudice to any
rights of the Lessor in respect of arrears of rent or other subsisting breach
of any condition or covenant or agreement on the part of the Lessee.

         I N  W I T N E S S  whereof the Lessor and  the Lessee have caused
their respective Common Seals to be hereunto affixed the day and year first
above written.

         THE FIRST SCHEDULE above referred to

         ALL THAT piece of parcel of land situate in the Parish of Chesham in
the County of Buckinghamshire having frontages on the northerly side to
Nashleigh Hill on the westerly side to Preston Hill and in part on the southerly
side to Cherry Tree Walk formerly known as Nashleigh Works but now known 


                                      -27-
<PAGE>   28
as The Childrens Centre Nashleigh Hill Chesham all which piece or parcel of land
comprises 1.75 acres or thereabouts and is shown for identification only edged
red on the plan annexed hereto.

         THE SECOND SCHEDULE above referred to
         -------------------------------------

         This demise is subject to and with the benefit (so far as applicable)
of the covenants conditions and provisions contained in a Conveyance dated 13th
May 1984 and made between Nora May Day of the one part and Allied Ironfounders
Limited of the other part.

                                        (THE COMMON SEAL of DRAWHEATH
                                        (LIMITED was hereunto affixed
                                        (in the presence of:




                                         Director




                                         Secretary


                                      -28-
<PAGE>   29


                                [INSERT GRAPH 1]
<PAGE>   30
                                        DATED    1st           1978
                                        ---------------------------


                                            DRAWHEATH LIMITED

                                                  -to-


                                        THE PENINSULAR AND ORIENTAL
                                        STEAM NAVIGATION COMPANY
                                        ---------------------------






                                                  L E A S E

                                                     -of-


                                             Nashleigh Works, Nashleigh
                                             Hill, Chesham, Buckinghamshire.
                                             -------------------------------

<PAGE>   1


                               TENANCY AGREEMENT

         The undersigned: Mr. N.W. Dijkhuizen, acting in this case in his
capacity as director of the Stichting Pensioanfonds Produktschappen
Voedselvoorsiening (Pension Fund Foundation for Food Supply Commodity Boards),
domiciled at The Hague, Duinweg 25, and as such legally representing this
Foundation,

to be named hereinafter lessor,

and Mr N. de Jager, M.Sc., acting in this case in his capacity as director of
the private company Koninklijke Pabriek Inventum B.V., having its seat at
Bilthoven, Lijenseveg 101, and as such legally representing this private
company,


to be named hereinafter tenant,

declare having made a tenancy agreement on 15th December 1988 with regard to:

office/industrial building under construction, in conformity with the attached
brief technical description dated 19th December 1989 by Esbouw
Projectmanagement B.V., ref.: Es/ar/8825/18, initialled by the parties, letters
dated 16th January 1989 ref.: Es/aj/8825/05 and 12th April 1989 ref.:
Es/aj/8825/05 from Esbouw to Inventum B.V., the drawings of the firm of
architects Alberts en van Huut B.V., numbers 88027-W01 up to and including W07,
dated 19th December 1989, and the construction drawing(s) of High Tech
Raadgevende Ingenieurs b.v. (High Tech Consulting Engineers b.v.), nr.: 88290
pages A and B, dated 30th March 1989, as well as the adjoining building plot of
about 1,555 m2 of surface standing and situated on Parkerbann 20 at Nieuvegein,
as indicated by red shading in so far as the office/industrial building is
concerned, and by yellow shading in respect of the building plot (see attached
ground plan(s)), all this well known to the parties.

to be named hereinafter the property hired

as well as the drawings by Hoogendoorn B.V., dated 14-12-1989, the pages
1-01-1-2 and the drawings of Radiar B.V. (air conditioning system) P.12863A
dated 14-12-1989, P.12863 B, P.12863 F, P.12863 EZ, P.12863 E and the drawing
Compressed Air Line ground floor dated 18-12-1989. Drawings of the Electische
Installatie (electric installation) Sielman B.V., dated 20-11-1989, pages 1 up
to and including 3, and the drawings KO-1, Hk1-2 K1-3, LO-1 dated 20-11-1989.



Tenant's initials:                                    Lessor's initials:


                                      -1-
<PAGE>   2
         Furthermore, they have agreed upon the following:

GENERAL

         1.1 This contract commits the undersigned to comply with statutory
provisions, as well as with local regulations and customs, with regard to
letting and hiring, to the extent that it does not deviate from them.

         1.2 This contract forms an integral part of the general terms and
conditions deposited at the office of the court at Utrecht on 10th April 1984,
where registered under number 230/84.

         The undersigned declare having received a copy thereof and to be fully
familiar with its contents.

         These general terms and conditions are held to verbally form part of
this contract and are binding upon the undersigned, subject to any explicit
deviation therefrom in the clauses to be expressed below, or if application
thereof is not feasible with regard to the property hired.

TENANCY - OPTION AND EXTENSION

         2.1. This contract has been made for the period of 5 years commencing
on 1st December 1989 and expiring on 30th November 1994.

         2.2 Tenant is entitled to 5 optional years, commencing on 1st December
1994 and thus expiring on 30th November 1999. Tenant is held to use his right
of option, unless he notifies the lessor by registered letter with
acknowledgement of receipt or writ that he does not want to use this right, at
least 12 months before the above date of commencement, thus before or on 30th
November 1993.



Tenant's initials:                                   Lessor's initials:

                                      -2-
<PAGE>   3
RENT

         3.1. The initial rent shall amount to NLG 324,682.--, in words: three
hundred twenty four thousand six hundred eighty two guilders per year excluding
V.A.T., payable in advance in 4 instalments, each of 3 months, each amounting to
NLG 81,170.50 excluding V.A.T., the first being due on 1st January 1990, without
prejudice to what is laid down in clause 4. The above initial rent includes the
rent of the adjoining building plot of about 1,555 m2 area, as well as the rent
increase covering the additional work and the reduced amount of work carried out
at the tenant's request for the lessor's account, as specified on the enclosed
list dated 19th December, 1989. The letters dated 16th January 1989 ref.:
Es/aj/8825/05 from Esbouv to Inventum B.V. and dated 25th April 1989 nr.: 1050
from the lessor to Inventum B.V. is hereby annulled, however only as regards the
financial consequence already worked up in the above list.

         In view of the commencement date of this contract, the first payment
shall be made covering the period from 1st December 1989 till 1st January 1990,
and amounts to NLG 27,056.80 excluding V.A.T., in words: twenty seven thousand
fifty six guilders and eighty cents.

         Any appeal for a discount or a set-off against a claim which the tenant
believes to have or may obtain against the lessor, shall be ruled out.

         3.2. On the other hand the lessor and the tenant mutually agree that
the lessor shall charge the tenant for value added tax on the rent referred to
in paragraph 1.

Adaptation and Revision of rent

         4. The rent referred to in paragraph 1 of clause 3 shall be adjusted
each year, for the first time as at 1st December 1990, in accordance with what
is laid down in clauses IIC and IID of the general terms and conditions, on the
understanding that the rent shall never be lower than the initial rent.



Tenant's initials:                                   Lessor's initials:


                                      -3-
<PAGE>   4



SERVICE CHARGE

5.1.  The tenant shall owe to the lessor, each time payable 3 months in advance,
      an amount of NLG 2,500.--, in words: two thousand five hundred guilders
      per quarter excluding V.A.T. by way of advance to be settled on account
      against the cost of the following marked supplies and services:

*     maintenance and periodic inspection of heating system(s). 
*     maintenance and periodic inspection of (mechanical) exhaust system(s) 
*     maintenance and periodic inspection of triple mechanical ventilation 
*     maintenance and periodic inspection of lift installation 
*     maintenance of premises, gardens, drainage, including replacement of 
      plants 
*     clerical expenses of 5%.

5.2. if a tenant is debited for service charge V.A.T. shall be payable.

USE

         6. The property hired is exclusively destined for use as
office/industrial accommodation for the purpose of operations being carried out
by the tenant, as described in the attached copy of extract from the Register of
Business Names of the Chamber of Commerce.

SECURITY

         7. On signing this contract the tenant shall make available to the
lessor a bank guarantee of NLG 96,000.--, in words: ninety six thousand guilders
including V.A.T.


Tenant's initials:          Lessor's initials:               

                                      -4-
<PAGE>   5
LIABILITY
         B.1. The lessor shall not be liable for the consequences of apparent or
latent defects to the property hired, nor for consequential loss to the tenant,
nor for damage to persons or property of the tenant or of any third party, nor
for any other damage whatsoever, except in the case of damage due to the
condition of the property hired, to the extent that the lessor can in such case 
be blamed for gross negligence.

         B.2. The tenant shall indemnify the lessor against any third party
claim in respect of damage to people or goods present in the property hired,
caused as a consequence of any defect as described above.

CHARGES PUBLIC UTILITIES 
         9. Any charge connected with the supply and use of water, gas and
electricity including standing charges in the property hired, shall run for the
tenant's account, as also any expense connected with a transformer unit, if
required, or with the reinforcing of the existing unit. The respective charges
shall be paid by the tenant directly to the relevant utilities.
 
SPECIAL REGULATIONS
Commencement date payment of rent e.g. of service charges

         The rent and the service charges shall be due as at 1st December 1989.

Tenant's initials:                                     Lesssor's initials:

                                      -5-
<PAGE>   6
DELIVERY DATES AND DELIVERY/INSPECTION REPORT

         The property hired shall be delivered on 19th December 1999.

         On delivery of the property hired by the lessor to the tenant, the
lessor and the tenant shall arrange for the property hired to be inspected to
ascertain whether the property hired has been delivered in conformity with the
attached appendices. The tenant shall not refuse to sign the inspection report
on unreasonable grounds.

         The lessor shall repair to the tenant's satisfaction the
shortcomings/defects recorded in the inspection report, if possible within 30
days from date of inspection.

         The inspection report shall serve as delivery report on expiry of the
tenancy agreement, on the understanding that in the case of shortcomings/defects
the inspection report to be drawn up on completion of repairs shall be accepted
as such.


Tenant's initials:                                   Lessor's initials:


                                      -6-
<PAGE>   7
RIGHT TO PURCHASE

         a. Should the tenant, during the currency of this tenancy agreement,
but latest before 30th November 1994, wish to proceed to buy the property hired
sufficiently well known to the parties, the tenant shall be entitled to
purchase.

         b. If intending to buy the property hired, the tenant shall notify the
lessor of his decision to use his right to purchase, latest within 30th November
1994 by registered letter send to the lessor. Then, notwithstanding a
termination of hire as referred to in paragraph 2 of clause 2, the present
tenancy contract shall remain in full force until the date of transfer.

         Such purchase shall take place at the market value of the property
hired then prevailing, increased by V.A.T., on the understanding that same shall
at no time be lower than the cost of acquisition paid by the lessor, which to
include also the cost increased by V.A.T. for the technical and/or architectural
facilities supplied at the tenant's request, to the extent that same shall not
yet have been paid out of the rental.

         This market value shall be fixed by three estate agents. Of these three
agents one shall be appointed by each of the parties within a fortnight from the
date on which either of the parties shall have received a respective request
from the other party.

         A third agent shall be nominated by the two agents within eight days
from the date of acceptance of their appointment.

         The judgment passed by the third agent shall be decisive failing
agreement among the agents on the market value to be established.

         If either of the parties fails to nominate an estate agent or failing
the two nominated agents to agree on the appointment of a third agent, then the
willing party could ask the chairman of the Chamber of Commerce and Factories of
the district in which the estate is located, to nominate, in the first instance,
two estate agents and, in the second instance, one agent. The fees of the agents
shall be borne by the parties on a fifty-fifty basis. The agents shall issue
their report within six weeks from their definite nomination.

         The charges and transfer tax due on the sale and delivery of the
property hired/sold shall run for the tenant's/buyer's account.


Tenant's initials:                                   Lessor's initials:


                                      -7-
<PAGE>   8




The tenant/buyer now for then irrevocably authorizes the lessor/vendor to lodge
on his behalf a petition of option because of taxed delivery. If the petition is
not granted, or if, due to the tenant's/buyer's failure, the petition is not
lodged or lodged too late, the selling price shall be increased by the amount of
the V.A.T., which would have been due had the petition been granted c.q.
(timely) lodged.

         c. If the tenant uses his right to purchase, the deed of conveyance
shall be executed as soon as possible before a civil law notary to be nominated
by the lessor; such deed shall contain the terms and conditions normally
included by this civil law notary in deeds of conveyance. The purchase price and
whatever to which the tenant, as purchaser, shall be bound, shall be settled by
the latter when passing the deed, on pain of forfeiture of any preferential
right and without prejudice to the lessor's rights to damages.

         d. The lessor shall not be empowered to sell the property hired to any
third party within the above period of time, thus before 30th November 1994,
unless with the tenant's consent.

         e. Failing the tenant to make use of his right to purchase, the right
to purchase shall become extinct and the lessor shall be free to sell the
property hired to a third party on expiry of the above period, thus from 1st
December 1994, while the tenant shall continue to be bound to his tenancy
agreement, without prejudice to what is laid down in clauses 2.1. 2.2. and 4.

         f. Any notification referred to above shall be made by registered
letter, of which only the date shall be decisive.

         g. Under this clause by sale it is understood that assets brought in or
transferred/sold within companies also belonging to the lessor's concern, shall
not be included.



Tenant's initials:             Lessor's initials:            


                                      -8-
<PAGE>   9
CLAUSE IV PARAGRAPH C:

         Contrary to what is laid down in Paragraph C of clause IV of the
General Terms and Conditions, the parties agree on the following: The words "or
his legal predecessor"  shall be annulled.

CLAUSE V PARAGRAPH C:

         Contrary to what is laid down in Paragraph C of Clause V of the General
Terms and Conditions, the parties agree on the following: the first line from
"Without" up to and including "lend", shall be annulled and replaced by the
following:

SUBLET

The tenant has obtained the lessor's permission to lend or sublet the property
hired wholly or partially to group companies, provided:

              a.  such group companies, are, in the lessor's judgement,
         sufficiently solvent.

              b.  no regulations and conditions are stipulated with group
         companies that are in conflict with those laid down in this contract.

              c.  the time of hiring in the sublet agreements coincides with the
         time of hiring of this contract.

              d.  if the right involved is used, the tenant informs the lessor
         of the names of the group companies and the conditions stipulated.

         The lessor's consent shall not be refused for other than objectively
business-inspired reasons.

Tenant's initials:                                           Lessor's initials:
                                      -9-
<PAGE>   10
CLAUSE V PARAGRAPH E:

         Contrary to what is laid down in Paragraph E of clause V of the
General Terms and Conditions, the parties agree on the following: Instead of
the first and second sentences shall be read:

         The lessor grants permission to the tenant to provide advertisements
and/or signs on the following conditions and without prejudice to what is
otherwise stipulated in this tenancy agreement, namely:

- -    if available, the plans and/or the specification on the subject shall be
     submitted to the lessor for his approval;

- -    the tenant shall ensure that the required licence(s) and/or exemption(s),
     if required, are obtained; its/their refusal or withdrawal shall not at any
     time cause the annulment or nullification of the tenancy agreement nor any
     other action against the lessor; the tenant shall be liable to ensure that
     in executing the works any pertinent requisites imposed or to be imposed
     by the authorities are complied with;

- -    any costs and risks, including the risk of underinsurance, connected with
     the advertisements and/or signs to be provided to the property hired,
     shall run for the tenant's account;

- -    if, consequent upon the advertisements and/or signs provided, the premium
     of the fire insurance of the property hired and/or properties adjoining
     should be increased, such increase shall run for the tenant's account;

- -    any damage c.q. consequential damage, maintenance, renewal, repairs and
     liability claims of third parties with regard to the advertisements and/or
     signs provided shall be for the tenant's rink and account;

- -    the relevant advertisements and/or signs provided by the tenant in, to
     and/or on the property hired, shall, on expiry of the tenancy (be causes
     to) be removed by the tenant.

         The 3rd sentence shall be read as follows "shall (fit) non relevant
aerials and piping on or to the property hired".



Tenant's initials:                                         Lessor's initials:

                                      -10-



 
 

<PAGE>   11
OF THE GENERAL TERMS AND CONDITIONS THE FOLLOWING CLAUSES SHALL NOT BE
APPLICABLE:

Clause I

Clause II Paragraph E:

Clause IX

Clause X

MADE in triplicate and signed on 19th December 1989.

TENANT:                            LESSOR:
Koninklijke Fabrick Inventur       Stichting Pensioenfonds
B.V.                               Produktschappen Voednel-
                                   voorsiening

sgd.: illegible                    sgd.: illegible

Nr N. de Jager                     Mr N.W. Dijkhuisen

                                      -11-
<PAGE>   12
                          GENERAL TERMS AND CONDITIONS

I.   GENERAL: lodged at the office of the court of Utrecht on 10th April 1984,
              where registered under number 230/84.

         The Lessor guarantees that the consent required for this tenancy
agreement has been obtained from the mortgagees.

II.  RENT

         A. The rent shall be paid in legal Dutch currency or by remittance into
a bank or Girobank account to be indicated by the lessor. Payment shall be made
such as to enable the lessor to dispose of the money latest on the due date of
the respective instalment of rent. 

         B. Whenever it is agreed that value added tax shall be charged, the
following shall apply;

_    The tenant irrevocably authorizes the lessor to lodge the petition, also in
     his, the tenant's, name, referred to in subsection b, fifth, of paragraph 1
     of section 11 of the 1968 Sales Tax Act, to the effect that value added tax
     may be charged on the rent referred to in paragraph 1 clause 3 of the
     tenancy agreement.

_    In the event the lessor proves that dismissal of the above petition is due
     to the tenant, the rent shall be increased by the amount of value added tax
     that would be payable if the petition had been granted.

     The same shall apply if the petition is granted as at a later date than the
     date asked for, albeit only for the period expiring on the date of
     commencement of the taxed letting.

_    In the event the tenant proves that dismissal of the petition is due to the
     lessor, the rent referred to in paragraph 1 of clause 3 of the tenancy
     agreement shall not be increased by value added tax.

_    The value added tax due shall be paid simultaneously with the rent. In the
     event of a sale of the property hired by the lessor, the new owner and
     tenant shall be bound to what has been agreed between the lessor and the
     tenant with regard to the value added tax, unless the new owner and tenant
     should agree to the contrary.



Tenant's initials:                                   Lessor's initials:        

                                      -1-




<PAGE>   13
         c. The annual adjustment of the rent shall take place in accordance
with the modification of the price-index figure of family consumption, series of
wage-earning families having in 1985 a family income below the maximum wage
level for entitlement to national health insurance, fixed by the Central
Statistical Office on the most recent time basis. The new rent shall be obtained
each time by multiplying the current rent in force until the date of adjustment
of this ruling rent by a factor to be obtained by dividing the average
price-index figure of the calendar year preceding the date of adjustment of the
rent by the average price-index figure of the calendar year preceding the date
of commencement of the then prevailing rent and by rounding off the figure so
obtained to three decimal places.

Consequently,   the new rent shall be: price-index figure for the calendar 
                year preceding the date of commencement of the new rent

prevailing rent X ____________________________________________________________
                price-index figure for the calendar year preceding the date
                of commencement of the rent in force. 

         D. If the Central Statistical Office suspends the announcement of the
said price-index figure or changes the basis of its calculation, a possibly
comparable index figure shall be applied.

In the case of difference of opinion on this matter, the willing party may ask
the Central Statistical Office for a judgment that shall be binding upon the
parties. Any expenses connected therewith shall be borne by the parties on a
fifty-fifty basis.



Tenant's initials:                                 Lessor's initials:         
 
                                      -2-
 
<PAGE>   14
         E. If either of the parties wants to make use of the power to revise
the rent, he shall notify the other party accordingly by registered letter with
acknowledgement of receipt latest six months prior to the date on which the
revision shall become effective. Failing the parties to come to an
understanding within two months from receipt of the notice referred to above,
the rent shall be fixed by three estate agents, members of the Dutch
Association of Estate Agents NVM. Of these three agents each party shall
nominate one within a fortnight from the date on which a party shall have
received a request to this end from the other party.

The third agent shall be nominated by these two agents within eight days from
their acceptance of the nomination. The judgment of third agent shall be
decisive failing agreement between the agents on the rent to be fixed.

Failing one of the parties to nominate an agent or failing both nominated agents
to agree on the nomination of a third agent, the willing party may ask the
nomination from the chairman of the Chamber of Commerce and Factories of the
district in which the estate is located, in the first instance of the two agents
and in the second instance of one agent. The agents' fees shall be borne by the
parties on a fifty-fifty basis. The agents shall issue their report within six
weeks from definite nomination.

III. SERVICE CHARGES

         A. The amount payable by the tenant in advance for the additional
supplies and services may before the time specified be modified by the lessor
on the basis of a reasonable calculation.



Tenant's initials:                                         Lessor's initials:
                                      -3-

<PAGE>   15
         B.  The tenant shall be obliged to supply the lessor each year with a
specified summary of the expenses referred to in the preceding paragraph.

         Any differential between the expenses actually incurred and the amounts
paid by the tenant by way of advance, shall be settled within one month from the
issue of the specified summary.

         C.  On giving notice to the tenant, the lessor may, if in the letter's
opinion there is a reason for it, extend, reduce or annul the supplies and
services both in terms of type and volume.

IV.  THE PROPERTY HIRED

         A.  The tenant shall arrange to obtain licences and/or exemptions, if
required, for the conduct of business, while their cancellation or withdrawal
can never cause the tenancy agreement to be annulled or nullified nor any other
action against the lessor.

         B.  If the lessor and/or co-tenant(s) should be charged with a higher
premium for fire insurance in connection with the nature and/or conduct of
tenant's business, the tenant shall refund to the lessor and/or co-tenant(s)
such extra premium calculated in respect of the aggregate insured sum.

The lessor shall be free in fixing the sum to be insured, in electing the
insurance company/companies and in judging the fairness of the premium due.

         C.  Any taxes and duties due for items fitted by the tenant or his
legal predecessor, the property tax for account of factual use as well as the
costs of water consumption shall run for the tenant's account, even to the
extent that the assessments c.q. invoices are made out in the name of the
lessor.

         D.  In the event any alterations and/or changes to or in the property
hired are necessary, whether or not on the strength of regulations made by the
authorities, in connection with the purpose described in clause 6 of the tenancy
agreement, than the provisions under paragraph D of clause V shall apply, the
expenses involved being for the tenant's account.



Tenant's initials:                                   Lessor's initials:        

                                      -4-




  
<PAGE>   16
V. THE USE

         A. The tenant declares to be sufficiently familiar with the property
hired, not requiring any further description thereof. The lessor shall not be
liable for the consequences of apparent or latent defects of the property hired.

Such defects shall also include the defective functioning or failure to
function of the piping and installations serving for the supply and discharge
of heat, water and electricity.

         B. The tenant shall use the property hired as a tenant should and in
conformity with the purpose stated in clause 6 of the tenancy agreement, while,
in addition, he shall, in line with this purpose, provide and keep it provided
with adequate inventory c.q. the required fittings and furniture. The tenant
shall not be free without written consent from the lessor, to change the
purpose of the property hired.

The tenant shall be obliged to take care that he, or any third party working
for his and/or any member of the household, causes no inconvenience to users of
the premises involved c.q. the adjoining premises. The tenant undertakes to
conduct his business as a tenant should.

         C. Without the previous written consent of the lessor, the tenant
shall not have the property hired used, neither wholly nor partly, by any third
party or sublet it to any third party.

In the event the tenancy rights fall under an undivided estate, the transfer of
the tenancy rights, following allotment in the case of partition of property,
shall take place only with previous written consent of the lessor. The tenant
shall, without the previous written consent from the lessor, be prohibited from
bringing any tenancy right under the present contract into a company,
partnership and the like, or from making use of his tenancy rights in each
company or partnership.


Tenant's initials:                                         Lessor's initials:
                                      -5-
<PAGE>   17
         D. The tenant shall not provide, change or remove anything in or to the
property hired, nor to the piping and discharge systems belonging to it, unless
with the previous explicit written consent of the lessor. The tenant shall be
liable to ensure that in carrying out the works, the pertinent requisites made
or to be made by the authorities are complied with, and also that any licences
required shall be obtained.

         Whatever the tenant shall have provided, changed or removed in or to
the property hired, and this entirely for his own risk and account, shall be
left intact by him on expiry of the tenancy without the tenant's right to claim
any corresponding compensation from the lessor.

         Any exception to this rule shall be valid only if, in granting the
consent referred to in the first sentence of this section, the lessor shall have
reserved his right to require the tenant, on expiry of the tenancy, to bring the
property hired in the condition in which it was on commencement of the tenancy
agreement.

         E. The tenant shall not provide any advertisements or signs without
having obtained the explicit written consent of the lessor.

         The lessor shall for himself and/or for third parties reserve the right
to provide advertisements to or on the property hired or the complex to which
the property hired belongs, to the extent that this shall not affect the
tenant's conduct of business c.q. causes him inconvenience.

         Without the explicit written consent of the lessor, no aerials and
piping shall be provided on or to the property hired. The tenant shall forfeit 
a penalty of NLG 250.-- for each day on which he maintains an aerial and/or 
a pipeline without the previous written consent of the lessor.

         The tenant shall ensure that no people are allowed on the roof and that
no objects are put on it.

         No items shall be provided in or to the property hired that may cause
damage to it.


Tenant's initials:                                 Lessor's initials:       

                                      -6-
<PAGE>   18
VI.  MAINTENANCE AND REPAIRS

         A. The tenant shall be obliged to continue keeping in proper state of
maintenance the object hired, including the sanitary jettings, which he has
accepted in good condition, with pipelines and discharge system, and to have the
chimneys swept for his account.

         The tenant shall, for his own account, substitute as soon as possible
by quite identical new panes, all glass panes of the property hired, including
plate glass windows or shop-windows, which should break or be damaged during the
tenancy.

         In the case of frost or snow the tenant shall take all steps to avoid
damage to the property hired or to property of any third party, in particular he
shall during frosty weather take all measures to prevent heating systems and/or
hot water plants (if and when available in the property hired), pipeline and
discharge systems from freezing. The tenant shall be liable for the proper and
professional maintenance and use of all facilities and installations existing in
or to the property hired.

         B. The repairs referred to in section 1619 of the Civil Code as
running for the tenant's account shall also include those to door/window
furniture, sanitary fittings, electric installation and gas plant, awnings,
partition walls, ceiling covering, as well as ventilating and airconditioning
plant(s) and central heating system(s) (including the renewal of radiator
cocks).

         In the event the lessor wants to institute investigations into the
advisability to have repairs carried out as referred to in clause 1591 of the
Civil Code, or if he wants to have such repairs prepared or carried out, or if
works have to be done on behalf of other tenants or occupants, the tenant shall
be obliged to give the lessor, or the person reporting to him in the name of the
lessor, as soon as possible but latest within 24 hours from receiving the notice
to be given to the tenant on the part of the lessor, access to this effect to
the property hired and to enable him to carry out the intended investigations
and/or the works deemed necessary by the lessor, without being entitled to make
any condition in this respect nor to require any consideration.

         This shall hold good regardless of the duration of such works.



Tenant's initials:                                   Lessor's initials:        

                                      -7-











<PAGE>   19
VII. DEFAULT

         A. If the tenant, on written demand, is in default in the fulfilment of
any obligation imposed on him by the law, the local regulations and customs
and/or the present contract, the lessor shall be entitled to notify him to
terminate the tenancy forthwith before expiry, without giving any further notice
or judicial interposition to this effect being required, so far as permitted by
law. Alternatively, in the event of the above demand, such notification may
already take place conditionally, namely if such demand is ignored.

         The costs of demand and notification shall run for the tenant's
account, the former also if on its receipt the tenant as yet complies with his
obligations.

         B. The tenant shall be bound to compensate the lessor for any damage
sustained by the latter due to the default and/or the termination of tenancy
before expiry referred to above, without prejudice to both parties' obligation
to meet with any liability that should occur for each of them until the expiry
of the tenancy.

         C. Any cost, both in and out of court, caused to the lessor by the
tenant's default against any of the clauses of this contract, shall run for the
tenant's account. Any extrajudicial costs running for the tenant's account,
shall, in the case of default in payment of the rent, be fixed by the parties
at at least 15% of the rent due for payment.

         D. In the case of non-payment of rent the lessor shall be entitled,
without any demand and/or giving further notice being required, to charge an
interest of 1% per month (or part of a month) on the rent in arrears.

         E. These stipulations shall leave intact the lessor's power to demand
at law, under the provisions of section 1302 of the Civil Code, annulment of
the tenancy agreement on the ground of default by the tenant, coupled with
indemnification and clearance of the property hired.



Tenant's initials:                                    Lessor's initials:        
                                      -8-


<PAGE>   20
VIII. SECURITY AND/OR BANK GUARANTEE

         A. The security c.q. bank guarantee shall serve as security:

- -    for whatever the tenant, under the present contract or its extension, if
     any, shall become due to the lessor or his successor(s) in title,
     (including any indemnification to be for the tenant's account as well as
     the interest and costs referred to in clause VII).

- -    as well as for any financial damage sustained by the lessor in the case of
     termination of the tenancy agreement before its expiry, due to the tenant's
     bankruptcy, to the extent that no recovery against the tenant and/or the
     estate shall be possible.

         B. If during the currency of the tenancy agreement the lessor is forced
to call on the security c.q. bank guarantee, the tenant shall pay same up as
soon as possible but anyway within two weeks.

         C. The bank guarantee shall remain valid until at least three months
from expiry of the tenancy agreement.

         D. No interest shall be paid on the security.

         E. The tenant shall not be entitled to require any amount due to the
lessor to be set off against the security.

         F. On expiry of the tenancy, the clearance and the delivery, the lessor
shall fix as soon as possible the amount of his claims, and, so far as possible
after setting off same against the security, pay over the balance of the
security to the tenant, c.q. give his consent to the tenant to withdraw the bank
guarantee.

IX. DELIVERY

         The tenant shall renounce the rights which he may enforce against the
lessor, in the event the latter is unable to place the property hired at the
tenant's disposal on the agreed date, provided this is due to any act or default
of a third party, if and to the extent that the lessor cannot reasonably be
blamed for this.




        
Tenant's initials:                                            Lessor's initials:




                                      -9-
<PAGE>   21




X.   APARTMENTS

         A. If, at the time of concluding the present tenancy agreement, the
property hired forms part of a building belonging to a cooperative society or
being split up in apartments, the tenant undertakes to comply with any
commitment resulting from the use and the rules and/or regulations.

         B. The tenant to be conversant with those rules and/or regulations and
to have received a copy thereof.

         C. If, during the currency of the present tenancy agreement, the
building, of which the property hired forms part, comes into the ownership of a
cooperative society or is split up into apartments, the tenant undertakes to
comply with all corresponding commitments resulting from the rules and/or
regulations, to the extent that some shall not be contrary to the provisions of
the present tenancy agreement.

XI.  TERMINATION OF THE TENANCY AND A POSSIBLE PURCHASE

         A. For a period of twelve months prior to termination of the tenancy,
and also in the case of an intended private or public sale, and at any rate from
the date on which notice of termination of the tenancy agreement is given, the
tenant shall be obliged to permit the property hired to be inspected from 14.00
to 16.00 hours on every Tuesday and Thursday, alternatively, if local customs so
require, on two other days of the week and, in addition, on the date of the
public sale, as well as to permit notices of the public sale, selling or letting
boards or notices being put up.

         B. On termination of the tenancy, the tenant shall be obliged to timely
vacate the property and, with due observance of clause V D, to place same in
good condition and properly cleaned at the lessor's disposal, as well as to hand
the keys over to the lessor.

         C. If, on termination of the tenancy, the lessor should not receive the
keys in time, he shall be entitled to gain entrance into the property hired at
the tenant's expense, without prejudice to the tenant's obligation to indemnify
him for any damage that should occur due to this failure.



Tenant's initials:                                  Lessor's initials:         

                                      -10-
<PAGE>   22
         D. Any items which the tenant should leave behind in the property hired
once the tenancy has expired, shall be deemed to have been abandoned by him to
the lessor.

         The lessor shall be entitled to dispose of such items as his property,
without being required to pay any corresponding compensation to the tenant or
without being accountable to him in this respect, without prejudice to the
lessor's right to remove such items at the tenant's expense.

XII. DOMICILE

         The tenant declares to continue electing domicile in the property hired
for any notices etc. which the lessor should wish to give in connection with the
execution of this agreement (including termination of the tenancy before expiry,
annulment and clearance).



Tenant's initials:                                    Lessor's initials:




                                      -11-
<PAGE>   23
                                               CHAMBER OF COMMERCE AND FACTORIES
                                               FOR UTRECHT AND DISTRICT


                                                             FILE NUMBER; 1132 0
                                                             PAGE              1

IN THE REGISTER OF BUSINESS NAMES OF THE CHAMBER OF COMMERCE AND FACTORIES FOR
UTRECHT AND DISTRICT IS ENTERED UNDER NUMBER 1132 THE COMPANY UNDER THE STYLE OF
KONINKLIJKE FABRIEK INVENTUM B.V.

LEGAL FORM  :  PRIVATE COMPANY

NAME OF THE COMPANY  :  KONINKLIJKE FABRIEK INVENTUM B.V.
PLACE OF BUSINESS  : DE BILT
DATE MEMORANDUM OF ASSOCIATION  :  22ND MAY 1915
DATE LATEST MODIFICATION ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION  :  2ND MARCH 1982

AUTHORIZED CAPITAL  :  NLG 5,000,000
SUBSCRIBED CAPITAL  :  NLG 2,802,000
PAID-UP CAPITAL     :  NLG 2,802,000

ADDRESS OF THE COMPANY  : LEYENSEWEG 101, 3721 BC BILTHOVEN

DATE OF ESTABLISHMENT OF THE COMPANY 22ND MAY 1915  :
2ND MARCH 1982.

DATE OF CONTINUATION OF THE COMPANY BY THE PRIVATE COMPANY  :
2ND MARCH 1982.

DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS:
MANUFACTURE OF INSTRUMENTS AND ELECTRIC DEVICES

PEOPLE EMPLOYED IN THE ENTIRE BUSINESS  :  CAT. 8 (100 UP TO AND INCLUDING 199
EMPLOYED PERSONS)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

MANAGEMENT:

????, DE, NICOLAAS, N.SC., RESIDING AT VOORSCHOTEN, NADURONEG 4,
BORN AT ???, ON 7TH AUGUST 1940
OF DUTCH NATIONALITY
COMMENCED DUTIES ON  :  15TH JANUARY 1989
TITLE OF THIS MANAGER  :  DIRECTOR
COMPETENT ALL BY HIMSELF (COMPETENT INDIVIDUALLY)

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

SUPERVISORY DIRECTORS:

(???)     20TH JANUARY 1989
<PAGE>   24
                                               CHAMBER OF COMMERCE AND FACTORIES
                                               FOR UTRECHT AND DISTRICT


                                                             FILE NUMBER: 1132 0
                                                             PAGE              2


BRINK, VAN DEN, GIJSBERTUS, LL.M., RESIDING AT HILVERSUM, PARKLAAN 7; BORN AT
ZEIST, ON 3OTH MAY 1946 DUTCH NATIONALITY COMMENCED DUTIES ON: 26TH OCTOBER 1987
OFFICE: SUPERVISORY DIRECTOR

BRINKERT, JACOB WILLEM, M.SC., RESIDING AT LEUSDEN, GEULNIJK 12, BORN AT THE
HAGUE ON 15TH DECEMBER 1931 DUTCH NATIONALITY COMMENCED DUTIES ON: 15TH JANUARY
1989 OFFICE: SUPERVISORY DIRECTOR

- ---------------------------------------------------------------------

PERSON(S) HOLDING A POWER OF ATTORNEY:

???; HENDRIKUS, FREDERIKUS, ANTONIUS, RESIDING AT HUSSOM, JANSLAAN, ST. ??, BORN
AT HUSSUM ON 13TH JULY 1954 DUTCH NATIONALITY COMMENCED DUTIES ON: 7TH MARCH
1988 TITLE OF THIS DEPUTY MANAGER: HEAD OF FINANCIAL DEPARTMENT LIMITED POWER OF
ATTORNEY (SEE FILE OF REGISTER OF BUSINESS NAMES)

VALID ONLY IF PROVIDED BY THE CHAMBER WITH AN ORIGINAL SIGNATURE.

                           UTRECHT, 20TH JANUARY 1989
                       WE CERTIFY THIS TO BE A TRUE COPY
                           OF ITS ORIGINAL SEEN BY US
sgd.: illegible
<PAGE>   25
                                                                FILE NUMBER 1132

                       CHAMBER OF COMMERCE AND FACTORIES

                            FOR UTRECHT AND DISTRICT




EXTRACT FROM THE REGISTER OF BUSINESS NAMES


APPENDIX WITH REGARD TO THE SUBSIDIARY ESTABLISHMENTS:
- ------------------------------------------------------

Trade name               :    Koninklijke Fabriek Inventum B.V.
Present business         :    Factory of instruments and electric devices.
Place of business        :    Wolvega, Weststellingwerf municipality,
                              Industrieweg 15.
Date of establishment    :    15th July 1957.






                           Utrecht, 20th January 1989

                       WE CERTIFY THIS TO BE A TRUE COPY
                           OF ITS ORIGINAL SEEN BY US

                                agd.: illegible


               Only valid if provided with an original signature.
<PAGE>   26
[INSERT GRAPH 2]
<PAGE>   27
ESBOUW

Inventum B.V.                                                      En/aj/8825/05
Postbus 4
3720 AA BILTHOVEN
Attention: Mr J.W. Brinkert


Re: Newbuilding office with industrial accommodation at Nieuwegein-Plettenburg.


Woarden, 15th January 1988

Dear Mr Brinkert,

Enclosed herewith is the summary of the additional work as discussed at
Bilthoven on 16-12-1988, on which we already had a preliminary discussion with
the investor and on which which we have offered.

The offer now in the hands of the investor includes the following additional
works:

Architectural
Amendment plan in respect of our offer
dated 16-06-1988, according to drawing 88027-D0-1
dated 14-12-1988, including additional costs

                    Extra rent totalling                           NLG 34,500.00

Installations (excl. transformers c.a.)
Electrical equipment connection machinery,
mechanical exhaustion and pickling shop,
extension central heating system in connection
with several rooms, higher temperatures and
extra groups.
Provisional sum plumbing and electrics on
behalf of the laboratory in the amount of 
NLG 16,500.-- excluding V.A.T.
Triple mechanical ventilation top cooling
prepared by means of empty cooler section.
Drawings and calculations installation
consultant.

                    Extra rent totalling                           NLG 29,500.00

Total extra rent architecture and installation                     NLG 64,000.00





<PAGE>   28
E S B O U W


The total rent excluding acquisition of extra land:

offer dated 16th June 1988            NLG 216,000.00 excl.v.a.t.p.a.
additional work dated 16th Dec.1988   NLG  64,000.00 excl.v.a.t.p.a.
                                      --------------
Total rent                            NLG 280,000.00 excl.v.a.t.p.a.

The acquisition of about 1,555 m2 of extra land will entail, as indicated in the
letter of intent dated 15th December 1988, an extra rent of NLG 24,750.--
excl.v.a.t.p.a.

As advised by us on 16-12-1988, any extra regulations to be imposed by the
authorities and/or public utilities, and also any additional requirement on your
part, both from an architectural and installation-technical point of view, have
not been included.

On acceptance of the aforegoing by the investor, the latter will conclude a
tenancy agreement with you, with due observance of the above letter of intent.

The building scheme has already been lodged by us with the municipal authorities
for the purpose of obtaining the building licence.

We trust that the above information will be satisfactory for your purpose and
will visit you at 09.00 hours on 27th January 1989 for a co-ordinating meeting.


Yours faithfully,

Esbouw Projectmanagement B.V.

sgd.: illegible

H. Esschandal


                                      -2-
<PAGE>   29
E S B O U W


Inventum B.V.                                                      Es/aj/8825/08
Postbus 4
3720 AA BILTHOVEN
Attention: Mr J.B.A. van Wijk


Re: Newbuilding industrial building Inventair at Nieuwegein.


Woarden, 12th April 1989

Dear Mr van Wijk,

With reference to our statement made during the meeting of 16th December 1988
that the amendments required by you, as reproduced on the drawing no. 88027-DO-1
dated 14-12-1988, had still to be looked into by our designer to establish their
consequences, we have now pleasure in enclosing the construction drawings no.
88290 pages A and B dated 16-03-89 and 15-03-1989.

Due to the changed column lay-out in connection with the routing and machine
scheduling as well as the addition of the extra intermediate floors and the
fitting of a roof structure on behalf of the mechanical ventilation, the
quantity of steel has increased by approximately 35,000 kilos.

The extra charge involved will in terms of annual rent amount to NLG 8,850. -
excluding V.A.T.

We Trust that the above information will be sufficient for your purpose.

Yours faithfully,

Esbouw Projectmanagement B.V.

egd.: illegible

H. Esschandal


c.c.: SPPV, Mr. N.W. Dijkuizen.                   
<PAGE>   30
         Appendix belonging to the tenancy agreement between

         1. STICHTING PENSIOENFONDS PRODUKTSCHAPPEN VOEDSELVOORZIENING, to be
named hereinafter the lessor, and


         2. KONINKLIJKE FABRIEK INVENTUM B.V., to be named hereinafter the
tenant, dated 15th December 1988 covering the office/ industrial building to be
developed, together with the adjoining building plot of about 1,555 m2 surface
in the zoning plan Plattenburg-De Wiers at Nieuwegein, sufficiently well known
to the parties.

Whereas:

- -    a purchase contract was signed on 19th December 1988 between the lessor and
     the Nieuwegein municipality with regard to a plot of industrial premises of
     about 4,255 m2, located in the zoning plan Plattenburg -De Wiers, known as
     Jutphaas municipality, section D, nr. 1881 and 1882 (partially), on part of
     which the aforesaid office/industrial building will be errected;

- -    the following commitments imposed by the municipality are applicable to the
     present tenancy agreement, for which reference is made to the aforesaid
     purchase contract, in which, among other things, it is stated verbally as
     follows:

Clause 9 (use):

         The purchased property, including the completed buildings referred to
under a of clause B, shall be used exclusively for the exercise of industrial
purposes.



Tenant's initials:                                   Lessor's initials:
<PAGE>   31
CLAUSE II (tolerating commitment):

         The purchaser shall accept that piles, cables, wires, insulators,
rosettes, designatory boards and pipelines for public purposes are fitted and
maintained on, in, at or over the purchased property and the buildings to be
erected on it, in places where and the manner in which manner the mayor and
aldermen shall deem it necessary; regarding the said places and in which manner
previous consultations shall be held with the purchaser. The purchaser shall be
obliged to leave intact whatsoever is fitted on the strength of this
stipulation.

CLAUSE 12 (rights in rem):

         The parties undertake to mutually grant, in the notarial deed of
conveyance c.q. by separate instrument(s), the power of attorney to create any
such easement c.q. right in rem, including those referred to in subsection b,
paragraph 3, section 5 of Hindrance Act Private Law, at the expense of/to the
benefit of the adjoining premises remaining the property of the municipality,
c.q. the sold property, which easements c.q. rights in rem are deemed necessary
by the municipality c.q. the purchaser, among other things, due to the nature,
location and construction of the building complex.

CLAUSE 14 (parking):

         For his own use and for visitors the purchaser shall - without
prejudice to what is laid down in this respect in the municipal building law -
realize and maintain on his own premises, built-in or built-out, adequate
parking places. Discharging and loading and any other forwarding activities
shall take place on his own premises.


Tenant's initials:                                    Lessor's initials:
<PAGE>   32
CLAUSE 16 (retail trade):

The purchaser undertakes towards the municipality not to afford facilities on
the property purchased or part of it, for performing any acts of retail trade
nor for causing them to be performed. By acts of retail trade shall be
understood: to offer for sale, including sales display, to sell and/or supply
goods, in the ordinary course of business, to the ultimate consumer and/or user.

CLAUSE 17 (perpetual clauses):

         a. Unless the mayor and aldermen have permitted to deviate from what is
laid down in this clause, any clause of this agreement, in so far as such clause
has not lost its effect by its nature and currency, shall be imposed with each
whole or partial alienation of the property purchased and of the buildings to be
erected on it, each creation of real rights of enjoyment on it, each letting and
giving the free use, in favour of any successor in ownership or claimant of the
real right of enjoyment, on pain of a penalty up to the amount of the purchase
money, payable by the offender to the municipality forthwith, without any notice
of default or judicial interposition being required, by the mere fact of a
default against or non-compliance with such clause, all this in favour of
Nieuwegein municipality, which accepts these clauses already now for then and
expresses to insist on their observance.

         Such amount shall be paid within a fortnight from receiving a written
demand to this effect from the mayor and aldermen, an the understanding that at
no time any explicit notion giving shall be required.

         b. All conditions stipulated above together with this clause shall
continue to apply also to reconstruction and repairs of the property sold to
the extent that such time the conditions are still in force.


Tenant's initials:                                    Lessor's initials:

 
<PAGE>   33
CLAUSE 18 (penalty clause):

         In the case of non-compliance with or default against of the clauses of
this purchase contract or of the instruments resulting therefrom, the mayor and
aldermen of Nieuwegein municipality may impose upon the purchaser c.q. his
successors in title a penalty of NLG 10,000.-- (ten thousand guilders) for each
default or non-compliance and of NLG 1,000.-- (one thousand guilders) for each
day or apart of a day on which such default or non-compliance continues, without
any notice giving or demand being required , by the mere fact of such default or
non-compliance, without prejudice to the municipality's right to demand
compliance and indemnification over and above the penalties.

         The penalty shall be due and payable forthwith and shall be forfeited
by the mere fact of the non-compliance or default itself or by the mere expiry
of the period of time stipulated, without any notice giving being required, all
this without prejudice to the right to demand repairs, modification or removal
of what has taken place contrary to what is laid down in this contract; in case
the municipality's demand for repairs or removal is not fulfilled within the
period of time fixed by the mayor and aldermen in a notice issued to this
effect, the required repairs, modification or removal of what has taken place
contrary to what is laid down in this contract; in case the municipality's
demand for repairs or removal is not in a notice issued to this effect, the
required repairs, modification or removal may, without prejudice to what is
stipulated on the strength of the aforegoing, be affected by or on behalf of the
municipality, at the expense of the offender or his successors in title, and his
premises and buildings may be entered upon to this effect by persons designated
by the mayor and aldermen for the purpose.








Tenant's initials:                                            Lessor's initials:
<PAGE>   34
THE PARTIES DECLARE THE FOLLOWING:

         1. The lessor declares to impose on the tenant all clauses stated above
and to commit the latter to punctual observance of these clauses towards
Nieuvegein municipality.

         2. The tenant declares to be familiar with the clauses referred to and
to consider them as forming an integral part of the tenancy agreement and to
undertake punctual observance thereof towards Nieuwegein municipality, and the
lessor, now acting as voluntarily looking after the interests of Nieuwegein
municipality, accepts the aforegoing for and on behalf of this municipality.

MADE in triplicate and signed on 19th December 1989.

LESSOR:                                         TENANT:

Stichting pensionfonds                          Koninklijke fabriek
produktschappen voedsel-                        Inventum B.V.
voorziening

sgd.: illegible                                 sgd.: illegible

Mr. N.W. Dijkhuizen                             Mr. N. de Jager, M.Sc.    
<PAGE>   35


_______________________________________________________________________________

                         B & F PROPERTY MANAGEMENT B.V.
_______________________________________________________________________________


Inventum
Postbus 4
3720 AA BILTHOVEN


Amsterdam, 2nd September 1992

Re: adjustment rent Parkerbaan, of Nieuwegein.

Dear Sirs,

In accordance with what is laid down in the tenancy agreement signed with you in
respect of the above object, the rent will be adjusted every year on 1st
December on the basis of the price-index figure of family consumption, series of
wage-earning families, as published by the Central Statistical Office.

Proceeding from the clause included in the tenancy agreement we have calculated
the new yearly rent as follows:

- -    index figure calendar year 1991 - 107.7 (1985=100)
- -    index figure calendar year 1990 - 103.7 (1985=100)

New rent: 107.7/103.7 - 1.039 x NLG 336,456.17 = NLG 349,577.96

Per quarter: NLG 87,394.49.

The next rent invoices will be based directly on the new yearly rent.

We trust that our information is sufficient for your purpose.

Yours faithfully,

sgd.: illegible

B & F PROPERTY MANAGEMENT B.V.
<PAGE>   36
APPENDIX belonging to the tenancy agreement between


         1. STICHTING PENSIOENFONDS PRODUKTSCHAPPEN VOEDSELVOORZIENING, to be
named hereinafter the lessor, and

         2. KONINKLIJKE FABRIEN INVENTUM B.V., to be named hereinafter the
tenant, dated 15th December 1988 covering the office/industrial building to be
developed, together with the adjoining building plot of approximately 1,555 m2
surface, in the zoning plan Plettenburg-De Wiers at Nieuwegein, sufficiently
well known to the parties.

WHEREAS:

- --   a purchase contract was signed on 19th December 1988 between the lessor and
     Nieuwegein municipality with regard to a plot of industrial premises of
     about 4,255 m2, located in the zoning plan Plettenburg-De Wiers, known as
     Jutphaas municipality, section D, nr. 1881 and 1882 (partially), on part of
     which the aforesaid office/industrial building will be erected;

- --   the following commitments imposed by the municipality are applicable to the
     present tenancy agreement, for which reference is made to the aforesaid
     purchase contract, in which, among other things, it is stated verbally as
     follows:

CLAUSE 9 (use):

         The property purchased, including the completed buildings referred to
under a of clause 8, shall be used exclusively for the exercises of industrial
purposes.




Tenants's initials:                               Lessor's initials:

<PAGE>   37
CLAUSE II (tolerating commitment):

         The purchaser shall accept that piles, cables, wires, insulators,
rosettes, designatory boards and pipelines for public purposes are fitted and
maintained on, in, at or over the purchased property and the buildings to be
erected on it, in places where and the manner in which the mayor and aldermen
shall deem it necessary; regarding the said places and in which manner previous
consultations shall be held with the purchaser. The purchaser shall be obliged
to leave intact whatsoever is fitted on the strength of this stipulation.

CLAUSE 12 (rights in rem):

         The parties undertake to mutually grant, in the notarial deed of
conveyance c.q. by separate instrument(s), the power of attorney to create any
such easement c.q. right in rem, including those referred to in subsection b,
paragraph 3, section 5 of Hindrance Act Private Law, at the expense of/to the
benefit of the adjoining premises remaining the property of the municipality,
c.q. the sold property, which easements c.q. rights in rem are deemed necessary
by the municipality c.q. the purchaser, among other things, due to the nature,
location and construction of the building complex.

CLAUSE 14 (parking):

         For his own use and for visitors the purchaser shall - without
prejudice to what is laid down in this respect in the municipal building law -
realize and maintain on his own premises, built-in or built-out, adequate
parking places. Discharging and loading and any other forwarding activities
shall take place on his own premises.



Tenant's initials:                             Lessor's initials:        
<PAGE>   38
CLAUSE 16 (retail trade):

         The purchaser undertakes towards the municipality not to afford
facilities on the property purchased or part of it, for performing any acts of
retail trade nor for causing them to be preformed.

         By acts of retail trade shall be understood: to offer for sale,
including sales display, to sell and/or supply goods, in the ordinary course of
business, to the ultimate consumer and/or user.

CLAUSE 17 (perpetual clauses):

         a. Unless the mayor and aldermen have permitted to deviate from what is
laid down in this clause, any clause of this agreement, in so far as such clause
has not lost its effect by its nature and currency, shall be imposed with each
whole or partial alienation of the property purchased and of the buildings to be
erected on it, each creation of real rights of enjoyment on it, each letting and
giving the free use, in favour of any successor in ownership or claimant of the
real right of enjoyment, on pain of a penalty up to the amount of the purchase
money, payable by the offender to the municipality forthwith, without any notice
of default or judicial interposition being required, by the mere fact of a
default against or non-compliance with such clause, all this in favour of
Nieuwegein municipality, which accepts these clauses already now for then and
expresses to insist on their observance.

         Such amount shall be paid within a fortnight from receiving an written
demand to this effect from the mayor and aldermen, on the understanding that at
no time any explicit notice giving shall be required.

         b. All conditions stipulated above together with this clause shall
continue to apply also to reconstruction and repairs of the property sold, to
the extent that at such time the conditions are still in force.


Tenant's initials:                                   Lessor's initials:
<PAGE>   39
CLAUSE 18 (penalty clause):

         In the case of non-compliance with or default against any of the
clauses of this purchase contract or of the instruments resulting therefrom, the
mayor and alderman of Nieuwegein municipality may impose upon the purchaser e.g.
his successors in title a penalty of NLG 10,000. -- (ten thousand guilders) for
each default or non-compliance and of NLG 1,000.  -- (one thousand guilders) for
each day or part of a day on which such default or non-compliance continues,
without any notice giving or demand being required, by the mere fact of such
default or non-compliance, without prejudice to the municipality's right to
demand compliance and indemnification over and above the penalties.

         The penalty shall be due and payable forthwith and shall be forfeited
by the mere fact of the non-compliance or default itself or by the mere expiry
of the period of time stipulated, without any notice giving being required, all
this without prejudice to the right to demand repairs, modification or removal
of what has taken place contrary to what is laid down in this contract; in case
the municipality's demand for repairs or removal is not fulfilled within the
period of time fixed by the mayor and alderman in a notice issued to this
effect, the required repairs, modification or removal may, without prejudice to
what is stipulated on the strength of the aforegoing, be effected by or on
behalf of the municipality, at the expense of the offender or his successors in
title, and his premises and buildings may be entered upon to this effect by
persons designated by the mayor and alderman for the purpose.


Tenant's initials:                                   Lessors' initials:
<PAGE>   40
the parties declare the following:

         1. The lessor declares to impose on the tenant all clauses stated above
and to commit the latter to punctual observance of these clauses towards
Nieuwegein municipality.

         2. The tenant declares to be familiar with the clauses referred to and
to consider them as forming an integral part of the tenancy agreement and to
undertake punctual observance thereof towards Nieuwegein municipality, and the
lessor, now acting as voluntarily looking after the interests of Nieuwegein
municipality, accepts the aforegoing for and on behalf of this municipality.

MADE in triplicate and signed on 19th December 1989.




Lessor:                                                Tenant:

Stichting pensioenfonds                                Koninklijke fabriek
produktschappen voedsel-                               Inventum B.V.
voorsiening

sgd.: illegible                                        sgd.: illegible

Mr N.W. Dijkhuizen                                     Mr N. de Jager, M.Sc.
<PAGE>   41
19/12/1989
Additional works/reduced amount of works
Rear/minsferaerken SPPV/inventum


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
     Inventum   SPPV       SPPV             Inventum    SPPV      SPPV
                in huur    niet in huur                 in huur   niet in huur
                on hire    not on hire                  on hire   not on hire
_______________________________________________________________________________
<S>  <C>        <C>        <C>         <C>  <C>         <C>       <C>
SB 1            (1,178.00)             SB 1 40,434.00    
   2            11,598.00                 2  7,186.00
   3            64,900.00                 3 23,128.00
   4  6,930.00   4,213.00  4,214.00       4 14,170.00
   5             3,252.00                 5      0.00
   6      0.00       0.00                 6  4,711.00
   7      0.00       0.00                 7 16,716.00
   8  9,749.00                            8 24,268.00
   9                 0.00                 9 18,264.00
  10  9,749.00                           10  2,342.00
  11             6,996.00                11  1,926.00
  12 35,739.00                           12  3,873.00
  13            (8,847.00)               13 11,584.00
  14            (1,249.00)               14             11,688.00
  15            (3,600.00)               15    214.00
  16  1,449.00                           16  4,546.00
  17             1,400.00                17  6,375.00 
  18  1,320.00                           18 15,827.00
  19             3,000.00                19 10,089.00
  20            11,034.00                20  3,599.00
  21            16,956.00                21  7,472.00
  22               576.00                22         0
  23             3,079.00                23         0
  24  2,950.00
  25         0
===================================    =====================================
SVG  83,167.00 191,449.00  4,214.00    SVG 216,497.00   11,688.00       0.00

                     (Totalling) latest    279,844.00  123,137.00   4,214.00
</TABLE>



<TABLE>

<S>                           <C>                       <C>  <C>
Rate of rent increase         Nsurverhogingspercentage 9.99  11,002.53
Modification of plan          Plemuljziging                  64,000.00
Modification of construction  Konstruktiouijziging            8,850.09
                                                             --------- excl. btw

Yearly rent adjustment        Rewreamposing par jaar         83,932.33
Basic rent per year           Insiskuur per jaar            214,000.00
Land                          Bread                          24,750.00
                                                            ----------

                      per year excl. V.A.T.     327,682.33 per jaar excl. btw
                      per quarter excl. V.A.T.  87,170.50 per tuartusi excl. btw
</TABLE>

<PAGE>   1
lease for industrial space

according to the model laid down by the Council for Real Estate in October 1988.
Reference to this model shall only be permitted if the text filled in, added or
deviating is clearly recognisable as such. Preferably any additions and
deviations are to be included under the heading "special provisions".

The undersigned:

G.W. van de Grift Onroarend Goed B.V.

established/residing in

Soest, at Kerkstraat 19, P.O. Box 268, 3760 AC SOEST, tel. 02155 - 14691,
and/or Mr             yet to be specified,

                                        hereinafter called: "lessor" 

and

Koninklijke Fabrick Inventum, for the purposes of this matter legally
represented by its managing director N. de Jager M.Sc.

established/residing in

Bilthoven at Layenseweg 101, P.O. BOX 4, 3720 AA BIL'HOVEN, tel. 030 - 290855,

                                        hereinafter called: "leasee",

have entered into the following lease:


Object, purpose, floor load

         1.1 This agreement relates to the object hereinafter called "the
property hired", locally known as Galvanibaan/Struktuurbaan in Nieuwegein, all
this in accordance with a provisional building plan of August 1991 and
specifications and drawings to elaborated in conformity with that plan for an
industrial pavilion with offices, standing and located at Plettenburg in
Nieuwegein, Galvanibaan/Struktuurbaan, in accordance with the cadastral map and
also the finishing level in the letter of 26th August 1991 from Schoeman
Makelaars to Inventum B.V. and has been indicated in more detail on the drawing
and/or description of the hired property attached to this instrument and signed
by the parties.



                                      -1-
<PAGE>   2
         1.2 The lessee shall use the property hired only as office and
industrial space for its Inventair aviation division.

         1.3 The maximum permissible load of the floors of the property hired
is:

a.   on the ground floor 2,000 kg/m2

b.   of the other spaces 450 kg/m2

Conditions

         2.1 This agreement also comprises:

a.   The general provisions for the lease of an industrial space, filed at the
     office of the clerk of the District Court of The Hague on 12th April 1989
     and registered there under number 58/1989, hereinafter called "general
     provisions". These general provisions are known to the parties. The lessee
     has received a copy of them.

b.   The provisions of the property division agreement, the corresponding rules
     of division of ownership and any bye-laws determined, in so far as these
     provisions apply and if the property hired forms part of a building or
     complex that has been divided into apartments.

         2.2 The rules following from 2.1 shall apply except in so far as they
are deviated from in the following provisions or application in respect of the
property hired is not possible.

Duration, renewal and termination.

         3.1 This agreement has been entered into for a 10-year (ten-year)
period, commencing on the first of the month following the month in which the
delivery of the newly built property hired has been made.

         3.2 During the period mentioned in 3.1 the parties cannot terminate the
agreement before the agreed time by giving notice. For termination at the end of
this period notice will have to be given in accordance with 3.4.

         3.3 If the period mentioned in 3.1 ends without notice in accordance
with 3.2 the agreement shall continue for a following 5-year (five-year) period,
so until 15 years after the lease commenced in accordance with the
above-mentioned scheme.

         The agreement shall only end at that time, however, if notice is given
in accordance with 3.4. If such notice is not given the agreement shall continue
for a following 1-year (one-year) period and so on, but always subject to notice
in accordance with 3.4 by the end of a following period.

         3.4 The agreement can only be terminated by writ or registered letter
and with observance of at least 12 (twelve)


                                      -2-
<PAGE>   3


months' notice before expiry of the current period.
         3.5  This article shall leave intact the provisions under 7 of the 
general provisions.

Obligation to pay, period of payment.
         4.1  The lessee's obligation to pay consists of:
- -    the rent
- -    the value added tax legally due on this rent and this charge or an amount
     corresponding to it as referred to under 5.
         4.2  The rent shall be F1 573,000.00 on an annual basis say FIVE
HUNDRED AND SEVENTY-THREE THOUSAND GUILDERS. After expiry of 12 months, for the
first time 12 months after the date of commencement of the lease and so on, the
rent shall be raised in accordance with article 4 of the general provisions.
         4.3  The charge for additional supplies and services shall be
determined in accordance with article 11 of the general provisions and a system
of advance payments with later settlement shall be applied to this charge, as
indicated there.
         4.4  The rent and the advance on the charge for additional supplies
and services and the value added tax or the corresponding amount shall be
payable in advance, always before or on the first day of the period to which
the payment relates.
         4.5  For every lease period of 3 (three) month(s)
- -    the rent shall be                            F1 143,250.00
- -    the advance on the charge for heating        
     or hot water supply                          n.a.
- -    the advance on the charge for
     additional supplies and services             n.a.

so that the lessee has to pay in total            F1 143,250.00

say  ONE HUNDRED AND FORTY-THREE THOUSAND TWO HUNDRED AND FIFTY GUILDERS

         to be increased by the legally due value added tax or the
corresponding amount as referred to under 5.
         4.6  In view of the date of commencement of this agreement the first
period of payment shall relate to a period yet to be fixed and the amount
payable for this first period is yet to be determined, to be increased by the
legally due value added tax or the corresponding amount as referred to under 5.
The lessee shall pay this amount before or on the date of delivery of the hired
property to the lessee.


                                      -3-
<PAGE>   4
Value added tax


         5.1 All the amounts mentioned in this agreement shall be exclusive of
value added tax on the rent. The lessee shall owe value added tax on the rent
and the charge for additional supplies and services. The value added tax shall
be charged by the lessor and must be paid simultaneously with the rent and the
charge for additional supplies and services, or the advance thereon.

         5.2 The lessee hereby grants an irrevocable power of attorney to the
lessor to submit a request as referred to in Section 11(1)(b)(5) of the Income
Tax Act 1968 (taxed lease option) on his behalf as well. On request he shall
co-sign this request within fourteen days after he has received it for the
purpose from the lessor and shall put it at the lessor's disposal again.

         5.3 If the request is not submitted within the period set for it by law
or is not granted, the lessee shall owe not only the rent and the charge for
additional supplies and services or the advance thereon but also an amount that
corresponds to the amount in value added tax that would have been payable if the
request had been granted. The same shall apply if the request is granted with
effect from a later date than the one requested, albeit only during the period
that ends with the commencing date of the taxed lease.

         5.4 If the lessee proves that the lessor is to blame for the request
not being submitted in time or not being granted, the amount corresponding to
the value added tax referred to under 5.3 shall not be payable.

         5.5 If the lessor alienates the property hired or the building or
complex of which the property hired forms part and the new owner also chooses a
taxed lease, the lessor shall also be bound by the provisions of this article.

SPECIAL PROVISIONS:

RENT:

         The above-mentioned rent of F1 573,000.00 shall include a component of
F1 26,000.00 as rent payable for the reserve building site. If during the lease
period the lessee wishes to proceed to extension of the property hired and
built, a new rent shall be fixed in consultation with the lessor on which
occasion the basic rent shall be fixed at F1 547,000.00 say: FIVE HUNDRED AND
FORTY-SEVEN THOUSAND GUILDERS exclusive of indexations.

                                      -4-
<PAGE>   5
LEASEE'S SECURITY:

         Van de Grift Holding B.V. shall guarantee timely commencement of
building, finishing and also timely completion of the property hired. All this
in conformity with the attached copy of the Inventair building plan schedule as
prepared on 20th November 1991 by the architect. Stagnation in the timely issue
of the building permit as a result of government procedures to be followed shall
exclusively at the risk of lessee and lessor.

Bank guarantee

         7.1 in respect of the security to be given by the lessee the provisions
of the general provisions under a shall apply. 

         7.2 The amount referred to under 8.1 of the general provisions is
hereby fixed between the parties at F1 679,000.00 say SIX HUNDRED AND
SEVENTY-NINE THOUSAND GUILDERS to be filed at the latest 14 days after the
signing of this agreement 

Manager

         8. Until the lessor states otherwise Van de Grift Onroarend Goed B.V.
shall act as manager.

Appendixes

         9. This agreement is accompanied by the following appendixes

- -     the general provisions as referred to in 2.2.a 
- -     the drawing of the property hired attached to this agreement and signed
      by the parties 
- -     the description of the property hired attached to this agreement and 
      signed by the parties 
- -     the bank guarantee as referred to under 7.

Special provisions

Thus drawn up and signed in    -fold
place Soest                    place Soest
date 31st January 1992         date 31st January 1992

(Lessor)                       (Lessee)
(signed) illegible             (signed) illegible
(signed) illegible             (signed) illegible

                                      -5-
<PAGE>   6
                                       Inventum
                                       Attn. Mr J. de Jager M.Sc.
                                       P.O. Box 4
                                       3720 AA BILTHOVEN


                                       Soeat, 26th August 1991


Subject: new accommodation of Inventair in Nieuwegein/Bilthoven

Dear Mr De Jager

         Following our talks, the confirmation of your interest to the Mayor and
Aldermen of the Municipality of De Bilt and exchange of your provisional
programme of desires, contractor Van de Grift will be pleased to conclude a
contract for work with you on the basis of the following principal starting
points:

1.   Van de Grift is willing to make a general plan and to make a specified
     quotation.

2.   On the basis of the specified quotation, the foundation expenses and the
     lease to be offered by you we shall bring in an investor who is prepared to
     buy the realized plan.

3.   Rent per sq.m. of hall space   Nieuwegein   F1   90.00
     Rent per sq.m. of office space Nieuwegein   F1  165.00

     Rent per sq.m. of hall space   Bilthoven    F1   90.00
     Rent per sq.m. of office space Bilthoven    F1  180.00

4.   Finishing level: Office space including partitions to 80 running metres for
     every 100 sq.m. of office space, ceilings, lighting, central heating,
     sanitation space, exclusive of floor covering and sun protection. Hall
     space: free height from 5.50 metres, free span 12 metres, insulated sheet
     piling sections, steel construction, concrete floor 2,000 kg/sp.m.
     Electrical lighting, heating by means of heaters, Parapet 1.20 metres.

5.   Development of Bilthoven/Nieuwegein. The choice of the place of
     establishment depends on internal and external factors. At this state the
     parties are concentrating on both locations. In the middle of September
     1991 you will choose which final place of establishment we are going to
     develop.
<PAGE>   7
6.   From the date of the final choice arrangements will be made about risk,
     loss of interest etc.

         The plan will be further developed for the two locations and we trust
that we are of service to you with this confirmation. After provisional
determination of the foundation expenses and the investment value you will be
offered a lease.

With kind regards,

                                                   Yours faithfully

                                                   "SCHOEMAN SOEST B.V."

                                                   (signed) illegible

                                                    B.J.A.N. Majoor


                                      -2-

<PAGE>   8
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>



                                   Schedule
                                   Invantair
                                   building plant
                                   Nieuwegein


Your ref. a: neiuwegein            Soest, 20th November 1991

<S>                      <C>       <C>

1. 1st December 91       1.1       Consultation principal/architect 
   (2 mos.)                        about elaboration of building
                                   proposal into final design

                         1.2       Details p.v.a./finishing level

                         1.3       Consultation with fire
                                   department, urban development
                                   and building inspectorate

                         1.4       Financial examination

2. 1st March 1992        2.1       Submission of building
   (6 mos.)                        application

                         2.2       Start of preparatory work for
                                   building
                                   - specification
                                   - specification drawings
                                   - work drawings

   1st September 1992    2.3       Ultimate date for grant of
                                   building permit

3. 1st September 1992    3.1       start of structural work (after
   (4 mos.)                        construction industry holiday)

   1st January 1993      3.2       start of finishing
   (3 mos.)              

   1st April 1993        3.3       completion (2 months' margin)
                                   for fitters

   1st June 1993         3.4       start of furnish/moving

   Final completion / commencing date of lease 1st June 1992

   1st July 1993         3.5       start of production by Invantair

For approval:   (signed) illegible      (signed) illegible
31st January 1992        Lessor                  Lessee

</TABLE>
<PAGE>   9
General provisions of lease for industrial space according to the model laid
down by the Council for Real Estate and filed at the office of the clerk of the
District Court of The Hague on 12th April 1989 and registered there under number
58/1989.

         The headings above the articles of these general provisions are only
intended to make them easier to read. So the contents and tenor of the article
included under a certain heading are not limited to that heading.

The property hired

         1.1  The property hired shall also include the installations and
facilities present, in so far as they are owned by the lessor and are described
in the signed description belonging to the agreement.

         1.2  The property hired shall be delivered and accepted in the
condition as indicated in the signed description belonging to the agreement, or
failing that the one in which it is at the time of delivery. If desired, the
lessor may make changes or facilities in or at the property hired, at his
expense, after consultation with the lessee.

Purpose and use

Use

         2.1  The lessee must use the property hired -- during the whole period
of the agreement -- actually, properly and himself only in accordance with the
purpose indicated in the lease and with observance of existing real rights and
requirements imposed or yet to be imposed by the authorities or the public
utilities. He must provide it with sufficient furniture and fixtures and keep it
so provided.

         2.2  The lessee shall conduct himself in accordance with the provisions
of the law and the local ordinances and also in accordance with the customs
concerning hiring and letting, the prescriptions of the authorities, the public
utilities, if applicable of the agency for Sprinkler protection and the
insurers, and also in accordance with the oral and written instructions given by
or on behalf of the lessor in the interest of a proper use of the property hired
and the indoor and outdoor spaces, installations and facilities of the building
or complex of which the property hired forms part, especially including those in
respect of maintenance, appearance, sound level, order, fire safety, parking
behaviour and the proper functioning of the building or complex of which the
property hired forms part.

The lessee shall always see to any operations and measures required for the
purpose as soon as possible.

         2.3  The lessee shall not cause other users of the same building or
complex any nuisance or inconvenience and shall
<PAGE>   10


see to it that any third parties present with his approval and also his or
their visitors do not do so either. The lessor shall not be obliged to enforce
observance of this. But he does remain empowered to do so.
         Nuisance and inconvenience shall also include radio and television
reception and the operation of other electrical appliances.
         2.4  If the property hired comprises shopping space or other
industrial space in the sense of Section 1624 of the Civil Code, the lessee
shall be obliged to keep the property hired open for the public in accordance
with the nature of the business carried on by him in it and actually to carry
on his business in it:
- -    If the property hired forms part of a shopping centre, shopping arcade or
     other group of shops during the opening hours of that shopping centre or
     that shopping arcade or that group of shops, including so-called late
     openings;
- -    if the property hired does not form part of a shopping centre or that
     shopping arcade or that group of shops, during the opening hours
     determined by the competent authority or failing that the customary
     opening hours for similar or at any rate comparable spaces.

Licences
         2.5.3  The lessee himself must see to compliance with the requirements
including the possession of licences, permits, exemptions etc. in connection
with the conduct of his business or profession in the property hired, including
those in pursuance of the Nuisance Act and environmental laws. If those
requirement are not or no longer complied with this shall never give the lessee
occasion for rescission or annulment of the lease or for any other action
against the lessor.
         2.5.2  If any alterations or facilities at or in the property hired
are necessary in connection with 2.5.1., by order of the authorities or
otherwise, it shall be the lessee's liability, without prejudice to the
provisions under 2.9, that the requirements made or to be made by the
authorities are met in the execution of the work, and also that any licences
required are obtained while the cost of the alterations or facilities shall be
for the lessee's account.

Associations
         2.6.1  If an association or another group of lessees or users of the
building or complex of which the property hired forms part - for instance a
shopkeepers' association or an


                                      -2-
<PAGE>   11
association of users of factory halls in an industrial estate -- recognized by
the lessor exists or is formed, the lessee shall be obliged to become a member
of it immediately and to stay a member for the whole duration of the agreement
and also to pay any amounts for his account because of this association or group
on first demand.

         2.6.2. For the period that the lessee is not a member he shall owe the
lessor the same amounts as those that he would owe as a member of the
association or group.

         The lessor shall be obliged to pass on these amounts immediately to the
association or group.

         The lessee shall not be permitted to cooperate in the creation of
rules, decisions and the like of an association or group of lessees or users
that conflict with the lease.

Advertising

         2.7 The lessor shall be entitled, after consultation with the lessee,
both for his own benefit and for the benefit of the lessee or third parties, to
use the roofs, outer facades, gardens and grounds of the property hired and of
the building or complex of which the property hired forms part for (illuminated)
advertising, signs and otherwise.

         When exercising this right the lessor shall take account of the
lessee's interests that are justified in his opinion. The lessee shall be
obliged to allow the work and facilities and shall never have any action against
the lessor in the matter.

Apartments

         2.8.1. If the building or complex of which the property hired forms
part is divided into apartments the lessee shall be obliged to observe the
prescriptions following from the property division agreement, articles and rules
concerning the use. The same shall apply if the building or complex is or
becomes the property of a cooperative society.

         2.8.2. The lessor shall be obliged, in so far as this is within his
control, not to cooperate in prescriptions that are in conflict with the lease.

         2.8.3 The lessor shall see to it that the lessee is given the
prescriptions concerning use referred to under 2.8.1.

Prohibitions and rules of order

         2.9.1 The lessee shall not be permitted:

         a. to have materials that constitute a danger to the environment in, on
at or in the direct vicinity of the property hired, including those that spread
odours, constitute a fire hazard or are explosive, unless they

                                      -3-
<PAGE>   12
belong to the normal stock in trade;

         b. to subject the floors of the property hired or of the building or
complex of which the property hired forms part to higher loads than are
permissible from an angle of building technology or have been indicated in the
agreement;

         c. to use the property hired in such a manner that as a result of this
use soil or other environmental pollution occurs, damage may be done to the
property hired or the appearance of the property hired can be harmed, also
including the use of means of transport that may damage the floors;

         d. to make alterations or facilities in or at the property hired that
are contrary to the prescriptions of the authorities and of the public utilities
or contrary to the conditions under which the owner of the property hired has
acquired the ownership of the property hired or contrary to other real rights or
that lead to nuisance for other lessees or neighbours or hinder them in their
use.

         2.9.2. Without the lessor's prior written approval the lesses shall not
be permitted:

         a. to make alterations or facilities in or at the property hired, also
including the making of noles, however small, in the facades.

         b. to instal or have things, including name indications, advertising,
signs, notices, publications, buildings, structures, soaffolds, packing, goods,
vending machines, lighting, sun screans, aerials wits accessories, flag poles
etc. on, at or in the direct vicinity of the property hired or to make windows
non/transparent;

         c. to enter or allow others to enter the services and installation
spaces, the roof terraces, roofs, gutters and spaces and places not intended for
communal use of the property hired or of the building or complex of which the
property hired forms part;

         d. to perform any acts in connection with the central installations;

         e. to park means of transport in other places than those designated for
the purpose.

         2.9.3 The lessee shall be obliged to keep fire hydrants and fire hose
reals and also escape routes in the property hire free from obstructions at all
times, also those that serve as an escape route for other users of the building.
In the event of a calamity the lessee must unable any other users to use the
escape routes designated for them in so far as they are 

                                      -4-




 







<PAGE>   13
located in the property hired. Likewise in the event of a calamity the lessee
shall be entitled to use the escape routes designated for him, even in so far
as they are not located in the property hired.

         2.9.4 If a lift is part of the property hired or if the property hired
can be reached by lift, the lessee and visitors can only make use of this lift
at their own risk. All instructions given or yet to be given by or on behalf of
the lessor, the installer of the lift or the authorities must be fallowed
carefully. If and as long as this is necessary the lessor can put the lift
installation out of operation without giving the lessee any right to
compensation or reduction of the rent.

         2.9.5 If the property hired forms part of a building or complex the
above provisions shall also apply, in so far as applicable, to the spaces of
that building or complex not hired.

         2.9.6 The lessor may attach conditions to his approval and can
withdraw his approval at all times, unless it has been agreed differently.

Subletting

         3.1 Without the lessor's prior written approval the lessee shall not
be authorised to let, sublet or surrender the use of part of all of the
property hired to third parties, or to assign all of some of the leasing rights
to third parties or to bring them into a partnership, company or legal person,
or to allot the leasing rights, in so far as they belong to a community, in the
event of partition and distribution thereof.

         3.2 Any approval given by or on behalf of the lessor shall be
once-only and shall not hold good for other or following cases.

         3.3 The lessor shall be entitled to attach conditions to his approval.

         3.4 Irrespective whether the lessor has given approval the lessee
shall remain severally liable, without prejudice to liability of third parties,
for the performance of the obligations under the lease. The lessee shall see to
it that a third party that obtains leasing or user rights also accepts the
liabilities resulting from the lease for the lessee or user.

         3.5 If the lessee acts contrary to the provisions of this article he
shall forfeit to the lessor for every calendar day that the infringement lasts
a time claimable at once and not susceptible of nitigation, equal to twice the
daily rent effective for the lessee at that time without prejudice to the
lessor's right to demand performance or rescission owing to

                                      -5-
<PAGE>   14
default and also compensation.

Rent increase

         4.1 If it has been agreed in the lease that the rent shall be raised
periodically this increase shall be affected on the basis of the annual price
index number for family consumption, series for employees' families with a
family income below the wage limit of the compulsory health insurance in 1985
(1985 - 100), published by the Netherlands Central Bureau of Statistics (CBS).

         The adjusted rent shall be calculated in accordance with the formula:
the adjusted rent is equal to the applicable rent multiplied by the index number
for the calendar year preceding the year in which the adjusted rent takes
effect, divided by the index number for the calendar year preceding the date of
commencement of the applicable rent.

         4.2 The rent shall not be adjusted if the adjustment should lead to a
rent lower than the last one applicable.

         4.3 The adjusted rent shall apply, even if the adjustment is not
communicated to the lessee.

         4.4 If the CBS discontinues publication of the said price index number
or changes the basis of its calculation, an index number that is as comparable
as possible shall be used.

         If there is disagreement on the subject the willing party can ask the
managing director of the CBS for an opinion that shall be binding on the
parties. Any expenses involved in this shall be borne by the parties, each for
half.

End of the lease or use

         5.1 At the end of the lease and also at the end of the use, the lessee
shall be obliged to deliver the hired property to the lessor to the lessor's
satisfaction in the original condition -- being the condition laid down in the
description drawn up at the start and signed as mentioned in 2.1 and failing
that in good condition -- entirely vacated and free of use and user rights and
properly cleaned and to hand over all the keys to the lessor. At his own expense
the lessee shall be obliged to remove all matters that have been installed by
him in, at or on the property hired or have been taken over by him from the
previous lessee or user unless the parties agree differently on the subject. For
matters not removed the lessor shall not owe the lessee any payment.

         5.2 If the lessee has terminated the use in a timely or untimely
fashion without having handed over the keys to the lessor, the lessor shall be
entitled to consider the lease ended, to gain access to the property hired at
the lessee's expense and to take possession thereof, without the lessee 

                                      -6-
<PAGE>   15
having any right to compensation or anything else as a result.

         5.3 All the goods which the lessee has apparently abandoned by leaving
them behind in the property hired when he actually left the property hired can
be removed by the lessor, at the lessor's discretion, without any liability on
his part, at the lessee's expense, unless the lessor knows that the following
lessee has taken over the goods.

         In such a case the lessor's conduct shall be with the lessee's approval
and shall be regarded between the parties as not being in conflict with Section
138 of the Criminal Code.

         5.4 In due time before the end of the issue or the use the parties are
to inspect the hired property together, lay down their findings in an inspection
report and agree in writing in what way any repairs appearing necessary during
that inspection and the maintenance in arrear, in so far as they are for account
of the lessee, shall be performed for account of the lessee.

         5.5 If the lessee does not cooperate in the inspection and the report
in a reasonable time the lessor's inspection and his report of his findings
shall be considered binding between the parties.

         5.6 The lessee must have performed the repairs mentioned in the
inspection report and the maintenance whose performance is for his account in 
a timely fashion before the end of the lease to the lessor's satisfaction.

         5.7 If the written agreement referred to in 5.4 is not brought about
within a reasonable period and also if the lessee does not or not sufficiently
fulfil the obligations resulting from that agreement within a reasonable period
set by the lessor, the lessor shall be entitled, after summons and notice of
default, to carry out the relevant work for account of the lessee.

         5.8 For the time involved in the performance of the said repairs and
the maintenance in arrear referred to in 5.6 and 5.7, counting from the date 
of the end of the lease, the lessee shall owe the lessor an amount calculated 
in accordance with the current rent and charge for additional supplies and 
services, without prejudice to the lessor's claim on compensation of the 
further damage and expenses.

         5.9 The provisions applicable under 5.4 through 5.8 shall apply
accordingly if the inspection is only carried out after the property hired has
been vacated by the lessee.

Damage

         6.1 The lessee shall be obliged to take the necessary suitable measures
immediately to prevent and limit damage to the property hired -- and in so far
as he has any possibility

                                      -7-
<PAGE>   16
of doing so to the building or complex of which the property hired forms part
and the adjacencies -- such as damage as a result of short circuit, fire,
leakage, storm, frost, inflow or outflow of gases or liquids, including measures
to prevent damage as a result of any weather condition. Moreover the lessee
shall be obliged to inform the lessor forthwith if such damage or an event as
referred to in 6.3 occurs or is about to occur.

         6.2 The lessee shall be liable to the lessor for all damage and losses
caused to or undergone by the property hired unless the lessee proves that he,
the persons whom he has admitted to the property hired, his personnel and the
persons for whom he is liable are not to blame in the matter.

         6.3 The lessor shall not be liable for damage caused to the person or
goods of the lessee or of third parties -- and the lessee indemnifies the lessor
for claims of third parties in the matter -- by the occurrence and the
consequences of visible and invisible defects to the property hired or the
building or complex of which the property hired forms part or arisan owing to
the occurrence and the consequences of weather conditions, of stagnation in the
accessibility of the property hired, of stagnation in the supply of gas, water,
electricity, heat, ventilation or air conditioning, of breakdown of the
installations and equipment, of inflow and outflow of gases or liquids, of fire,
explosion and other events, of interruption in the enjoyment of the lease and of
interruption or shortcomings in the supplies and services, everything except in
the event of damage is a result of gross culpability or serious negligence by
the lessor in respect of the condition of the property hired or of the building
or complex of which the property hired form part.

         6.4 The lessor shall never be liable for consequential loss of the
lessee or for damage as a result of the activities of other lessees or of
impediments in the use of the property hired that is caused by third parties.

Early termination, default

7.1  If the lessee

- -    does not pay the rent and the charge for additional supplies and services
     at the fixed times,

- -    discontinues his profession or business in the hired property entirely or
     for an important part,

- -    fails to observe any other provision of the lease,

- -    does not satisfy any condition attached to approval given by the lessor,

- -    loses the free disposal of his capital or part of it, not being a natural
     person, loses his legal 

                                      -8-


 
<PAGE>   17
     personality, is wound up or liquidated in fact,

- -    files a petition for an official moratorium or in bankruptcy,

- -    is declared bankrupt,

- -    offers a compromise outside bankruptcy or

- -    if goods of the lessee are attached,

the lessor shall be entitled to give notice to terminate the lease immediately
before the agreed time or, in so far as the law allows this, to declare the
lease terminated with immediate effect, without any notice of default being
required.

         7.2 The lessee shall be in default by the mere lapse of a certain
period or by the mere occurrence of a circumstance as mentioned above.

         7.3 The lessee shall be obliged to pay the lessor for all damage,
expenses and interests as a result of a circumstance referred to in 7.1 and as
a result of early termination of the lease, also in the event of bankruptcy and
an official moratorium. That damage shall at any rate include the rent, the
charge for additional supplies and services, including the heating charges, the
value added tax (VAT) and the other amounts payable according to the lease
until the original contractual final date of the lease, the expenses of
relating and also all expenses of measures both in and out of court incurred by
the lessor, including those of legal aid in connection with a circumstance as
stated in 7.1.

         7.4 The provisions under 7.1 through 7.3 do not exclude the lessor's
power to exercise his other rights, including his right to demand performance
with compensation or rescission with vacation and compensation by virtue of the
provisions of Section 1302 of the Civil Code or Section 39 of the Bankruptcy
Act.

         7.5 If the lessee fails to do things the lessor himself shall be
entitled automatically and without judicial interposition to (have others)
perform them at his discretion at the lessee's expense and risk.

Bank guarantee

        8.1 As security for the proper fulfilment of his obligations from the
lease the lessee shall give the lessor a bank guarantee to the lessor's
satisfaction at the time when the lease is signed, amounting to a sum yet to be
determined in the lease, related to the lessee's obligation of payment to the
lessor, increased by the applicable value added tax (VAT). This bank guarantee
must also be valid for the renewals of the lease including any amendments
thereof, must remain valid until three months after termination of the lease
and must

                                      -9-
<PAGE>   18
also apply to the lessor's legal successors.

         8.2 The lessee shall not be entitled to set off any amount against the
bank guarantee.

         8.3 If the bank guarantee has been used, the lessee shall provide a new
bank guarantee to the original amount on the lessor's first demand.

         8.4 After an upward adjustment of the rent, of the charge for supplies
and services or the advance thereon and of the applicable value added tax the
lessee shall be obliged to provide a new bank guarantee on the lessor's first
demand to an amount adjusted to the new obligation of payment increased by the
applicable value added tax (VAT).

         8.5 Prior to the commencement of any new lease period on the strength
of a lease renewal, the lessee shall provide a new bank guarantee on the
lessor's first demand to an amount adjusted to the new obligation of payment
increased by the applicable value added tax (VAT).

         8.6 If the lessee does not meet the obligations described in this
article he shall forfeit to the lessor for every transgression a fine
immediately claimable and not susceptible of mitigation to the amount of 
Fl 500.00 for every calendar day that he remains in default after the default 
has been pointed out to him by registered letter.

Maintenance

For the lessor's account

         9.1 Unless it is a matter of operations that must be considered minor
and daily repairs in the sense of the law (Sect. 2519 of the Dutch Civil Code)
or operations on matters that have not been installed by or on behalf of the
lessor, the lessor shall bear the cost of

         a. maintenance, repair and renewal of structural parts of the property
hired, such as foundations, columns, beams, structural floors, roofs, roof
terraces, bearing walls, outside facades (with the exception of window panes);

         b. maintenance, repair and renewal of stairs, stair treads, lines,
sewers, drains, gutters, outside frames, etc., without prejudice to the
provisions under 9.2.1.;

         c. repair and renewal of installations, such as the lift, central
heating and fire hydrant booster installations;

         d. outdoor paintwork.

For the lessee's account

         9.2 The lessee shall bear the cost of all other maintenance, repair and
renewals such as:

         a. internal maintenance not being maintenance as referred



                                      -10-
<PAGE>   19
to under 9.1, and also the external maintenance if and in so far as it is a
matter of operations that must be considered minor and daily maintenance in the
sense of the law (Sect. 1618 of the Dutch Civil Code), all this without
prejudice to the further provisions here;

         b. the expenses of a service subscription for the installations serving
the property hired or the building or complex of which the property hired forms
part such as a lift, fire hydrant booster or central heating installation, or at
any rate in so far as those expenses are due for:

- -    performing periodical preventive maintenance including the performance of
     inspection work and keeping moving parts operational (corrective
     maintenance);

- -    replacing parts that are subject to rapid wear and that must be replaced
     during almost every maintenance job;

- -    removing breakdowns outside normal office hours;

- -    performing minor repairs;

- -    everything that can furthermore be considered minor and daily maintenance
     in the sense of the law (Sect. 1619 of the Dutch Civil Code);

         c. renewal of lamps, broken (plate glass) windows, glass doors and
glass partitions;

         d. maintenance of fences, gardens and grounds;

         e. maintenance, repair and renewal in similar design of ironmongery,
taps, switches, wall sockets, bell installations, lighting (including fixture),
sun screen, floor covering, soft furnishing, window panes, interior paintwork,
sinks, sanitation, mirrors, cisterns;

         f. cleaning work of the property hired both internally and externally,
which shall also include the cleaning of windows, frames and facades and at
least the cleaning of gutters and the sweepings of chimneys once a year, and
also the unplugging of pits, sewers and drains;

         g. maintenance, repair and renewal of matters that have not been
installed by or on behalf of the lessor;

         h. maintenance, repair and renewal that have become necessary owing to
the actions or omissions of the lessee himself, his personnel, of those persons
for whom he is liable and of those persons whom he has admitted to the property
hired.

         9.3 If upon being summoned to do so, the lessee fails to perform or
have others perform maintenance, repair or renewal at his expense -- or if the
lessor's opinion such work has 

                                      -11-


<PAGE>   20
been done in an injudicious or poor manner -- the lessor shall be entitled,
after summons and notice of default, to perform or have other perform them at
the lessee's expense and risk. If the operations for the lessee's account cannot
brook delay the lessor shall be entitled to perform them or have them performed
immediately at the lessee's expense.

         9.4 If the lessor considers it necessary to perform or have others
perform maintenance, repair, renovation or other operations to the property
hired or the building or complex of which the property hired forms part or to
adjacencies or if they are necessary in connection with requirements or measures
of the authorities or public utilities, the lessee shall admit the persons
necessary to perform those operations and those measures in the property hired
and shall allow those operations and measures and any nuisance without being
able to claim any compensation or reduction of the obligation to pay or
dissolution of the lease in return, even if all this takes more than forty days.
If possible the lessor shall consult with the lessee about the time of execution
of the operations.

Access of lessor

         10.1 The lessor and all persons to be appointed by him shall be
entitled to have access to the property hired -- apart from emergencies -- after
prior notification at any time on working days between 08.00 hours and 17:30
hours for inspection of the condition of the property hired, for the operations
and measures mentioned under 1.2, 2.7 and 9 and for valuations.

         10.2 In the event of an intended sale or auction of the property hired,
and during one year before the end of the lease the lessee shall be obliged
without any compensation, after prior notification by the lessor or his
attorney, to provide an opportunity to view the hired property during at least
two working days a week and he shall allow the customary "for sale" or "to let"
signs or posters on or at the property hired.

Charges for energy etc. and for supplies and services

         11.1 In addition to the rent the lessee shall bear the charges for the
consumption of water and energy for the property hired, including the expenses
of entering into an agreement for supply and meter rent, and also any other
expenses and fines that are charged by the public utilities. The lessee himself
must conclude the supply contracts with the relevant bodies, unless the property
hired has no separate connections and the lessor takes care of these matters as
part of the agreed supplies and services.

         11.2 If no additional supplies and services are agreed, the

                                      -12-




<PAGE>   21
lessee shall take care of all matters and performances as mentioned below at
his own expense and risk and to the lessor's satisfaction. In that case the
lessee himself shall conclude service contracts in connection with the
installations, to be approved beforehand by the lesser.

         11.3 If additional supplies and services have been agreed, the lessor
shall fix the charge payable for it by the lessee on the basis of the costs that
are involved in the supplies and services and the related administrative work.
In so far as the property hired forms part of a building or complex and the
supplies and services also relate to other parts belonging to it, the lessor
shall fix the lessee's share in the charges for those supplies and services that
he believes to be reasonable. In that connection the lessor need not make any
allowance for the circumstance that the lessee does not use one or more of these
supplies and services. If one or more parts of the building or complex are not
being used, the lessor shall see to it, when fixing the lessee's share, that it
does not become higher than when the building or complex would be fully used.

         11.4 Every year the lessor shall furnish the lessee with a categorized
review of the charges for the supplies and services, stating the method of
calculation thereof and, in so far as applicable, the lessee's share in those
charges.

         11.5 Any amount underpaid by the lessee or overcharged by the lessor,
according to the review for the relevant period, taking account of advances,
shall be paid as yet or refunded within one month after production of the
review. If the accuracy of the review is contested this shall not suspend this
obligation.

         11.6 The lessor shall be entitled to limit or extend the supplies and
services after consultation with the lessee. In that connection or otherwise he
can adjust the advance payable by the lessee on the charge for supplies and
services to the costs expected by him.

         11.7 If the supply of heat or hot water is among the supplies and
services the lessor shall be entitled to adapt the method of determining the
consumption and corresponding lessee's share in the charge for consumption,
after consultation with the lessee. If the consumption of heat or hot water is
determined on the basis of consumption meters and the malfunctioning of these
meters should cause any conflict about the lessee's share in the supply charges,
the statement of the presumable share by a company specializing in measuring and
determining the heat consumed, consulted by the lessor, shall be binding. This
shall also apply to damage, destruction or fraud in connection with meters,
irrespective of any other rights that the lessor should have in that case
vis-a-vis the




                                      -13-
<PAGE>   22
lessee, such as the right to repair or renewal of the maters and compensation
of the loss suffered.

Expenses

         12. In all cases in which the lessor has a summons, notice of default
or writ served on the lessee, or in the event of legal actions against the
lessee to compel him to perform this agreement or to vacate the property hired,
the lessee shall be obliged to pay the lessor all the expenses, both in and out
of court -- with the exception of legal costs to be paid by the lessor in
pursuance of a final court order. The expenses incurred shall be fixed
beforehand between the parties at an amount that is not lower than the
customary rate that is used by bailiffs

Payments

         13.1 Payment of the rent and of any other dues payable under this
agreement shall be made at the latest on the due day in legal Dutch tender --
without any discount, deduction or net-off against a claim that the lessee has
or believes to have on the lessor -- at the lessor's office or by payment into
or transfer to an account yet to be stated by the lessor. 

The lessor shall be free to change the place or method of payment by means of a
written statement to the lessee. The lessor shall be entitled to determine from
which outstanding claim under the lease a payment received by him from the
lessee shall be deducted.

         13.2 If an amount payable by the lessee on the strength of the lease
is not paid promptly on the due date, the lessee shall forfeit to the lessor,
automatically, for each instance that he is in default, from the due date, a
fine immediately claimable and not susceptible of mitigation to the amount of
2% a month of the amount due with a minimum of Fl 250.00 per calendar month,
with any part of a month counting as a full month.

Taxes, burdens, levies, premiums, etc.

         14.1 The following charges shall be paid by the lessee even if the
lessor receives assessments for them:

         a. the real estate tax in respect of the actual use of the property
hired and the actual shared use of the service spaces, general spaces and
so-called sommunal spaces;

         b. other existing or future taxes, sufferance taxes, burdens, levies
and dues in respect of the property hired and of property of the lessee:

         c. environmental levies including the pollution levy for surface
waters and the contribution to cleaning charges

                                      -14-
<PAGE>   23
for waste water and amounts on the strength of environmental protection in any
other levy.

         14.7 If as a result of the nature or performance of the lessee's
profession or business a higher fire insurance premium than usual is charged
for building or contents of the property hired or complex of which the property
hired forms part to the lessor or other lessees of the building or complex, the
lessee shall pay the excess above the normal premium to the lessor or those
other lessees. The lessor and other lessees shall be free in the choice of the
insurance company, the determination of the sum insured and also in the
assessment of the reasonability of the premium due.

Several liability and indivisibility

         15.1 If different (natural or legal) persons have bound themselves as
lessees they shall always be severally and independently liable for the whole
to the lessor for all commitments resulting from the lease and they shall not
be entitled to rely on the provisions of the Sections 1460 (1) and 1476 of the
Civil Code.

         15.2 The commitments from the lease shall be indivisible, also as far
as the lessee's heirs and legal successors are concerned.

Untimely availability

         16. If the property hired is not available on the agreed commencing
date of the lease because the property hired has not been completed in time,
the previous user has not vacated it in time or the lessor has not yet obtained
the permits to be obtained by him from the authorities, the lessee shall not
owe any rent or charge for additional supplies and services until the date of
availability and his other obligations and the agreed periods shall advance
accordingly. The lessor shall inform the lessee of an impending delay at least
a month beforehand, if possible.

         The lessor shall not be liable for any damage, of whatever nature,
that the lessee could suffer if the property hired cannot be delivered on the
agreed date.

         The lessee cannot claim any rescission unless the late delivery has
been caused by deliberate actions or omissions of the lessor and entails such a
delay that it cannot be expected of the lessee in reason that the agreement be
maintained (without amendment).
                                      
                                      -15-
<PAGE>   24
Domicile

         17. In respect of everything relating to the lease the lessee shall
choose domicile in the property hired.

Manager, complaints

         18.1 If a manager has been or is appointed by the lessor, the lessee
shall contact the manager about all matters relating to the agreement.

         18.2 The lessee shall submit complaints and wishes in writing. In
urgent cases this can be done orally. In such cases the lessee shall confirm
such a complaint or wish in writing as soon as possible.

                                      -16-

<PAGE>   1
                                    AGREEMENT

         This Agreement is made and entered into in Wellesley, Massachusetts by
and between BE Avionics, Inc., a Delaware corporation ("BEA"), and Amin J.
Khoury ("Khoury"), as of January 1, 1992.

         FOR AND IN CONSIDERATION OF THE MUTUAL PROMISES, TERMS, PROVISIONS AND
CONDITIONS CONTAINED IN THIS AGREEMENT, the parties hereby agree as follows:

1.       ARRANGEMENT. Khoury shall provide to BEA, and BEA shall accept from
Khoury, the services, set forth in Paragraph 3.2, subject to the terms and
conditions set forth in this Agreement.

2.       TERM. Khoury shall provide, and BEA shall purchase, the services
hereunder for a term (the "Service Term") of ten (10) years, commencing on the
date hereof and ending on December 31, 2001 (the "Expiration Date").

3.  CAPACITY, PERFORMANCE, ETC.

         3.1. CAPACITY. Khoury shall serve BEA (i) as its Chief Executive
Officer, and (ii) as its Chairman of the Board, or in such other Board capacity
as the Board may designate from time to time, but only upon agreement with
Khoury.

         3.2. SERVICES. In the capacities set forth in Paragraph 3.1 above,
Khoury shall be retained by BEA and shall perform such duties and
responsibilities on behalf of BEA as Khoury and the Board shall by mutual
agreement from time to time determine.

         3.3. PERFORMANCE. During the Service Term, Khoury shall use his
business judgment, skill and knowledge to the advancement of BEA's interests and
to the discharge of his duties and responsibilities hereunder.

4.       COMPENSATION AND BENEFITS.

         4.1. BASE FEE. As consideration for his services performed during the
Service Term, BEA agrees to pay Khoury a base fee of $360,000 per annum (the
"Base Fee") , payable in accordance with the payroll practices of BEA for its
executives generally, but in no event less frequently than monthly, and subject
to increase from time to time by the Board, in its sole discretion; PROVIDED,
HOWEVER, that the Base Fee shall be increased on January 1 of each year by an
amount not less than the amount determined by applying to the Adjusted Base Fee
(as defined below) as in effect for the next preceding year the percentage
increase in the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics Consumer Price Index Revised -
Urban Wage Earners and Clerical



<PAGE>   2



Workers - National - All Items (1982-84 = 100) (the "Index") for the preceding
twelve months, from December to December (the Base Fee as adjusted from time to
time shall be referred to as the "Adjusted Base Fee"). In no event shall such
adjustment reduce the Adjusted Base Fee below $360,000.00 per year. If the
Bureau of Labor Statistics does not issue the Index on or before January 1 of
any year for the preceding twelve months, December to December, any adjustments
to either the Base Fee or the Adjusted Base Fee shall be made retroactive to the
beginning of the appropriate adjustment period after the Index is so issued. If
the Index is no longer issued, the Board and Khoury shall agree upon a
substitute adjustment index issued by such agency.

         4.2. BONUSES. Khoury may receive bonuses from BEA when, as and if
determined from time to time by the Board. Any such bonuses paid to Khoury shall
be in addition to the Adjusted Base Fee.

         4.3. BENEFITS. At BEA's expense, during the Service Term Khoury shall
be treated for benefit purposes as a BEA employee and shall be entitled to
participate in any and all employee benefit plans, medical insurance plans, life
insurance plans, disability income plans, incentive compensation plans and other
benefit plans, other than retirement plans, as may be from time to time in
effect for executives of BEA generally.

         4.4. BUSINESS EXPENSES. BEA shall pay or reimburse Khoury during the
Service Term for all reasonable business expenses incurred or paid by him in the
performance of his services, subject to reasonable substantiation and
documentation.

5.       PROPRIETARY RIGHTS AND NON-COMPETITION.

         Khoury acknowledges that BEA is engaged in a continuous program of
research, development and production in connection with its business, present
and future, and hereby covenants as follows:

         5.1. CONFIDENTIALITY. Khoury will maintain in confidence and will not
disclose or use, either during or after the Service Term, any proprietary or
confidential information or know-how belonging to BEA ("Proprietary
Information"), whether or not in written form, except to the extent required to
perform duties on behalf of BEA. For purposes of this Agreement, "Proprietary
Information" shall mean any information, not generally known in the relevant
trade or industry, which was obtained from BEA, or which was learned,
discovered, developed, conceived, originated or prepared by Khoury in connection
with this Agreement. Such Proprietary Information includes, without limitation,
software, technical and business information relating to BEA's inventions or
products, research and development, production processes, manufacturing and
engineering processes, machines and equipment, finances, customers, marketing
and production and future business plans, information belonging to customers or
suppliers of BEA disclosed incidental to Khoury's performance under this

                                       -2-



<PAGE>   3


Agreement, and any other information which is identified as confidential by BEA,
but only so long as the same is not generally known in the relevant trade or
industry.

         5.2.  INVENTIONS.

                  5.2.1. DEFINITION OF INVENTIONS. For purposes of this
         Agreement, "Inventions" shall mean any new or useful art, discovery,
         contribution, finding or improvement, whether or not patentable, and
         all related know-how. Inventions shall include, without limitation, all
         designs, discoveries, formulae, processes, manufacturing techniques,
         semiconductor designs, computer software, inventions, improvements and
         ideas.

                  5.2.2. DISCLOSURE AND ASSIGNMENT OF INVENTIONS. Khoury will
         promptly disclose and describe to BEA all Inventions which he may
         solely or jointly conceive, develop, or reduce to practice during the
         Service Term (i) which relate at the time of conception, development,
         or reduction to practice of the Invention to BEA's business or actual
         or demonstrably anticipated research or development, (ii) which were
         developed, in whole or in part, on BEA's time or with the use of any of
         BEA's equipment, supplies, facilities or trade secret information, or
         (iii) which resulted from any work performed by Khoury for BEA (the
         "BEA Inventions"). Khoury hereby assigns all of his right, title and
         interest worldwide in the BEA Inventions and in all intellectual
         property rights based upon the BEA Inventions; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that
         Khoury does not assign or agree to assign any Inventions, whether or
         not relating in any way to the BEA business or demonstrably anticipated
         research and development, which were made by him prior to the date of
         this Agreement, or which were developed by him independently during the
         term of this Agreement and not under the conditions stated in
         subparagraph (ii) above.

         5.3.  DOCUMENTS AND MATERIALS. Upon termination of this Agreement or at
any other time upon BEA's request, Khoury will promptly deliver to BEA, without
retaining any copies, all documents and other materials furnished to him by BEA,
prepared by him for BEA or otherwise relating to BEA's business, including,
without limitation, all written and tangible material in his possession
incorporating any Proprietary Information.

         5.4.  COMPETITIVE EMPLOYMENT.  During the Service Term and for a period
of two (2) years thereafter (collectively, the "Extended Term"), Khoury will not
engage in any employment, consulting, or other activity in any business
competitive with BEA without BEA's written consent, which consent shall not be
unreasonably withheld; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, because Khoury has other existing
commitments, a list of which is attached hereto, services rendered to those
entities will in no event be deemed competitive with BEA; PROVIDED, FURTHER,
that nothing in this Section 5.4 shall preclude Khoury from serving as a
director of any other corporation.



                                      -3-


<PAGE>   4

         5.5.  NON-SOLICITATION. During the Extended Term, Khoury will not
solicit or encourage, or cause others to solicit or encourage, any employees of
BEA to terminate their employment with BEA.

         5.6.  ACTS TO SECURE PROPRIETARY RIGHTS.

                  5.6.1. FURTHER ACTS. Khoury agrees to perform, during and
         after the Service Term, all acts deemed necessary or desirable by BEA
         to permit and assist it, at its expense, in perfecting and enforcing
         the full benefits, enjoyment, rights and title throughout the world in
         the BEA Inventions. Such acts may include, without limitation,
         execution of documents and assistance or cooperation in the
         registration and enforcement of applicable patents and copyrights or
         other legal proceedings.

                  5.6.2. APPOINTMENT OF ATTORNEY-IN-FACT. In the event that BEA
         is unable, for any reason whatsoever, to secure Khoury's signature to
         any lawful and necessary document required to apply for or execute any
         patent, copyright or other applications with respect to any BEA
         Inventions (including improvements, renewals, extensions,
         continuations, divisions or continuations in part thereof), Khoury
         hereby irrevocably appoints BEA and its duly authorized officers and
         agents as his agents and attorneys-in-fact to execute and file any such
         application and to do all other lawfully permitted acts to further the
         prosecution and issuance of patents, copyrights or other rights thereon
         with the same legal force and effect as if executed by him, intending
         hereby to create a so-called "durable power" which will survive any
         subsequent disability.

         5.7.  NO CONFLICTING OBLIGATIONS. Khoury's performance of this 
Agreement does not breach and will not breach any agreement to keep in
confidence proprietary information, knowledge or data acquired by him.

         5.8.  CORPORATE OPPORTUNITIES. Khoury agrees that he will first present
to the Board, for its acceptance or rejection on behalf of BEA, any opportunity
to create or invest in any company which is or will be involved in equipping or
furnishing airplane cabin interiors, which comes to his attention and in which
he, or any affiliate, might desire to participate. If the Board rejects the same
or fails to act thereon in a reasonable time, Khoury shall be free to invest in,
participate or present such opportunity to any other person or entity.

         5.9.  SPECIFIC PERFORMANCE. Khoury acknowledges that a breach of any of
the promises or agreements contained herein could result in irreparable and
continuing damage to BEA for which there may be no adequate remedy at law, and
BEA shall be entitled to seek injunctive relief and/or a decree for specific
performance, and such other relief as may be proper (including monetary damages
if appropriate).


                                      -4-



<PAGE>   5

6.       TERMINATION AND COMPENSATION THEREON.

         6.1. TERMINATION DATE. The term "Termination Date" shall mean the
earlier of (i) the Expiration Date or (ii) if Khoury's services to BEA are
terminated (A) by his death, then the date of his death, or (B) by his
incapacity, then the date on which such termination is to be effective pursuant
to the notice of termination to be given by BEA pursuant to Section 6.3 hereof.

         6.2. DEATH. This Agreement shall terminate upon the death of Khoury. In
such event, BEA shall pay to such person as Khoury from time to time may
designate in a notice filed with BEA, or, if no such person shall have been so
designated, to his estate, (i) all fees earned, but not yet paid, hereunder and
(ii) the Retirement Compensation as hereinafter provided.

         6.3. INCAPACITY. If, in the reasonable judgement of the Board, as a
result of Khoury's incapacity due to physical or mental illness or otherwise,
Khoury shall for at least nine (9) consecutive months during the term of this
Agreement have been unable to perform his duties under this Agreement, BEA may
terminate this Agreement, and Khoury's services hereunder, by notice to Khoury.
In such event, BEA shall pay the Retirement Compensation to Khoury, and (to the
extent legally practicable) extend to him the applicable fringe benefits
referred to in Section 4.3 hereof until the Expiration Date. Any dispute between
the Board and Khoury with respect to Khoury's incapacity shall be settled by
reference to a competent medical authority mutually agreed to by the Board and
Khoury, the decision of which authority shall be binding on all parties.

         6.4. RETIREMENT COMPENSATION. In recognition that Khoury will not be
eligible for any retirement plan to be offered by BEA to its executives (as
provided in Section 4.3), upon the occurrence of the earlier of the Expiration
Date or the Termination Date (such earlier date referred to as the "Cessation
Date"), Khoury shall be entitled to retirement compensation ("Retirement
Compensation") equal to the Adjusted Base Fee in effect immediately prior to the
Cessation Date for each year of service by Khoury to BEA, such service having
commenced as of August 1, 1987 ("Commencement Date"), with a ratable adjustment
should Khoury's final period of service be less than a full year, and payable as
provided in Section 6.5.

         6.5. PAYMENT OF RETIREMENT COMPENSATION. Retirement Compensation shall
be paid to Khoury in monthly installments, the first installment to be due and
payable on the first day of the month next beginning after the Cessation Date,
except that if the Cessation Date falls on or after the twentieth day of a
month, such first installment shall be paid on the first day of the second month
next beginning, and in either instance, monthly on the same day of each
succeeding month, for that number of months equal to the number of months
elapsed from the Commencement Date through the Cessation Date. The amount of
each monthly installment 


                                      -5-



<PAGE>   6

shall be equal to one-twelfth (1/12th) of the Adjusted Base Fee in effect as of
the Cessation Date.

         Notwithstanding the foregoing, Khoury, or his personal representative
if Khoury is deceased or incapable, physically or mentally, of so acting, may
elect to receive the entire Retirement Compensation, or the remaining unpaid
balance thereof, in a lump sum upon written notice to the Board. In such event,
the Board may determine the time of payment of such amount, not to exceed ninety
(90) days from the date of such notice, and the monthly installments due and
payable up to such date shall continue to be paid, except that the lump sum to
be paid shall be present-valued using the lowest Prime Rate reported in the Wall
Street Journal on the first business day after the Board is sent notice of such
election, and if no such Prime Rate is then being published by the Wall Street
Journal, then the rate announced by the largest New York City bank as its prime
or base rate shall be used.

7.       WITHHOLDING. All payments made by BEA under this Agreement shall be 
reduced by any tax or other amounts required to be withheld by BEA under 
applicable law.

8.       ASSIGNMENT. Neither BEA nor Khoury may make any assignment of this
Agreement or any interest herein, by operation of law or otherwise, without the
prior written consent of the other party; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that BEA may assign
its rights and obligations under this Agreement without the consent of Khoury if
BEA shall hereafter effect a reorganization, consolidate with, or merge into any
other entity or transfer all or substantially all of its properties or assets to
any other person or entity. This Agreement shall inure to the benefit of and be
binding upon BEA, Khoury and their respective successors, executors,
administrators, heirs and permitted assigns.

9.       INDEMNIFICATION. To the maximum extent permitted under Delaware law as
from time to time in effect, BEA hereby agrees to indemnify Khoury and hold him
harmless from, against and in respect of any and all damages, deficiencies,
actions, suits, proceedings, demands, assessments, judgments, claims, losses,
costs, expenses, obligations and liabilities arising from or related to the
performance of this Agreement by Khoury.

10.      WAIVER. The waiver by any party hereto of a breach of any provision of
this Agreement by any other party will not operate or be construed as a waiver
of any other or subsequent breach by such other party.

11.      SEVERABILITY. If any part of this Agreement is found invalid or
unenforceable, that part will be amended to achieve as nearly as possible the
same economic effect as the original provision, and the remainder of this
Agreement will remain in full force.



                                      -6-


<PAGE>   7

12.      NOTICES. Any notice or other communication in connection with this
Agreement shall be deemed to be delivered if in writing, addressed as provided
below and actually delivered at said address.

         If to Khoury, to him at the following address:

                  c/o The K.A.D. Companies, Inc.
                  36 Washington Street
                  Suite 190
                  Wellesley Hills, Massachusetts 02181

         If to BEA, to it at the following address:

                  1601 East Chestnut Avenue
                  Santa Ana, California 92702
                  Attention: President

         or to such other person or address as to which either party may notify
         the other in accordance with this Section 12.

13.      ARBITRATION. In the event of a dispute between the parties as to the
meaning or interpretation of this Agreement, or the performance of either party
hereunder, either party may submit the matter for arbitration in Boston,
Massachusetts, to the American Arbitration Association, which is expressly
permitted and required hereby, to include the reasonable costs of arbitration,
including attorney fees, of the prevailing party, in its decision. If the
non-prevailing party should then fail to comply with such decision, the
reasonable costs of enforcement, including attorneys fees, shall be paid to the
prevailing party. Such costs shall specifically include any judicial proceeding
to confirm such decision.

14.      SURVIVAL. The obligations of Khoury pursuant to Section 5 hereof and
the obligations of BEA pursuant to Section 6 hereof shall each survive
termination of this Agreement.

15.      MISCELLANEOUS. This Agreement constitutes the entire understanding of
the parties with respect to the subject matter hereof and supersedes all prior
and current understandings and agreements, whether written or oral. This
Agreement may be amended or modified only by a written instrument signed by
Khoury and by a duly authorized representative of BEA. This Agreement may be
executed in any number of counterparts which together shall constitute one
instrument and shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws
(other than the conflicts of laws rules) of the Commonwealth of Massachusetts.



                                       -7-


<PAGE>   8



         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have hereunto set their hands,
as of the date first above written.




                                             -----------------------------------
                                             AMIN J. KHOURY

                                             BE AVIONICS, INC.



                                             By
                                               ---------------------------------
                                               Robert J. Khoury,
                                               duly authorized



                                       -8-


<PAGE>   1
                              EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

         THIS EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT is made as of this 1st day of March, 1992 by
and between BE Avionics, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company" or
"Employer"), and Robert J. Khoury (the "Executive").

                                    RECITALS

         1. The Executive has been employed by the Employer as President.

         2. The services and ability of the Executive have constituted a major
factor in the growth and development of the Employer.

         3. The Employer desires to continue to employ and retain the Executive
and to make secure for itself the experience, abilities and services of the
Executive and to prevent the loss of such experience, services and abilities.

         4. In consideration of the employment to be provided hereby and the
amounts to be paid as provided herein, the Executive desires to be employed by
the Employer and to agree with the Employer as further provided herein.

         NOW THEREFORE, the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:

1. EMPLOYMENT. The Employer shall employ the Executive, and the Executive shall
perform services for and continue in the employment of the Employer, for a
period of six (6) years (the "Employment Period") commencing on March 1, 1992
and ending on February 28, 1997 (the "Expiration Date") unless such employment
shall have been sooner terminated as hereinafter set forth. In consideration of
such employment and in consideration of any subsequent retention as a consultant
as provided in Section 4(f) hereof, the Executive has concurrently executed a
Proprietary Rights Agreement, a copy of which is attached as Exhibit A hereto.

2. POSITION AND DUTIES. The Executive shall serve in the capacity of President,
Cabin Products Division or in such other executive position as the Board of
Directors of the Company may designate from time to time (but only upon
agreement with the Executive), shall be accountable to, and shall have such
other powers, duties and responsibilities, consistent with his capacity, as the
Board of Directors and the Executive shall by mutual agreement from time to time
determine. The Executive shall perform and discharge, faithfully, diligently and
to the best of his ability, such duties and responsibilities. The Executive
shall devote substantially all of his working time and efforts to the business
and affairs of the Company.

3. COMPENSATION.



<PAGE>   2




         (a) SALARY. During each year of the Employment Period, the Executive
shall receive an annual salary (the "Salary") of $200,000. Such rate shall be
subject to adjustment from time to time by the Board of Directors; PROVIDED,
HOWEVER, that it shall at no time be adjusted below $200,000. The Salary shall
be payable biweekly or in accordance with the Company's current payroll
practices. Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, the Salary shall be
pro-rated for any period of service less than a full year.

         (b) INCENTIVE BONUS. During each year of the Employment Period, the
Executive shall receive an incentive bonus for such year as determined in
advance by the Board of Directors of the Company at the end of the year, which
bonus shall not exceed 100% of the Salary.

         (c) EXPENSES. During the Employment Period, the Executive shall be
entitled to receive prompt reimbursement for all reasonable business expenses
incurred by him on behalf of the Employer.

         (d) FRINGE BENEFITS. During the Employment Period, the Executive shall
be entitled to participate in or receive benefits under any life or disability
insurance, health, pension, retirement and accident plans or arrangements made
generally available by the Company to its executives and key management
employees, subject to and on a basis consistent with the terms, conditions and
overall administration of such plans and arrangements. In accordance with the
Company policy, the Executive shall also be entitled to paid vacation in any
fiscal year during the Employment Period as well as all paid holidays given by
the Company to its employees.

         (e) AUTOMOBILE. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing,
during the Employment Period, the Executive shall be furnished with a
Company-owned automobile or an automobile allowance, at the discretion of the
Company.

4. TERMINATION AND COMPENSATION THEREON.

         (a) TERMINATION DATE. The term (the "Termination Date") shall mean the
earlier of (i) the Expiration Date or (ii) if the Executive's employment is
terminated (A) by his death, the date of his death, or (B) for any other reason,
the date on which such termination is to be effective pursuant to the notice of
termination given by the party terminating the employment relationship.

         (b) DEATH. The Executive's employment hereunder shall terminate upon
his death. In such event, the Company shall pay to such person as the Executive
shall have designated in a notice filed with the Company, or, if no such person
shall have been designated, to his estate, an amount equal to the Salary that
would have been due to the Executive had this Agreement been in effect from the
date of his death until the Expiration Date.

                                       -2-



<PAGE>   3



         (c) INCAPACITY. If in the reasonable judgment of the Board of Directors
of the Company, as a result of the Executive's incapacity due to physical or
mental illness or otherwise, the Executive shall for at least six consecutive
months during the term of this Agreement have been unable to perform his duties
under this Agreement on a full-time basis, the Company may terminate the
Executive's employment hereunder by notice to the Executive. In such event, the
Employer shall continue to pay the Executive his Salary (at the rate in effect
as of the Termination Date) and (to the extent legally practicable) extend to
him the applicable fringe benefits referred to in Section 3(d) hereof until the
Expiration Date. The Company's obligation to pay the Executive his Salary and
extend to him such benefits shall terminate if the Executive subsequently takes
other employment to the extent of the Executive's salary and benefits from such
other employment. Any dispute between the Board of Directors of the Company and
the Executive with respect to the Executive's incapacity shall be settled by
reference to a competent medical authority mutually agreed to by the Board of
Directors and the Executive, whose decision shall be binding on all parties.

         (d) RETIREMENT. If the Executive terminates his employment hereunder or
under any renewal hereof on or after his fifty-fifth birthday and after at least
10 years of service to the Company, then the Company shall pay to the Executive
(or in the event of the Executive's death after such termination, to such person
as the Executive shall have designated in a notice filed with the Company, or,
if no such person shall have been designated, to his estate) for ten successive
years after such termination an annual sum equal to one-half TIMES the
Executive's annual salary for the three fiscal years most recently completed
immediately preceding such termination. Notwithstanding the termination of the
Employment Period by the Executive in accordance with this Section 4(d), the
obligations of the Company pursuant to this Section 4(d) shall survive such
termination.

         (e) TERMINATION BY THE COMPANY. The Company may terminate the
Executive's employment hereunder for "cause". For purposes of this Agreement,
"cause" shall mean (A) the Executive's material failure, refusal or neglect to
perform and discharge his duties and responsibilities hereunder (including
duties prescribed by the Board of Directors pursuant to Section 2), other
material breach of the terms hereof, or breach of his fiduciary duties as an
officer or member of the Board of Directors of the Company or any subsidiary or
affiliate thereof, as applicable, or (B) a felony conviction or a conviction for
any crime involving the Executive's personal dishonesty or moral turpitude. If
the Executive's employment is terminated pursuant to this Section 4(e), the
Employer shall have no further obligations to the Executive hereunder after the
Termination Date, except for unpaid Salary and benefits accrued through the
Termination Date.

         (f) CONSULTING PERIOD UPON TERMINATION. If the Company (i) terminates
the Executive's employment hereunder prior to the Expiration Date for any reason
whatsoever or (ii) fails to extend the Executive's employment hereunder for a
period of at least three years beyond the Expiration Date at his then current
Salary and otherwise on the terms and 


                                      -3-


<PAGE>   4

conditions set forth herein, then the Company shall have the option, at its sole
discretion, of retaining the Executive as a consultant to perform such services
as the Company may reasonably request, in consideration for which services the
Company shall continue to pay the Executive the same Salary and (to the extent
legally practicable) extend to him the applicable fringe benefits referred to in
Section 3(d), as in effect on the Termination Date (in the case of (i) above) or
the Expiration Date (in the case of (ii) above) for the period commencing on the
Termination Date or Expiration Date and ending on the date five years after the
Expiration Date or on such earlier date as the Company may otherwise specify by
at least two weeks' prior written notice (the "Consulting Period").

5. AMENDMENTS. No amendment to this Agreement or any schedule hereto shall be
effective unless it shall be in writing and signed by each party hereto.

6. NOTICES. All notices and other communications hereunder shall be in writing
and shall be deemed given when delivered personally or three days after being
mailed by registered or certified mail (return receipt requested) to the parties
at the following addresses (or at such other address for a party as shall be
specified by like notice):

         (i)      if to Employer, to it at:

                  c/o The K.A.D. Companies, Inc.
                  36 Washington Street, Suite 190
                  Wellesley, MA 02181
                  Attention: Amin J. Khoury

                  with copies to

                  Ropes & Gray
                  One International Place
                  Boston, Massachusetts 02110
                  Attention: C. Dean Dusseault

         (ii)     if to the Executive, to him at:

                  975 Sunshine Lane
                  Altamonte Springs, FL 32714

7. ENTIRE AGREEMENT. This Agreement and the Proprietary Rights Agreement of even
date herewith constitute the entire agreement among the parties hereto
pertaining to the subject matter hereof and supersede all prior and
contemporaneous agreements, understandings, negotiations and discussions,
whether oral or written, of the parties.



                                      -4-



<PAGE>   5

8. MISCELLANEOUS. The invalidity or unenforceability of any term or provision
hereof shall not affect the validity or enforceability of any other term or
provision hereof. The headings in this Agreement are for convenience of
reference only and shall not alter or otherwise affect the meaning hereof. This
Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts which together shall
constitute one instrument and shall be governed and construed in accordance with
the laws (other than the conflict of laws rules) of the State of Florida and
shall bind and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective
successors and assigns.



                                       -5-



<PAGE>   6




         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto execute this Agreement as of the
date first written above.

                                               BE AVIONICS, INC.


                                               By:___________________________
                                                  Amin J. Khoury
                                                  Chairman of the Board


                                               ROBERT J. KHOURY





                                               ------------------------------







                                       -6-


<PAGE>   7



                                                                       Exhibit A

                   PROPRIETARY RIGHTS AND CONSULTING AGREEMENT

This Agreement is intended to set forth in writing my responsibility to BE
Avionics, Inc. (the "Company") during my employment with the Company, during any
subsequent consulting period and thereafter. I recognize that the Company is
engaged in a continuous program of research, development, and production
respecting its business, present and future. As part of my employment with the
Company and any subsequent consultancy, I have certain obligations relating to
confidential information of the Company and inventions which I develop during my
employment or consultancy.

In return for my employment by the Company, I acknowledge and agree that:

1. AGREEMENT; EFFECTIVE DATE. I have today executed an Employment Agreement of
even date herewith (the "Employment Agreement") between the Company and myself.
In return for my employment pursuant thereto and any subsequent consulting
pursuant to Section 4(f) thereof, I agree to abide by the terms of this
Proprietary Rights Agreement during my employment with the Company and any
subsequent Consulting Period (as defined in Section 4(f) of the Employment
Agreement). This Proprietary Rights Agreement shall be effective on March 1,
1992 and shall continue in effect throughout my employment and the Consulting
Period, if any (the "Agreement Period").

2. CONFIDENTIALITY. I will maintain in confidence and will not disclose or use,
either during or after the Agreement Period, any proprietary or confidential
information or know-how belonging to the Company ("Proprietary Information"),
whether or not in written form, except to the extent required to perform duties
on behalf of the Company. Proprietary Information refers to any information, not
generally known in the relevant trade or industry, which was obtained from the
Company, or which was learned, discovered, developed, conceived, originated or
prepared by me in the scope of my employment or consultancy. Such Proprietary
Information includes, but is not limited to, the Company's inventions or
products, research and development, production processes, manufacturing and
engineering processes, machines and equipment, finances, customers, marketing,
and production and future business plans, information belonging to customers or
suppliers of the Company disclosed incidental to my employment or consultancy
and any other information which is identified as confidential by the Company.



                                      -1-


<PAGE>   8

3. INVENTIONS.

         3.1. DEFINITION OF INVENTIONS. As used in this Agreement, the term
"Invention" means any new or useful art, discovery, contribution, finding or
improvement, whether or not patentable, and all related know-how. Inventions
include, but are not limited to, all designs, discoveries, formulas, processes,
manufacturing techniques, semiconductor designs, computer software, inventions,
improvements and ideas.

         3.2. DISCLOSURE AND ASSIGNMENT OF INVENTIONS.

         (a) I will promptly disclose and describe to the Company all Inventions
which I may solely or jointly conceive, develop, or reduce to practice during
the Agreement Period (i) which relate, at the time of conception, development,
or reduction to practice of the Invention, to the Company's business or actual
or demonstrably anticipated research or development, (ii) which were developed,
in whole or in part, on the Company's time or with the use of any of the
Company's equipment, supplies, facilities or trade secret information, or (iii)
which resulted from any work I performed for the Company (the "Company
Inventions"). I assign all my right, title, and interest worldwide in the
Company Inventions and in all intellectual property rights based upon the
Company Inventions. However, I do not assign or agree to assign any Inventions
relating in any way to the Company business or demonstrably anticipated research
and development which were made by me prior to my employment with the Company,
which Inventions, if any, are identified on Exhibit "A" to this Agreement.
Exhibit "A" contains no confidential information. I have no rights in any
Inventions other than the inventions specified in Exhibit "A". If no such list
is attached, I have no such Inventions or I grant an irrevocable, nonexclusive,
royalty-free, worldwide license to the Company to make, use and sell Inventions
developed by me prior to my employment with the Company.

         (b) I recognize that Inventions relating to my activities while working
for the Company and conceived or made by me, alone or with others, within one
(1) year after termination of the Agreement Period may have been conceived in
significant part while I was retained by the Company. Accordingly, I agree that
such Inventions shall be presumed to have been conceived during my employment or
consultancy with the Company and are to be assigned to the Company as a Company
Invention unless and until I have established the contrary. I agree to disclose
promptly in writing to the Company all Inventions made or conceived by me for
one (1) year after the Agreement Period, whether or not I believe such
Inventions are subject to this Agreement, to permit a determination by the
Company as to whether or not the Inventions should be the property of the
Company. Any such information will be received in confidence by the Company.

4. DOCUMENTS AND MATERIAL. Upon termination of my employment with the Company
(regardless of whether or not the Company retains me as a consultant) or at any
other time upon the Company's request, I will promptly deliver to the Company,
without retaining any 


                                      -2-
<PAGE>   9


copies, all documents and other materials furnished to me by the Company,
prepared by me for the Company or otherwise relating to the Company's business,
including without limitation all written and tangible material in my possession
incorporating any Proprietary Information.

5. COMPETITIVE EMPLOYMENT. During the Agreement Period, I will not engage in any
employment, consulting, or other activity in any business competitive with the
Company without the Company's written consent.

6. NON-SOLICITATION. During the Agreement Period and for a period of two (2)
years thereafter, I will not solicit or encourage, or cause others to solicit or
encourage, any employees of the Company to terminate their employment with the
Company.

7. ACTS TO SECURE PROPRIETARY RIGHTS.

         7.1. FURTHER ACTS. I agree to perform, during and after the Agreement
Period, all acts deemed necessary or desirable by the Company to permit and
assist it, at its expense, in perfecting and enforcing the full benefits,
enjoyment, rights and title throughout the world in the Company Inventions. Such
acts may include, but are not limited to, execution of documents and assistance
or cooperation in the registration and enforcement of applicable patents and
copyrights or other legal proceedings.

         7.2. APPOINTMENT OF ATTORNEY-IN-FACT. In the event that the Company is
unable for any reason whatsoever to secure my signature to any lawful and
necessary document required to apply for or execute any patent, copyright or
other applications with respect to any Company Inventions (including
improvements, renewals, extensions, continuations, divisions or continuations in
part thereof), I hereby irrevocably appoint the Company and its duly authorized
officers and agents as my agents and attorneys-in-fact to execute and file any
such application and to do all other lawfully permitted acts to further the
prosecution and issuance of patents, copyrights or other rights thereon with the
same legal force and effect as if executed by me.

8. NO CONFLICTING OBLIGATIONS. My performance of this Agreement does not and
will not breach any agreement to keep in confidence proprietary information,
knowledge or data acquired by me prior to my employment with the Company. I will
not disclose to the Company, or induce the Company to use, any confidential or
proprietary information or material belonging to any previous employer or other
person or entity. I am not a party to any other agreement which will interfere
with my full compliance with this Agreement. I will not enter into any
agreement, whether written or oral, conflicting with the provisions of this
Agreement.

9. SURVIVAL. Notwithstanding the termination of the Agreement Period, Sections
2, 3.2, 4, 6 and 7 hereof shall survive such termination. This Agreement does
not in any way restrict my 



                                      -3-


<PAGE>   10

right or the right of the Company to terminate my employment at any time, for
any reason or for no reason. I understand, however, that only the Company may
terminate my consultancy, in its sole discretion, by at least two (2) weeks
written notice.

10. SPECIFIC PERFORMANCE. A breach of any of the promises or agreements
contained herein will result in irreparable and continuing damage to the Company
for which there will be no adequate remedy at law, and the Company shall be
entitled to injunctive relief and/or a decree for specific performance, and such
other relief as may be proper (including monetary damages if appropriate).

11. WAIVER. The waiver by the Company of a breach of any provision of this
Agreement by me will not operate or be construed as a waiver of any other or
subsequent breach by me.

12. SEVERABILITY. If any part of this Agreement is found invalid or
unenforceable, that part will be amended to achieve as nearly as possible the
same economic effect as the original provision, and the remainder of this
Agreement will remain in full force.

13. GOVERNING LAW. This Agreement will be governed by and construed in
accordance with the laws (other than the conflict of laws rules) of the State of
Florida.

14. ENTIRE AGREEMENT. This Agreement, the Exhibits to this Agreement and the
Employment Agreement of even date herewith constitute the entire agreement
between the parties relating to this subject matter and supersede all prior or
simultaneous representations, discussions, negotiations, and agreements, whether
written or oral. This Agreement may be amended or modified only with the written
consent of both me and the Company. No oral waiver, amendment or modification
will be effective under any circumstances whatsoever.





                                       -4-



<PAGE>   11




15. ASSIGNMENT. This Agreement may be assigned by the Company. I may not assign
or delegate my duties under this Agreement without the Company's prior written
approval. This Agreement shall be binding upon my heirs, successors, and
permitted assignees.

                                                      EMPLOYEE:


Date:  March 1, 1992                          _________________________
                                                      Signature


                                                      -------------------------
                                                      Printed Name

                                                      BE AVIONICS, INC.


Date:  March 1, 1992                          By:______________________

                                                      Title:___________________






                                       -5-




<PAGE>   1
                              EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

         THIS EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT is made as of this 1st day of March, 1992 by
and between BE Avionics, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company" or
"Employer"), and Marco Lanza (the "Executive").

                                    RECITALS

         1. The Executive has been employed by the Employer as Vice President,
Marketing and Product Development.

         2. The services and ability of the Executive have constituted a major
factor in the growth and development of the Employer.

         3. The Employer desires to continue to employ and retain the Executive
and to make secure for itself the experience, abilities and services of the
Executive and to prevent the loss of such experience, services and abilities.

         4. In consideration of the employment to be provided hereby and the
amounts to be paid as provided herein, the Executive desires to be employed by
the Employer and to agree with the Employer as further provided herein.

         NOW THEREFORE, the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:

1. EMPLOYMENT. The Employer shall employ the Executive, and the Executive shall
perform services for and continue in the employment of the Employer, for a
period of five (5) years (the "Employment Period") commencing on March 1, 1992
and ending on February 28, 1997 (the "Expiration Date"), unless such employment
shall have been sooner terminated as hereinafter set forth. In consideration of
such employment and in consideration of any subsequent retention as a consultant
as provided in Section 4(e) hereof, the Executive has concurrently executed a
Proprietary Rights Agreement, a copy of which is attached as Exhibit A hereto.

2. POSITION AND DUTIES. The Executive shall serve in the capacity of President,
Inflight Entertainment Division or in such other executive position as the Board
of Directors of the Company may designate from time to time, shall be
accountable to, and shall have such other powers, duties and responsibilities,
consistent with his capacity, as may from time to time be prescribed by the
Board of Directors. The Executive shall perform and discharge, faithfully,
diligently and to the best of his ability, such duties and responsibilities. The
Executive shall devote substantially all of his working time and efforts to the
business and affairs of the Company.



<PAGE>   2



3. COMPENSATION.

         (a) SALARY. During each year of the Employment Period, the Executive
shall receive an annual salary (the "Salary") of $150,000. Such rate shall be
subject to adjustment from time to time by the Board of Directors; PROVIDED,
HOWEVER, that it shall at no time be adjusted below $150,000. The Salary shall
be payable biweekly or in accordance with the Company's current payroll
practices. Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, the Salary shall be
pro-rated for any period of service less than a full year.

         (b) INCENTIVE BONUS. During each year of the Employment Period, the
Executive shall receive an incentive bonus for such year as determined in
advance by the Board of Directors of the Company at the end of the year, which
bonus shall not exceed 100% of the Salary.

         (c) EXPENSES. During the Employment Period, the Executive shall be
entitled to receive prompt reimbursement for all reasonable business expenses
incurred by him on behalf of the Employer.

         (d) FRINGE BENEFITS. During the Employment Period, the Executive shall
be entitled to participate in or receive benefits under any life or disability
insurance, health, pension, retirement and accident plans or arrangements made
generally available by the Company to its executives and key management
employees, subject to and on a basis consistent with the terms, conditions and
overall administration of such plans and arrangements. In accordance with the
Company policy, the Executive shall also be entitled to paid vacation in any
fiscal year during the Employment Period as well as all paid holidays given by
the Company to its employees.

         (e) AUTOMOBILE. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing,
during the Employment Period, the Executive shall be furnished with a
Company-owned automobile or an automobile allowance, at the discretion of the
Company.

4. TERMINATION AND COMPENSATION THEREON.

         (a) TERMINATION DATE. The term (the "Termination Date") shall mean the
earlier of (i) the Expiration Date or (ii) if the Executive's employment is
terminated (A) by his death, the date of his death, or (B) for any other reason,
the date on which such termination is to be effective pursuant to the notice of
termination given by the party terminating the employment relationship.

         (b) DEATH. The Executive's employment hereunder shall terminate upon
his death. In such event, the Company shall pay to such person as the Executive
shall have designated in a notice filed with the Company, or, if no such person
shall have been designated, to his estate, an amount equal to the Salary that
would have been due to the Executive had this Agreement been in effect from the
date of his death until the Expiration Date.

                                       -2-




<PAGE>   3



         (c) INCAPACITY. If in the reasonable judgment of the Board of Directors
of the Company, as a result of the Executive's incapacity due to physical or
mental illness or otherwise, the Executive shall for at least six consecutive
months during the term of this Agreement have been unable to perform his duties
under this Agreement on a full-time basis, the Company may terminate the
Executive's employment hereunder by notice to the Executive. In such event, the
Employer shall continue to pay the Executive his Salary (at the rate in effect
as of the Termination Date) and (to the extent legally practicable) extend to
him the applicable fringe benefits referred to in Section 3(d) hereof until the
Expiration Date. The Company's obligation to pay the Executive his Salary and
extend to him such benefits shall terminate if the Executive subsequently takes
other employment to the extent of the Executive's salary and benefits from such
other employment. Any dispute between the Board of Directors of the Company and
the Executive with respect to the Executive's incapacity shall be settled by
reference to a competent medical authority mutually agreed to by the Board of
Directors and the Executive, whose decision shall be binding on all parties.

         (d) TERMINATION BY THE COMPANY. The Company may terminate the
Executive's employment hereunder for "cause". For purposes of this Agreement,
"cause" shall mean (A) the Executive's material failure, refusal or neglect to
perform and discharge his duties and responsibilities hereunder (including
duties prescribed by the Board of Directors pursuant to Section 2), other
material breach of the terms hereof, or breach of his fiduciary duties as an
officer or member of the Board of Directors of the Company or any subsidiary or
affiliate thereof, as applicable, or (B) a felony conviction or a conviction for
any crime involving the Executive's personal dishonesty or moral turpitude. If
the Executive's employment is terminated pursuant to this Section 4(d), the
Employer shall have no further obligations to the Executive hereunder after the
Termination Date, except for unpaid Salary and benefits accrued through the
Termination Date.

         (e) CONSULTING PERIOD UPON TERMINATION. If the Company (i) terminates
the Executive's employment hereunder prior to the Expiration Date for any reason
whatsoever or (ii) fails to extend the Executive's employment hereunder for a
period of at least three years beyond the Expiration Date at his then current
Salary and otherwise on the terms and conditions set forth herein, then the
Company shall have the option, at its sole discretion, of retaining the
Executive as a consultant to perform such services as the Company may reasonably
request, in consideration for which services the Company shall continue to pay
the Executive the same Salary and (to the extent legally practicable) extend to
him the applicable fringe benefits referred to in Section 3(d), as in effect on
the Termination date (in the case of (i) above) or the Expiration Date (in the
case of (ii) above) for the period commencing on the Termination Date or
Expiration Date and ending on the date five years after the Expiration Date or
on such earlier date as the Company may otherwise specify by at least two weeks'
prior written notice (the "Consulting Period").

5. AMENDMENTS. No amendment to this Agreement or any schedule hereto shall be
effective unless it shall be in writing and signed by each party hereto.



                                      -3-


<PAGE>   4

6. NOTICES. All notices and other communications hereunder shall be in writing
and shall be deemed given when delivered personally or three days after being
mailed by registered or certified mail (return receipt requested) to the parties
at the following addresses (or at such other address for a party as shall be
specified by like notice):

         (i)      if to Employer, to it at:

                  c/o The K.A.D. Companies, Inc.
                  36 Washington Street, Suite 190
                  Wellesley, MA 02181
                  Attention: Amin J. Khoury

                  with copies to

                  Ropes & Gray
                  One International Place
                  Boston, Massachusetts 02110
                  Attention: C. Dean Dusseault

         (ii)     if to the Executive, to him at:

                  1601 East Chestnut Ave.
                  Santa Ana, CA 92701

7. ENTIRE AGREEMENT. This Agreement and the Proprietary Rights Agreement of even
date herewith constitute the entire agreement among the parties hereto
pertaining to the subject matter hereof and supersede all prior and
contemporaneous agreements, understandings, negotiations and discussions,
whether oral or written, of the parties.

8. MISCELLANEOUS. The invalidity or unenforceability of any term or provision
hereof shall not affect the validity or enforceability of any other term or
provision hereof. The headings in this Agreement are for convenience of
reference only and shall not alter or otherwise affect the meaning hereof. This
Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts which together shall
constitute one instrument and shall be governed and construed in accordance with
the laws (other than the conflict of laws rules) of The State of California and
shall bind and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective
successors and assigns.



                                       -4-



<PAGE>   5



         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto execute this Agreement as of the
date first written above.

                                                 BE AVIONICS, INC.


                                                 By:___________________________
                                                    Amin J. Khoury
                                                    Chairman  of the Board


                                                 MARCO LANZA



                                                 ------------------------------







                                       -5-




<PAGE>   6


                                                                       Exhibit A

                   PROPRIETARY RIGHTS AND CONSULTING AGREEMENT

This Agreement is intended to set forth in writing my responsibility to BE
Avionics, Inc. (the "Company") during my employment with the Company, during any
subsequent consulting period and thereafter. I recognize that the Company is
engaged in a continuous program of research, development, and production
respecting its business, present and future. As part of my employment with the
Company and any subsequent consultancy, I have certain obligations relating to
confidential information of the Company and inventions which I develop during my
employment or consultancy.

In return for my employment by the Company, I acknowledge and agree that:

1. AGREEMENT; EFFECTIVE DATE. I have today executed an Employment Agreement of
even date herewith (the "Employment Agreement") between the Company and myself.
In return for my employment pursuant thereto and any subsequent consulting
pursuant to Section 4(e) thereof, I agree to abide by the terms of this
Proprietary Rights Agreement during my employment with the Company and any
subsequent Consulting Period (as defined in Section 4(e) of the Employment
Agreement). This Proprietary Rights Agreement shall be effective on March 1,
1992 and shall continue in effect throughout my employment and the Consulting
Period, if any (the "Agreement Period").

2. CONFIDENTIALITY. I will maintain in confidence and will not disclose or use,
either during or after the Agreement Period, any proprietary or confidential
information or know-how belonging to the Company ("Proprietary Information"),
whether or not in written form, except to the extent required to perform duties
on behalf of the Company. Proprietary Information refers to any information, not
generally known in the relevant trade or industry, which was obtained from the
Company, or which was learned, discovered, developed, conceived, originated or
prepared by me in the scope of my employment or consultancy. Such Proprietary
Information includes, but is not limited to, the Company's inventions or
products, research and development, production processes, manufacturing and
engineering processes, machines and equipment, finances, customers, marketing,
and production and future business plans, information belonging to customers or
suppliers of the Company disclosed incidental to my employment or consultancy
and any other information which is identified as confidential by the Company.



                                      -1-

<PAGE>   7

3. INVENTIONS.

         3.1. DEFINITION OF INVENTIONS. As used in this Agreement, the term
"Invention" means any new or useful art, discovery, contribution, finding or
improvement, whether or not patentable, and all related know-how. Inventions
include, but are not limited to, all designs, discoveries, formulas, processes,
manufacturing techniques, semiconductor designs, computer software, inventions,
improvements and ideas.

         3.2. DISCLOSURE AND ASSIGNMENT OF INVENTIONS.

         (a) I will promptly disclose and describe to the Company all Inventions
which I may solely or jointly conceive, develop, or reduce to practice during
the Agreement Period (i) which relate, at the time of conception, development,
or reduction to practice of the Invention, to the Company's business or actual
or demonstrably anticipated research or development, (ii) which were developed,
in whole or in part, on the Company's time or with the use of any of the
Company's equipment, supplies, facilities or trade secret information, or (iii)
which resulted from any work I performed for the Company (the "Company
Inventions"). I assign all my right, title, and interest worldwide in the
Company Inventions and in all intellectual property rights based upon the
Company Inventions. However, I do not assign or agree to assign any Inventions
relating in any way to the Company business or demonstrably anticipated research
and development which were made by me prior to my employment with the Company,
which Inventions, if any, are identified on Exhibit "A" to this Agreement.
Exhibit "A" contains no confidential information. I have no rights in any
Inventions other than the inventions specified in Exhibit "A". If no such list
is attached, I have no such Inventions or I grant an irrevocable, nonexclusive,
royalty-free, worldwide license to the Company to make, use and sell Inventions
developed by me prior to my employment with the Company.

         (b) I recognize that Inventions relating to my activities while working
for the Company and conceived or made by me, alone or with others, within one
(1) year after termination of the Agreement Period may have been conceived in
significant part while I was retained by the Company. Accordingly, I agree that
such Inventions shall be presumed to have been conceived during my employment or
consultancy with the Company and are to be assigned to the Company as a Company
Invention unless and until I have established the contrary. I agree to disclose
promptly in writing to the Company all Inventions made or conceived by me for
one (1) year after the Agreement Period, whether or not I believe such
Inventions are subject to this Agreement, to permit a determination by the
Company as to whether or not the Inventions should be the property of the
Company. Any such information will be received in confidence by the Company.

         3.3. NON-ASSIGNABLE INVENTIONS. This Agreement does not apply to an
Invention which qualifies fully as a Non-Assignable Invention under the
provision of Section 2870 of the California Labor Code.



                                      -2-

<PAGE>   8

4. DOCUMENTS AND MATERIAL. Upon termination of my employment with the Company
(regardless of whether or not the Company retains me as a consultant) or at any
other time upon the Company's request, I will promptly deliver to the Company,
without retaining any copies, all documents and other materials furnished to me
by the Company, prepared by me for the Company or otherwise relating to the
Company's business, including without limitation all written and tangible
material in my possession incorporating any Proprietary Information.

5. COMPETITIVE EMPLOYMENT. During the Agreement Period, I will not engage in any
employment, consulting, or other activity in any business competitive with the
Company without the Company's written consent.

6. NON-SOLICITATION. During the Agreement Period and for a period of two (2)
years thereafter, I will not solicit or encourage, or cause others to solicit or
encourage, any employees of the Company to terminate their employment with the
Company.

7. ACTS TO SECURE PROPRIETARY RIGHTS.

         7.1.  FURTHER ACTS. I agree to perform, during and after the Agreement
Period, all acts deemed necessary or desirable by the Company to permit and
assist it, at its expense, in perfecting and enforcing the full benefits,
enjoyment, rights and title throughout the world in the Company Inventions. Such
acts may include, but are not limited to, execution of documents and assistance
or cooperation in the registration and enforcement of applicable patents and
copyrights or other legal proceedings.

         7.2.  APPOINTMENT OF ATTORNEY-IN-FACT. In the event that the Company is
unable for any reason whatsoever to secure my signature to any lawful and
necessary document required to apply for or execute any patent, copyright or
other applications with respect to any Company Inventions (including
improvements, renewals, extensions, continuations, divisions or continuations in
part thereof), I hereby irrevocably appoint the Company and its duly authorized
officers and agents as my agents and attorneys-in-fact to execute and file any
such application and to do all other lawfully permitted acts to further the
prosecution and issuance of patents, copyrights or other rights thereon with the
same legal force and effect as if executed by me.

8. NO CONFLICTING OBLIGATIONS. My performance of this Agreement does not and
will not breach any agreement to keep in confidence proprietary information,
knowledge or data acquired by me prior to my employment with the Company. I will
not disclose to the Company, or induce the Company to use, any confidential or
proprietary information or material belonging to any previous employer or other
person or entity. I am not a party to any other agreement which will interfere
with my full compliance with this Agreement. I will not enter into any
agreement, whether written or oral, conflicting with the provisions of this
Agreement.



                                      -3-


<PAGE>   9

9. SURVIVAL. Notwithstanding the termination of the Agreement Period, Sections
2, 3.2, 4, 6 and 7 hereof shall survive such termination. This Agreement does
not in any way restrict my right or the right of the Company to terminate my
employment at any time, for any reason or for no reason. I understand, however,
that only the Company may terminate my consultancy, in its sole discretion, by
at least two (2) weeks written notice.

10. SPECIFIC PERFORMANCE. A breach of any of the promises or agreements
contained herein will result in irreparable and continuing damage to the Company
for which there will be no adequate remedy at law, and the Company shall be
entitled to injunctive relief and/or a decree for specific performance, and such
other relief as may be proper (including monetary damages if appropriate).

11. WAIVER. The waiver by the Company of a breach of any provision of this
Agreement by me will not operate or be construed as a waiver of any other or
subsequent breach by me.

12. SEVERABILITY. If any part of this Agreement is found invalid or
unenforceable, that part will be amended to achieve as nearly as possible the
same economic effect as the original provision, and the remainder of this
Agreement will remain in full force.

13. GOVERNING LAW. This Agreement will be governed by and construed in
accordance with the laws of the United States and the State of California as
applied to agreements entered into and to be performed entirely within
California between California residents.

14. CHOICE OF FORUM. The parties hereby submit to the jurisdiction of, and waive
any venue objections against, the United States District Court for Los
Angeles/Orange County, and the Superior and Municipal Courts of the State of
California, Orange County, in any litigation arising out of this Agreement.

15. ENTIRE AGREEMENT. This Agreement, the Exhibits to this Agreement and the
Employment Agreement of even date herewith constitute the entire agreement
between the parties relating to this subject matter and supersede all prior or
simultaneous representations, discussions, negotiations, and agreements, whether
written or oral. This Agreement may be amended or modified only with the written
consent of both me and the Company. No oral waiver, amendment or modification
will be effective under any circumstances whatsoever.

16. ASSIGNMENT. This Agreement may be assigned by the Company. I may not assign
or delegate my duties under this Agreement without the Company's prior written
approval. This Agreement shall be binding upon my heirs, successors, and
permitted assignees.

                                                      EMPLOYEE:

Date:  March 1, 1992                        _________________________



                                      -4-


<PAGE>   10

                                                      Signature


                                                      -------------------------
                                                      Printed Name

                                                      BE AVIONICS, INC.


Date:  March 1, 1992                        By:______________________

                                                      Title:___________________






                                       -5-




<PAGE>   11



                         LIMITED EXCLUSION NOTIFICATION

         THIS IS TO NOTIFY you in accordance with Section 2872 of the California
Labor Code that the above Agreement between you and the Company does not require
you to assign to the Company, any invention for which no equipment, supplies,
facility or trade secret information of the Company was used and which was
developed entirely on your own time, and (a) which does not relate (1) to the
business of the Company or (2) to the Company's actual or demonstrably
anticipated research or development, or (b) which does not result from any work
performed by you for the Company. This limited exclusion does not apply to any
patent or invention covered by a contract between the Company and the United
States or any of its agencies requiring full title to such patent or invention
to be in the United States.

         I ACKNOWLEDGE RECEIPT of a copy of this notification.



                                               -------------------------
                                               Signature


                                               -------------------------
                                               Printed Name of Employee

                                               Dated:___________________

Witnessed by:



- ------------------------------


- ------------------------------
Representative

Dated:________________________





                                       -6-




<PAGE>   12


                                   EXHIBIT "A"

                                 PRIOR INVENTION












                                       -7-




<PAGE>   1
                                                           EXECUTION COUNTERPART

                              EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

         THIS EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT is made as of this 1st day of April, 1992 by
and between BE Avionics, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company" or
"Employer"), and G. Bernard Jewell (the "Executive").

                                    RECITALS

         1. The Employer desires to employ the Executive as Group Vice President
- - Marketing and Product Development.

         2. The Employer desires to retain the Executive and to make secure for
itself the experience, abilities and services of the Executive and to prevent
the loss of such experience, services and abilities.

         3. The Executive has submitted to a physical examination by a physician
approved by the Company, and the Company has received the results of such
examination.

         4. In consideration of the employment to be provided hereby and the
amounts to be paid as provided herein, the Executive desires to be employed by
the Employer and to agree with the Employer as further provided herein.

         NOW THEREFORE, the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:

1. EMPLOYMENT. The Employer shall employ the Executive, and the Executive shall
perform services for and continue in the employment of the Employer, for a
period of three (3) years commencing on the date hereof (the "Employment
Period"), which Employment Period shall be extended after the third anniversary
of the date hereof from year to year thereafter, provided that this Agreement
shall expire upon twelve (12) months notice from either the Company or the
Executive, which notice may first be given on the second anniversary of the date
hereof and subsequently on each anniversary thereafter (such date of expiration
referred to hereinafter as the "Expiration Date"), unless such employment shall
have been sooner terminated as hereinafter set forth. In consideration of such
employment and in consideration of any subsequent retention as a consultant as
provided in Section 4(e) hereof, the Executive has concurrently executed a
Proprietary Rights Agreement, a copy of which is attached as Exhibit A hereto.

2. POSITION AND DUTIES. The Executive shall serve in the capacity of Group Vice
President Marketing and Product Development or in such other executive position
as the Chief Executive Officer of the Company or the Board of Directors of the
Company may designate from time to time, shall be accountable to, and shall have
such other powers, duties and responsibilities,






<PAGE>   2



consistent with his capacity, as may from time to time be prescribed by the
Chief Executive Officer or the Board of Directors. The Executive shall perform
and discharge, faithfully, diligently and to the best of his ability, such
duties and responsibilities. The Executive shall devote substantially all of his
working time and efforts to the business and affairs of the Company.

3. COMPENSATION.

         (a) SALARY. During each year of the Employment Period, the Executive
shall receive an annual salary (the "Salary") of $100,000. Such rate shall be
subject to adjustment from time to time by the Board of Directors; PROVIDED,
HOWEVER, that it shall at no time be adjusted below $100,000. The Salary shall
be payable biweekly or in accordance with the Company's current payroll
practices. Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, the Salary shall be
pro-rated for any period of service less than a full year.

         (b) INCENTIVE BONUS. During each year of the Employment Period, the
Executive shall receive an incentive bonus (the "Bonus") for such year as
determined in advance by the Board of Directors of the Company at the end of the
year, which bonus shall not exceed 100% of the Salary. The Bonus shall be
payable as follows: (i) the Company shall pay the Executive fifty percent (50%)
of the Bonus in cash at the end of the fiscal year in which such Bonus was
earned and (ii) the Company shall pay the Executive the remaining unpaid Bonus
in five equal annual installments commencing on the first anniversary of the
Expiration Date.

         (c) EXPENSES. During the Employment Period, the Executive shall be
entitled to receive prompt reimbursement for all reasonable business expenses
incurred by him on behalf of the Employer.

         (d) FRINGE BENEFITS. During the Employment Period, the Executive shall
be entitled to participate in or receive benefits under any life or disability
insurance, health, pension, retirement and accident plans or arrangements made
generally available by the Company to its executives and key management
employees, subject to and on a basis consistent with the terms, conditions and
overall administration of such plans and arrangements with such modifications as
the Company deems reasonably necessary in light of the results of the physical
examination referred to above. In accordance with the Company policy, the
Executive shall also be entitled to paid vacation in any fiscal year during the
Employment Period as well as all paid holidays given by the Company to its
employees.

         (e) AUTOMOBILE. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing,
during the Employment Period, the Executive shall be furnished with an
automobile either owned or leased by the Company or an automobile allowance, at
the discretion of the Company.

                                       -2-




<PAGE>   3



         (f) STOCK OPTION GRANTS. During the Employment Period, the Executive
shall be entitled to receive grants of options to purchase up to 35,000 shares
of the Company's Common Stock.

         (g) MOVING EXPENSES, ETC. In connection with the Executive's relocation
from Pfafftown, North Carolina, the Executive will transfer to the Company all
right, title and interest in and to his house located in such town, and the
Company will (i) retain a qualified appraiser to value such house; (ii) retain a
qualified broker to sell such house; (iii) advance to the Executive the greater
of (i) the appraised value of such house MINUS any indebtedness secured thereby
and (ii) an amount equal to $92,000 (being the Executive's equity in such
house), PROVIDED THAT, if the net cash proceeds (after deducting any
indebtedness secured by such house, together with any fees or expenses but
without deducting brokerage fees) from the sale of such house are less than such
amount advanced, the Executive shall promptly thereafter remit to the Company
the amount of such difference; and (iv) reimburse the Executive for all
reasonable moving expenses incurred as a result of his relocation from North
Carolina, including expenses relating to (A) moving personal property, and (B)
food and lodging for the Executive and his wife prior to the Executive's
purchase of a replacement house.

4. TERMINATION AND COMPENSATION THEREON.

         (a) TERMINATION DATE. The term (the "Termination Date") shall mean the
earlier of (i) the Expiration Date or (ii) if the Executive's employment is
terminated (A) by his death, the date of his death, or (B) for any other reason,
the date on which such termination is to be effective pursuant to the notice of
termination given by the party terminating the employment relationship.

         (b) DEATH. The Executive's employment hereunder shall terminate upon
his death. In such event, the Company shall pay to such person as the Executive
shall have designated in a notice filed with the Company, or, if no such person
shall have been designated, to his estate, an amount equal to the Salary that
would have been due to the Executive had this Agreement been in effect from the
date of his death until the Expiration Date.

         (c) INCAPACITY. If in the reasonable judgment of the Board of Directors
of the Company, as a result of the Executive's incapacity due to physical or
mental illness or otherwise, the Executive shall for at least six consecutive
months during the term of this Agreement have been unable to perform his duties
under this Agreement on a full-time basis, the Company may terminate the
Executive's employment hereunder by notice to the Executive. In such event, the
Employer shall continue to pay the Executive his Salary (at the rate in effect
as of the Termination Date) and (to the extent legally practicable) extend to
him the applicable fringe benefits referred to in Section 3(d) hereof until the
Expiration Date. The Company's obligation to pay the Executive his Salary and
extend to him such benefits shall terminate if the Executive subsequently takes
other employment to the extent of the Executive's salary and benefits from such
other employment. Any dispute between the Board of Directors of the

                  

                                       -3-




<PAGE>   4



Company and the Executive with respect to the Executive's incapacity shall be
settled by reference to a competent medical authority mutually agreed to by the
Board of Directors and the Executive, whose decision shall be binding on all
parties.

         (d) TERMINATION BY THE COMPANY. The Company may terminate the
Executive's employment hereunder for "cause". For purposes of this Agreement,
"cause" shall mean (A) the Executive's material failure, refusal or neglect to
perform and discharge his duties and responsibilities hereunder (including
duties prescribed by the Board of Directors pursuant to Section 2), other
material breach of the terms hereof, or breach of his fiduciary duties as an
officer or member of the Board of Directors of the Company or any subsidiary or
affiliate thereof, as applicable, or (B) a felony conviction or a conviction for
any crime involving the Executive's personal dishonesty or moral turpitude. If
the Executive's employment is terminated pursuant to this Section 4(d), the
Employer shall have no further obligations to the Executive hereunder after the
Termination Date, except for unpaid Salary and benefits accrued through the
Termination Date.

         (e) CONSULTING PERIOD UPON TERMINATION. If the Company (i) terminates
the Executive's employment hereunder prior to the Expiration Date for any reason
whatsoever or (ii) fails to extend the Executive's employment hereunder for a
period of at least three years beyond the Expiration Date at his then current
Salary and otherwise on the terms and conditions set forth herein, then the
Company shall have the option, at its sole discretion, of retaining the
Executive as a consultant to perform such services as the Company may reasonably
request, in consideration for which services the Company shall continue to pay
the Executive fifty percent (50%) of his Salary and (to the extent legally
practicable) extend to him the applicable fringe benefits referred to in Section
3(d), as in effect on the Termination Date (in the case of (i) above) or the
Expiration Date (in the case of (ii) above) for the period commencing on the
Termination Date or Expiration Date and ending on the date three years after the
Expiration Date or on such earlier date as the Company may otherwise specify by
at least two weeks' prior written notice (the "Consulting Period").

5. AMENDMENTS. No amendment to this Agreement or any schedule hereto shall be
effective unless it shall be in writing and signed by each party hereto.

6. NOTICES. All notices and other communications hereunder shall be in writing
and shall be deemed given when delivered personally or three days after being
mailed by registered or certified mail (return receipt requested) to the parties
at the following addresses (or at such other address for a party as shall be
specified by like notice):

         (i)      if to Employer, to it at:

                  c/o The K.A.D. Companies, Inc.
                  36 Washington Street, Suite 190
                  Wellesley, MA 02181




                                       -4-




<PAGE>   5



                  Attention: Amin J. Khoury

                  with copies to

                  Ropes & Gray
                  One International Place
                  Boston, Massachusetts 02110
                  Attention: C. Dean Dusseault

         (ii)     if to the Executive, to him at:


                  -----------------------------

                  -----------------------------

                  -----------------------------

7. ENTIRE AGREEMENT. This Agreement and the Proprietary Rights Agreement of even
date herewith constitute the entire agreement among the parties hereto
pertaining to the subject matter hereof and supersede all prior and
contemporaneous agreements, understandings, negotiations and discussions,
whether oral or written, of the parties.

8. MISCELLANEOUS. The invalidity or unenforceability of any term or provision
hereof shall not affect the validity or enforceability of any other term or
provision hereof. The headings in this Agreement are for convenience of
reference only and shall not alter or otherwise affect the meaning hereof. This
Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts which together shall
constitute one instrument and shall be governed and construed in accordance with
the laws (other than the conflict of laws rules) of the State of Florida and
shall bind and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective
successors and assigns.




                                       -5-




<PAGE>   6




         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto execute this Agreement as of the
date first written above.

                                                BE AVIONICS, INC.


                                                By:______________________
                                                   Amin J. Khoury
                                                   Chairman of the Board


                                                G. BERNARD JEWELL




                                                -------------------------






                                       -6-




<PAGE>   7



                                                                       Exhibit A

                   PROPRIETARY RIGHTS AND CONSULTING AGREEMENT

This Agreement is intended to set forth in writing my responsibility to BE
Avionics, Inc. (the "Company") during my employment with the Company, during any
subsequent consulting period and thereafter. I recognize that the Company is
engaged in a continuous program of research, development, and production
respecting its business, present and future. As part of my employment with the
Company and any subsequent consultancy, I have certain obligations relating to
confidential information of the Company and inventions which I develop during my
employment or consultancy.

In return for my employment by the Company, I acknowledge and agree that:

1. AGREEMENT; EFFECTIVE DATE. I have today executed an Employment Agreement of
even date herewith (the "Employment Agreement") between the Company and myself.
In return for my employment pursuant thereto and any subsequent consulting
pursuant to Section 4(e) thereof, I agree to abide by the terms of this
Proprietary Rights Agreement during my employment with the Company and any
subsequent Consulting Period (as defined in Section 4(e) of the Employment
Agreement). This Proprietary Rights Agreement shall be effective on April ___,
1992, the first day of my employment with the Company, and shall continue in
effect throughout my employment and the Consulting Period, if any (the
"Agreement Period").

2. CONFIDENTIALITY. I will maintain in confidence and will not disclose or use,
either during or after the Agreement Period, any proprietary or confidential
information or know-how belonging to the Company ("Proprietary Information"),
whether or not in written form, except to the extent required to perform duties
on behalf of the Company. Proprietary Information refers to any information, not
generally known in the relevant trade or industry, which was obtained from the
Company, or which was learned, discovered, developed, conceived, originated or
prepared by me in the scope of my employment or consultancy. Such Proprietary
Information includes, but is not limited to, the Company's inventions or
products, research and development, production processes, manufacturing and
engineering processes, machines and equipment, finances, customers, marketing,
and production and future business plans, information belonging to customers or
suppliers of the Company disclosed incidental to my employment or consultancy
and any other information which is identified as confidential by the Company.




                                       -1-




<PAGE>   8



3. INVENTIONS.

         3.1.  DEFINITION OF INVENTIONS. As used in this Agreement, the term
"Invention" means any new or useful art, discovery, contribution, finding or
improvement, whether or not patentable, and all related know-how. Inventions
include, but are not limited to, all designs, discoveries, formulas, processes,
manufacturing techniques, semiconductor designs, computer software, inventions,
improvements and ideas.

         3.2.   DISCLOSURE AND ASSIGNMENT OF INVENTIONS.

         (a) I will promptly disclose and describe to the Company all Inventions
which I may solely or jointly conceive, develop, or reduce to practice during
the Agreement Period (i) which relate, at the time of conception, development,
or reduction to practice of the Invention, to the Company's business or actual
or demonstrably anticipated research or development, (ii) which were developed,
in whole or in part, on the Company's time or with the use of any of the
Company's equipment, supplies, facilities or trade secret information, or (iii)
which resulted from any work I performed for the Company (the "Company
Inventions"). I assign all my right, title, and interest worldwide in the
Company Inventions and in all intellectual property rights based upon the
Company Inventions. However, I do not assign or agree to assign any Inventions
relating in any way to the Company business or demonstrably anticipated research
and development which were made by me prior to my employment with the Company,
which Inventions, if any, are identified on Exhibit "A" to this Agreement.
Exhibit "A" contains no confidential information. I have no rights in any
Inventions other than the inventions specified in Exhibit "A". If no such list
is attached, I have no such Inventions or I grant an irrevocable, nonexclusive,
royalty-free, worldwide license to the Company to make, use and sell Inventions
developed by me prior to my employment with the Company.

         (b) I recognize that Inventions relating to my activities while working
for the Company and conceived or made by me, alone or with others, within one
(1) year after termination of the Agreement Period may have been conceived in
significant part while I was retained by the Company. Accordingly, I agree that
such Inventions shall be presumed to have been conceived during my employment or
consultancy with the Company and are to be assigned to the Company as a Company
Invention unless and until I have established the contrary. I agree to disclose
promptly in writing to the Company all Inventions made or conceived by me for
one (1) year after the Agreement Period, whether or not I believe such
Inventions are subject to this Agreement, to permit a determination by the
Company as to whether or not the Inventions should be the property of the
Company. Any such information will be received in confidence by the Company. 

4. DOCUMENTS AND MATERIAL. Upon termination of my employment with the Company
(regardless of whether or not the Company retains me as a consultant) or at any
other time upon the Company's request, I will promptly deliver to the Company,
without retaining any copies, all documents and other materials furnished to me
by the Company, prepared by me for



                                       -2-




<PAGE>   9



the Company or otherwise relating to the Company's business, including without
limitation all written and tangible material in my possession incorporating any
Proprietary Information.

5. COMPETITIVE EMPLOYMENT. During the Agreement Period, I will not engage in any
employment, consulting, or other activity in any business competitive with the
Company without the Company's written consent.

6. NON-SOLICITATION. During the Agreement Period and for a period of two (2)
years thereafter, I will not solicit or encourage, or cause others to solicit or
encourage, any employees of the Company to terminate their employment with the
Company.

7. ACTS TO SECURE PROPRIETARY RIGHTS.

         7.1.  FURTHER ACTS. I agree to perform, during and after the Agreement
Period, all acts deemed necessary or desirable by the Company to permit and
assist it, at its expense, in perfecting and enforcing the full benefits,
enjoyment, rights and title throughout the world in the Company Inventions. Such
acts may include, but are not limited to, execution of documents and assistance
or cooperation in the registration and enforcement of applicable patents and
copyrights or other legal proceedings.

         7.2.  APPOINTMENT OF ATTORNEY-IN-FACT. In the event that the Company is
unable for any reason whatsoever to secure my signature to any lawful and
necessary document required to apply for or execute any patent, copyright or
other applications with respect to any Company Inventions (including
improvements, renewals, extensions, continuations, divisions or continuations in
part thereof), I hereby irrevocably appoint the Company and its duly authorized
officers and agents as my agents and attorneys-in-fact to execute and file any
such application and to do all other lawfully permitted acts to further the
prosecution and issuance of patents, copyrights or other rights thereon with the
same legal force and effect as if executed by me.

8. NO CONFLICTING OBLIGATIONS. My performance of this Agreement does not and
will not breach any agreement to keep in confidence proprietary information,
knowledge or data acquired by me prior to my employment with the Company. I will
not disclose to the Company, or induce the Company to use, any confidential or
proprietary information or material belonging to any previous employer or other
person or entity. I am not a party to any other agreement which will interfere
with my full compliance with this Agreement or the Employment Agreement. I will
not enter into any agreement, whether written or oral, conflicting with the
provisions of this Agreement or the Employment Agreement.

9. SURVIVAL. Notwithstanding the termination of the Agreement Period, Sections
2, 3.2, 4, 6 and 7 hereof shall survive such termination. This Agreement does
not in any way restrict my right or the right of the Company to terminate my
employment at any time, for any reason or



                                       -3-



<PAGE>   10



for no reason. I understand, however, that only the Company may terminate my
consultancy, in its sole discretion, by at least two (2) weeks written notice.

10. SPECIFIC PERFORMANCE. A breach of any of the promises or agreements
contained herein will result in irreparable and continuing damage to the Company
for which there will be no adequate remedy at law, and the Company shall be
entitled to injunctive relief and/or a decree for specific performance, and such
other relief as may be proper (including monetary damages if appropriate).

11. WAIVER. The waiver by the Company of a breach of any provision of this
Agreement by me will not operate or be construed as a waiver of any other or
subsequent breach by me.

12. SEVERABILITY. If any part of this Agreement is found invalid or
unenforceable, that part will be amended to achieve as nearly as possible the
same economic effect as the original provision, and the remainder of this
Agreement will remain in full force.

13. GOVERNING LAW. This Agreement will be governed by and construed in
accordance with the laws (other than the conflict of laws rules) of the State of
Florida.

14. ENTIRE AGREEMENT. This Agreement, the Exhibits to this Agreement and the
Employment Agreement of even date herewith constitute the entire agreement
between the parties relating to this subject matter and supersede all prior or
simultaneous representations, discussions, negotiations, and agreements, whether
written or oral. This Agreement may be amended or modified only with the written
consent of both me and the Company. No oral waiver, amendment or modification
will be effective under any circumstances whatsoever.




                                      -4-




<PAGE>   11




15. ASSIGNMENT. This Agreement may be assigned by the Company. I may not assign
or delegate my duties under this Agreement without the Company's prior written
approval. This Agreement shall be binding upon my heirs, successors, and
permitted assignees.

                                                     EMPLOYEE:


Date: April 1, 1992                         ___________________________
                                                     Signature


                                                     --------------------------
                                                     Printed Name

                                                     BE AVIONICS, INC.



Date: April 1, 1992                        By:_________________________

                                                     Title:____________________






                                       -5-




<PAGE>   12


                                   EXHIBIT "A"

                                 PRIOR INVENTION










                                       -6-


<PAGE>   1
BE AEROSPACE, INC. SAVINGS PLAN

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS FOR THE
YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 AND 1996,
SUPPLEMENTAL SCHEDULES,
AND INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
<PAGE>   2
BE AEROSPACE, INC. SAVINGS PLAN

TABLE OF CONTENTS
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                                                            PAGE

INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT                                                   1

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS:
Statements of net assets available for benefits
  as of December 31, 1997 and 1996                                             2
Statements of changes in net assets available for benefits
  for the years ended December 31, 1997 and 1996                               3
Notes to financial statements                                                  4

SUPPLEMENTAL SCHEDULES PROVIDED PURSUANT TO THE DEPARTMENT
  OF LABOR'S RULES AND REGULATIONS:
Line 27a - Schedule of assets held for investment purposes
  as of December 31, 1997                                                     13
Line 27d - Schedule of reportable transactions
  for the year ended December 31, 1997                                        14

All other schedules required by the Department of Labor are omitted because of
the absence of the conditions under which they are required.
<PAGE>   3
INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT


The Administrative Committee
BE Aerospace, Inc. Savings Plan
Wellington, Florida


We were engaged to audit the financial statements and supplemental schedules of
BE Aerospace, Inc. Savings Plan (the Plan) as of December 31, 1997 and 1996, and
for the years then ended, listed in the Table of Contents. These financial
statements and supplemental schedules are the responsibility of the Plan's
management.

As permitted by Section 2520.103-8 of the Department of Labor's Rules and
Regulations for Reporting and Disclosure under the Employee Retirement Income
Security Act of 1974, the Plan administrator instructed us not to perform, and
we did not perform, any auditing procedures with respect to the investment
information summarized in Note 2 and certain information in Notes 3 and 4 that
was certified by PW Trust Company, the trustee of the Plan, except for comparing
the information with the related information included in the financial
statements and supplemental schedules. We have been informed by the Plan
administrator that the trustee holds the Plan's investment assets and executes
investment transactions. The Plan administrator has obtained certifications from
the trustee that the information as of and for the years ended December 31, 1997
and 1996 provided to the Plan administrator by the trustee is complete and
accurate.

Because of the significance of the information that we did not audit, we are
unable to express, and do not express, an opinion on the accompanying financial
statements and supplemental schedules taken as a whole. The form and content of
the information included in the financial statements and supplemental schedules,
other than that derived from the information certified by the trustee, have been
audited by us in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards and, in
our opinion, are presented in compliance with the Department of Labor's Rules
and Regulations for Reporting and Disclosure under the Employee Retirement
Income Security Act of 1974.




April 24, 1998
<PAGE>   4
BE AEROSPACE, INC. SAVINGS PLAN

STATEMENTS OF NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR BENEFITS
AS OF DECEMBER 31, 1997 AND 1996
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    1997           1996
<S>                                                              <C>            <C>
ASSETS -
  Investments, at fair value (Note 3):
    Investment in the PW Trust Company Pooled Trusts (Note 2)    $39,878,562    $31,645,268
    BE Aerospace, Inc. common stock (Note 2)                       6,390,953      5,939,236
    Participant loans receivable                                     102,236        133,783
                                                                 -----------    -----------
      Total investments                                           46,371,751     37,718,287

EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTIONS RECEIVABLE                                    128,318        237,825

CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS (Note 2)                                    36,467        189,965
                                                                 -----------    -----------
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR BENEFITS                                $46,536,536    $38,146,077
                                                                 ===========    ===========
</TABLE>

See independent auditors' report and notes to financial statements.


                                                                               2
<PAGE>   5
BE AEROSPACE, INC. SAVINGS PLAN

STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR BENEFITS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 AND 1996
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                       1997           1996

<S>                                                                <C>            <C>
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR BENEFITS,
  beginning of year                                                $38,146,077    $23,275,706

ADDITIONS TO NET ASSETS ATTRIBUTED TO:
Investment income:
  Net appreciation in fair value of investments (Notes 2 and 3)      5,262,288      6,841,934
  Interest and dividends (Note 2)                                       21,482         93,585
                                                                   -----------    -----------
      Total investment income                                        5,283,770      6,935,519

Contributions and rollovers (Note 1)                                 7,275,773     12,124,167
                                                                   -----------    -----------
      Total additions to net assets                                 12,559,543     19,059,686

DEDUCTIONS FROM NET ASSETS ATTRIBUTED TO:
Distributions to participants or their beneficiaries                 3,768,400      3,901,531
Plan administrative expenses                                           361,581        256,790
Loan repayments                                                         39,103         30,994
                                                                   -----------    -----------
      Total deductions from net assets                               4,169,084      4,189,315
                                                                   -----------    -----------
NET INCREASE                                                         8,390,459     14,870,371
                                                                   -----------    -----------
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR BENEFITS,
  end of year                                                      $46,536,536    $38,146,077
                                                                   ===========    ===========
</TABLE>

See independent auditors' report and notes to financial statements.


                                                                               3
<PAGE>   6
BE AEROSPACE, INC. SAVINGS PLAN


NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 AND 1996
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------


1.      GENERAL AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

        Description of Plan - Effective August 1, 1988, BE Aerospace, Inc. (the
        Company) adopted the BE Aerospace, Inc. Savings Plan (formerly the BE
        Aerospace, Inc. Savings and Profit Sharing Plan and Trust) (the Plan), a
        defined contribution retirement plan designed to qualify under Internal
        Revenue Code (IRC) Section 401(a) and 401(k) for the cash or deferred
        arrangement part of the Plan.

        Under the Plan, contributions are made on behalf of employees
        (participants) who choose to defer a portion of their total gross pay.
        Effective December 1994, the Plan was amended to allow participants to
        make a contribution election from 2% to 15%. Elective contributions
        under a qualified cash or deferred arrangement are treated as employer
        contributions. Company contributions are made in the Company common
        stock (the Stock). Participants 55 years old or older have the option of
        receiving the matching contribution in cash. The Stock is held by the
        trustee and adjusted to fair value as determined by published market
        prices. Resulting unrealized gains and losses are included in the
        statement of changes in net assets available for benefits.

        In January 1996, the Company purchased Burns Aerospace, Inc. from Eagle
        Industries. Former Burns Aerospace, Inc. employees who transferred to
        the Company and were participants under the Eagle Industries 401(k) Plan
        were cashed out of the Eagle plan, and their distributions totaling
        $7,154,260 were rolled over into the Plan.

        Termination Benefits and Vesting - Upon termination of employment with
        the Company, participants are immediately vested in their contributions
        and are entitled to receive all vested contributions, with 100% vesting
        after five years of service.

        Forfeitures - Forfeited nonvested account balances are used to reduce
        future employer contributions.

        Cash and Cash Equivalents - Cash and cash equivalents consist of
        highly-liquid investments with initial maturities of 90 days or less.

        Investment in the PW Trust Company Pooled Trusts - The investment in the
        PW Trust Company Pooled Trusts (the Trusts) consists primarily of
        guaranteed insurance contracts (GICs) and certain debt and equity
        securities held by the Trusts. It is the policy of the Trusts to hold
        GIC investments until maturity. GIC investments are stated at contract
        value that approximates their fair value at December 31, 1997 and 1996,
        as determined by quoted or published market prices. All other
        investments are stated at their fair value.


                                                                               4
<PAGE>   7
BE AEROSPACE, INC. SAVINGS PLAN

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 AND 1996 (CONTINUED)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------


        Income Tax - The Plan is intended to be qualified under 401(a) of the
        IRC of 1986 and is intended to be exempt from taxation under 501(a) of
        the IRC. The Plan received a favorable IRS determination letter dated
        October 23, 1996. The Plan has been amended since receiving the
        determination letter. However, the Plan administrator believes that the
        Plan is currently designed and being operated in compliance with the
        applicable requirements of the IRC and the related trust was tax exempt
        as of the financial statement date. Therefore, no provision of income
        taxes has been included in the Plan's financial statements.

        Benefits Payable - Benefits under the Plan are distributed upon
        retirement, death, disability or termination of employment. At December
        31, 1997, payables to participants totaled $43,133. There were no
        benefits payable at December 31, 1996.

        Administrative Expenses - Administrative expenses are paid by the Plan.

        Use of Estimates - The preparation of financial statements in conformity
        with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to
        make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of
        assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and
        liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported
        amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting periods. Actual
        results could differ from those estimates.

        The foregoing description of the Plan provides only general information.
        Participants should refer to the Plan document for a more complete
        description of the Plan's provisions.


2.      INFORMATION CERTIFIED BY TRUSTEE (UNAUDITED)

        Plan investments are held by PW Trust Company, the trustee. The
        following is a summary of the unaudited information regarding the Plan,
        included in the Plan's financial statements and supplemental schedules,
        that was prepared by the trustee and reported to the Plan administrator.
        The Company has obtained certifications from the trustee that such
        information is complete and accurate.


                                                                               5
<PAGE>   8
BE AEROSPACE, INC. SAVINGS PLAN

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 AND 1996 (CONTINUED)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------


        a.      Assets held at fair value as of December 31:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 1997           1996
<S>                                                           <C>            <C>
        Investments, at fair value:
          GIC Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
             Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan          $ 9,647,288    $10,209,520
          Balanced Value Portfolio of the PW Trust
            Company Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits
            Plan                                                6,983,055      6,252,891
          Capital Growth Portfolio of the PW Trust
            Company Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits
            Plan                                               11,148,710      8,525,566
          Strategic Balance Portfolio of the PW Trust
            Company Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits
            Plan                                                3,048,384      1,941,631
          Strategic Growth Portfolio of the PW Trust
            Company Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits
            Plan                                                4,726,181      2,944,103
          Target Value Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
            Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan             3,893,093      1,771,557
          Overseas Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
            Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan               431,851
          BE Aerospace, Inc. common stock                       6,390,953      5,939,236
                                                              -----------    -----------
              Total investments                                46,269,515     37,584,504
        
           Cash and cash equivalents - Money Market Fund           36,467        189,965
                                                              -----------    -----------
                                                              $46,305,982    $37,774,469
                                                              ===========    ===========
</TABLE>


                                                                               6
<PAGE>   9
BE AEROSPACE, INC. SAVINGS PLAN

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 AND 1996 (CONTINUED)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------


        b.      Changes in net assets available for benefits for the years ended
                December 31:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   1997          1996
<S>                                                             <C>           <C>
        Investment income:
          Net appreciation in fair value of investments         $5,262,288    $6,841,934
          Interest and dividends                                    21,482        93,585
                                                                ----------    ----------
              Total investment income                           $5,283,770    $6,935,519
                                                                ==========    ==========
</TABLE>

        c.      Line 27a - Schedule of assets held for investment purposes as of
                December 31, 1997, excluding participant loan data obtained from
                the Company (see supplemental schedule)

        d.      Line 27d - Schedule of reportable transactions for the year
                ended December 31, 1997 (see supplemental schedule)


3.      INVESTMENTS

        Investments consist of the following:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                AS OF DECEMBER 31, 1997
                                                               --------------------------
                                                                                 FAIR
                                                                  COST           VALUE
<S>                                                            <C>            <C>
        GIC Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
          Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan              $ 8,285,706    $ 9,647,288
        Balanced Value Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
          Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan                4,585,451      6,983,055
        Capital Growth Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
          Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan                7,340,587     11,148,710
        Strategic Balance Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
          Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan                2,554,079      3,048,384
        Strategic Growth Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
          Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan                4,019,957      4,726,181
        Target Value Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
          Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan                3,392,434      3,893,093
        Overseas Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
          Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan                  437,462        431,851
        BE Aerospace, Inc. common stock                          3,401,478      6,390,953
        Participant loans receivable                               102,236        102,236
                                                               -----------    -----------
                                                               $34,119,390    $46,371,751
                                                               ===========    ===========
</TABLE>


                                                                               7
<PAGE>   10
BE AEROSPACE, INC. SAVINGS PLAN

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 AND 1996 (CONTINUED)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                AS OF DECEMBER 31, 1996
                                                               --------------------------
                                                                                 FAIR
                                                                  COST           VALUE
<S>                                                            <C>            <C>
        GIC Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
          Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan              $ 8,943,004    $10,209,520
        Balanced Value Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
          Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan                4,537,113      6,252,891
        Capital Growth Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
          Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan                5,903,640      8,525,566
        Strategic Balance Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
          Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan                1,814,099      1,941,631
        Strategic Growth Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
          Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan                2,751,358      2,944,103
        Target Value Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
          Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan                1,622,011      1,771,557
        BE Aerospace, Inc. common stock                          2,344,546      5,939,236
        Participant loans receivable                               133,783        133,783
                                                               -----------    -----------
                                                               $28,049,554    $37,718,287
                                                               ===========    ===========
</TABLE>

        Investments are in the custody of the trustee under a trust agreement
        with the Plan. The trustee has no authority, however, for the purchase
        or sale of investments.

        During the years ended December 31, 1997 and 1996, the Plan's
        investments appreciated in fair value by $5,262,288 and $6,841,934,
        respectively.


                                                                               8
<PAGE>   11
BE AEROSPACE, INC. SAVINGS PLAN

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 AND 1996 (CONTINUED)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------


4.      STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR BENEFITS BY FUND
        FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 (UNAUDITED)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                            DECEMBER 31, 1997 SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION BY FUND
                                           ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                                                               
                                                            BALANCED       CAPITAL      STRATEGIC      STRATEGIC      TARGET   
                                               GIC           VALUE         GROWTH        BALANCE        GROWTH        VALUE    
                                           ------------   ------------   ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
<S>                                        <C>            <C>            <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>         
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR
  BENEFITS, beginning of year              $ 10,242,926   $  6,272,522   $  8,552,004  $  1,958,799  $  2,975,820  $  1,788,273

ADDITIONS TO NET ASSETS
  ATTRIBUTED TO:
Investment income:
  Net appreciation (depreciation) in fair
    value of investments (Notes 2 and 3)        617,592      1,159,170      1,979,922       418,420       624,311       548,827
  Interest and dividends (Note 2)                                                                                              
                                                                                                                               
      Total investment income (loss)            617,592      1,159,170      1,979,922       418,420       624,311       548,827

Contributions and rollovers                   1,043,732        685,079        991,533       690,171     1,130,643       905,439
                                           ------------   ------------   ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
        Total additions to net assets         1,661,324      1,844,249      2,971,455     1,108,591     1,754,954     1,454,266

DEDUCTIONS FROM NET ASSETS
  ATTRIBUTED TO:
Distributions to participants or
  their beneficiaries                         1,684,714        565,669        578,400       121,775       228,034       192,063
Plan administrative expenses                     44,372         82,056        120,721        30,683        45,461        36,553
Loan repayments                                                                                                                
                                                                                                                               
        Total deductions from net assets      1,729,086        647,725        699,121       152,458       273,495       228,616
                                           ------------   ------------   ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
NET (DECREASE) INCREASE                         (67,762)     1,196,524      2,272,334       956,133     1,481,459     1,225,650

ACCOUNT TRANSFERS                              (513,903)      (481,072)       317,114       131,998       255,008       869,598
                                           ------------   ------------   ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR
  BENEFITS, end of year                    $  9,661,261   $  6,987,974   $ 11,141,452  $  3,046,930  $  4,712,287  $  3,883,521
                                           ============   ============   ============  ============  ============  ============

<CAPTION>                                  
                                               DECEMBER 31, 1997 SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION BY FUND
                                           -----------------------------------------------------------               
                                                            BE AEROSPACE                   CASH AND                  
                                                                COMMON     PARTICIPANT       CASH                    
                                               OVERSEAS         STOCK         LOANS       EQUIVALENTS      TOTAL     
                                             ------------   ------------   ------------   ------------  ------------ 
<S>                                          <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>           <C>          
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR                                                                                             
  BENEFITS, beginning of year                $         --   $  6,031,985   $    133,783   $    189,965  $ 38,146,077 
                                                                                                                     
ADDITIONS TO NET ASSETS                                                                                              
  ATTRIBUTED TO:                                                                                                     
Investment income:                                                                                                   
  Net appreciation (depreciation) in fair                                                                            
    value of investments (Notes 2 and 3)           (7,856)       (78,098)                                  5,262,288 
  Interest and dividends (Note 2)                                                 7,556         13,926        21,482 
                                                                           ------------   ------------  ------------ 
      Total investment income (loss)               (7,856)       (78,098)         7,556         13,926     5,283,770 
                                                                                                                     
Contributions and rollovers                       200,311      1,628,865                                   7,275,773 
                                             ------------   ------------                                ------------ 
        Total additions to net assets             192,455      1,550,767          7,556         13,926    12,559,543 
                                                                                                                     
DEDUCTIONS FROM NET ASSETS                                                                                           
  ATTRIBUTED TO:                                                                                                     
Distributions to participants or                                                                                     
  their beneficiaries                               2,049        395,696                                   3,768,400 
Plan administrative expenses                        1,735                                                    361,581 
Loan repayments                                                                  39,103                       39,103 
                                                                           ------------                 ------------ 
        Total deductions from net assets            3,784        395,696         39,103                    4,169,084 
                                             ------------   ------------   ------------                 ------------ 
NET (DECREASE) INCREASE                           188,671      1,155,071        (31,547)        13,926     8,390,459 
                                                                                                                     
ACCOUNT TRANSFERS                                 243,598       (654,917)                     (167,424)              
                                             ------------   ------------                  ------------               
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR                                                                                             
  BENEFITS, end of year                      $    432,269   $  6,532,139   $    102,236   $     36,467  $ 46,536,536 
                                             ============   ============   ============   ============  ============ 
</TABLE>

The Plan maintains a holding account that allows for the future distributions of
cash and cash equivalents and liabilities to the appropriate fund.
                                                                               9
<PAGE>   12
BE AEROSPACE, INC. SAVINGS PLAN


NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 AND 1996 (CONTINUED)

STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR 
BENEFITS BY FUND
FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1996 (UNAUDITED)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 DECEMBER 31, 1996 SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION BY FUND
                                            ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                                                           
                                                             BALANCED    CAPITAL      STRATEGIC    STRATEGIC    TARGET     
                                              GIC              VALUE     GROWTH        BALANCE      GROWTH       VALUE     

<S>                                         <C>             <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR
  BENEFITS, beginning of year               $  8,102,104    $5,338,952   $7,058,665   $  112,724   $  432,832   $  141,630   

ADDITIONS TO NET ASSETS
  ATTRIBUTED TO:
Investment income:
  Net appreciation (depreciation) in fair
    value of investments (Notes 2 and 3)         577,917       810,880    1,541,361      147,610      216,857      170,099   
  Interest and dividends (Note 2)                                                                                            

      Total investment income (loss)             577,917       810,880    1,541,361      147,610      216,857      170,099   

Contributions and rollovers                      790,168       475,334      667,774      508,101      898,060      463,152   
                                            ------------    ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   
        Total additions to net assets          1,368,085     1,286,214    2,209,135      655,711    1,114,917      633,251   

DEDUCTIONS FROM NET ASSETS
  ATTRIBUTED TO:
Distributions to participants or
  their beneficiaries                          1,703,992       648,171      689,249      193,832      198,348      182,567   
Plan administrative expenses                      39,860        69,730       96,996       14,366       22,986       12,104   
Loan repayments                                                                                                              

        Total deductions from net assets       1,743,852       717,901      786,245      208,198      221,334      194,671   
                                            ------------    ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   
NET (DECREASE) INCREASE                         (375,767)      568,313    1,422,890      447,513      893,583      438,580   

ACCOUNT TRANSFERS                              2,516,589       365,257       70,449    1,398,562    1,649,405    1,208,063   
                                            ------------    ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR
  BENEFITS, end of year                     $ 10,242,926    $6,272,522   $8,552,004   $1,958,799   $2,975,820   $1,788,273   
                                            ============    ==========   ==========   ==========   ==========   ==========   
</TABLE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           DECEMBER 31, 1996 SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION BY FUND
                                           --------------------------------------------------      
                                            BE AEROSPACE                         CASH AND          
                                              COMMON           PARTICIPANT         CASH
                                               STOCK             LOANS          EQUIVALENTS           TOTAL
                                                                                                                   
<S>                                        <C>                <C>               <C>                <C>             
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR                   
  BENEFITS, beginning of year              $1,772,161         $  38,932          $   277,706       $23,275,706     
                                                                                                                   
ADDITIONS TO NET ASSETS                                                                                            
  ATTRIBUTED TO:                                                                                                   
Investment income:                                                                                                 
  Net appreciation (depreciation) in fair  
    value of investments (Notes 2 and 3)    3,377,210                                                6,841,934      
  Interest and dividends (Note 2)                                                     93,585            93,585      
                                                                                 -----------       -----------     
      Total investment income (loss)        3,377,210                                 93,585         6,935,519      
                                                                                                                    
Contributions and rollovers                 1,167,318                              7,154,260        12,124,167      
                                           ----------                            -----------       -----------     
        Total additions to net assets       4,544,528                              7,247,845        19,059,686      
                                                                                                                    
DEDUCTIONS FROM NET ASSETS                                                                                          
  ATTRIBUTED TO:                                                                                                    
Distributions to participants or                                                                                    
  their beneficiaries                         285,372                                                3,901,531      
Plan administrative expenses                                                             748           256,790      
Loan repayments                                                  30,994                                 30,994      
                                                              ---------                            -----------
        Total deductions from net assets      285,372            30,994                  748         4,189,315      
                                           ----------         ---------          -----------       -----------     
NET (DECREASE) INCREASE                     4,259,156           (30,994)           7,247,097        14,870,371      
                                                                                                                    
ACCOUNT TRANSFERS                                 668           125,845           (7,334,838)                       
                                           ----------         ---------          -----------       
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR                                                                                            
  BENEFITS, end of year                    $6,031,985         $ 133,783          $   189,965       $38,146,077      
                                           ==========         =========          ===========       ===========      
</TABLE>

The Plan maintains a holding account that allows for the future distribution of
cash and cash equivalents and liabilities to the appropriate fund.


                                                                              10
<PAGE>   13
BE AEROSPACE, INC. SAVINGS PLAN


NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 AND 1996 (CONTINUED)

STATEMENT OF NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR BENEFITS BY
FUND AS OF
DECEMBER 31, 1997 (UNAUDITED)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                           DECEMBER 31, 1997 SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION BY FUND
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                         BALANCED     CAPITAL         STRATEGIC      STRATEGIC      TARGET       
                                             GIC           VALUE      GROWTH           BALANCE         GROWTH        VALUE       
<S>                                         <C>          <C>          <C>             <C>            <C>            <C>
ASSETS:                                     
Investments, at fair value (Note 3):        
Investment in the PW Trust Company          
  Pooled Trusts (Note 2)                    $9,647,288   $6,983,055   $ 11,148,710    $ 3,048,384    $ 4,726,181    $ 3,893,093    
BE Aerospace, Inc. common stock             
  (Note 2)                                                                                                                         
Participant loans receivable                                                                                                       
                                            
    Total investments                        9,647,288    6,983,055     11,148,710      3,048,384      4,726,181      3,893,093    
                                            
EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTIONS                      
  RECEIVABLE                                    13,973        4,919         (7,258)        (1,454)       (13,894)        (9,572)   
                                            
CASH AND CASH                          
  EQUIVALENTS (Note 2)                                                                                                        

NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR
  BENEFITS                                  $9,661,261   $6,987,974   $ 11,141,452    $ 3,046,930    $ 4,712,287    $ 3,883,521    
                                            ==========   ==========   ============    ===========    ===========    ===========    
</TABLE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   DECEMBER 31, 1997 SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION BY FUND
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                     BE AEROSPACE                        CASH AND
                                                       COMMON          PARTICIPANT         CASH
                                       OVERSEAS         STOCK             LOANS         EQUIVALENTS        TOTAL
<S>                                    <C>           <C>               <C>              <C>              <C>
ASSETS:                                                                                                              
Investments, at fair value (Note 3):                                                                                 
Investment in the PW Trust Company                                                                                   
  Pooled Trusts (Note 2)               $431,851        $        -        $      -        $      -        $39,878,562  
BE Aerospace, Inc. common stock                                                                                       
  (Note 2)                                              6,390,953                                          6,390,953  
Participant loans receivable                                              102,236                            102,236  
                                                                         --------                        -----------
    Total investments                   431,851         6,390,953         102,236                         46,371,751  
                                                                                                                      
EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTIONS                                                                                                
  RECEIVABLE                                418           141,186                                            128,318  
                                                                                                                      
CASH AND CASH                                                                                                         
  EQUIVALENTS (Note 2)                                                                     36,467             36,467  
                                                                                         --------        -----------
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR                                                                                              
  BENEFITS                             $432,269        $6,532,139        $102,236        $ 36,467        $46,536,536  
                                       ========        ==========        ========        ========        ===========  
</TABLE>


                                                                              11
<PAGE>   14
BE AEROSPACE, INC. SAVINGS PLAN

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997 AND 1996 (CONTINUED)
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------

     STATEMENT OF NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR BENEFITS BY
     FUND AS OF
     DECEMBER 31, 1996 (UNAUDITED)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                           DECEMBER 31, 1996 SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION BY FUND
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------       
                                                         BALANCED       CAPITAL      STRATEGIC     STRATEGIC       TARGET
                                              GIC          VALUE         GROWTH       BALANCE        GROWTH         VALUE       

<S>                                       <C>            <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>            
ASSETS:
Investments, at fair value (Note 3):
Investment in the PW Trust Company
  Pooled Trusts (Note 2)                  $10,209,520    $6,252,891    $8,525,566    $1,941,631    $2,944,103    $1,771,557     

BE Aerospace, Inc. common stock
  (Note 2)                                                                                                                      
Participant loans receivable                                                                                                    
                                                                                                                                

    Total investments                      10,209,520     6,252,891     8,525,566     1,941,631     2,944,103     1,771,557     

EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTIONS
  RECEIVABLE                                   33,406        19,631        26,438        17,168        31,717      16,716       

CASH AND CASH
  EQUIVALENTS (Note 2)                                                                                                          
                                                                                                                                

NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR
  BENEFITS                                $10,242,926    $6,272,522    $8,552,004    $1,958,799    $2,975,820    $1,788,273     
                                          ===========    ==========    ==========    ==========    ==========    ==========     
</TABLE>


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                            DECEMBER 31, 1997 SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION BY FUND
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                          BE AEROSPACE                  CASH AND                        
                                            COMMON      PARTICIPANT       CASH                          
                                             STOCK         LOANS       EQUIVALENTS          TOTAL       
                                                                                                        
<S>                                        <C>            <C>           <C>              <C>
ASSETS:                                                                                                 
Investments, at fair value (Note 3):                                                                    
Investment in the PW Trust Company            
  Pooled Trusts (Note 2)                  $     --        $   --        $      --        $31,645,268                        
                                                                                                        
BE Aerospace, Inc. common stock               
  (Note 2)                                 5,939,236                                       5,939,236    
Participant loans receivable                               133,783                           133,783 
                                                          --------                       -----------                      
                                               
    Total investments                      5,939,236       133,783                        37,718,287                     
                                                                                                        
EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTIONS                           
  RECEIVABLE                                 92,749                                          237,825                         
                                                                                                        
CASH AND CASH                                                                   
  EQUIVALENTS (Note 2)                                                      189,965          189,965           
                                                                        -----------      -----------    
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR                                                                                
  BENEFITS                                $6,031,985      $133,783      $   189,965      $38,146,077    
                                          ==========      ========      ===========      ===========    
</TABLE>


                                                                              12
<PAGE>   15
                   SUPPLEMENTAL SCHEDULE PROVIDED PURSUANT TO
                 THE DEPARTMENT OF LABOR'S RULES AND REGULATIONS
<PAGE>   16
BE SAVINGS AEROSPACE, INC. PLAN

LINE 27a - SCHEDULE OF ASSETS HELD FOR INVESTMENT PURPOSES
AS OF DECEMBER 31, 1997
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                          UNITS/                            CURRENT
                                                          RATES             COST             VALUE

<S>                                                    <C>              <C>              <C>        
GIC Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
  Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan              479,427,218      $ 8,285,706      $ 9,647,288
Balanced Value Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
  Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan              217,217,383        4,585,451        6,983,055
Capital Growth Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
  Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan              487,926,766        7,340,587       11,148,710
Strategic Balance Portfolio of the PW Trust
  Company Pooled Trust for Employee
  Benefits Plan                                        180,448,902        2,554,079        3,048,384
Strategic Growth Portfolio of the PW Trust
  Company Pooled Trust for Employee
  Benefits Plan                                        266,425,324        4,019,957        4,726,181
Target Value Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
  Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plan              218,665,473        3,392,434        3,893,093
Overseas Portfolio of the PW Trust Company
  Pooled Trust for Employee Benefits Plans              32,462,378          437,462          431,851
BE Aerospace, Inc. common stock                            238,354        3,401,478        6,390,953
Participant loans receivable                              6 to 13%          102,236          102,236
                                                                        -----------      -----------

                                                                        $34,119,390      $46,371,751
                                                                        ===========      ===========
</TABLE>



                                                                              13
<PAGE>   17
BE SAVINGS AEROSPACE, INC. PLAN

LINE 27d - SCHEDULE OF REPORTABLE TRANSACTIONS
FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1997
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                         NUMBER        PURCHASE         SELLING         COST OF
                                        OF UNITS         PRICE           PRICE         ASSET SOLD      NET GAIN

<S>                                    <C>             <C>             <C>             <C>             <C>     
GIC Portfolio of the PW Trust
  Company Pooled Trust for
  Employee Benefits Plan -
  442 transactions                     341,331.669     $2,869,736      $4,051,447      $3,516,261      $535,186
Strategic Growth Portfolio of
  the PW Trust Company
  Pooled Trust for Employee
  Benefits Plan - 287
  transactions                         209,424.493     $2,357,213      $1,234,848      $1,104,396      $130,452
</TABLE>


                                                                              14

<PAGE>   1
BE AEROSPACE, INC.
1994 EMPLOYEE STOCK PURCHASE PLAN

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS FOR THE
YEARS ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1998 AND 1997
AND INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
<PAGE>   2
BE AEROSPACE, INC.
1994 EMPLOYEE STOCK PURCHASE PLAN

TABLE OF CONTENTS


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                  PAGE
<S>                                                                              <C>
INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT                                                        1

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS:
Statements of net assets available for benefits
  as of February 28, 1998 and 1997                                                  2
Statements of changes in net assets available for benefits
  for the years ended February 28, 1998 and 1997                                    3
Notes to financial statements for the years ended
  February 28, 1998 and 1997                                                        4
</TABLE>

All schedules pursuant to the Department of Labor's rules and regulations are
  omitted because of the absence of the conditions under which they are
  required.
<PAGE>   3
INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT



The Administrative Committee
BE Aerospace, Inc.
1994 Employee Stock Purchase Plan
Wellington, Florida


We have audited the accompanying statements of net assets available for benefits
of BE Aerospace, Inc. 1994 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (the Plan) as of
February 28, 1998 and 1997, and the related statements of changes in net assets
available for benefits for the years then ended. These financial statements are
the responsibility of the Plan's Administrative Committee. Our responsibility is
to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, such financial statements present fairly, in all material
respects, the net assets available for benefits of BE Aerospace, Inc. 1994
Employee Stock Purchase Plan as of February 28, 1998 and 1997, and the changes
in net assets available for benefits for the years then ended in conformity with
generally accepted accounting principles.




April 24, 1998
<PAGE>   4
BE AEROSPACE, INC.
1994 EMPLOYEE STOCK PURCHASE PLAN



STATEMENTS OF NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR BENEFITS
AS OF FEBRUARY 28, 1998 AND 1997


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                            1998            1997
<S>                                       <C>             <C>
ASSETS - Cash and cash equivalents        $859,217        $339,119

LIABILITIES - Stock subscribed             854,147         337,974
                                          --------        --------

NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR BENEFITS         $  5,070        $  1,145
                                          ========        ========
</TABLE>


See notes to financial statements.

                                                                               2
<PAGE>   5
BE AEROSPACE, INC.
1994 EMPLOYEE STOCK PURCHASE PLAN



STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR BENEFITS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1998 AND 1997


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     1998              1997
<S>                                               <C>               <C>
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR BENEFITS,
  beginning of period                             $    1,145        $      462

ADDITIONS TO NET ASSETS ATTRIBUTED TO -
  Participant payroll deductions                   1,462,575           599,468

DEDUCTIONS FROM NET ASSETS ATTRIBUTED TO -
  Purchase of BE Aerospace common stock            1,458,650           598,785
                                                  ----------        ----------

NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR BENEFITS,
  end of period                                   $    5,070        $    1,145
                                                  ==========        ==========
</TABLE>


See notes to financial statements.

                                                                               3
<PAGE>   6
BE AEROSPACE, INC.
1994 EMPLOYEE STOCK PURCHASE PLAN



NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1998 AND 1997


1.      GENERAL AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

        Description of Plan - Effective April 1, 1994, BE Aerospace, Inc. (the
        Company) adopted the BE Aerospace, Inc. 1994 Employee Stock Purchase
        Plan (the Plan).

        The Company is the Plan sponsor. All employees (participants) with a
        minimum of 90 days service, who generally complete a minimum of 20 hours
        of service per week, are eligible to participate. Under the Plan,
        contributions are made on behalf of participants who choose to
        contribute from 2% to 15% of their total gross pay.

        Common stock of the Company is purchased every six months on
        approximately February 28 and August 31 (Option Period). The purchase
        price is 85% of the lesser of the fair value of either the first day or
        last day of each Option Period. Participants are allocated a pro rata
        share of stock consistent with the balance of the participant account.
        The stock is then issued by the Plan transfer agent, Boston Equiserve,
        directly to the participant. The maximum number of shares available for
        each option period to an individual is the largest whole number of
        shares which, when multiplied by the fair market value of the Company
        stock at the beginning of the option period, produces a dollar amount of
        $12,500 or less.

        Stock Subscribed - The Plan issues the stock to participants subsequent
        to the end of each Option Period but dated the last day of the Option
        Period. Therefore, a liability for stock purchased by the Plan but not
        yet distributed to the participants has been reflected as stock
        subscribed in the accompanying statements of net assets available for
        benefits as of February 28, 1998 and 1997.

        Stock purchased by the Plan for the years ended February 28, 1998 and
        1997 was 63,463 and 47,930 shares, respectively.

        Termination Benefits and Vesting - Upon termination of employment with
        the Company, a participant is entitled to receive all contributions not
        yet used to acquire stock of the Company.

        Cash and Cash Equivalents - Cash and cash equivalents consist of
        highly-liquid investments purchased with original maturities of 90 days
        or less.

        Income Tax - The Plan administrator believes that the Plan is currently
        designed and being operated in compliance with the applicable
        requirements of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986. Plan assets consist
        of cash not yet used to purchase common stock. Such cash remains an
        asset of the Company until used to purchase common stock. Accordingly,
        Plan assets are not held in trust; therefore, the Plan is not subject to
        income tax.

                                                                               4
<PAGE>   7



        Administrative Expenses - Administrative expenses have been paid
        directly by the Company and, accordingly, are not reflected in the
        Plan's financial statements. There is no written agreement requiring the
        Company to pay these expenses, and the Company may elect to stop paying
        Plan expenses at any time.


2.      PLAN TERMINATION

        Although it has not expressed any intent to do so, the Company has the
        right under the Plan to terminate the Plan.

                                                                               

<PAGE>   1
                               BE AEROSPACE, INC.
                                  Subsidiaries



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                         BUSINESS OR TYPE            OWNER AND PERCENTAGE          DATE ACQUIRED   STATE OR COUNTRY
              NAME                       OF OPERATIONS               OF OWNERSHIP                  OR CREATED      OF INCORPORATION
              ----                       -------------               ------------                  ----------      ----------------
<S>                                      <C>                         <C>                          <C>              <C>
BE Aerospace (UK) Holdings Limited       Holding company             B/E - 100%                    March-98        England

BE Aerospace (UK) Limited                Seat manufacturer           BE Aerospace (Holdings)-100%  March-98        Northern Ireland

BE Aerospace International Ltd           Shell company               Acurex Corporation - 100%     August-93       Barbados

BE Aerospace (France) S.A.R.L.           Trading company             B/E - 98%                     May-92          France

Burns Aerospace SARL (France)            Trading company             B/E - 100%                    January-96      France

BE Aerospace (Sales & Services) BV       Service company             B/E Aerospace Netherlands BV  June-92         England

AFI Holdings Limited                     Inactive                    BE Aerospace (UK) Limited     February-93     Northern Ireland

Fort Hill Aircraft Limited               Inactive                    BE Aerospace (UK) Limited     February-93     England

BE Aerospace (U.S.A.), Inc.              Holding company             B/E - 100%                    April-93        Delaware

BE Aerospace (Netherlands) B.V.          Holding company             B/E-90% / B/E (USA)-10%       April-93        Netherlands

Royal Inventum B.V.                      Galley insert manufacturer  B/E (Netherlands) BV - 100%   April-93        Netherlands

B/E Harris Live TV, LLC                  Live TV systems             IFE - 51%                     June-05         California

Puritan-Bennett Aero Systems Co.         Oxygen Systems-WEMAC        B/E - 100%                    April-98        Delaware

B/E Aerospace Services, Inc.             Maintenance & Repair        B/E - 100%                    November-97     Delaware

In-Flight Entertainment, LLC             Aircraft Entertainment      B/E - 100%                    November-97     Delaware
                                         Systems
</TABLE>

<PAGE>   2
                               BE AEROSPACE, INC.
                                  Subsidiaries



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                         Business or type            Owner and Percentage          Date Acquired   State or Country
              Name                       of Operations               of Ownership                  or Created      of Incorporation
              ----                       -------------               ------------                  ----------      ----------------
<S>                                      <C>                         <C>                          <C>              <C>

B/E Advanced Thermal Technologies, Inc.  Temperature Control Units   B/E - 100%                    December-97      Delaware

Acurex Corporation                       Galley products             B/E - 100%                    August-93        Delaware

Nordskog Industries, Inc.                Galley products             B/E - 100%                    August-93        California

Aerospace Interiors, Inc.                Maintenance & Repair        B/E - 100%                    March-98         Texas

B/E Intellectual Property, Inc.          Intangibles company         B/E - 100%                    March-98         Delaware

B/E Intellectual Property, LLC           Inactive                    B/E - 100%                                     Delaware
</TABLE>
<PAGE>   3
                               BE AEROSPACE, INC.
                                  Subsidiaries



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                         BUSINESS OR TYPE            OWNER AND PERCENTAGE          DATE ACQUIRED   STATE OR COUNTRY
              NAME                       OF OPERATIONS               OF OWNERSHIP                  OR CREATED      OF INCORPORATION
              ----                       -------------               ------------                  ----------      ----------------
<S>                                      <C>                         <C>                          <C>              <C>

Tepaco Properties B.V.                Sales and service                  BEA-90% / BEA (USA)-10%  April 1993      Netherlands
                                      company

Nordskog Industries, Inc.             Galley structures and              BEA-100%                 August 1993     California
                                      inserts manufacturer

Acurex Corporation                    Galley inserts manu-               BEA-100%                 August 1993     Delaware
                                      facturer

BE Aerospace International, Ltd.      Foreign sales corporation          Acurex-100%              August 1993     Barbados
(formerly known as Acurex Foreign
Sales Company, Ltd.)

Burns Aerospace                       Aircraft seating manufacturer      BEA-100%                 January 1996    Delaware
</TABLE>

<PAGE>   1
                                                                      EXHIBIT 23





INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' CONSENT



We consent to the incorporation by reference in Registration Nos. 333-14037,
33-48119, 33-72194 and 33-82894 on Form S-8 of B/E Aerospace, Inc. of our
reports dated April 15, 1998 (B/E Aerospace, Inc.), April 24, 1998 (B/E
Aerospace, Inc. Savings and Profit Sharing Plan and Trust for the year ended
December 31, 1997) and April 24, 1998 (B/E Aerospace 1994 Employee Stock
Purchase Plan for the year ended February 28, 1998), appearing in this Annual
Report on Form 10-K of B/E Aerospace, Inc. for the year ended February 28, 1998.





Costa Mesa, California
May 26, 1998

<TABLE> <S> <C>

<ARTICLE> 5
<MULTIPLIER> 1,000
       
<S>                             <C>
<PERIOD-TYPE>                   YEAR
<FISCAL-YEAR-END>                          FEB-28-1998
<PERIOD-END>                               FEB-28-1998
<CASH>                                         164,685
<SECURITIES>                                         0
<RECEIVABLES>                                   90,121
<ALLOWANCES>                                   (2,190)
<INVENTORY>                                    121,728
<CURRENT-ASSETS>                               382,213
<PP&E>                                         151,715
<DEPRECIATION>                                (47,894)
<TOTAL-ASSETS>                                 681,757
<CURRENT-LIABILITIES>                          119,709
<BONDS>                                        349,557
                                0
                                          0
<COMMON>                                           229
<OTHER-SE>                                     196,546
<TOTAL-LIABILITY-AND-EQUITY>                   681,757
<SALES>                                        487,999
<TOTAL-REVENUES>                               487,999
<CGS>                                          309,094
<TOTAL-COSTS>                                  429,330
<OTHER-EXPENSES>                                     0<F1>
<LOSS-PROVISION>                                     0
<INTEREST-EXPENSE>                              22,765
<INCOME-PRETAX>                                 35,904
<INCOME-TAX>                                     5,386
<INCOME-CONTINUING>                             30,518
<DISCONTINUED>                                       0
<EXTRAORDINARY>                                  8,956
<CHANGES>                                            0
<NET-INCOME>                                    21,562
<EPS-PRIMARY>                                     0.96
<EPS-DILUTED>                                     0.92
        
<FN>
<F1> (note: non-recurring in oth exp consistent with FY96; integration/
consolidation of European seating bus.)
</FN>

</TABLE>

<TABLE> <S> <C>

<ARTICLE> 5
<RESTATED>
<MULTIPLIER> 1,000
       
<S>                             <C>                     <C>                     <C>                     <C>
<PERIOD-TYPE>                   3-MOS                   3-MOS                   3-MOS                   YEAR
<FISCAL-YEAR-END>                          FEB-28-1998             FEB-28-1998             FEB-28-1998             FEB-22-1997
<PERIOD-END>                               MAY-31-1997             AUG-30-1997             NOV-29-1997             FEB-22-1997
<CASH>                                          44,223                  56,876                  58,221                  44,149
<SECURITIES>                                         0                       0                       0                       0
<RECEIVABLES>                                   70,951                  76,997                  82,666                  78,353
<ALLOWANCES>                                   (3,877)                 (3,479)                 (2,696)                 (4,864)
<INVENTORY>                                     98,171                  97,986                 113,869                  92,900
<CURRENT-ASSETS>                                 5,001                 234,102                 258,995                 213,319
<PP&E>                                         129,561                 134,189                 144,925                 123,916
<DEPRECIATION>                                (39,315)                (42,251)                (46,172)                (36,028)
<TOTAL-ASSETS>                                 491,793                 510,521                 546,711                 491,089
<CURRENT-LIABILITIES>                           83,469                  89,416                 105,713                  91,145
<BONDS>                                        225,461                 225,446                 225,339                 225,402
                                0                       0                       0                       0
                                          0                       0                       0                       0
<COMMON>                                           220                     227                     228                     219
<OTHER-SE>                                    (56,593)                (50,890)                (38,606)                 165,542
<TOTAL-LIABILITY-AND-EQUITY>                   491,793                 510,521                 546,711                 491,089
<SALES>                                        113,846                 233,689                 362,687                 412,379
<TOTAL-REVENUES>                               113,846                 233,689                 362,687                 412,379
<CGS>                                           72,783                 148,477                 230,825                 270,557
<TOTAL-COSTS>                                   99,547                 204,491                 317,025                 369,981
<OTHER-EXPENSES>                                     0                       0                       0                       0
<LOSS-PROVISION>                                     0                       0                       0                       0
<INTEREST-EXPENSE>                               6,130                  11,531                  16,899                  27,167
<INCOME-PRETAX>                                  8,169                  17,667                  28,763                  15,231
<INCOME-TAX>                                     1,226                   2,647                   4,311                   1,522
<INCOME-CONTINUING>                              6,943                  15,020                  24,452                  13,709
<DISCONTINUED>                                       0                       0                       0                       0
<EXTRAORDINARY>                                      0                       0                       0                       0
<CHANGES>                                            0                       0                       0                       0
<NET-INCOME>                                     6,943                  15,020                  24,452                  13,709
<EPS-PRIMARY>                                     0.32                    0.68                    1.10                    0.77
<EPS-DILUTED>                                     0.30                    0.64                    1.04                    0.72
        

</TABLE>

<TABLE> <S> <C>

<ARTICLE> 5
<RESTATED>
<MULTIPLIER> 1,000
       
<S>                             <C>                     <C>                     <C>                     <C>
<PERIOD-TYPE>                   3-MOS                   3-MOS                   3-MOS                   YEAR
<FISCAL-YEAR-END>                          FEB-22-1997             FEB-22-1997             FEB-22-1997             FEB-24-1996
<PERIOD-END>                               MAY-25-1996             AUG-31-1996             NOV-30-1996             FEB-24-1996
<CASH>                                           6,151                  14,188                  13,670                  15,376
<SECURITIES>                                         0                       0                       0                       0
<RECEIVABLES>                                   68,579                  64,497                  75,391                  59,215
<ALLOWANCES>                                   (5,156)                 (4,562)                 (5,236)                   4,973
<INVENTORY>                                     72,645                  77,518                  89,419                  72,569
<CURRENT-ASSETS>                               150,688                 159,779                 177,609                 149,808
<PP&E>                                         113,920                 120,403                 124,302                 113,929
<DEPRECIATION>                                (30,002)                (33,516)                (36,192)                (27,572)
<TOTAL-ASSETS>                                 428,925                 443,340                 458,758                 433,586
<CURRENT-LIABILITIES>                           99,951                  97,497                 100,666                 107,279
<BONDS>                                        272,104                 282,058                 282,107                       0
                                0                       0                       0                       0
                                          0                       0                       0                       0
<COMMON>                                           165                     169                     167                     164
<OTHER-SE>                                      45,792                  51,975                  66,198                  43,993
<TOTAL-LIABILITY-AND-EQUITY>                   428,925                 443,340                 458,758                 433,586
<SALES>                                         97,302                 200,328                 308,158                 232,582
<TOTAL-REVENUES>                                97,302                 200,328                 308,158                 232,582
<CGS>                                           64,755                 133,342                 204,655                 160,061
<TOTAL-COSTS>                                   88,775                 182,267                 278,054                 274,027
<OTHER-EXPENSES>                                     0                       0                       0                       0
<LOSS-PROVISION>                                     0                       0                       0                       0
<INTEREST-EXPENSE>                               6,935                  14,399                  21,845                  18,636
<INCOME-PRETAX>                                  1,592                   3,662                   8,259                (60,081)
<INCOME-TAX>                                       159                     366                     825                       0
<INCOME-CONTINUING>                              1,433                   3,296                   7,434                (60,081)
<DISCONTINUED>                                       0                       0                       0                       0
<EXTRAORDINARY>                                      0                       0                       0                       0
<CHANGES>                                            0                       0                       0                (22,332)
<NET-INCOME>                                     1,433                   3,296                   7,434                (82,413)
<EPS-PRIMARY>                                     0.09                    0.20                    0.44                  (5.15)
<EPS-DILUTED>                                     0.08                    0.19                    0.41                  (5.15)
        

</TABLE>

<PAGE>   1
                                                                    EXHIBIT 99.1

                                  RISK FACTORS

DEPENDENCE UPON CONDITIONS IN THE AIRLINE INDUSTRY

      The Company's principal customers are the world's commercial airlines. As
a result, the Company's business is directly dependent upon the financial
condition of the world's commercial airlines. In the late 1980s and early 1990s,
the world airline industry suffered a severe downturn, which resulted in record
losses and several air carriers seeking protection under bankruptcy laws. As a
consequence, during such period, airlines sought to conserve cash by reducing or
deferring scheduled cabin interior refurbishment and upgrade programs and
delaying purchases of new aircraft. This led to a significant contraction in the
commercial aircraft cabin interior products industry, and a decline in the
Company's business and profitability. The airline industry has experienced an
economic turnaround and the levels of airline spending on refurbishment and new
aircraft purchases have expanded. However, there can be no assurance that the
current financial strength of the airline industry will continue or that the
airlines will maintain or increase expenditures on cabin interior products for
refurbishments or new aircraft.

Recently, turbulence in the financial and currency markets of many Pacific Rim
countries has led to uncertainty with respect to the economic outlook for these
countries. Although not all carriers have been affected by the current economic
events in the Pacific Rim, certain carriers could cancel or defer their existing
orders and future orders from airlines in these countries may be adversely
affected.

NEW PRODUCT INTRODUCTIONS AND TECHNOLOGICAL CHANGE

     Airlines currently are taking delivery of a new generation of aircraft and
demanding increasingly sophisticated cabin interior products. As a result, the
cabin interior configurations of commercial aircraft are becoming more complex
and will require more technologically advanced and integrated products. For
example, airlines increasingly are seeking sophisticated in-flight entertainment
systems, such as the MDDS interactive individual-passenger in-fight
entertainment system developed by B/E. Development of the MDDS required
substantial investment by the Company and third parties in research, development
and engineering. Earnings contributions from this product will depend, to a
significant extent, on the Company's ability to manufacture successfully and
deliver, on a timely basis, its MDDS product and to have the MDDS perform at the
level expected by B/E's customers and their passengers, as well as the Company's
ability to continue to develop, profitability manufacture and deliver, on a
timely basis, other technologically advanced, reliable high-quality products,
which can be readily integrated into complex cabin interior configurations.

COMPETITION

     The Company competes with a number of established companies that have
significantly greater financial, technological and marketing resources than the
Company. Although the Company has achieved a significant share of the market for
a number of its cabin interior products, there can be no assurance that the
Company will be able to maintain this market share. The ability of the Company
to maintain its market share will depend not only on its ability to remain the
supplier of retrofit and refurbishment products and spare parts on the
commercial fleets on which its products are currently in service, but also on
its success in causing its products to be selected for installation in new
aircraft, including next-generation aircraft, expected to be purchased by the
airlines over the next decade, and in avoiding product obsolescence. In
addition, the Company's primary competitors in the market for new passenger
entertainment products, including individual seat video and in-flight
entertainment and cabin management systems, Matsushita Electronics and Rockwell
Collins, have significantly greater technological capabilities and financial and
marketing resources than the Company.

ADVERSE CONSEQUENCES OF FINANCIAL LEVERAGE

     The Company has substantial indebtedness and, as a result, significant debt
service obligations. As of February 28, 1998, the Company had approximately $383
million aggregate amount of indebtedness outstanding, representing 53% of total
capitalization.
<PAGE>   2
     The degree of the Company's leverage could have important consequences to
purchasers or holders of its shares of common stock, including: (i) limiting the
Company's ability to obtain additional financing to fund future working capital
requirements, capital expenditures, acquisitions or other general corporate
requirements; (ii) requiring a substantial portion of the Company's cash flow
from operations to be dedicated to debt service requirements, thereby reducing
the funds available for operations and further business opportunities; and (iii)
increasing the Company's vulnerability to adverse economic and industry
conditions. In addition, since any borrowings under the Company's bank credit
facilities will be at variable rates of interest, the Company will be vulnerable
to increases in interest rates. The Company may incur additional indebtedness in
the future, although its ability to do so will be restricted by the indentures
governing the Company's 9 7/8% Notes, 8% Notes and Bank Credit Facilities. The
ability of the Company to make scheduled payments under its present and future
indebtedness will depend on, among other things, the future operating
performance of the Company and the Company's ability to refinance its
indebtedness when necessary. Each of these factors is to a large extent subject
to economic, financial, competitive and other factors beyond the Company's
control.

     The Company's bank credit facilities and the indentures governing the 9
7/8% Notes and 8% Notes contain numerous financial and operating covenants that
will limit the discretion of the Company's management with respect to certain
business matters. These covenants will place significant restrictions on, among
other things, the ability of the Company to incur additional indebtedness, to
create liens or other encumbrances, to make certain payments and investments,
and to sell or otherwise dispose of assets and merge or consolidate with other
entities. The Company's bank credit facilities also require the Company to meet
certain financial ratios and tests. A failure to comply with the obligations
contained in the Company's bank credit facilities, or the indentures governing
the 9 7/8% Notes and 8% Notes, could result in an event of default under the
Company's Bank Credit Facilities, or the aforementioned indentures, which could
permit acceleration of the related debt and acceleration of debt under other
instruments that may contain cross-acceleration or cross-default provisions.

CUSTOMER DELIVERY REQUIREMENTS

     The commercial aircraft cabin interior products industry is currently
experiencing a period of rapid growth. Since February 1997, the Company has
experienced a 33% increase in its backlog. The ability of the Company to receive
new contract awards and to deliver its existing backlog is dependent upon its
(and its suppliers') ability to ramp-up deliveries to meet the recent surge in
demand. Although the Company believes it has sufficient manufacturing capacity
to meet customer demand, and each of its acquired businesses have previously
delivered products at a significantly higher level, there can be no assurance
that the Company, or its suppliers, will be able to meet the increased product
delivery requirements.

ABILITY TO INTEGRATE ACQUIRED BUSINESSES

     Since 1987, B/E has acquired eleven companies. The Company intends to
consider future strategic acquisitions in the commercial airline cabin interior
industry, some of which could be material to the Company. The ability of the
Company to continue to achieve its goals will depend upon its ability to
integrate effectively the recent and any future acquisitions and to achieve cost
efficiencies. Although B/E has been successful in the past in doing so, there
can be no assurance that the Company will continue to be successful.

REGULATION

     The Federal Aviation Administration (the "FAA") prescribes standards and
licensing requirements for aircraft components, including virtually all
commercial airline cabin interior products, and licenses component repair
stations within the United States. Comparable agencies regulate these matters in
other countries. If the Company fails to obtain a required license for one of
its products or services or loses a license previously granted, the sale of the
subject product or service would be prohibited by law until such license is
obtained or renewed. In addition, designing new products to meet existing FAA
requirements and retrofitting installed products to comply with new FAA
requirements can be both expensive and time-consuming.


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission